]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/calc.texi
Merge from emacs-24; up to 2012-11-15T23:31:37Z!dancol@dancol.org
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / calc.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3 @c smallbook
4 @setfilename ../../info/calc
5 @c [title]
6 @settitle GNU Emacs Calc Manual
7 @setchapternewpage odd
8 @comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
9
10 @include emacsver.texi
11
12 @c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
13 @c @texline foo
14 @c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
15 @c @infoline foo
16 @c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
17
18 @c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
19 @c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
20
21 @iftex
22 @macro texline
23 @end macro
24 @alias infoline=comment
25 @alias expr=math
26 @alias tfn=code
27 @alias mathit=expr
28 @alias summarykey=key
29 @macro cpi{}
30 @math{@pi{}}
31 @end macro
32 @macro cpiover{den}
33 @math{@pi/\den\}
34 @end macro
35 @end iftex
36
37 @ifnottex
38 @alias texline=comment
39 @macro infoline{stuff}
40 \stuff\
41 @end macro
42 @alias expr=samp
43 @alias tfn=t
44 @alias mathit=i
45 @macro summarykey{ky}
46 \ky\
47 @end macro
48 @macro cpi{}
49 @expr{pi}
50 @end macro
51 @macro cpiover{den}
52 @expr{pi/\den\}
53 @end macro
54 @end ifnottex
55
56
57 @tex
58 % Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
59 \gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
60 @end tex
61
62 @c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
63 @iftex
64 @finalout
65 @mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
66 @tex
67 \gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
68
69 \gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
70 \gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
71 \gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
72 \gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
73 @end tex
74 @newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
75 @newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
76 @newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
77 @ignore
78 @newcount@calcpageno
79 @newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
80 @everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
81 @ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
82 @catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
83 \r@ggedbottomtrue
84 \catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
85 @end ignore
86 @end iftex
87
88 @copying
89 @ifinfo
90 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
91 @end ifinfo
92 @ifnotinfo
93 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator, included with
94 GNU Emacs @value{EMACSVER}.
95 @end ifnotinfo
96
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1990-1991, 2001-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 @quotation
100 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
101 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
102 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
103 Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
104 Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
105 Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section
106 entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
107
108 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
109 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
110 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
111 @end quotation
112 @end copying
113
114 @dircategory Emacs misc features
115 @direntry
116 * Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
117 @end direntry
118
119 @titlepage
120 @sp 6
121 @center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
122 @sp 4
123 @center GNU Emacs Calc
124 @c [volume]
125 @sp 5
126 @center Dave Gillespie
127 @center daveg@@synaptics.com
128 @page
129
130 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
131 @insertcopying
132 @end titlepage
133
134
135 @summarycontents
136
137 @c [end]
138
139 @contents
140
141 @c [begin]
142 @ifnottex
143 @node Top, Getting Started, (dir), (dir)
144 @chapter The GNU Emacs Calculator
145
146 @noindent
147 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
148 written by Dave Gillespie that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
149
150 This manual, also written (mostly) by Dave Gillespie, is divided into
151 three major parts: ``Getting Started,'' the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the
152 ``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial introduces all the major aspects of
153 Calculator use in an easy, hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is
154 a complete reference to the features of the Calculator.
155 @end ifnottex
156
157 @ifinfo
158 For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
159 file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
160 longer Info tutorial.)
161 @end ifinfo
162
163 @insertcopying
164
165 @menu
166 * Getting Started:: General description and overview.
167 @ifinfo
168 * Interactive Tutorial::
169 @end ifinfo
170 * Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
171
172 * Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
173 * Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
174 * Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
175 * Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
176 * Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
177 * Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
178 * Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
179 * Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
180 * Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
181 * Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
182 * Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
183 * Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
184 * Keypad Mode:: Operating Calc from a keypad.
185 * Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
186 * Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
187
188 * Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
189 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
190 * Customizing Calc:: Customizing Calc.
191 * Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
192
193 * Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
194
195 * Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
196 * Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
197 * Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
198 * Concept Index:: General concepts.
199 * Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
200 * Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
201 @end menu
202
203 @ifinfo
204 @node Getting Started, Interactive Tutorial, Top, Top
205 @end ifinfo
206 @ifnotinfo
207 @node Getting Started, Tutorial, Top, Top
208 @end ifnotinfo
209 @chapter Getting Started
210 @noindent
211 This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
212 Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
213 and what are the various ways that it can be used.
214
215 @menu
216 * What is Calc::
217 * About This Manual::
218 * Notations Used in This Manual::
219 * Demonstration of Calc::
220 * Using Calc::
221 * History and Acknowledgments::
222 @end menu
223
224 @node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
225 @section What is Calc?
226
227 @noindent
228 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
229 part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
230 series of calculators, its many features include:
231
232 @itemize @bullet
233 @item
234 Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
235
236 @item
237 Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
238
239 @item
240 Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
241 error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
242 and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
243 and algebraic formulas.
244
245 @item
246 Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
247
248 @item
249 Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
250
251 @item
252 Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
253
254 @item
255 Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
256 modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
257
258 @item
259 Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
260
261 @item
262 Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
263
264 @item
265 Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
266 inside any editing buffer.
267
268 @item
269 Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
270
271 @item
272 Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
273 algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
274 @end itemize
275
276 Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
277 large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
278 use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
279 read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
280 first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
281 the program you can learn its additional features. Calc does not
282 have the scope and depth of a fully-functional symbolic math package,
283 but Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and freedom.
284
285 @node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
286 @section About This Manual
287
288 @noindent
289 This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
290 Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices and as
291 a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
292 experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
293 this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
294 regularly.
295
296 This manual is divided into three major parts:@: the ``Getting
297 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial, and the Calc
298 reference manual.
299 @c [when-split]
300 @c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
301 @c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
302 @c chapter.
303
304 If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
305 below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
306 pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
307 will show you everything you need to know to begin.
308 @xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
309
310 The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
311 with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
312 to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
313 beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
314 with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
315 Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
316 to use its features.
317
318 The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
319 the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
320 of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
321 Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
322 need to know.
323
324 @c @cindex Marginal notes
325 Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
326 in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
327 variables also have their own indices.
328 @c @texline Each
329 @c @infoline In the printed manual, each
330 @c paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
331 @c in the margin with its index entry.
332
333 @c [fix-ref Help Commands]
334 You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by pressing
335 the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window, you can press
336 @kbd{C-x * i} to read the manual on-line. From within Calc the command
337 @kbd{h t} will jump directly to the Tutorial; from outside of Calc the
338 command @kbd{C-x * t} will jump to the Tutorial and start Calc if
339 necessary. Pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{C-x * s} will take you directly
340 to the Calc Summary. Within Calc, you can also go to the part of the
341 manual describing any Calc key, function, or variable using
342 @w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v}, respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
343
344 @ifnottex
345 The Calc manual can be printed, but because the manual is so large, you
346 should only make a printed copy if you really need it. To print the
347 manual, you will need the @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free
348 program by Donald Knuth at Stanford University) as well as the
349 @file{texindex} program and @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can
350 be obtained from the FSF as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
351 To print the Calc manual in one huge tome, you will need the
352 source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
353 Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
354 Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
355 source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
356 get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
357 The result will be a device-independent output file called
358 @file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
359 for your system. On many systems, the command is
360
361 @example
362 lpr -d calc.dvi
363 @end example
364
365 @noindent
366 or
367
368 @example
369 dvips calc.dvi
370 @end example
371 @end ifnottex
372 @c Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
373 @c Foundation.
374
375 @node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
376 @section Notations Used in This Manual
377
378 @noindent
379 This section describes the various notations that are used
380 throughout the Calc manual.
381
382 In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
383 the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
384 held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
385 are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
386 Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
387 @key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
388 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
389 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
390 regularly using Emacs.
391
392 (If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
393 the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
394 If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
395 also press @key{ESC} or @kbd{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
396 that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
397
398 Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
399 that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
400 is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
401
402 Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
403 or @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
404 normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{C-x * k} key sequence,
405 but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
406
407 Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
408 are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
409 the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
410 the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
411 be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
412
413 A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
414 [@code{sincos}].
415
416 @node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
417 @section A Demonstration of Calc
418
419 @noindent
420 @cindex Demonstration of Calc
421 This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
422 Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
423 everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
424 Tutorial.
425
426 To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
427 does this), and type @kbd{C-x * c} to start the
428 Calculator. (You can also use @kbd{M-x calc} if this doesn't work.
429 @xref{Starting Calc}, for various ways of starting the Calculator.)
430
431 Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
432 difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
433 @key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
434 Delete, and Space keys.
435
436 @strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
437 then the command to operate on the numbers.
438
439 @noindent
440 Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
441 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
442 @infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
443
444 @noindent
445 Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
446 @texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
447 @infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
448
449 @noindent
450 Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
451
452 @noindent
453 Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
454 Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
455
456 @noindent
457 Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
458
459 @strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
460 conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
461 use the apostrophe key.
462
463 @noindent
464 Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
465 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
466 @infoline the square root of 2+3.
467
468 @noindent
469 Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
470 @texline @math{\pi^2}.
471 @infoline `pi' squared.
472 To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
473
474 @noindent
475 Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
476 result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
477
478 @strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
479 @w{@kbd{C-x * k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
480 the next section.)
481
482 @noindent
483 Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
484 ``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
485
486 @noindent
487 Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @tfn{y^x}.
488
489 @noindent
490 Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
491
492 @noindent
493 Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
494
495 @noindent
496 Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
497 the Keypad Calculator off.
498
499 @strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{C-x * x} if necessary to exit Calc.
500 Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
501 front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
502 then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
503 the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{C-x * i}}, or just
504 type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{C-x * g} to
505 ``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
506
507 @example
508 @group
509 1.23 1.97
510 1.6 2
511 1.19 1.08
512 @end group
513 @end example
514
515 @noindent
516 The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
517 Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
518
519 @noindent
520 Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
521 the product of the numbers.
522
523 @noindent
524 You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
525 the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
526 the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{C-x * r}.
527
528 @noindent
529 Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
530 @texline @math{3\times2}
531 @infoline 3x2
532 matrix into a
533 @texline @math{2\times3}
534 @infoline 2x3
535 matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
536 vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
537 of the two original columns. (There is also a special
538 grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{C-x * :}.)
539
540 @strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
541 Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
542 Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
543
544 @strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
545 time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
546 @kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
547 many weeks have passed since then.
548
549 @strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
550 or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
551 to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
552 (Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
553 in @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
554 these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
555
556 @noindent
557 Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
558 Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
559 to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
560 and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the @LaTeX{} typesetting
561 system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
562
563 @noindent
564 Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
565 (That's the letter @kbd{l}, not the numeral @kbd{1}.)
566
567 @ifnotinfo
568 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
569 manual. Type @kbd{C-x * c} to return to Calc after each of these
570 commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
571 @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
572 @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
573 @end ifnotinfo
574 @ifinfo
575 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
576 manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{C-x * c}, to
577 return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
578 about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
579 @code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
580 @end ifinfo
581
582 Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
583 To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again.
584
585 @node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgments, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
586 @section Using Calc
587
588 @noindent
589 Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
590 different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
591 there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
592
593 @menu
594 * Starting Calc::
595 * The Standard Interface::
596 * Quick Mode Overview::
597 * Keypad Mode Overview::
598 * Standalone Operation::
599 * Embedded Mode Overview::
600 * Other C-x * Commands::
601 @end menu
602
603 @node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
604 @subsection Starting Calc
605
606 @noindent
607 On most systems, you can type @kbd{C-x *} to start the Calculator.
608 The key sequence @kbd{C-x *} is bound to the command @code{calc-dispatch},
609 which can be rebound if convenient (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
610
611 When you press @kbd{C-x *}, Emacs waits for you to press a second key to
612 complete the command. In this case, you will follow @kbd{C-x *} with a
613 letter (upper- or lower-case, it doesn't matter for @kbd{C-x *}) that says
614 which Calc interface you want to use.
615
616 To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{C-x * c}. To get
617 Keypad mode, type @kbd{C-x * k}. Type @kbd{C-x * ?} to get a brief
618 list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
619 a complete list.
620
621 To ease typing, @kbd{C-x * *} also works to start Calc. It starts the
622 same interface (either @kbd{C-x * c} or @w{@kbd{C-x * k}}) that you last
623 used, selecting the @kbd{C-x * c} interface by default.
624
625 If @kbd{C-x *} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
626 commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
627 @w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
628 (that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
629 type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
630
631 The same commands (like @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}) that start
632 the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
633
634 @node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
635 @subsection The Standard Calc Interface
636
637 @noindent
638 @cindex Standard user interface
639 Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
640 operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}
641 to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
642 with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
643
644 @smallexample
645 @group
646
647 ...
648 --**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
649 --- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calculator Trail
650 2: 17.3 | 17.3
651 1: -5 | 3
652 . | 2
653 | 4
654 | * 8
655 | ->-5
656 |
657 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%*- *Calc Trail*
658 @end group
659 @end smallexample
660
661 In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
662 ``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
663 actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
664 called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
665 @dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
666 calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
667 record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
668 a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
669 you do.
670
671 In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
672 were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
673 multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
674 (The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
675 The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
676
677 Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
678 there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
679 the trail and retrieve any previous result.
680
681 Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
682 Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
683 letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
684 commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
685 @kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
686 the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
687 ``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
688
689 There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
690 window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
691 @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
692 inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
693 cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
694 as Calc commands.
695
696 When you quit by pressing @kbd{C-x * c} a second time, the Calculator
697 windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
698 hidden. When you press @kbd{C-x * c} once again you will get the
699 same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
700 Calculator.
701
702 The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
703 Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{C-x * c} will give you
704 a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
705 you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
706 One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
707 Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
708 always treat @kbd{C-x * *} the same as @kbd{C-x * c}.
709
710 The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
711
712 If you type @kbd{C-x * b} first and then @kbd{C-x * c}, you get a
713 full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
714 trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
715 Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again to quit,
716 the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{C-x * b} key
717 switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
718 normal partial-screen mode.
719
720 Finally, @kbd{C-x * o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x * c}
721 except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
722 editing before remains selected instead. If you are in a Calc window,
723 then @kbd{C-x * o} will switch you out of it, being careful not to
724 switch you to the Calc Trail window. So @kbd{C-x * o} is a handy
725 way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; you can then
726 type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
727
728 @node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
729 @subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
730
731 @noindent
732 @dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
733 full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{C-x * q}
734 (@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
735
736 Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
737 standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
738 the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
739 in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
740 were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{C-x * q}
741 again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
742 will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
743 at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
744
745 Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
746 go into regular Calc (with @kbd{C-x * c}) to change the mode settings.
747
748 @c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
749 @xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
750
751 @node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
752 @subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
753
754 @noindent
755 @dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
756 It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
757 don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
758 arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
759
760 Type @kbd{C-x * k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
761 get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
762 instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
763 Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
764
765 @tex
766 \dimen0=\pagetotal%
767 \advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
768 \ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
769 \medskip
770 @end tex
771 @smallexample
772 @group
773 |--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
774 |2: 17.3
775 |1: -5
776 | .
777 |--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
778 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
779 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
780 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
781 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
782 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
783 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
784 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
785 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
786 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
787 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
788 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
789 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
790 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
791 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
792 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
793 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
794 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
795 @end group
796 @end smallexample
797
798 Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
799 is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
800 commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
801 always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
802 standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
803 often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
804
805 To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
806 keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
807 shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
808 add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
809 the stack).
810
811 If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
812 keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
813 math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
814 numbers.
815
816 Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
817 the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
818 this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
819 keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
820 explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
821
822 If you press @kbd{C-x * b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
823 (@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
824 left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
825
826 @c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
827 @xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
828
829 @node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
830 @subsection Standalone Operation
831
832 @noindent
833 @cindex Standalone Operation
834 If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
835 you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
836 can give the commands:
837
838 @example
839 emacs -f full-calc
840 @end example
841
842 @noindent
843 or
844
845 @example
846 emacs -f full-calc-keypad
847 @end example
848
849 @noindent
850 which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * c}) or
851 a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * k}).
852 In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
853 @kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
854 itself.
855
856 @node Embedded Mode Overview, Other C-x * Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
857 @subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
858
859 @noindent
860 @dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
861 editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
862 document like this:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @group
866 The derivative of
867
868 ln(ln(x))
869
870 is
871 @end group
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
876 you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
877 do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
878 you want the result to be, leaving a blank line before and after the
879 formula:
880
881 @smallexample
882 @group
883 The derivative of
884
885 ln(ln(x))
886
887 is
888
889 ln(ln(x))
890 @end group
891 @end smallexample
892
893 Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{C-x * e}.
894 Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to tell
895 how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly) onto the Calc
896 stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the editing buffer, but
897 the line with the formula will now appear as it would on the Calc stack
898 (in this case, it will be left-aligned) and the buffer's mode line will
899 change to look like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like
900 @samp{12 Deg} and so on). Even though you are still in your editing
901 buffer, the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
902 you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take the
903 derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
904
905 @smallexample
906 @group
907 The derivative of
908
909 ln(ln(x))
910
911 is
912
913 1 / x ln(x)
914 @end group
915 @end smallexample
916
917 (Note that by default, Calc gives division lower precedence than multiplication,
918 so that @samp{1 / x ln(x)} is equivalent to @samp{1 / (x ln(x))}.)
919
920 To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
921 the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
922
923 @smallexample
924 @group
925 The derivative of
926
927 ln(ln(x))
928
929 is
930 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
931 % [calc-mode: language: big]
932
933 1
934 -------
935 x ln(x)
936 @end group
937 @end smallexample
938
939 Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
940 that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
941 in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
942 @LaTeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
943 to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
944 out of the way.)
945
946 As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
947 righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
948
949 @smallexample
950 @group
951 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
952 % [calc-mode: language: big]
953 % [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
954
955 1
956 ------- (1)
957 ln(x) x
958 @end group
959 @end smallexample
960
961 To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{C-x * e} again. The mode line
962 and keyboard will revert to the way they were before.
963
964 The related command @kbd{C-x * w} operates on a single word, which
965 generally means a single number, inside text. It searches for an
966 expression which ``looks'' like a number containing the point.
967 Here's an example of its use (before you try this, remove the Calc
968 annotations or use a new buffer so that the extra settings in the
969 annotations don't take effect):
970
971 @smallexample
972 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
973 @end smallexample
974
975 Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{C-x * w} to enable
976 Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
977 and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
978 then @w{@kbd{C-x * w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
979
980 @smallexample
981 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
982 @end smallexample
983
984 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
985 @xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
986
987 @node Other C-x * Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
988 @subsection Other @kbd{C-x *} Commands
989
990 @noindent
991 Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{C-x * g} and @kbd{C-x * r},
992 which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
993 Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
994 a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
995 cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
996
997 The @kbd{C-x * g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
998 top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
999 of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
1000 user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
1001 to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
1002 @kbd{C-u C-x * g} interprets the region as a single number or
1003 formula.
1004
1005 The @kbd{C-x * r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1006 mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1007 is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1008
1009 Complementary to these is @kbd{C-x * y}, which ``yanks'' the
1010 value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1011 If you type @w{@kbd{C-x * y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1012 yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{C-x * y} while
1013 in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1014 editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1015 to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1016 is something on the Calc stack.
1017
1018 Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{C-x *} commands.
1019 The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1020 following @kbd{C-x *}.
1021
1022 @noindent
1023 Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1024
1025 @table @kbd
1026 @item *
1027 Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1028
1029 @item =, +, -, /, \, &, #
1030 Alternatives for @kbd{*}.
1031
1032 @item C
1033 Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1034 interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1035 in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1036
1037 @item O
1038 Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1039 Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1040 move it out of that window.
1041
1042 @item B
1043 Control whether @kbd{C-x * c} and @kbd{C-x * k} use the full screen.
1044
1045 @item Q
1046 Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1047
1048 @item K
1049 Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1050
1051 @item E
1052 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1053
1054 @item J
1055 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1056
1057 @item W
1058 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1059
1060 @item Z
1061 Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1062
1063 @item X
1064 Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1065 (This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1066 @end table
1067 @iftex
1068 @sp 2
1069 @end iftex
1070
1071 @noindent
1072 Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1073
1074 @table @kbd
1075 @item G
1076 Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1077
1078 @item R
1079 Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1080
1081 @item :
1082 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1083
1084 @item _
1085 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1086
1087 @item Y
1088 Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1089 @end table
1090 @iftex
1091 @sp 2
1092 @end iftex
1093
1094 @noindent
1095 Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1096
1097 @table @kbd
1098 @item A
1099 ``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1100 contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1101 so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1102
1103 @item D
1104 Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1105 the duplicate.
1106
1107 @item F
1108 Insert a new formula at the current point.
1109
1110 @item N
1111 Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1112
1113 @item P
1114 Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1115
1116 @item U
1117 Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1118
1119 @item `
1120 Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1121 @end table
1122 @iftex
1123 @sp 2
1124 @end iftex
1125
1126 @noindent
1127 Miscellaneous commands:
1128
1129 @table @kbd
1130 @item I
1131 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1132 (This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1133
1134 @item T
1135 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1136
1137 @item S
1138 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1139
1140 @item L
1141 Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1142 are loaded only as they are needed.)
1143
1144 @item M
1145 Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1146 and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1147
1148 @item 0
1149 (This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1150 its initial state: Empty stack, and initial mode settings.
1151 @end table
1152
1153 @node History and Acknowledgments, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1154 @section History and Acknowledgments
1155
1156 @noindent
1157 Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1158 in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1159 the value of
1160 @texline @math{2^{32}}.
1161 @infoline @expr{2^32}.
1162 I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1163 @code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1164 question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1165 digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1166 was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1167 all.
1168
1169 I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1170 and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1171 all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1172 got too far out of hand.
1173
1174 To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1175 solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1176 turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1177
1178 Emacs Lisp didn't have built-in floating point math (now it does), so
1179 this had to be simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers would
1180 only comfortably fit six decimal digits or so (at the time)---not
1181 enough for a decent calculator. So I had to write my own
1182 high-precision integer code as well, and once I had this I figured
1183 that arbitrary-size integers were just as easy as large integers.
1184 Arbitrary floating-point precision was the logical next step. Also,
1185 since the large integer arithmetic was there anyway it seemed only
1186 fair to give the user direct access to it, which in turn made it
1187 practical to support fractions as well as floats. All these features
1188 inspired me to look around for other data types that might be worth
1189 having.
1190
1191 Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1192 calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1193 numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I
1194 decided that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once
1195 things had gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at
1196 serious algebra systems for further ideas. Since these systems did
1197 far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided to focus on
1198 rewrite rules and other programming features so that users could
1199 implement what they needed for themselves.
1200
1201 Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1202 format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1203 was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1204
1205 Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1206 bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1207 including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1208
1209 Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1210 Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1211 expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1212 idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1213 back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1214 algebra system for microcomputers.
1215
1216 Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1217 features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1218 who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1219 rules, and many other algebra features;
1220 @texline Fran\c{c}ois
1221 @infoline Francois
1222 Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1223 as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1224 Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1225 errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1226 Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1227 algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
1228 Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Juha
1229 Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
1230 parts; Bob Weiner, who helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port; and
1231 Robert J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises as
1232 well as many other things.
1233
1234 @cindex Bibliography
1235 @cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1236 @cindex Numerical Recipes
1237 @c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1238 Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1239 of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1240 Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1241 and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis
1242 for the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham,
1243 Knuth, and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the
1244 @emph{CRC Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and
1245 Abramowitz and Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical
1246 Functions}. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written without
1247 the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil Lewis and
1248 Dan LaLiberte.
1249
1250 Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1251 of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1252 finished in two weeks.
1253
1254 @c [tutorial]
1255
1256 @ifinfo
1257 @c This node is accessed by the `C-x * t' command.
1258 @node Interactive Tutorial, Tutorial, Getting Started, Top
1259 @chapter Tutorial
1260
1261 @noindent
1262 Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1263
1264 Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1265 section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1266 for this).
1267
1268 Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1269 If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1270 or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1271 go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1272
1273 Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1274 appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1275 the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1276 you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1277 @kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1278
1279 You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1280
1281 Press the number @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
1282
1283 @menu
1284 * Tutorial::
1285 @end menu
1286
1287 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Interactive Tutorial, Top
1288 @end ifinfo
1289 @ifnotinfo
1290 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1291 @end ifnotinfo
1292 @chapter Tutorial
1293
1294 @noindent
1295 This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1296 a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1297 work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1298 If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1299 @c [not-split]
1300 to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1301 @c [when-split]
1302 @c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1303
1304 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1305 This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1306 The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1307 self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1308 the Embedded mode interface.
1309
1310 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1311 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. Press
1312 @kbd{C-x * t} to set this up; the on-line tutorial will be opened in the
1313 current window and Calc will be started in another window. From the
1314 Info window, the command @kbd{C-x * c} can be used to switch to the Calc
1315 window and @kbd{C-x * o} can be used to switch back to the Info window.
1316 (If you have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead; in
1317 that case you only need to press @kbd{C-x * c} to start Calc.)
1318
1319 This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1320 manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1321 does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1322 general areas.
1323
1324 @ifnottex
1325 You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1326 it as you learn Calc. @xref{About This Manual}, to see how to make a
1327 printed summary. @xref{Summary}.
1328 @end ifnottex
1329 @iftex
1330 The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1331 space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1332 Calc.
1333 @end iftex
1334
1335 @menu
1336 * Basic Tutorial::
1337 * Arithmetic Tutorial::
1338 * Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1339 * Types Tutorial::
1340 * Algebra Tutorial::
1341 * Programming Tutorial::
1342
1343 * Answers to Exercises::
1344 @end menu
1345
1346 @node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1347 @section Basic Tutorial
1348
1349 @noindent
1350 In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1351 work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1352 to control various modes of the Calculator.
1353
1354 @menu
1355 * RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1356 * Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1357 * Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1358 * Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1359 @end menu
1360
1361 @node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1362 @subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1363
1364 @cindex RPN notation
1365 @noindent
1366 @ifnottex
1367 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1368 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1369 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1370 Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1371 @end ifnottex
1372 @tex
1373 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1374 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1375 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1376 Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1377 @end tex
1378
1379 The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1380 calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1381 added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1382 from the top of the stack.
1383
1384 @cindex Operators
1385 @cindex Operands
1386 In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1387 and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1388 enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1389 number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1390 When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1391 number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1392
1393 Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1394 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1395 the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1396 you wish; type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1397 @kbd{C-x * c} again or @kbd{C-x * o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1398 The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1399 The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1400 and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1401 will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1402
1403 @smallexample
1404 @group
1405 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1406 . 1: 3 .
1407 .
1408
1409 C-x * c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1410 @end group
1411 @end smallexample
1412
1413 The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1414 Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1415 the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1416 less distracting in regular use.
1417
1418 @cindex Stack levels
1419 @cindex Levels of stack
1420 The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1421 numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1422 @expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1423 as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1424 stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1425 which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1426 work on the top few levels of the stack.
1427
1428 @c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1429 The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1430 it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1431 cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1432 view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1433 before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1434 upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1435 commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1436 we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1437 if you are interested.
1438
1439 You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1440 @key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1441 other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1442 automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1443 Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1444
1445 Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1446 stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1447
1448 @smallexample
1449 @group
1450 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1451 . 1: 3 .
1452 .
1453
1454 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1455 @end group
1456 @end smallexample
1457
1458 @noindent
1459 Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1460 with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1461 press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1462
1463 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1464 at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1465 are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1466 include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1467 reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1468 exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1469 return to where you were.)
1470
1471 @noindent
1472 Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1473 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1474 multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1475 if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1476
1477 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1478 @texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.5) + {5\over4}}
1479 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1480 using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1481
1482 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1483 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1484 regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1485 top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1486 the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1487 in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1488 results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1489 In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1490 clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1491
1492 (It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1493 whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1494 spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1495
1496 Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1497 stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1498 the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1499 So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1500 will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1501
1502 You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1503 the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1504 from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1505
1506 @cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1507 If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1508 is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1509
1510 @smallexample
1511 @group
1512 1: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1513 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1514 . .
1515
1516 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1517 @end group
1518 @end smallexample
1519
1520 @noindent
1521 (Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1522 to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1523
1524 The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1525 as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1526 the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1527
1528 @cindex Exchanging stack entries
1529 Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1530 two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1531 to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1532 was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1533
1534 @smallexample
1535 @group
1536 1: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1537 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1538 . .
1539
1540 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1541 @end group
1542 @end smallexample
1543
1544 @noindent
1545 Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1546
1547 @smallexample
1548 @group
1549 1: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1550 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1551 . 1: 3 .
1552 .
1553
1554 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1555 @end group
1556 @end smallexample
1557
1558 A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1559 @key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1560 bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1561
1562 @smallexample
1563 @group
1564 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1565 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1566 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1567 . . .
1568
1569 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1570 @end group
1571 @end smallexample
1572
1573 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1574 on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1575 without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1576 one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1577
1578 Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1579 arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1580 @kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1581 think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1582
1583 @smallexample
1584 @group
1585 1: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1586 . . 1: 16 . .
1587 .
1588
1589 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1590 @end group
1591 @end smallexample
1592
1593 @noindent
1594 (Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1595 typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1596
1597 @cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1598 Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1599 right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1600 @kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1601 We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1602
1603 @smallexample
1604 @group
1605 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1606 . 1: 4 .
1607 .
1608
1609 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1610 @end group
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1614 gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1615 like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1616 prefix for you:
1617
1618 @smallexample
1619 @group
1620 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1621 . 1: 4 .
1622 .
1623
1624 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1625 @end group
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1629
1630 @smallexample
1631 @group
1632 1: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1633 . . .
1634
1635 4 @key{RET} n Q
1636 @end group
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @noindent
1640 The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1641 Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1642 Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1643 @expr{(a, b)} notation.
1644
1645 If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1646 feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1647 errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1648 taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1649 complex result.)
1650
1651 Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1652 @kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1653
1654 @smallexample
1655 @group
1656 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1657 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1658 . .
1659
1660 ( 2 , 3 )
1661 @end group
1662 @end smallexample
1663
1664 You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1665 However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1666
1667 @smallexample
1668 @group
1669 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1670 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1671 . 1: 3 . .
1672 .
1673 (error)
1674 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1675 @end group
1676 @end smallexample
1677
1678 @noindent
1679 Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1680 produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1681
1682 Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1683 moved around by the regular stack commands.
1684
1685 @smallexample
1686 @group
1687 2: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
1688 1: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1689 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1690 . . .
1691
1692 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1693 @end group
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 @noindent
1697 Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1698 When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1699 entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1700 to use the comma. It's up to you.
1701
1702 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1703 your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1704 (Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1705 keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1706 @xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1707
1708 Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1709 brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1710 the tutorial.
1711
1712 Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1713 typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1714 awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1715 necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1716 @kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1717 prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1718 on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1719
1720 @smallexample
1721 @group
1722 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1723 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1724 . 1: 30 1: 30
1725 . .
1726
1727 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1728 @end group
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1732 prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1733 negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1734 argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1735 the second-to-top element of the stack:
1736
1737 @smallexample
1738 @group
1739 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1740 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1741 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1742 . . 1: 20
1743 .
1744
1745 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1746 @end group
1747 @end smallexample
1748
1749 @cindex Clearing the stack
1750 @cindex Emptying the stack
1751 Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1752 (The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1753 entire stack.)
1754
1755 @node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1756 @subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1757
1758 @noindent
1759 If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1760 Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1761 non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1762 in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1763
1764 @strong{Notice:} Calc gives @samp{/} lower precedence than @samp{*}, so
1765 that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}; this is not
1766 standard across all computer languages. See below for details.
1767
1768 You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1769 You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1770 key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1771 The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1772 If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1773 computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1774 @key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1775
1776 Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1777 The result should be the number 9.
1778
1779 Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1780 @samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1781 of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1782 evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1783 @samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1784
1785 @example
1786 2 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1787 @end example
1788
1789 @noindent
1790 is equivalent to
1791
1792 @example
1793 2 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1794 @end example
1795
1796 @noindent
1797 or, in large mathematical notation,
1798
1799 @ifnottex
1800 @example
1801 @group
1802 3 * 4 * 5
1803 2 + --------- - 9
1804 8
1805 6 * 7
1806 @end group
1807 @end example
1808 @end ifnottex
1809 @tex
1810 \beforedisplay
1811 $$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1812 \afterdisplay
1813 @end tex
1814
1815 @noindent
1816 The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1817
1818 Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1819 except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
1820 example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
1821 can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
1822
1823 Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
1824 that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
1825 equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
1826 to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
1827
1828 If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
1829 Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
1830 when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
1831 mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
1832 should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
1833
1834 Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
1835
1836 In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
1837 entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
1838 key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
1839 an algebraic entry.
1840
1841 Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
1842 must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
1843 the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
1844 @code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
1845 the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
1846
1847 Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
1848 be @expr{0.16227766017}.
1849
1850 Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
1851 the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
1852 out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
1853 command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
1854 rule to use!
1855
1856 Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
1857 form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
1858 distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
1859
1860 Still in Algebraic mode, type:
1861
1862 @smallexample
1863 @group
1864 1: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
1865 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
1866 . .
1867
1868 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
1869 @end group
1870 @end smallexample
1871
1872 Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
1873 an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
1874 after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
1875
1876 (You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
1877 mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
1878 though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
1879 Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
1880 normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
1881 to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
1882 mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
1883
1884 If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
1885
1886 Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
1887 In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
1888 use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
1889 use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
1890 intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
1891 accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
1892 of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
1893 In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
1894 of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
1895 @texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
1896 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
1897 which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
1898 @kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
1899
1900 @smallexample
1901 @group
1902 1: 8 1: 9 1: 3
1903 . . .
1904
1905 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
1906 @end group
1907 @end smallexample
1908
1909 @noindent
1910 Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
1911 because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
1912
1913 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
1914 pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
1915 if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
1916 @xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1917
1918 The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
1919 entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
1920
1921 Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
1922 variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
1923 @key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
1924 @kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
1925 on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
1926 stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
1927 or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
1928
1929 @smallexample
1930 @group
1931 1: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
1932 . . .
1933
1934 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
1935 @end group
1936 @end smallexample
1937
1938 @noindent
1939 The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
1940 variables by the values that were stored in them.
1941
1942 For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
1943 stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
1944 or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
1945
1946 @smallexample
1947 @group
1948 1: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
1949 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
1950 . 1: 2 .
1951 .
1952
1953 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
1954 @end group
1955 @end smallexample
1956
1957 If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
1958 get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
1959 They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
1960 @code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
1961 simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
1962 @kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
1963
1964 Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
1965 values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
1966
1967 @smallexample
1968 @group
1969 1: 2 a + 2 b 1: 2 b + 34
1970 . .
1971
1972 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
1973 @end group
1974 @end smallexample
1975
1976 Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
1977 alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
1978
1979 @smallexample
1980 @group
1981 1: log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3) + 2
1982 .
1983
1984 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
1985 @end group
1986 @end smallexample
1987
1988 @noindent
1989 In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
1990 calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
1991 undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
1992 is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
1993 fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
1994 ``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
1995 Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
1996 have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
1997 ``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
1998 automatically displays the first message only if the message is
1999 sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
2000 of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
2001 report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2002 will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2003
2004 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2005 stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2006 @samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2007 expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2008 @xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2009
2010 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2011 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2012 @xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2013
2014 One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2015 @dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2016 Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2017 the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2018 command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2019 the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2020 between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2021 the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2022
2023 @smallexample
2024 @group
2025 2: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
2026 1: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2027 . .
2028
2029 ' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2030 @end group
2031 @end smallexample
2032
2033 @noindent
2034 Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2035 @samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2036 were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2037 set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2038 to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2039
2040 You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2041
2042 @smallexample
2043 @group
2044 2: 2 + 5 => 5
2045 1: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2046 .
2047
2048 s u a @key{RET}
2049 @end group
2050 @end smallexample
2051
2052 We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2053 when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2054
2055 @node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2056 @subsection Undo and Redo
2057
2058 @noindent
2059 If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2060 the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2061 and restart Calc (@kbd{C-x * * C-x * *}) to make sure things start off
2062 with a clean slate. Now:
2063
2064 @smallexample
2065 @group
2066 1: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2067 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2068 . .
2069
2070 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2071 @end group
2072 @end smallexample
2073
2074 You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2075 all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2076 above example, you could type:
2077
2078 @smallexample
2079 @group
2080 1: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2081 . 1: 3 .
2082 .
2083 (error)
2084 U U U U
2085 @end group
2086 @end smallexample
2087
2088 You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2089 mistakenly.
2090
2091 @smallexample
2092 @group
2093 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2094 . 1: 3 . .
2095 .
2096 (error)
2097 D D D D
2098 @end group
2099 @end smallexample
2100
2101 @noindent
2102 It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2103 by something other than an undo command.
2104
2105 @cindex Time travel
2106 You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2107 @kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2108 backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2109 reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2110 again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2111 was an earlier undo command.
2112
2113 You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2114 the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2115 did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2116 press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2117
2118 Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2119 undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2120 @kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2121 @samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2122 entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2123 Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2124 @expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2125 stack.
2126
2127 If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2128 went into the trail.
2129
2130 Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2131 a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2132 what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2133 (which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2134 The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2135 the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2136 incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2137 continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2138
2139 To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2140 search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2141 can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2142 remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2143 then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2144
2145 You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2146 the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2147 all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2148 enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2149 two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2150 key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2151 to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2152 anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2153 followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2154 so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2155 You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2156
2157 Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2158
2159 @smallexample
2160 trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2161 @end smallexample
2162
2163 @noindent
2164 The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2165 trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2166 with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2167 that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2168 @kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2169 again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2170 are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2171
2172 When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2173 still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2174 it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2175 was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2176 the prefix.
2177
2178 One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2179 The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2180 directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2181 to edit a stack entry.
2182
2183 Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2184 @cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2185 Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2186 the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2187 press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2188 new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2189 of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2190 during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2191
2192 @node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2193 @subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2194
2195 @noindent
2196 Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2197 your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2198 mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2199 try some of the most common ones here.
2200
2201 Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2202 Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2203
2204 @smallexample
2205 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
2206 @end smallexample
2207
2208 @noindent
2209 Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2210 about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2211 The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
2212 12 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2213 we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2214 leading and trailing zeros.
2215
2216 You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2217 then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2218 then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 @group
2222 1: 0.142857142857
2223 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2224 .
2225 @end group
2226 @end smallexample
2227
2228 Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2229 has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2230 all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2231 Calc has to stop somewhere.
2232
2233 Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2234 Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2235
2236 Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2237 though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2238 we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2239 down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2240 duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2241 key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2242 But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2243
2244 @smallexample
2245 @group
2246 1: 0.142857142857
2247 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2248 3: 1.14285714286
2249 .
2250 @end group
2251 @end smallexample
2252
2253 @noindent
2254 In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2255 digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2256
2257 How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2258 answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2259 @dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2260 that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2261 ``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2262 itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2263 have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2264 If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2265 correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2266 use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2267 arithmetic.
2268
2269 You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2270 floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2271 to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2272
2273 Let's try entering that last calculation:
2274
2275 @smallexample
2276 @group
2277 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2278 . 1: 10000 .
2279 .
2280
2281 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2282 @end group
2283 @end smallexample
2284
2285 @noindent
2286 @cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2287 Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2288 power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2289 number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2290 want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2291
2292 @smallexample
2293 @group
2294 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2295 . 1: 10000. .
2296 .
2297
2298 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2299 @end group
2300 @end smallexample
2301
2302 @cindex Round-off errors
2303 @noindent
2304 Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2305 of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2306 exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2307 a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2308 number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2309 multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2310 power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2311 a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2312 one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2313 out:
2314
2315 @smallexample
2316 @group
2317 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2318 . 1: 10000. .
2319 .
2320
2321 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2322 @end group
2323 @end smallexample
2324
2325 @noindent
2326 @cindex Guard digits
2327 Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2328 calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2329 have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2330 no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2331 accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2332 last place.
2333
2334 @cindex Guard digits
2335 Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2336 precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2337 In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2338 its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2339 afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2340 wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2341 never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2342
2343 What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2344 We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2345 formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2346 @dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2347 notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2348 @kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2349 supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2350 should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2351 onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2352 use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2353 numbers shown here:
2354
2355 @smallexample
2356 @group
2357 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2358 3: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
2359 2: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
2360 1: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2361 . . . . .
2362
2363 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2364 @end group
2365 @end smallexample
2366
2367 @noindent
2368 Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2369 to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2370 five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2371 affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2372 displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2373 of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2374
2375 Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2376 except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2377 a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2378 there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2379
2380 Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2381 in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2382 so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2383 prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2384 mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2385
2386 @smallexample
2387 @group
2388 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2389 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
2390 2: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
2391 1: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2392 . . . . .
2393
2394 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2395 @end group
2396 @end smallexample
2397
2398 @noindent
2399 Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2400 updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2401 causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2402 entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2403 whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2404 format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2405 the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2406
2407 Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2408 of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2409 displayed exactly.
2410
2411 @cindex Large numbers, readability
2412 Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2413 the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2414
2415 @example
2416 2417851639229258349412352
2417 @end example
2418
2419 @noindent
2420 Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2421
2422 @example
2423 2,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2424 @end example
2425
2426 @noindent
2427 Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2428 We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2429 people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2430
2431 @example
2432 24178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2433 @end example
2434
2435 Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2436 First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2437 to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2438
2439 @example
2440 24,17851,63922.9258349412352
2441 @end example
2442
2443 @noindent
2444 The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2445 @kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2446
2447 @example
2448 24,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2449 @end example
2450
2451 If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2452 changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2453
2454 @example
2455 24 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2456 @end example
2457
2458 Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2459 @kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2460 restore the default precision.
2461
2462 Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2463 (Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2464 you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2465 Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2466
2467 @example
2468 16#200000000000000000000
2469 @end example
2470
2471 @noindent
2472 The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2473 Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2474 got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2475 In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2476 form:
2477
2478 @example
2479 2#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2480 @end example
2481
2482 @noindent
2483 We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2484 fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2485 scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2486 stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2487 something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2488 stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2489
2490 You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2491 Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2492 binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2493 lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2494 help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2495
2496 @example
2497 2#101,1111,1110
2498 @end example
2499
2500 Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2501 is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2502 other radix.
2503
2504 Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2505
2506 @example
2507 1,534
2508 @end example
2509
2510 Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2511 just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2512 in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2513 to integers, fractions, and floats.
2514
2515 @cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2516 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2517 as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2518 @samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2519 that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2520 @samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2521 saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2522 @samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2523 @xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2524
2525 @cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2526 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2527 modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2528 a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2529 Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2530 @samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2531 What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2532 work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2533
2534 The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2535 Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2536 modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2537 the way they are actually computed.
2538
2539 The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2540 the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2541 a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2542 angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2543
2544 @smallexample
2545 @group
2546 1: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2547 . . . .
2548
2549 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2550 @end group
2551 @end smallexample
2552
2553 @noindent
2554 The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2555 of 45 degrees is
2556 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2557 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2558 squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2559 roundoff error because the representation of
2560 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2561 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2562 wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2563 in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2564 re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2565
2566 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2567 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2568 of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2569 result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2570 What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2571
2572 To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2573 (The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2574 @cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2575 again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2576 @kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2577
2578 @smallexample
2579 @group
2580 1: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2581 . . .
2582
2583 P 4 / m r S
2584 @end group
2585 @end smallexample
2586
2587 Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2588 either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2589
2590 @smallexample
2591 @group
2592 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2593 . . .
2594
2595 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2596 @end group
2597 @end smallexample
2598
2599 @noindent
2600 Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2601 @texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2602 @infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2603 first in radians, then in degrees.
2604
2605 Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2606 and vice-versa.
2607
2608 @smallexample
2609 @group
2610 1: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2611 . . .
2612
2613 45 c r c d
2614 @end group
2615 @end smallexample
2616
2617 Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2618 dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2619 quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2620 causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2621 number, instead.
2622
2623 @smallexample
2624 @group
2625 2: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
2626 1: 9 . .
2627 .
2628
2629 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2630 @end group
2631 @end smallexample
2632
2633 @noindent
2634 In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2635 In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2636
2637 You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2638 (Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2639 because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2640 elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2641 produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2642 what to do when dividing two integers.
2643
2644 @cindex Fractions vs. floats
2645 @cindex Floats vs. fractions
2646 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2647 why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2648 @xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2649
2650 Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2651 In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2652 again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2653 evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2654 recompute for you.
2655
2656 @smallexample
2657 @group
2658 1: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2659 . . .
2660
2661 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2662 @end group
2663 @end smallexample
2664
2665 @noindent
2666 In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2667 on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2668 again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2669 on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2670 might affect their values.
2671
2672 @node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2673 @section Arithmetic Tutorial
2674
2675 @noindent
2676 In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2677 available in the Calculator.
2678
2679 The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2680 and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2681 and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2682 change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2683
2684 @smallexample
2685 @group
2686 1: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2687 . . . . .
2688
2689 5 & & n n
2690 @end group
2691 @end smallexample
2692
2693 @cindex Binary operators
2694 You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2695 stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2696 pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2697 a negative prefix.
2698
2699 @smallexample
2700 @group
2701 3: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
2702 2: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
2703 1: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2704 . . 1: 10 .
2705 .
2706
2707 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2708 @end group
2709 @end smallexample
2710
2711 @cindex Unary operators
2712 You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2713 stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2714
2715 @smallexample
2716 @group
2717 3: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
2718 2: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
2719 1: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2720 . . .
2721
2722 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2723 @end group
2724 @end smallexample
2725
2726 Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2727 We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2728 ``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2729 integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2730 integer.
2731
2732 @smallexample
2733 @group
2734 7: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
2735 6: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
2736 5: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
2737 4: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
2738 3: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
2739 2: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
2740 1: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2741 . . .
2742
2743 M-7 F U M-7 R
2744 @end group
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2748 common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2749 backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2750 computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2751 the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2752
2753 @smallexample
2754 @group
2755 2: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
2756 1: 100 . 1: 100 .
2757 . .
2758
2759 1234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2760 @end group
2761 @end smallexample
2762
2763 These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2764
2765 @smallexample
2766 @group
2767 2: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
2768 1: 1 . 1: 1 .
2769 . .
2770
2771 3.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2772 @end group
2773 @end smallexample
2774
2775 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2776 frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2777 of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2778 Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2779 provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2780
2781 We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2782 commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2783 @kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2784 logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2785 @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2786
2787 Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2788 identity
2789 @texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2790 @infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2791 We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2792 With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2793
2794 @smallexample
2795 @group
2796 2: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
2797 1: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2798 . . . .
2799
2800 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2801 @end group
2802 @end smallexample
2803
2804 @noindent
2805 (For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2806 You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2807
2808 Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2809 of squares, command.
2810
2811 Another identity is
2812 @texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2813 @infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2814 @smallexample
2815 @group
2816
2817 2: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2818 1: 0.43837 . .
2819 .
2820
2821 U / I T
2822 @end group
2823 @end smallexample
2824
2825 A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
2826 @expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
2827 your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
2828 we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
2829
2830 @smallexample
2831 @group
2832 2: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2833 1: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
2834 . .
2835
2836 U U M-2 n / I T
2837 @end group
2838 @end smallexample
2839
2840 @noindent
2841 How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
2842 loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
2843 is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
2844 can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
2845 computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
2846 Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
2847 to give you a full 360-degree answer.
2848
2849 @smallexample
2850 @group
2851 2: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
2852 1: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
2853 . 1: 0.43837 .
2854 .
2855
2856 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
2857 @end group
2858 @end smallexample
2859
2860 @noindent
2861 The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
2862 point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
2863
2864 The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
2865 ``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
2866 restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
2867 the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
2868 where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
2869 have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
2870 the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
2871 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
2872
2873 A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
2874 except that it is the @emph{difference}
2875 @texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
2876 @infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
2877 that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
2878
2879 @smallexample
2880 @group
2881 2: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
2882 1: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
2883 . . . . .
2884
2885 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
2886 @end group
2887 @end smallexample
2888
2889 @noindent
2890 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2891 Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
2892 the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
2893 numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
2894 place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
2895 error.
2896
2897 We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
2898 say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
2899 enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
2900 0.99999, reasonably close to 1.
2901
2902 Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
2903 a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
2904
2905 @cindex Common logarithm
2906 Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
2907 The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
2908 @expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
2909 prefix.
2910
2911 @smallexample
2912 @group
2913 1: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
2914 . . . .
2915
2916 1000 L U H L
2917 @end group
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 @noindent
2921 First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
2922 and compute a common logarithm instead.
2923
2924 The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
2925 value of @var{b}.
2926
2927 @smallexample
2928 @group
2929 2: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
2930 1: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
2931 . .
2932
2933 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
2934 @end group
2935 @end smallexample
2936
2937 @noindent
2938 Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
2939 the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
2940 1000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
2941 that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
2942 onto the stack.
2943
2944 You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
2945 of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
2946 an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
2947 where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
2948 floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
2949 computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
2950 exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
2951 a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
2952 not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
2953 probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
2954
2955 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
2956 the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
2957 result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2958
2959 The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
2960 and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
2961 which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
2962
2963 @smallexample
2964 @group
2965 1: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
2966 . . . .
2967
2968 100 ! U c f !
2969 @end group
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @noindent
2973 Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
2974 top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
2975 of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
2976 accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
2977 exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
2978 in this case).
2979
2980 If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
2981 factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
2982 @texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
2983 @infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
2984 (which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
2985
2986 @smallexample
2987 @group
2988 3: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
2989 2: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
2990 1: 5. 1: 120.
2991 . .
2992
2993 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
2994 @end group
2995 @end smallexample
2996
2997 @noindent
2998 Here we verify the identity
2999 @texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
3000 @infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
3001
3002 The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3003 @texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3004 is defined by
3005 @texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3006 @infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3007 for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3008 formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3009 @kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3010 large intermediate values.
3011
3012 The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3013 combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3014 coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3015
3016 @smallexample
3017 @group
3018 2: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
3019 1: 20 . .
3020 .
3021
3022 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3023 @end group
3024 @end smallexample
3025
3026 @noindent
3027 You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{V R *} to multiply
3028 together the elements of this vector. The result is the original
3029 number, 30045015.
3030
3031 @cindex Hash tables
3032 Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
3033 10000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3034 of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3035
3036 @smallexample
3037 @group
3038 1: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3039 . . .
3040
3041 10000 k n I k n
3042 @end group
3043 @end smallexample
3044
3045 @noindent
3046 Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
3047 10000.
3048
3049 @c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3050 @xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3051 commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3052 like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3053
3054 @c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3055 @xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3056 on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3057
3058 @node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3059 @section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3060
3061 @noindent
3062 A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3063 Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3064 are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3065 a vector as a list of objects.
3066
3067 @menu
3068 * Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3069 * Matrix Tutorial::
3070 * List Tutorial::
3071 @end menu
3072
3073 @node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3074 @subsection Vector Analysis
3075
3076 @noindent
3077 If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3078 elements, taken pairwise.
3079
3080 @smallexample
3081 @group
3082 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3083 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3084 .
3085
3086 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3087 @end group
3088 @end smallexample
3089
3090 @noindent
3091 Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3092 spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3093 algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3094 vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3095
3096 If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3097 of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3098 of the vectors.
3099
3100 @smallexample
3101 @group
3102 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
3103 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3104 .
3105
3106 r 1 r 2 *
3107 @end group
3108 @end smallexample
3109
3110 @cindex Dot product
3111 The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3112 lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3113 is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3114 specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3115 (absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3116 vector.
3117
3118 @smallexample
3119 @group
3120 3: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
3121 2: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
3122 1: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3123 . .
3124
3125 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3126 @end group
3127 @end smallexample
3128
3129 @noindent
3130 First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3131 we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3132 obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3133 by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3134 The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3135 is about 56 degrees.
3136
3137 @cindex Cross product
3138 @cindex Perpendicular vectors
3139 The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3140 is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3141 angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3142 input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3143 defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3144 our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3145
3146 @smallexample
3147 @group
3148 2: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
3149 1: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3150 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3151 .
3152
3153 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3154 @end group
3155 @end smallexample
3156
3157 @noindent
3158 First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3159 which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3160 by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3161 this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3162
3163 @c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3164 Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3165 Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3166 to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3167 the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3168 prefix keys have this property.)
3169
3170 If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3171 to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3172 that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3173
3174 @smallexample
3175 @group
3176 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
3177 1: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3178 . .
3179
3180 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3181 @end group
3182 @end smallexample
3183
3184 @cindex Normalizing a vector
3185 @cindex Unit vectors
3186 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3187 stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3188 vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3189 direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3190
3191 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3192 at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3193 those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3194 probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3195 Find the average position of the particle.
3196 @xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3197
3198 @node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3199 @subsection Matrices
3200
3201 @noindent
3202 A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3203 This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3204 also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3205 both methods here:
3206
3207 @smallexample
3208 @group
3209 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3210 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3211 . .
3212
3213 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3214 @end group
3215 @end smallexample
3216
3217 @noindent
3218 We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3219
3220 Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3221 better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3222 the second example.
3223
3224 When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3225 the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3226 Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3227 dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3228 of the right matrix.
3229
3230 If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3231 the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3232
3233 @smallexample
3234 @group
3235 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3236 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3237 .
3238
3239 @key{RET} *
3240 @end group
3241 @end smallexample
3242
3243 @noindent
3244 Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3245 of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3246 been left in symbolic form.
3247
3248 We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3249
3250 @smallexample
3251 @group
3252 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3253 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
3254 1: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3255 [ 2, 5 ] .
3256 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3257 .
3258
3259 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3260 @end group
3261 @end smallexample
3262
3263 Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3264 order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3265 matrix, as happened here!
3266
3267 If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3268 single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3269 on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3270 as a row or column as appropriate.
3271
3272 @smallexample
3273 @group
3274 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3275 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
3276 1: [1, 2, 3]
3277 .
3278
3279 r 4 r 1 *
3280 @end group
3281 @end smallexample
3282
3283 Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3284 rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3285 vector.
3286
3287 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3288 of the above
3289 @texline @math{2\times3}
3290 @infoline 2x3
3291 matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3292 to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3293 @xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3294
3295 @cindex Identity matrix
3296 An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3297 diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3298 by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3299 the original matrix.
3300
3301 @smallexample
3302 @group
3303 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3304 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3305 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3306 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3307 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3308 .
3309
3310 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3311 @end group
3312 @end smallexample
3313
3314 If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3315 that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3316 an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3317 inverse of a matrix.
3318
3319 @smallexample
3320 @group
3321 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3322 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3323 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3324 . .
3325
3326 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3327 @end group
3328 @end smallexample
3329
3330 @noindent
3331 The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3332 matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3333 our matrix to make it square.
3334
3335 We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3336
3337 @smallexample
3338 @group
3339 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3340 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3341 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3342 . .
3343
3344 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3345 @end group
3346 @end smallexample
3347
3348 @cindex Systems of linear equations
3349 @cindex Linear equations, systems of
3350 Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3351 Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3352
3353 @ifnottex
3354 @group
3355 @example
3356 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3357 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3358 7a + 6b = 3
3359 @end example
3360 @end group
3361 @end ifnottex
3362 @tex
3363 \beforedisplayh
3364 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3365 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3366 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3367 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3368 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3369 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3370 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3371 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3372 $$
3373 \afterdisplayh
3374 @end tex
3375
3376 @noindent
3377 This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3378
3379 @ifnottex
3380 @group
3381 @example
3382 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3383 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3384 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3385 @end example
3386 @end group
3387 @end ifnottex
3388 @tex
3389 \beforedisplay
3390 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3391 \times
3392 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3393 $$
3394 \afterdisplay
3395 @end tex
3396
3397 We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3398 inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3399
3400 @smallexample
3401 @group
3402 2: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3403 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3404 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3405 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3406 .
3407
3408 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3409 @end group
3410 @end smallexample
3411
3412 @noindent
3413 The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3414 (Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3415 inverse.)
3416
3417 Let's verify this solution:
3418
3419 @smallexample
3420 @group
3421 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3422 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3423 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3424 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3425 .
3426
3427 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3428 @end group
3429 @end smallexample
3430
3431 @noindent
3432 Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3433 the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3434 assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3435 come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3436 don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3437 vectors, use explicit
3438 @texline @math{N\times1}
3439 @infoline Nx1
3440 or
3441 @texline @math{1\times N}
3442 @infoline 1xN
3443 matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3444 vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3445
3446 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3447 vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3448 system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3449 in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3450
3451 @ifnottex
3452 @group
3453 @example
3454 x + a y = 6
3455 x + b y = 10
3456 @end example
3457 @end group
3458 @end ifnottex
3459 @tex
3460 \beforedisplay
3461 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3462 x &+ b y = 10}
3463 $$
3464 \afterdisplay
3465 @end tex
3466
3467 @noindent
3468 @xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3469
3470 @cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3471 @cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3472 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3473 if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3474 there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3475 equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3476 which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3477 you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3478 is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3479 only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3480 on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3481 @ifnottex
3482 @samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3483 @end ifnottex
3484 @tex
3485 $A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3486 @end tex
3487 Now
3488 @texline @math{A^T A}
3489 @infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3490 is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3491 @expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3492 solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3493 of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3494 system:
3495
3496 @ifnottex
3497 @group
3498 @example
3499 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3500 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3501 7a + 6b = 3
3502 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3503 @end example
3504 @end group
3505 @end ifnottex
3506 @tex
3507 \beforedisplayh
3508 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3509 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3510 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3511 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3512 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3513 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3514 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3515 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3516 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3517 $$
3518 \afterdisplayh
3519 @end tex
3520
3521 @noindent
3522 @xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3523
3524 @node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3525 @subsection Vectors as Lists
3526
3527 @noindent
3528 @cindex Lists
3529 Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3530 matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3531 simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3532 command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3533 number.
3534
3535 You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3536
3537 @smallexample
3538 @group
3539 3: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
3540 2: 20 . 2: 20
3541 1: 30 1: 30
3542 . .
3543
3544 M-3 v p v u
3545 @end group
3546 @end smallexample
3547
3548 You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3549 of many copies of a given value:
3550
3551 @smallexample
3552 @group
3553 1: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3554 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3555 . .
3556
3557 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3558 @end group
3559 @end smallexample
3560
3561 You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3562 @dfn{map} command.
3563
3564 @smallexample
3565 @group
3566 1: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3567 . . .
3568
3569 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3570 @end group
3571 @end smallexample
3572
3573 @noindent
3574 In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3575 of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3576 the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3577 vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3578 other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3579 of each element.
3580
3581 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3582 from
3583 @texline @math{2^{-4}}
3584 @infoline @expr{2^-4}
3585 to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3586
3587 You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3588 For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3589 elements in the vector:
3590
3591 @smallexample
3592 @group
3593 1: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3594 . . .
3595
3596 123123 k f V R *
3597 @end group
3598 @end smallexample
3599
3600 @noindent
3601 In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3602 multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3603
3604 We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3605 reduction:
3606
3607 @smallexample
3608 @group
3609 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
3610 1: [7, 6, 0] . .
3611 .
3612
3613 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3614 @end group
3615 @end smallexample
3616
3617 @noindent
3618 Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3619 sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3620 for the dot product as before.
3621
3622 A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3623 @kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3624 a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3625
3626 @smallexample
3627 @group
3628 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3629 . .
3630
3631 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3632 @end group
3633 @end smallexample
3634
3635 Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3636 rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3637 Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3638 for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3639 (if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3640 vector size).
3641
3642 @smallexample
3643 @group
3644 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3645 . .
3646
3647 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3648 @end group
3649 @end smallexample
3650
3651 Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3652 experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3653 ``abbreviated'' like this:
3654
3655 @smallexample
3656 @group
3657 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3658 . .
3659
3660 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3661 @end group
3662 @end smallexample
3663
3664 @noindent
3665 (where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3666 You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3667 even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3668 Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3669 experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3670 fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3671 to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3672
3673 An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3674 to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3675 with the full, unabbreviated value.
3676
3677 @cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3678 @cindex Fitting data to a line
3679 @cindex Line, fitting data to
3680 @cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3681 @cindex Columns of data, extracting
3682 As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3683 using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3684 least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3685 practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3686 of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3687
3688 @smallexample
3689 x y
3690 --- ---
3691 1.34 0.234
3692 1.41 0.298
3693 1.49 0.402
3694 1.56 0.412
3695 1.64 0.466
3696 1.73 0.473
3697 1.82 0.601
3698 1.91 0.519
3699 2.01 0.603
3700 2.11 0.637
3701 2.22 0.645
3702 2.33 0.705
3703 2.45 0.917
3704 2.58 1.009
3705 2.71 0.971
3706 2.85 1.062
3707 3.00 1.148
3708 3.15 1.157
3709 3.32 1.354
3710 @end smallexample
3711
3712 @noindent
3713 If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3714 easiest to press @kbd{C-x * i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3715 the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3716 @kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3717
3718 Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3719 to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3720 (On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3721 Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3722 You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3723 in the Info buffer, type @kbd{C-x * r}. This command
3724 (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3725 the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3726
3727 @smallexample
3728 @group
3729 1: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3730 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3731 @dots{}
3732 @end group
3733 @end smallexample
3734
3735 @noindent
3736 (You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3737 large matrix.)
3738
3739 We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3740 transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3741 just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3742 of row vectors on the stack.
3743
3744 @smallexample
3745 @group
3746 1: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3747 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3748 . .
3749
3750 v t v u
3751 @end group
3752 @end smallexample
3753
3754 @noindent
3755 Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3756
3757 @smallexample
3758 @group
3759 1: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3760 .
3761
3762 t 2 t 1
3763 @end group
3764 @end smallexample
3765
3766 @noindent
3767 (Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3768 stored value from the stack.)
3769
3770 In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3771
3772 @ifnottex
3773 @example
3774 m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3775 @end example
3776 @end ifnottex
3777 @tex
3778 \beforedisplay
3779 $$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3780 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3781 \afterdisplay
3782 @end tex
3783
3784 @noindent
3785 where
3786 @texline @math{\sum x}
3787 @infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3788 represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3789 actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3790 simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3791 this formula uses.
3792
3793 @smallexample
3794 @group
3795 1: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3796 . .
3797
3798 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3799
3800 @end group
3801 @end smallexample
3802 @noindent
3803 @smallexample
3804 @group
3805 1: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3806 . .
3807
3808 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3809 @end group
3810 @end smallexample
3811
3812 @ifnottex
3813 @noindent
3814 These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
3815 respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
3816 @samp{sum(x y)}.)
3817 @end ifnottex
3818 @tex
3819 These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
3820 respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
3821 $\sum x y$.)
3822 @end tex
3823
3824 Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
3825 the length of either of our lists.
3826
3827 @smallexample
3828 @group
3829 1: 19
3830 .
3831
3832 r 1 v l t 7
3833 @end group
3834 @end smallexample
3835
3836 @noindent
3837 (That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
3838
3839 Now we grind through the formula:
3840
3841 @smallexample
3842 @group
3843 1: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
3844 . 1: 566.70919 .
3845 .
3846
3847 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
3848
3849 @end group
3850 @end smallexample
3851 @noindent
3852 @smallexample
3853 @group
3854 2: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
3855 1: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
3856 . 1: 1733.0569 .
3857 .
3858
3859 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
3860 @end group
3861 @end smallexample
3862
3863 That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
3864 be found with the simple formula,
3865
3866 @ifnottex
3867 @example
3868 b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
3869 @end example
3870 @end ifnottex
3871 @tex
3872 \beforedisplay
3873 $$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
3874 \afterdisplay
3875 \vskip10pt
3876 @end tex
3877
3878 @smallexample
3879 @group
3880 1: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
3881 . 1: 21.70658 . .
3882 .
3883
3884 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
3885 @end group
3886 @end smallexample
3887
3888 Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
3889 @texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
3890 @infoline @expr{m x + b},
3891 and compare it with the original data.
3892
3893 @smallexample
3894 @group
3895 1: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
3896 . .
3897
3898 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
3899 @end group
3900 @end smallexample
3901
3902 @noindent
3903 Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
3904 to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
3905 common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
3906 we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
3907
3908 We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
3909 a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
3910
3911 @smallexample
3912 @group
3913 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
3914 . . .
3915
3916 r 2 - V M A V R X
3917 @end group
3918 @end smallexample
3919
3920 @noindent
3921 First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
3922 values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
3923 across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
3924 @kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
3925 operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
3926 @code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
3927 the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
3928 invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
3929 even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
3930
3931 If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
3932 data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
3933 GNUPLOT 3.0 or higher, the following instructions will work regardless
3934 of the kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
3935 may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
3936
3937 Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
3938 vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
3939 command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
3940 plotting of data.
3941
3942 @smallexample
3943 @group
3944 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3945 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3946 .
3947
3948 r 1 r 2 g f
3949 @end group
3950 @end smallexample
3951
3952 If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
3953 of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
3954 out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
3955 graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
3956 display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
3957 Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
3958
3959 Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
3960 @ifinfo
3961 (If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
3962 @kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
3963 replaced by a buffer named @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
3964 will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
3965 @end ifinfo
3966
3967 @smallexample
3968 @group
3969 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3970 1: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
3971 .
3972
3973 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
3974 @end group
3975 @end smallexample
3976
3977 It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
3978 second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
3979 when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
3980
3981 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
3982 least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
3983 points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
3984 different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
3985 to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
3986 @xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3987
3988 @cindex Geometric mean
3989 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
3990 rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{C-x * g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
3991 to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
3992 left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
3993 Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
3994 (The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
3995
3996 @example
3997 2.3 6 22 15.1 7
3998 15 14 7.5
3999 2.5
4000 @end example
4001
4002 @noindent
4003 The @kbd{C-x * g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4004 with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4005 @xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4006
4007 @ifnottex
4008 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4009 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4010 @var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4011 on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4012 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4013 for @expr{n=6}.
4014 @end ifnottex
4015 @tex
4016 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4017 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4018 ${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4019 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4020 for \cite{n=6}.
4021 @end tex
4022
4023 @smallexample
4024 @group
4025 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4026 . .
4027
4028 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4029
4030 @end group
4031 @end smallexample
4032 @noindent
4033 @smallexample
4034 @group
4035 1: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4036 . .
4037
4038 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4039 @end group
4040 @end smallexample
4041
4042 The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4043 to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4044 inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4045 The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4046 substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4047
4048 To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4049 argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4050 equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4051 entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4052 and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4053 would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4054
4055 Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4056 trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4057 @samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4058 The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4059 denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4060 would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4061 @kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4062 trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4063 @w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4064 Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4065 property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4066 it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4067 @samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4068 of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4069 @samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4070
4071 Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4072 the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4073 and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4074 @w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4075
4076 Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4077 vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4078 into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4079 one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4080 element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4081 and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4082
4083 @cindex Divisor functions
4084 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4085 @tex
4086 $\sigma_k(n)$
4087 @end tex
4088 is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4089 integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4090 function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4091 the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4092 @xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4093
4094 @cindex Square-free numbers
4095 @cindex Duplicate values in a list
4096 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4097 list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4098 know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4099 more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4100 keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4101 leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4102 @xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4103
4104 @cindex Triangular lists
4105 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4106 like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4107 command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4108
4109 @smallexample
4110 @group
4111 1: [ [1],
4112 [1, 2],
4113 [1, 2, 3],
4114 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4115 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4116 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4117 @end group
4118 @end smallexample
4119
4120 @noindent
4121 @xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4122
4123 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4124
4125 @smallexample
4126 @group
4127 1: [ [0],
4128 [1, 2],
4129 [3, 4, 5],
4130 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4131 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4132 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4133 @end group
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136 @noindent
4137 @xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4138
4139 @cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4140 @c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4141 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4142 @texline @math{J_1(x)}
4143 @infoline @expr{J1}
4144 function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4145 Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4146 which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4147 i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4148 is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4149 of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4150 @xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4151
4152 @cindex Digits, vectors of
4153 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4154 @texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4155 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4156 for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4157 twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4158 digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4159 add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4160 (since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4161 Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4162 to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4163
4164 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4165 @kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4166 happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4167
4168 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4169 is @cpi{}. The area of the
4170 @texline @math{2\times2}
4171 @infoline 2x2
4172 square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4173 random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4174 the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4175 @cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4176 command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4177 We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4178 @w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4179 this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4180 points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4181 @xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4182
4183 @cindex Matchstick problem
4184 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4185 another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4186 of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4187 onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4188 a line turns out to be
4189 @texline @math{2/\pi}.
4190 @infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4191 Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4192 the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4193 one turns out to be
4194 @texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4195 @infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4196 That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4197 @xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4198
4199 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4200 double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4201 (ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4202 Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4203 which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4204 Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4205 @dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4206 over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4207 any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4208 their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4209 but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4210 One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4211 Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4212 where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4213 we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4214 simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4215 The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4216 511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4217
4218 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4219 commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4220 value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4221 function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4222 and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4223 ``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4224 @expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4225 in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4226 @kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4227 walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4228 (Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4229 sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4230
4231 @node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4232 @section Types Tutorial
4233
4234 @noindent
4235 Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4236 In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4237
4238 The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4239 or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4240 the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4241 and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4242 which can exactly represent any rational number.
4243
4244 @smallexample
4245 @group
4246 1: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4247 . 1: 49 . . .
4248 .
4249
4250 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4251 @end group
4252 @end smallexample
4253
4254 @noindent
4255 The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4256 would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4257 Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4258 since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4259 fraction beginning with 49.
4260
4261 You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4262 @kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4263
4264 @smallexample
4265 @group
4266 1: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4267 . .
4268
4269 c f c F
4270 @end group
4271 @end smallexample
4272
4273 The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4274 ``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4275 same, to within the current precision.
4276
4277 @smallexample
4278 @group
4279 1: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4280 . . . .
4281
4282 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4283 @end group
4284 @end smallexample
4285
4286 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4287 result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4288 product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4289 to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4290
4291 @dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4292
4293 @smallexample
4294 @group
4295 1: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4296 . . . . .
4297
4298 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4299 @end group
4300 @end smallexample
4301
4302 @noindent
4303 The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4304 (@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4305 phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4306 operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4307
4308 Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4309 isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4310 Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4311 i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4312 also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4313 real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4314 algebraic entry.
4315
4316 @smallexample
4317 @group
4318 2: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
4319 1: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4320 . . . .
4321
4322 ' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4323 @end group
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 @noindent
4327 Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4328 number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4329 is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4330 (``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4331 negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4332 leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4333 infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4334 infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4335 the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4336 lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4337 the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4338 So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4339 with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4340
4341 Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4342 Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4343 to turn on Infinite mode.
4344
4345 @smallexample
4346 @group
4347 3: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
4348 2: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
4349 1: 0 . . .
4350 .
4351
4352 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4353 @end group
4354 @end smallexample
4355
4356 @noindent
4357 Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4358 it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4359 @code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4360 @expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4361 plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4362 infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4363 Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4364 That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4365 by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4366 point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4367 unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4368 yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4369 @code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4370 ``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4371 @code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4372 that matter, with anything else.
4373
4374 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4375 for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4376 @samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4377 @samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4378 @xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4379
4380 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4381 which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4382 a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4383 @xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4384
4385 @dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4386 seconds.
4387
4388 @smallexample
4389 @group
4390 1: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4391 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4392 .
4393
4394 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4395 @end group
4396 @end smallexample
4397
4398 HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4399 seconds.
4400
4401 @smallexample
4402 @group
4403 1: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4404 . . . .
4405
4406 0.5 I T c h S
4407 @end group
4408 @end smallexample
4409
4410 @noindent
4411 First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4412 form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4413 functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4414
4415 @cindex Beatles
4416 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
4417 47 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4418 average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4419 Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4420 song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4421
4422 A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4423 be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4424 @samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4425
4426 @smallexample
4427 @group
4428 2: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
4429 1: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4430 .
4431
4432 ' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4433 @end group
4434 @end smallexample
4435
4436 @noindent
4437 In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4438 number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4439 HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4440 date form.
4441
4442 @smallexample
4443 @group
4444 1: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4445 . .
4446
4447 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4448 @end group
4449 @end smallexample
4450
4451 @c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4452 @noindent
4453 The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4454 stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4455 time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4456 does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4457 the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4458 date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4459
4460 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4461 Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4462
4463 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4464 between now and the year 10001 A.D.? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4465
4466 @cindex Slope and angle of a line
4467 @cindex Angle and slope of a line
4468 An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4469 deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4470 a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4471 error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4472 meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4473 pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4474
4475 @smallexample
4476 @group
4477 1: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4478 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4479 .
4480
4481 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4482 @end group
4483 @end smallexample
4484
4485 @noindent
4486 This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4487 original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4488 a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4489
4490 @cindex Torus, volume of
4491 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4492 @texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4493 @infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4494 where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4495 defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4496 itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4497 within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4498 the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4499
4500 An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4501 error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4502 you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4503 our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4504 and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4505
4506 @smallexample
4507 @group
4508 1: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4509 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4510 .
4511
4512 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4513 @end group
4514 @end smallexample
4515
4516 @noindent
4517 If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4518 is sure to lie in the range shown.
4519
4520 The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4521 themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4522 telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4523 make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4524 parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4525 which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4526 the other.
4527
4528 @smallexample
4529 @group
4530 1: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4531 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4532 .
4533
4534 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4535 @end group
4536 @end smallexample
4537
4538 @noindent
4539 The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4540 be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4541 semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4542 or both endpoints.
4543
4544 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4545 @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4546 about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4547 zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4548 @xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4549
4550 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4551 are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4552 answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4553 If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4554 @xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4555
4556 A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4557 For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4558 or 24 hours.
4559
4560 @smallexample
4561 @group
4562 1: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4563 . . . .
4564
4565 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4566 @end group
4567 @end smallexample
4568
4569 @noindent
4570 In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4571 new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4572 number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4573 @var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4574 @var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4575
4576 @smallexample
4577 @group
4578 1: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4579 . . . .
4580
4581 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4582 @end group
4583 @end smallexample
4584
4585 @noindent
4586 These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4587 much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4588 that arises in the second one.
4589
4590 @cindex Fermat, primality test of
4591 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4592 says that
4593 @texline @math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}
4594 @infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4595 if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4596 @expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4597 @emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4598 informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4599 values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4600 are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4601
4602 It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4603 modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4604 For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4605 of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4606
4607 @smallexample
4608 @group
4609 1: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4610 . .
4611
4612 x time @key{RET} n
4613 @end group
4614 @end smallexample
4615
4616 @noindent
4617 This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4618
4619 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4620 is about
4621 @texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4622 @infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4623 seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4624 @xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4625
4626 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4627 for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4628 You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4629 seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4630 of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4631 @xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4632
4633 Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4634 @dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4635 application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4636 suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4637 like centimeters and inches.
4638
4639 @smallexample
4640 @group
4641 1: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4642 . . . .
4643
4644 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4645 @end group
4646 @end smallexample
4647
4648 @noindent
4649 We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4650 which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4651 first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4652 which in this case means meters.
4653
4654 @smallexample
4655 @group
4656 1: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4657 . . . .
4658
4659 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4660
4661 @end group
4662 @end smallexample
4663 @noindent
4664 @smallexample
4665 @group
4666 1: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4667 . . .
4668
4669 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4670 @end group
4671 @end smallexample
4672
4673 @noindent
4674 Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4675 root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4676 algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4677 ``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4678 being interpreted as unit names.
4679
4680 In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4681 units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4682 as its standard unit of length.
4683
4684 There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4685
4686 @smallexample
4687 @group
4688 1: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4689 . . . .
4690
4691 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4692 @end group
4693 @end smallexample
4694
4695 @noindent
4696 We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4697 hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4698 finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4699
4700 Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4701 interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4702 temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4703 units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4704 as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4705 for them.
4706
4707 @smallexample
4708 @group
4709 1: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4710 . . . .
4711
4712 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET}
4713 @end group
4714 @end smallexample
4715
4716 @noindent
4717 First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4718 change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4719 absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius.
4720
4721 For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4722 Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4723 When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4724 numbers are in which units:
4725
4726 @smallexample
4727 @group
4728 1: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4729 . . .
4730
4731 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4732 @end group
4733 @end smallexample
4734
4735 To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4736 @w{@kbd{C-x * c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4737 at the units table.
4738
4739 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4740 in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4741
4742 @cindex Speed of light
4743 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4744 the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4745 Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4746 cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4747 significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4748
4749 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4750 five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4751 Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4752 swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4753 @xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4754
4755 @node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4756 @section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4757
4758 @noindent
4759 This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4760 equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4761 formulas.
4762
4763 @menu
4764 * Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4765 * Rewrites Tutorial::
4766 @end menu
4767
4768 @node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4769 @subsection Basic Algebra
4770
4771 @noindent
4772 If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4773 the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4774 formulas as regular data objects.
4775
4776 @smallexample
4777 @group
4778 1: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (3 x^2 + y) (6 - 2 x^2)
4779 . . .
4780
4781 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4782 @end group
4783 @end smallexample
4784
4785 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4786 @kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4787 Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4788
4789 There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4790 formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4791
4792 @smallexample
4793 @group
4794 1: 18 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y - 2 y x^2 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4795 . .
4796
4797 a x a c x @key{RET}
4798 @end group
4799 @end smallexample
4800
4801 @noindent
4802 First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4803 terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4804
4805 Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4806 is one-half.
4807
4808 @smallexample
4809 @group
4810 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
4811 . .
4812
4813 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
4814 @end group
4815 @end smallexample
4816
4817 @noindent
4818 The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
4819 the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
4820 you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
4821 next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
4822 back to its original value, if any.
4823
4824 (An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
4825 variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
4826 unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
4827 properly.)
4828
4829 @cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
4830 Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
4831 is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
4832 do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
4833 values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
4834 derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
4835 the function has a local maximum there.
4836
4837 @smallexample
4838 @group
4839 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
4840 . .
4841
4842 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
4843 @end group
4844 @end smallexample
4845
4846 @noindent
4847 Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
4848 the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
4849
4850 @smallexample
4851 @group
4852 1: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
4853 . .
4854
4855 ' x @key{RET} / a x
4856
4857 @end group
4858 @end smallexample
4859 @noindent
4860 @smallexample
4861 @group
4862 1: 0.70588 x^2 = 1 1: x = 1.19023
4863 . .
4864
4865 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
4866 @end group
4867 @end smallexample
4868
4869 @noindent
4870 Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
4871
4872 @smallexample
4873 @group
4874 1: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
4875 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
4876 . .
4877
4878 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
4879 @end group
4880 @end smallexample
4881
4882 @noindent
4883 (The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
4884 Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
4885 @w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
4886 to delete the @samp{x}.)
4887
4888 @smallexample
4889 @group
4890 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
4891 1: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
4892 . .
4893
4894 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
4895 @end group
4896 @end smallexample
4897
4898 @noindent
4899 The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
4900 has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
4901 local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
4902
4903 When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
4904 @expr{0.70588 x^2 = 1} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
4905 two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
4906 single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
4907 arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
4908 If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
4909 solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
4910
4911 @smallexample
4912 @group
4913 1: 0.70588 x^2 = 1 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
4914 . . .
4915
4916 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
4917 @end group
4918 @end smallexample
4919
4920 @noindent
4921 Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
4922 it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
4923 the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
4924 If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
4925 negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
4926
4927 To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
4928 into the original formula.
4929
4930 @smallexample
4931 @group
4932 2: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
4933 1: x = 1.19023 s1 .
4934 .
4935
4936 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
4937 @end group
4938 @end smallexample
4939
4940 @noindent
4941 (Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
4942 with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
4943 like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
4944
4945 It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
4946 @code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
4947
4948 @smallexample
4949 @group
4950 2: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
4951 1: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
4952 .
4953
4954 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
4955 @end group
4956 @end smallexample
4957
4958 @noindent
4959 Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
4960 at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
4961 except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
4962 formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
4963 next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
4964 @samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
4965 different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
4966 the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
4967 default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
4968 what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
4969
4970 If there had been several different values, we could have used
4971 @w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
4972
4973 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
4974 @w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
4975 automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
4976 cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
4977 @expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
4978 which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
4979 method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
4980 to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
4981
4982 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
4983 polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
4984 sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
4985 polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
4986 multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
4987 @xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4988
4989 The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
4990 like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
4991 symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
4992 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
4993
4994 @smallexample
4995 @group
4996 2: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
4997 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
4998 . .
4999
5000 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5001 @end group
5002 @end smallexample
5003
5004 One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5005
5006 @smallexample
5007 @group
5008 3
5009 2: 34 x - 24 x
5010
5011 ____ ____
5012 V 51 V 51
5013 1: [-----, -----, 0]
5014 6 -6
5015
5016 .
5017
5018 d B
5019 @end group
5020 @end smallexample
5021
5022 Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5023 are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5024 language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5025 and @LaTeX{} mode.
5026
5027 @smallexample
5028 @group
5029 2: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
5030 1: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5031 . .
5032
5033 d C d F
5034
5035 @end group
5036 @end smallexample
5037 @noindent
5038 @smallexample
5039 @group
5040 3: 34 x - 24 x^3
5041 2: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
5042 1: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5043 .
5044
5045 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5046 @end group
5047 @end smallexample
5048
5049 @noindent
5050 As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5051 formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5052 functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5053 and notations for vectors and matrices.
5054
5055 Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5056 implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5057 like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5058 produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5059 correct.
5060
5061 Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5062 may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5063 are shown in normal mode.)
5064
5065 @cindex Area under a curve
5066 What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5067 This is simply the integral of the function:
5068
5069 @smallexample
5070 @group
5071 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5072 . .
5073
5074 r 1 a i x
5075 @end group
5076 @end smallexample
5077
5078 @noindent
5079 We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5080 One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5081
5082 @smallexample
5083 @group
5084 2: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
5085 1: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5086
5087 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5088 @end group
5089 @end smallexample
5090
5091 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5092 of
5093 @texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5094 @infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5095 (where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5096 integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
5097 3}. (@bullet{})
5098
5099 Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5100 others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5101 under the curve
5102 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5103 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5104 over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5105 @kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5106 long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5107 closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5108
5109 @cindex Integration, numerical
5110 @cindex Numerical integration
5111 One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5112 to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5113 slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5114 We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5115
5116 @smallexample
5117 @group
5118 3: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
5119 2: 1 .
5120 1: 0.1
5121 .
5122
5123 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5124 @end group
5125 @end smallexample
5126
5127 @noindent
5128 (Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5129 also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5130
5131 @smallexample
5132 @group
5133 2: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
5134 1: ln(x) sin(x) .
5135 .
5136
5137 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5138
5139 @end group
5140 @end smallexample
5141 @noindent
5142 @smallexample
5143 @group
5144 1: 3.4195 0.34195
5145 . .
5146
5147 V R + 0.1 *
5148 @end group
5149 @end smallexample
5150
5151 @noindent
5152 (If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5153 to Radians mode?)
5154
5155 Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5156 approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5157 the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5158 of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5159 faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5160 is the same for every box.)
5161
5162 The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5163 we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5164
5165 @smallexample
5166 @group
5167 1: ln(x) sin(x) 1: 0.84147 x + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5168 . .
5169
5170 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5171 @end group
5172 @end smallexample
5173
5174 @noindent
5175 Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5176 about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5177 approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5178
5179 @smallexample
5180 @group
5181 1: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5182 . . .
5183
5184 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5185 @end group
5186 @end smallexample
5187
5188 @noindent
5189 Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5190 in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5191 (Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5192 function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5193 expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5194 of @expr{x=1}.)
5195
5196 @cindex Simpson's rule
5197 @cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5198 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5199 curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5200 of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5201 method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5202 to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5203 @dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5204 that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5205 down to the formula,
5206
5207 @ifnottex
5208 @example
5209 (h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5210 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5211 @end example
5212 @end ifnottex
5213 @tex
5214 \beforedisplay
5215 $$ \displaylines{
5216 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5217 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5218 } $$
5219 \afterdisplay
5220 @end tex
5221
5222 @noindent
5223 where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5224 is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5225 For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5226 method:
5227
5228 @ifnottex
5229 @example
5230 h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5231 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5232 @end example
5233 @end ifnottex
5234 @tex
5235 \beforedisplay
5236 $$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5237 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5238 \afterdisplay
5239 @end tex
5240
5241 Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5242 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5243 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5244 using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5245 @xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5246
5247 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5248 It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5249 of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5250 result until the current precision is satisfied.
5251
5252 @c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5253 Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5254 large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5255 indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5256 of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5257 be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5258 details and examples.
5259
5260 @c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5261 @c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5262
5263 @node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5264 @subsection Rewrite Rules
5265
5266 @noindent
5267 No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5268 there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5269 in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5270 that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5271
5272 Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5273
5274 @smallexample
5275 @group
5276 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2
5277 .
5278
5279 ' 2sec(x)^2/tan(x)^2 - 2/tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s 1
5280 @end group
5281 @end smallexample
5282
5283 @noindent
5284 If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably combine over the common
5285 denominator. The @kbd{a n} algebra command will do this, but we'll do
5286 it with a rewrite rule just for practice.
5287
5288 Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5289
5290 @smallexample
5291 @group
5292 1: (2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2
5293 .
5294
5295 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5296 @end group
5297 @end smallexample
5298
5299 @noindent
5300 (The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5301 by itself the formula @samp{a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x} doesn't do anything,
5302 but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5303 it as a rewrite rule.)
5304
5305 The lefthand side, @samp{a/x + b/x}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5306 rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5307 match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5308 @dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5309 can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5310 the expression @samp{2 sec(x)^2}, the meta-variable @samp{b} matched
5311 the constant @samp{-2} and the meta-variable @samp{x} matched
5312 the expression @samp{tan(x)^2}.
5313
5314 This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5315 First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5316 match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5317 because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5318 denominators.
5319
5320 Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5321 target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5322 the subformula @samp{tan(x)^2}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5323 @samp{x}.
5324
5325 And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5326 properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5327 Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5328 @samp{a = 2 sec(x)^2}, @samp{b = -2}, and @samp{x = tan(x)^2}.
5329
5330 When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5331 that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5332 substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5333 @samp{(2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2}.
5334
5335 @c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5336 We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5337 the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5338 really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5339 we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5340 of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5341
5342 One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5343 @samp{tan(x)^2 + 1 = sec(x)^2}, but of course we must first rearrange
5344 the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5345 would be @samp{@w{2 sec(x)^2 - 2} := 2 tan(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5346 that the rule @samp{sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2} will also work. The
5347 latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5348 situations, too.
5349
5350 @smallexample
5351 @group
5352 1: 2
5353 .
5354
5355 a r sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2 @key{RET}
5356 @end group
5357 @end smallexample
5358
5359 You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5360 have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5361 you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5362 name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5363 use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5364 need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5365 can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5366 having to retype it.
5367
5368 @smallexample
5369 @group
5370 ' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5371 ' sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s t secsqr @key{RET}
5372
5373 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5374 . .
5375
5376 r 1 a r merge @key{RET} a r secsqr @key{RET}
5377 @end group
5378 @end smallexample
5379
5380 To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5381 Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5382 the edited value back into the variable.
5383 You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5384
5385 Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5386 message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5387 optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5388 This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5389 efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5390 only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5391 another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5392 entering them on the fly.
5393
5394 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5395 mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5396 Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying the top and
5397 bottom by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5398 to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5399 rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5400
5401 The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5402 a variable containing a vector of rules.
5403
5404 @smallexample
5405 @group
5406 1: [merge, secsqr] 1: [a/x + b/x := (a + b)/x, ... ]
5407 . .
5408
5409 ' [merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5410
5411 @end group
5412 @end smallexample
5413 @noindent
5414 @smallexample
5415 @group
5416 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5417 . .
5418
5419 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET}
5420 @end group
5421 @end smallexample
5422
5423 @c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5424 Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5425 repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5426 which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5427 the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5428 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5429
5430 Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5431 has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5432 to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5433 only one rewrite at a time.
5434
5435 @smallexample
5436 @group
5437 1: (2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5438 . .
5439
5440 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5441 @end group
5442 @end smallexample
5443
5444 You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5445 of rewrites that occur.
5446
5447 Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5448 with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5449
5450 @smallexample
5451 @group
5452 1: sin(x + 2 pi) + sin(x + 3 pi) + sin(x + 4 pi)
5453 .
5454
5455 ' sin(x+2pi) + sin(x+3pi) + sin(x+4pi) @key{RET}
5456
5457 @end group
5458 @end smallexample
5459 @noindent
5460 @smallexample
5461 @group
5462 1: sin(x + 3 pi) + 2 sin(x)
5463 .
5464
5465 a r sin(a + k pi) := sin(a) :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5466 @end group
5467 @end smallexample
5468
5469 @noindent
5470 (Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5471 which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5472
5473 An interesting point is that the variable @samp{pi} was matched
5474 literally rather than acting as a meta-variable.
5475 This is because it is a special-constant variable. The special
5476 constants @samp{e}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5477 A common error with rewrite
5478 rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5479 to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5480 only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5481
5482 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5483 @ignore
5484 @starindex
5485 @end ignore
5486 @tindex fib
5487 Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5488 Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5489 Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5490 later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5491 the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5492
5493 @smallexample
5494 @group
5495 ' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5496
5497 1: fib(7) 1: 13
5498 . .
5499
5500 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5501 @end group
5502 @end smallexample
5503
5504 One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5505 is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5506 be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5507 first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5508 be used preferentially.
5509
5510 This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5511 formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5512 will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5513 Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5514 fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5515 the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5516 @w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5517
5518 @smallexample
5519 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5520 @end smallexample
5521
5522 @noindent
5523 Now:
5524
5525 @smallexample
5526 @group
5527 1: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: fib(x) + fib(0) + 8
5528 . .
5529
5530 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5531 @end group
5532 @end smallexample
5533
5534 @noindent
5535 We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5536 @w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5537 this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5538 apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5539 variable @code{EvalRules}.
5540
5541 @smallexample
5542 @group
5543 1: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5544 . .
5545
5546 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5547 @end group
5548 @end smallexample
5549
5550 It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5551 more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5552 first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5553
5554 @smallexample
5555 @group
5556 fib(6) =
5557 fib(5) + fib(4) =
5558 fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5559 fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5560 @end group
5561 @end smallexample
5562
5563 @noindent
5564 Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5565 algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5566 them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5567 needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5568 to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5569 @code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5570
5571 @smallexample
5572 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5573 @end smallexample
5574
5575 @noindent
5576 If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5577 that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5578 to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5579 for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5580 example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5581 to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5582
5583 Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5584 type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5585
5586 With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5587 @samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5588 up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5589 computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5590 (and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5591
5592 All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5593 contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5594 un-store the variable.
5595
5596 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5597 a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5598 Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5599 to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5600 @samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5601 @var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5602 rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5603 interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5604 get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5605
5606 There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5607 are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5608 and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5609 could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5610
5611 @example
5612 [fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5613 @end example
5614
5615 @noindent
5616 That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5617 to 1.''
5618
5619 You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5620 For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5621 @samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5622 matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5623 and one for @samp{b}.
5624
5625 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5626 on the stack and tried to use the rule
5627 @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5628 @xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5629
5630 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5631 divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5632 Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5633 is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5634 reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5635 rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5636 is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5637 Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5638 configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5639 Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5640 to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5641 and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5642 vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5643 @xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5644
5645 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5646 @samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5647 @var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5648 is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5649 so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5650 @xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5651
5652 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5653 infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5654 values of @expr{x} near zero.
5655
5656 @ifnottex
5657 @example
5658 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5659 @end example
5660 @end ifnottex
5661 @tex
5662 \beforedisplay
5663 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5664 \afterdisplay
5665 @end tex
5666
5667 The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5668 is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5669 Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5670 Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5671 that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5672
5673 @ifnottex
5674 @example
5675 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5676 @end example
5677 @end ifnottex
5678 @tex
5679 \beforedisplay
5680 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5681 \afterdisplay
5682 @end tex
5683
5684 @noindent
5685 The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5686 if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5687
5688 The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5689 power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5690 For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5691 on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5692 @samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5693 rearranged. (This one is rather tricky; the solution at the end of
5694 this chapter uses 6 rewrite rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)}
5695 condition tests whether @samp{x} is a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer
5696 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5697
5698 Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5699 What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5700 a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5701
5702 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5703
5704 @node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5705 @section Programming Tutorial
5706
5707 @noindent
5708 The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5709 language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5710 anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5711 system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5712 all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5713 times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5714
5715 One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5716 Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5717 key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5718 the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5719 case @kbd{z} prefix.
5720
5721 @smallexample
5722 @group
5723 1: x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 + 1 1: x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 + 1
5724 . .
5725
5726 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5727 @end group
5728 @end smallexample
5729
5730 This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5731 The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5732 say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5733 @kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5734 function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5735 default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5736 answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5737 arguments?''
5738
5739 @smallexample
5740 @group
5741 1: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5742 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5743 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5744 .
5745
5746 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5747 @end group
5748 @end smallexample
5749
5750 @noindent
5751 First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5752 argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5753 we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5754 argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5755 function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5756 final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5757 in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5758
5759 @cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5760 @ignore
5761 @starindex
5762 @end ignore
5763 @tindex Si
5764 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5765 @texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5766 @infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5767 is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5768 @expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5769 integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5770 to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5771 give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5772 which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5773 with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5774 @code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5775 default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
5776 0.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5777 Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5778 you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5779 @xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5780
5781 The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5782 @dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5783 keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5784 For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5785 you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5786
5787 @smallexample
5788 @group
5789 1: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
5790 . .
5791
5792 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
5793
5794 1: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 n1 pi
5795 . .
5796
5797 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
5798 @end group
5799 @end smallexample
5800
5801 @noindent
5802 When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
5803 still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
5804 Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
5805 @w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
5806 re-execute the same keystrokes.
5807
5808 You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
5809
5810 @smallexample
5811 @group
5812 1: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
5813 . .
5814
5815 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
5816 @end group
5817 @end smallexample
5818
5819 @noindent
5820 Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
5821 @kbd{z} to call it up.
5822
5823 Keyboard macros can call other macros.
5824
5825 @smallexample
5826 @group
5827 1: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
5828 . . . .
5829
5830 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
5831 @end group
5832 @end smallexample
5833
5834 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
5835 the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
5836 the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5837
5838 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
5839 the following functions:
5840
5841 @enumerate
5842 @item
5843 Compute
5844 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
5845 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
5846 where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
5847
5848 @item
5849 Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
5850 the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
5851
5852 @item
5853 Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
5854 the stack.
5855 @end enumerate
5856 @noindent
5857 @xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5858
5859 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
5860 the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
5861 @xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5862
5863 In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
5864 Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
5865 inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
5866
5867 @smallexample
5868 @group
5869 1: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
5870 . 1: 4 .
5871 .
5872
5873 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
5874 @end group
5875 @end smallexample
5876
5877 @noindent
5878 Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
5879 enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
5880 This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
5881 executes the body of the loop that many times.
5882
5883 If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
5884 type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
5885
5886 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5887 Here's another example:
5888
5889 @smallexample
5890 @group
5891 3: 1 2: 10946
5892 2: 1 1: 17711
5893 1: 20 .
5894 .
5895
5896 1 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
5897 @end group
5898 @end smallexample
5899
5900 @noindent
5901 The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
5902 numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
5903 of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
5904 key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
5905
5906 @cindex Golden ratio
5907 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
5908 A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
5909 Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
5910 @texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
5911 @infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
5912 and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
5913 @texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
5914 @infoline @expr{phi},
5915 the ``golden ratio,'' is
5916 @texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
5917 @infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
5918 (For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
5919 variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
5920
5921 @smallexample
5922 @group
5923 1: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
5924 . . . .
5925
5926 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
5927 @end group
5928 @end smallexample
5929
5930 @cindex Continued fractions
5931 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
5932 representation of
5933 @texline @math{\phi}
5934 @infoline @expr{phi}
5935 is
5936 @texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
5937 @infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
5938 We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
5939 and then replacing the innermost
5940 @texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
5941 @infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
5942 by 1. Approximate
5943 @texline @math{\phi}
5944 @infoline @expr{phi}
5945 using a twenty-term continued fraction.
5946 @xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5947
5948 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
5949 Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
5950 vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
5951 vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
5952 @expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
5953 that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
5954 using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5955
5956 @cindex Harmonic numbers
5957 A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
5958 we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
5959 the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
5960
5961 @smallexample
5962 @group
5963 3: 0 1: 3.597739
5964 2: 1 .
5965 1: 20
5966 .
5967
5968 0 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
5969 @end group
5970 @end smallexample
5971
5972 @noindent
5973 The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
5974 repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
5975 the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
5976 body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
5977 finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
5978 increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
5979 uses a step of one.
5980
5981 This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
5982 total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
5983 you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
5984
5985 @smallexample
5986 @group
5987 1: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
5988 . 1: 20 .
5989 .
5990
5991 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
5992 @end group
5993 @end smallexample
5994
5995 @noindent
5996 The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
5997 variable (and removes that value from the stack).
5998
5999 It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6000 also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6001 other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6002 and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6003 or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6004 probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6005 situations where loops really are the way to go:
6006
6007 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6008 harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6009 @xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6010
6011 Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6012 we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6013 caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6014 fix, though:
6015
6016 @smallexample
6017 @group
6018 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6019 . . 2: 3.597739
6020 1: 0.6667
6021 .
6022
6023 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6024 @end group
6025 @end smallexample
6026
6027 @noindent
6028 When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6029 its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6030 for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6031 now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6032 @kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6033 this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6034 interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6035 the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6036 survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6037
6038 @cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6039 The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6040 property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6041 even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6042 by the formula
6043 @texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6044 @infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6045 Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6046 (Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6047 this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6048 numbers are very large fractions.)
6049
6050 @smallexample
6051 @group
6052 1: 10 1: 0.0756823
6053 . .
6054
6055 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6056 @end group
6057 @end smallexample
6058
6059 @noindent
6060 You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6061 @kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6062 command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6063 if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6064 if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6065 Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6066 if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6067
6068 The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 @group
6072 3: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
6073 2: 5:66 . . . .
6074 1: 0.0757575
6075 .
6076
6077 10 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6078 @end group
6079 @end smallexample
6080
6081 Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6082 Bernoulli numbers.
6083
6084 @smallexample
6085 @group
6086 3: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
6087 2: 2 .
6088 1: 30
6089 .
6090
6091 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6092 @end group
6093 @end smallexample
6094
6095 @noindent
6096 The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6097 we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6098 (initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6099 will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6100 onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6101 Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6102 sequence of keystrokes.)
6103
6104 With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6105 in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6106 which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6107 loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6108 ``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6109
6110 If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6111 it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6112 One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6113 then enter the real one in the edit command.
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 1: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6118 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6119
6120 1 ;; calc digits
6121 RET ;; calc-enter
6122 2 ;; calc digits
6123 + ;; calc-plus
6124
6125 C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6126 @end group
6127 @end smallexample
6128
6129 @noindent
6130 A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6131 @file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6132 macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6133 Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6134 @samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6135 Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6136 To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6137 characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6138 and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6139 @code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6140
6141 Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6142 First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6143 in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6144 to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6145 typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6146
6147 @smallexample
6148 Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
6149 0 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6150 st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
6151 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6152 1 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6153 TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6154 Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6155 & ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6156 s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
6157 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6158 1 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6159 Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6160 sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
6161 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6162 Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 @noindent
6166 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6167
6168 @smallexample
6169 @group
6170 1: 20 1: 3.597739
6171 . .
6172
6173 20 z h
6174 @end group
6175 @end smallexample
6176
6177 The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6178 which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6179 keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6180 (and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6181 command on the @kbd{C-x * m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6182 following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6183 one end of the text below, then type @kbd{C-x * m} at the other.
6184
6185 @example
6186 @group
6187 Z ` 0 t 1
6188 1 TAB
6189 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6190 r 1
6191 Z '
6192 @end group
6193 @end example
6194
6195 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6196 equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6197 @expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6198 @expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6199 this formula over and over:
6200
6201 @ifnottex
6202 @example
6203 new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6204 @end example
6205 @end ifnottex
6206 @tex
6207 \beforedisplay
6208 $$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f^{\prime}(x)} $$
6209 \afterdisplay
6210 @end tex
6211
6212 @noindent
6213 where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6214 values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6215 @texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6216 @infoline @expr{new_x}
6217 and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6218 of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6219 involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6220 on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6221 is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6222 @texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6223 @infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6224 near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6225 the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6226 method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6227
6228 @cindex Digamma function
6229 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6230 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
6231 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6232 @texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6233 @infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6234 is defined as the derivative of
6235 @texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6236 @infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6237 For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6238
6239 @ifnottex
6240 @example
6241 psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6242 @end example
6243 @end ifnottex
6244 @tex
6245 \beforedisplay
6246 $$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6247 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6248 $$
6249 \afterdisplay
6250 @end tex
6251
6252 @noindent
6253 where
6254 @texline @math{\sum}
6255 @infoline @expr{sum}
6256 represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6257 (or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6258 the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6259 While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6260 An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6261 to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6262 @texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6263 @infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6264 Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6265 for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6266 Fortunately, we can compute
6267 @texline @math{\psi(1)}
6268 @infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6269 from
6270 @texline @math{\psi(5)}
6271 @infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6272 using the recurrence
6273 @texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6274 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6275 Your task: Develop a program to compute
6276 @texline @math{\psi(z)};
6277 @infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6278 it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6279 if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6280 formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6281 to compute
6282 @texline @math{\gamma}
6283 @infoline @expr{gamma}
6284 to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6285 for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6286 @xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6287
6288 @cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6289 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6290 a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6291 @expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6292 write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6293 notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6294 should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6295 a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6296 @xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6297
6298 @cindex Recursion
6299 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6300 first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6301
6302 @ifnottex
6303 @example
6304 s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6305 s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6306 s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6307 @end example
6308 @end ifnottex
6309 @tex
6310 \beforedisplay
6311 $$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6312 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6313 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6314 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6315 $$
6316 \afterdisplay
6317 \vskip5pt
6318 (These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6319 @end tex
6320
6321 This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6322 program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6323 terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6324 ``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6325 the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6326 macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6327 So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6328 it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6329 using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6330 to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6331 the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6332 or @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6333 thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6334 that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6335 @expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6336 @expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6337 @kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6338 @xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6339
6340 The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6341 are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6342 that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6343 rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6344 program can:
6345
6346 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6347 computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6348 rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6349 from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6350
6351 @example
6352
6353 @end example
6354 This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6355 about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6356 Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6357 @c [not-split]
6358 The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6359 @c [when-split]
6360 @c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6361
6362 @page
6363 @node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6364 @section Answers to Exercises
6365
6366 @noindent
6367 This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6368
6369 @menu
6370 * RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6371 * RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6372 * RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6373 * RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6374 * Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6375 * Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6376 * Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6377 * Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6378 * Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6379 * Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6380 * Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6381 * Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6382 * Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6383 * Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6384 * Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6385 * Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6386 * Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6387 * Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6388 * List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6389 * List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6390 * List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6391 * List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6392 * List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6393 * List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6394 * List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6395 * List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6396 * List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6397 * List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6398 * List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6399 * List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6400 * List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6401 * List Answer 14:: Random walk
6402 * Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6403 * Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6404 * Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6405 * Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6406 * Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6407 * Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6408 * Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6409 * Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6410 * Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6411 * Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6412 * Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6413 * Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6414 * Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6415 * Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6416 * Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6417 * Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6418 * Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6419 * Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6420 * Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6421 * Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6422 * Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6423 * Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6424 * Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6425 * Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6426 * Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6427 * Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6428 * Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6429 * Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6430 * Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6431 * Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6432 * Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6433 * Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6434 * Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6435 * Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6436 * Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6437 * Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6438 * Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6439 @end menu
6440
6441 @c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6442 @c being entered on the table of contents.
6443 @tex
6444 \global\let\oldwrite=\write
6445 \gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6446 \global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6447 \gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6448 @end tex
6449
6450 @node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6451 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6452
6453 @noindent
6454 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6455
6456 The result is
6457 @texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6458 @infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6459
6460 @node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6461 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6462
6463 @noindent
6464 @texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6465 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6466
6467 After computing the intermediate term
6468 @texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6469 @infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6470 you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6471 term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6472 compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6473
6474 @smallexample
6475 @group
6476 2: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
6477 1: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6478 . 1: 9.5 .
6479 .
6480
6481 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6482
6483 @end group
6484 @end smallexample
6485 @noindent
6486 @smallexample
6487 @group
6488 4: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
6489 3: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
6490 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6491 1: 4 .
6492 .
6493
6494 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6495 @end group
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6499 with the third term.
6500
6501 @smallexample
6502 @group
6503 2: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
6504 1: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6505 . 1: 4 .
6506 .
6507
6508 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6509 @end group
6510 @end smallexample
6511
6512 On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6513 advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6514 can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6515 you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6516
6517 @node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6518 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6519
6520 @noindent
6521 The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6522
6523 @smallexample
6524 @group
6525 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
6526 2: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
6527 1: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6528 . . 1: 1 . .
6529 .
6530
6531 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6532 @end group
6533 @end smallexample
6534
6535 Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6536
6537 @smallexample
6538 @group
6539 3: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
6540 2: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
6541 1: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6542 . . . . .
6543
6544 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6545 @end group
6546 @end smallexample
6547
6548 @node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6549 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6550
6551 @noindent
6552 Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6553 but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6554
6555 @smallexample
6556 @group
6557 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6558 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6559 . . .
6560
6561 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6562 @end group
6563 @end smallexample
6564
6565 Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6566 extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6567 But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6568 deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6569 @key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6570
6571 @smallexample
6572 @group
6573 2: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
6574 1: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6575 . . .
6576
6577 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6578 @end group
6579 @end smallexample
6580
6581 (As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6582 enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6583 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6584 the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6585
6586 @node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6587 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6588
6589 @noindent
6590 Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6591
6592 If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6593 Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6594
6595 (Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6596 a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6597 @samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6598
6599 @node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6600 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6601
6602 @noindent
6603 In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6604 name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6605 has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6606 explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6607
6608 @node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6609 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6610
6611 @noindent
6612 The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6613 The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6614 is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6615 the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6616 times anything is zero.''
6617
6618 @c [fix-ref Infinities]
6619 The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6620 results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6621 multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6622 show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6623 further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6624
6625 @node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6626 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6627
6628 @noindent
6629 Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6630 an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
6631 0.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6632 the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6633 to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6634 multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6635
6636 When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6637 to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6638 to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6639 exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6640 numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6641 the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6642 happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6643 digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6644 he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
6645 0.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6646 higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6647
6648 If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6649 @kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6650 you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6651 so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6652 inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6653 rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6654 @samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6655 off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6656 nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6657 a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6658
6659 Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6660 @kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6661 you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6662 display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6663 always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6664 rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6665 be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6666 uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6667 than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6668 to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6669
6670 An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6671 floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6672 Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6673 represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6674 comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6675 they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6676 we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6677 be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6678 in decimal display mode.
6679
6680 It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6681 in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6682 of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6683 you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6684
6685 @node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6686 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6687
6688 If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6689 the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6690 needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6691 @samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6692 algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6693 normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6694 puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6695 way to enter this number.
6696
6697 The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6698 huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6699 @samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6700 exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6701 it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6702 matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6703 copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6704
6705 @node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6706 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6707
6708 @noindent
6709 The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6710
6711 The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6712 sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6713 Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6714 their inputs.
6715
6716 The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6717 squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6718 commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6719 place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6720 determining facts like this.
6721
6722 @smallexample
6723 @group
6724 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6725 . .
6726
6727 45 S 2 ^
6728
6729 @end group
6730 @end smallexample
6731 @noindent
6732 @smallexample
6733 @group
6734 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6735 . . .
6736
6737 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6738 @end group
6739 @end smallexample
6740
6741 A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6742 all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6743 exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6744 before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6745 for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6746
6747 @node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6748 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6749
6750 @noindent
6751 Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6752 height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6753 can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6754 a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6755 of time.
6756
6757 Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6758 done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6759 integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
6760 9304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6761 time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6762 calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6763
6764 Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6765 There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6766 @w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6767
6768 @node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6769 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6770
6771 @noindent
6772 Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6773 give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6774 down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6775 precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6776 with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6777 @texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6778 @infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6779 The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6780
6781 Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6782 floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6783 decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6784 produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6785 down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6786 format.
6787
6788 @node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6789 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
6790
6791 @noindent
6792 @kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
6793 does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
6794
6795 Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
6796 or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
6797 no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
6798 for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
6799
6800 @node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6801 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
6802
6803 @noindent
6804 Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
6805 by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
6806
6807 @smallexample
6808 @group
6809 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
6810 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
6811 .
6812
6813 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
6814 @end group
6815 @end smallexample
6816
6817 The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
6818 indeed have unit length.
6819
6820 @node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6821 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
6822
6823 @noindent
6824 The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
6825 positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
6826 definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
6827 is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
6828
6829 @node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6830 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
6831
6832 @noindent
6833 The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
6834 get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
6835
6836 @node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6837 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
6838
6839 @ifnottex
6840 @example
6841 @group
6842 x + a y = 6
6843 x + b y = 10
6844 @end group
6845 @end example
6846 @end ifnottex
6847 @tex
6848 \beforedisplay
6849 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
6850 x &+ b y = 10}
6851 $$
6852 \afterdisplay
6853 @end tex
6854
6855 Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
6856 matrix as usual.
6857
6858 @smallexample
6859 @group
6860 1: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [4 a / (a - b) + 6, 4 / (b - a) ]
6861 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
6862 [ 1, b ] ]
6863 .
6864
6865 ' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
6866 @end group
6867 @end smallexample
6868
6869 This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
6870 mode:
6871
6872 @smallexample
6873 @group
6874 4 a 4
6875 1: [----- + 6, -----]
6876 a - b b - a
6877 @end group
6878 @end smallexample
6879
6880 Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
6881
6882 @node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6883 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
6884
6885 @noindent
6886 To solve
6887 @texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
6888 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
6889 first we compute
6890 @texline @math{A' = A^T A}
6891 @infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
6892 and
6893 @texline @math{B' = A^T B};
6894 @infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
6895 now, we have a system
6896 @texline @math{A' X = B'}
6897 @infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
6898 which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
6899
6900 @ifnottex
6901 @example
6902 @group
6903 a + 2b + 3c = 6
6904 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
6905 7a + 6b = 3
6906 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
6907 @end group
6908 @end example
6909 @end ifnottex
6910 @tex
6911 \beforedisplayh
6912 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
6913 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
6914 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6915 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6916 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
6917 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
6918 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
6919 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
6920 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
6921 $$
6922 \afterdisplayh
6923 @end tex
6924
6925 The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
6926 quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
6927 @texline @math{B'}
6928 @infoline @expr{B2}
6929 vector.
6930
6931 @smallexample
6932 @group
6933 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
6934 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
6935 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
6936 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
6937 . .
6938
6939 ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
6940 @end group
6941 @end smallexample
6942
6943 @noindent
6944 Now we compute the matrix
6945 @texline @math{A'}
6946 @infoline @expr{A2}
6947 and divide.
6948
6949 @smallexample
6950 @group
6951 2: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
6952 1: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
6953 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
6954 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
6955 .
6956
6957 r 7 v t r 7 * /
6958 @end group
6959 @end smallexample
6960
6961 @noindent
6962 (The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
6963 round-off error.)
6964
6965 Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
6966 @texline @math{3\times3}
6967 @infoline 3x3
6968 system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
6969 added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
6970 by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
6971 answer since the
6972 @texline @math{4\times3}
6973 @infoline 4x3
6974 system would be equivalent to the original
6975 @texline @math{3\times3}
6976 @infoline 3x3
6977 system.)
6978
6979 Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
6980 can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
6981 the original system of equations to see how well they match.
6982
6983 @smallexample
6984 @group
6985 2: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
6986 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
6987 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
6988 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
6989 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
6990 .
6991
6992 r 7 @key{TAB} *
6993 @end group
6994 @end smallexample
6995
6996 @noindent
6997 This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
6998 @expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
6999
7000 @node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7001 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7002
7003 @noindent
7004 We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7005 adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7006 across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7007 plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7008
7009 @smallexample
7010 @group
7011 2: 2 2: 2
7012 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7013 . .
7014
7015 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7016 @end group
7017 @end smallexample
7018
7019 @noindent
7020 Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7021 vector.
7022
7023 @smallexample
7024 @group
7025 1: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7026 .
7027
7028 V M ^
7029 @end group
7030 @end smallexample
7031
7032 @node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7033 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7034
7035 @noindent
7036 Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7037 the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7038
7039 @ifnottex
7040 @example
7041 m*x + b*1 = y
7042 @end example
7043 @end ifnottex
7044 @tex
7045 \beforedisplay
7046 $$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7047 \afterdisplay
7048 @end tex
7049
7050 Thus we want a
7051 @texline @math{19\times2}
7052 @infoline 19x2
7053 matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7054 ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7055 we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7056
7057 @smallexample
7058 @group
7059 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
7060 1: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7061 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7062 @dots{}
7063
7064 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7065 @end group
7066 @end smallexample
7067
7068 @noindent
7069 Now we compute
7070 @texline @math{A^T y}
7071 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7072 and
7073 @texline @math{A^T A}
7074 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7075 and divide.
7076
7077 @smallexample
7078 @group
7079 1: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7080 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7081 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7082 .
7083
7084 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7085 @end group
7086 @end smallexample
7087
7088 @noindent
7089 (Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7090
7091 @smallexample
7092 @group
7093 1: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7094 .
7095
7096 /
7097 @end group
7098 @end smallexample
7099
7100 Since we were solving equations of the form
7101 @texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7102 @infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7103 these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7104 enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7105 @kbd{V R}!
7106
7107 The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7108 your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7109 arithmetic functions!
7110
7111 @c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7112 In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7113 fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7114
7115 @node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7116 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7117
7118 @noindent
7119 Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7120 whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7121 and type @w{@kbd{C-x * g}}.
7122
7123 @smallexample
7124 @group
7125 1: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7126 .
7127 @end group
7128 @end smallexample
7129
7130 To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7131 how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7132
7133 @smallexample
7134 @group
7135 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
7136 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7137 . .
7138
7139 @key{RET} V R *
7140
7141 @end group
7142 @end smallexample
7143 @noindent
7144 @smallexample
7145 @group
7146 2: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
7147 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7148 . .
7149
7150 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7151 @end group
7152 @end smallexample
7153
7154 @noindent
7155 (The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7156 You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7157 then raise the number to that power.)
7158
7159 @node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7160 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7161
7162 @noindent
7163 A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7164 @texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7165 @infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7166 The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7167
7168 @smallexample
7169 @group
7170 2: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
7171 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7172 . .
7173
7174 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7175 @end group
7176 @end smallexample
7177
7178 @noindent
7179 This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7180
7181 The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7182 The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7183
7184 @smallexample
7185 @group
7186 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7187 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7188 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7189 .
7190
7191 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7192 @end group
7193 @end smallexample
7194
7195 @noindent
7196 Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7197 a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7198
7199 @node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7200 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7201
7202 @noindent
7203 The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7204 This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7205 they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7206 the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7207
7208 @smallexample
7209 @group
7210 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7211 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7212 . .
7213
7214 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7215
7216 @end group
7217 @end smallexample
7218 @noindent
7219 @smallexample
7220 @group
7221 1: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7222 . . .
7223
7224 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7225 @end group
7226 @end smallexample
7227
7228 @noindent
7229 Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7230 so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7231 zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7232 the job is pretty straightforward.
7233
7234 Incidentally, Calc provides the
7235 @texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7236 @infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7237 function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7238 would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7239
7240 @node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7241 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7242
7243 @noindent
7244 First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7245 to get a list of lists of integers!
7246
7247 @node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7248 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7249
7250 @noindent
7251 Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7252 exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7253
7254 @smallexample
7255 @group
7256 1: [ [0],
7257 [0, 1],
7258 [0, 1, 2],
7259 @dots{}
7260
7261 1 -
7262 @end group
7263 @end smallexample
7264
7265 The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7266 the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7267 triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7268 can be computed directly by the formula
7269 @texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7270 @infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7271
7272 @smallexample
7273 @group
7274 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7275 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7276 . .
7277
7278 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7279 @end group
7280 @end smallexample
7281
7282 @noindent
7283 Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7284 result:
7285
7286 @smallexample
7287 @group
7288 1: [ [0],
7289 [1, 2],
7290 [3, 4, 5],
7291 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7292 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7293 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7294 .
7295
7296 V M +
7297 @end group
7298 @end smallexample
7299
7300 If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7301 computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7302 gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7303 triangular list.
7304
7305 @smallexample
7306 @group
7307 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7308 1: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7309 . .
7310
7311 @key{RET} V M V R +
7312 @end group
7313 @end smallexample
7314
7315 @noindent
7316 (This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7317 since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7318 @kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7319
7320 @node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7321 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7322
7323 @noindent
7324 The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7325
7326 @smallexample
7327 @group
7328 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7329 . . .
7330
7331 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7332 @end group
7333 @end smallexample
7334
7335 Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7336
7337 @smallexample
7338 @group
7339 1: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7340 .
7341
7342 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7343 @end group
7344 @end smallexample
7345
7346 @noindent
7347 (Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7348
7349 A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7350 @kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7351
7352 @smallexample
7353 @group
7354 2: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
7355 1: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7356 . .
7357
7358 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7359 @end group
7360 @end smallexample
7361
7362 @noindent
7363 It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7364 one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7365 @texline @math{\sin x}
7366 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7367 might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7368
7369 The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7370 the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7371 this back into the corresponding value itself.
7372
7373 @smallexample
7374 @group
7375 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
7376 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7377 .
7378
7379 r 1 V M * V R +
7380 @end group
7381 @end smallexample
7382
7383 If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7384 would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7385 useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7386 instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7387 correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7388 example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7389
7390 The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7391 efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7392 to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7393
7394 @smallexample
7395 @group
7396 2: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
7397 1: [0 .. 5] .
7398 .
7399
7400 ' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7401 @end group
7402 @end smallexample
7403
7404 @noindent
7405 The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7406 that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7407 As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7408
7409 @node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7410 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7411
7412 @noindent
7413 Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7414
7415 @smallexample
7416 @group
7417 1: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7418 . 2: 10
7419 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7420 .
7421
7422 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7423
7424 @end group
7425 @end smallexample
7426 @noindent
7427 @smallexample
7428 @group
7429 1: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
7430 2: [100000000000, ... ] .
7431 .
7432
7433 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7434 @end group
7435 @end smallexample
7436
7437 @noindent
7438 (Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7439
7440 @smallexample
7441 @group
7442 1: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7443 .
7444
7445 10 V M % s 2
7446 @end group
7447 @end smallexample
7448
7449 Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7450 the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7451 left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7452 the right of it are nines.
7453
7454 @smallexample
7455 @group
7456 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7457 . .
7458
7459 9 V M a = v v
7460
7461 @end group
7462 @end smallexample
7463 @noindent
7464 @smallexample
7465 @group
7466 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7467 . .
7468
7469 V U * v v 1 |
7470 @end group
7471 @end smallexample
7472
7473 @noindent
7474 Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7475 only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7476 except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7477 care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7478 rightmost digit.
7479
7480 @smallexample
7481 @group
7482 2: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
7483 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7484 .
7485
7486 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7487 @end group
7488 @end smallexample
7489
7490 @noindent
7491 Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7492 this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7493 digits that generated them.
7494
7495 Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7496
7497 @smallexample
7498 @group
7499 3: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
7500 2: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
7501 1: [100000000000, ... ] .
7502 .
7503
7504 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7505
7506 @end group
7507 @end smallexample
7508 @noindent
7509 @smallexample
7510 @group
7511 1: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7512 . .
7513
7514 V M * V R +
7515 @end group
7516 @end smallexample
7517
7518 @noindent
7519 Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7520 @w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7521
7522 @smallexample
7523 @group
7524 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7525 . .
7526
7527 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7528 @end group
7529 @end smallexample
7530
7531 @node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7532 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7533
7534 @noindent
7535 For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7536 which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7537 then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7538 compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7539
7540 Here's a more correct method:
7541
7542 @smallexample
7543 @group
7544 1: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7545 . 1: 7
7546 .
7547
7548 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7549
7550 @end group
7551 @end smallexample
7552 @noindent
7553 @smallexample
7554 @group
7555 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7556 . .
7557
7558 V M a = V R *
7559 @end group
7560 @end smallexample
7561
7562 @node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7563 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7564
7565 @noindent
7566 The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7567 @expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7568 and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7569
7570 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7571 commands.
7572
7573 @smallexample
7574 @group
7575 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
7576 1: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7577 . .
7578
7579 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7580
7581 @end group
7582 @end smallexample
7583 @noindent
7584 @smallexample
7585 @group
7586 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
7587 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7588 . .
7589
7590 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7591 @end group
7592 @end smallexample
7593
7594 Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7595 get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7596
7597 @smallexample
7598 @group
7599 1: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7600 . . .
7601
7602 + 1 V M a < V R +
7603 @end group
7604 @end smallexample
7605
7606 @noindent
7607 The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7608
7609 @smallexample
7610 @group
7611 1: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7612 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7613
7614 100 / 4 * P /
7615 @end group
7616 @end smallexample
7617
7618 @noindent
7619 Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7620 by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7621 not very efficient!
7622
7623 (Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7624 will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7625
7626 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7627 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7628
7629 @node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7630 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7631
7632 @noindent
7633 This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7634 symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7635 @expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7636 component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7637 @texline @math{\theta},
7638 @infoline @expr{theta},
7639 and see if @expr{x} and
7640 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7641 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7642 (which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7643 The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7644 numbers surround an integer.
7645
7646 Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7647 of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7648 to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7649 it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7650 to estimate @cpi{}!)
7651
7652 In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7653 coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7654 endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7655 match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7656 Pick random @expr{x} and
7657 @texline @math{\theta},
7658 @infoline @expr{theta},
7659 compute
7660 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7661 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7662 and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7663
7664 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7665 commands.
7666
7667 @smallexample
7668 @group
7669 1: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7670 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7671 .
7672
7673 v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7674 @end group
7675 @end smallexample
7676
7677 @noindent
7678 (The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7679
7680 @smallexample
7681 @group
7682 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
7683 1: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7684 .
7685
7686 m d V M C +
7687
7688 @end group
7689 @end smallexample
7690 @noindent
7691 @smallexample
7692 @group
7693 1: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7694 . . .
7695
7696 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7697 @end group
7698 @end smallexample
7699
7700 Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7701 one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7702 a random integer.
7703
7704 @smallexample
7705 @group
7706 2: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
7707 1: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7708 . .
7709
7710 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7711
7712 @end group
7713 @end smallexample
7714 @noindent
7715 @smallexample
7716 @group
7717 1: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7718 . . .
7719
7720 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7721
7722 @end group
7723 @end smallexample
7724 @noindent
7725 @smallexample
7726 @group
7727 1: 10.714 1: 3.273
7728 . .
7729
7730 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7731 @end group
7732 @end smallexample
7733
7734 For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7735 exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7736
7737 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7738 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7739
7740 @node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7741 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7742
7743 @noindent
7744 First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7745
7746 @smallexample
7747 @group
7748 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7749 .
7750
7751 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7752 @end group
7753 @end smallexample
7754
7755 @noindent
7756 Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7757 there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7758 we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7759 like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7760
7761 We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7762 if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7763 @expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7764 it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7765
7766 @smallexample
7767 @group
7768 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7769 1: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7770 . .
7771
7772 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7773
7774 @end group
7775 @end smallexample
7776 @noindent
7777 @smallexample
7778 @group
7779 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
7780 1: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7781 .
7782
7783 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7784 @end group
7785 @end smallexample
7786
7787 @noindent
7788 Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
7789 But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
7790 @kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
7791 function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
7792 plus its second argument.
7793
7794 @smallexample
7795 @group
7796 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
7797 . .
7798
7799 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
7800 @end group
7801 @end smallexample
7802
7803 @noindent
7804 If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
7805 Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
7806 except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
7807
7808 Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
7809 cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
7810 and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
7811 without affecting the result. While this means there are more
7812 arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
7813 the operations are faster.
7814
7815 @smallexample
7816 @group
7817 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
7818 . .
7819
7820 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
7821 @end group
7822 @end smallexample
7823
7824 Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
7825 @w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
7826 subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
7827 So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
7828
7829 @ifnottex
7830 @example
7831 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
7832 @end example
7833 @end ifnottex
7834 @tex
7835 \beforedisplay
7836 $$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
7837 \afterdisplay
7838 @end tex
7839
7840 @noindent
7841 for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
7842 the distributive law yields
7843
7844 @ifnottex
7845 @example
7846 9 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
7847 @end example
7848 @end ifnottex
7849 @tex
7850 \beforedisplay
7851 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
7852 \afterdisplay
7853 @end tex
7854
7855 @noindent
7856 The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
7857 contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
7858 term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
7859 @expr{n' = 3m + n},
7860
7861 @ifnottex
7862 @example
7863 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
7864 @end example
7865 @end ifnottex
7866 @tex
7867 \beforedisplay
7868 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n^{\prime} $$
7869 \afterdisplay
7870 @end tex
7871
7872 @noindent
7873 which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
7874 the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
7875
7876 Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
7877 basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
7878 modulo some value @var{m}.
7879
7880 @node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
7881 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
7882
7883 We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
7884 step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
7885 otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
7886
7887 @smallexample
7888 @group
7889 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7890 1: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
7891 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
7892 ...
7893
7894 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
7895 @end group
7896 @end smallexample
7897
7898 Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
7899 notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
7900 before nesting even begins.
7901
7902 We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
7903 rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
7904 to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
7905
7906 @smallexample
7907 @group
7908 2: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
7909 1: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
7910 .
7911
7912 v t v u g f
7913 @end group
7914 @end smallexample
7915
7916 Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
7917 independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
7918 to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
7919
7920 To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
7921 a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
7922 length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
7923 we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
7924
7925 @smallexample
7926 @group
7927 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7928 1: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
7929 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
7930 ...
7931
7932 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
7933 @end group
7934 @end smallexample
7935
7936 Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
7937
7938 An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
7939 complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
7940 In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
7941 and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
7942 angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
7943 Schwartz.)
7944
7945 @node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
7946 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
7947
7948 @noindent
7949 If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
7950 then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
7951
7952 @smallexample
7953 @group
7954 1: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
7955 . . .
7956
7957 2 ^ P / c F
7958 @end group
7959 @end smallexample
7960
7961 @noindent
7962 Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
7963 likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
7964 happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
7965 irrational number to within 12 digits.
7966
7967 But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
7968 precision slightly and try again:
7969
7970 @smallexample
7971 @group
7972 1: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
7973 . .
7974
7975 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
7976 @end group
7977 @end smallexample
7978
7979 @noindent
7980 Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
7981 this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
7982 @texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
7983 @infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
7984
7985 Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
7986 precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
7987 to the current precision before they begin.
7988
7989 @node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7990 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
7991
7992 @noindent
7993 @samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
7994 But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
7995
7996 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
7997 of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
7998 far as Calc is concerned all infinities are the same size.
7999 In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8000 to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8001 @expr{x} is not relevant here.
8002
8003 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8004 the input is infinite.
8005
8006 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8007 represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8008 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8009 The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8010 because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8011
8012 @samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8013 direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8014 right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8015 so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8016
8017 @samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8018 @samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8019
8020 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8021 input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8022 here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8023 treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8024
8025 @node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8026 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8027
8028 @noindent
8029 We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8030 @expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8031 infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8032 values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8033 (And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8034 in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8035
8036 In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8037 @w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8038 So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8039 as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8040
8041 The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8042 indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8043 for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8044 Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8045 unable to tell what the true answer is.
8046
8047 @node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8048 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8049
8050 @smallexample
8051 @group
8052 2: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
8053 1: 17 .
8054 .
8055
8056 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8057 @end group
8058 @end smallexample
8059
8060 @noindent
8061 The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8062
8063 @smallexample
8064 @group
8065 2: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
8066 1: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8067 .
8068
8069 20" + 17 *
8070 @end group
8071 @end smallexample
8072
8073 @noindent
8074 The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8075
8076 @node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8077 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8078
8079 @noindent
8080 Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8081 to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8082 We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8083
8084 @smallexample
8085 @group
8086 1: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8087 . . .
8088
8089 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8090 @end group
8091 @end smallexample
8092
8093 @noindent
8094 (Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8095
8096 This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8097 @kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8098 vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8099 ``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8100 argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8101
8102 @smallexample
8103 @group
8104 2: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
8105 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8106 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8107 .
8108
8109 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8110 @end group
8111 @end smallexample
8112
8113 @noindent
8114 Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8115
8116 @smallexample
8117 @group
8118 1: 242
8119 .
8120
8121 ' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8122 @end group
8123 @end smallexample
8124
8125 @noindent
8126 And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8127
8128 @node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8129 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8130
8131 @noindent
8132 The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8133 by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8134 that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8135 answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8136 exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8137 don't know the leap year rule.
8138
8139 Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8140 that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8141 the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8142 number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8143 equal to the number of leap years there were.
8144
8145 @smallexample
8146 @group
8147 1: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8148 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8149 .
8150
8151 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8152
8153 @end group
8154 @end smallexample
8155 @noindent
8156 @smallexample
8157 @group
8158 3: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
8159 2: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
8160 1: 1991 . .
8161 .
8162
8163 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8164 @end group
8165 @end smallexample
8166
8167 @c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8168 @noindent
8169 There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8170 of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8171 unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8172 background information in that regard.)
8173
8174 @node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8175 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8176
8177 @noindent
8178 The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8179 @samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8180
8181 @smallexample
8182 @group
8183 1: 1. 2: 1.
8184 . 1: 0.2
8185 .
8186
8187 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8188 @end group
8189 @end smallexample
8190
8191 Now we simply chug through the formula.
8192
8193 @smallexample
8194 @group
8195 1: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8196 . . .
8197
8198 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8199 @end group
8200 @end smallexample
8201
8202 It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8203 well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8204
8205 @smallexample
8206 @group
8207 3: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8208 2: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
8209 1: 706.21 .
8210 .
8211
8212 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8213 @end group
8214 @end smallexample
8215
8216 @noindent
8217 Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8218
8219 @node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8220 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8221
8222 @noindent
8223 The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8224 Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8225 close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8226 is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8227 but with no upper bound.
8228
8229 The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8230
8231 Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8232 @w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8233 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8234 is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8235
8236 If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8237 instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8238 as a possible value.
8239
8240 The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8241 Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8242 It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8243 will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8244 the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8245 in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8246 represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8247 It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8248 minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8249 that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8250
8251 @node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8252 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8253
8254 @smallexample
8255 @group
8256 1: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8257 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8258 . .
8259
8260 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8261 @end group
8262 @end smallexample
8263
8264 @noindent
8265 In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
8266 3, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8267 of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8268
8269 An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8270 many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8271 for different numbers.
8272
8273 The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8274
8275 @node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8276 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8277
8278 @noindent
8279 Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8280
8281 @smallexample
8282 @group
8283 1: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8284 . 811749612 .
8285 .
8286
8287 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8288 @end group
8289 @end smallexample
8290
8291 @noindent
8292 Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8293 must not be prime.
8294
8295 It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8296 various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8297 a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8298 use this method to test the second number.
8299
8300 @smallexample
8301 @group
8302 2: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
8303 1: 15485863 .
8304 .
8305
8306 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8307 @end group
8308 @end smallexample
8309
8310 @noindent
8311 The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
8312 15485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8313
8314 Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8315 would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8316 the power using full integer arithmetic.
8317
8318 Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8319 numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8320 of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8321 to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8322
8323 @node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8324 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8325
8326 @noindent
8327 There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8328 One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8329 multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8330
8331 @smallexample
8332 @group
8333 1: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8334 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8335 .
8336
8337 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8338
8339 @end group
8340 @end smallexample
8341 @noindent
8342 @smallexample
8343 @group
8344 2: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
8345 1: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8346 .
8347
8348 x time @key{RET} +
8349 @end group
8350 @end smallexample
8351
8352 @noindent
8353 It will be just after six in the morning.
8354
8355 The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8356 HMS form:
8357
8358 @smallexample
8359 @group
8360 1: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8361 . .
8362
8363 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8364 @end group
8365 @end smallexample
8366
8367 @noindent
8368 The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8369 the actual number 3.14159...
8370
8371 @node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8372 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8373
8374 @noindent
8375 As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8376 each.
8377
8378 @smallexample
8379 @group
8380 2: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
8381 1: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8382 .
8383
8384 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8385
8386 @end group
8387 @end smallexample
8388 @noindent
8389 @smallexample
8390 @group
8391 1: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8392 .
8393
8394 17 *
8395 @end group
8396 @end smallexample
8397
8398 @noindent
8399 No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8400
8401 @node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8402 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8403
8404 @noindent
8405 Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8406
8407 @node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8408 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8409
8410 @noindent
8411 How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8412 to the other?
8413
8414 @smallexample
8415 @group
8416 1: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8417 . .
8418
8419 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8420 @end group
8421 @end smallexample
8422
8423 @noindent
8424 (Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8425
8426 @smallexample
8427 @group
8428 1: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356
8429 2: 4.1 ns .
8430 .
8431
8432 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} /
8433 @end group
8434 @end smallexample
8435
8436 @noindent
8437 Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8438 go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8439 could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8440
8441 @node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8442 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8443
8444 @noindent
8445 The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8446 find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8447
8448 @smallexample
8449 @group
8450 1: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8451 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8452 .
8453
8454 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8455 @end group
8456 @end smallexample
8457
8458 The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8459 number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8460 answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8461
8462 @smallexample
8463 @group
8464 1: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8465 . 1: 2 .
8466 .
8467
8468 u s 2 B
8469 @end group
8470 @end smallexample
8471
8472 @noindent
8473 Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8474
8475 @node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8476 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8477
8478 @noindent
8479 @c [fix-ref Declarations]
8480 The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8481 Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8482 if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8483 simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8484 that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8485 that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8486
8487 @node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8488 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8489
8490 @noindent
8491 Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8492 is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8493 @expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8494 will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8495 familiar form.
8496
8497 @smallexample
8498 @group
8499 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8500 . .
8501
8502 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8503
8504 @end group
8505 @end smallexample
8506 @noindent
8507 @smallexample
8508 @group
8509 1: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: x*(x + 1.19023) (x - 1.19023)
8510 . .
8511
8512 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8513
8514 @end group
8515 @end smallexample
8516 @noindent
8517 @smallexample
8518 @group
8519 1: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8520 . .
8521
8522 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8523 @end group
8524 @end smallexample
8525
8526 @noindent
8527 Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8528 same as the original polynomial.
8529
8530 @node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8531 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8532
8533 @smallexample
8534 @group
8535 1: x sin(pi x) 1: sin(pi x) / pi^2 - x cos(pi x) / pi
8536 . .
8537
8538 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8539
8540 @end group
8541 @end smallexample
8542 @noindent
8543 @smallexample
8544 @group
8545 1: [y, 1]
8546 2: sin(pi x) / pi^2 - x cos(pi x) / pi
8547 .
8548
8549 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8550
8551 @end group
8552 @end smallexample
8553 @noindent
8554 @smallexample
8555 @group
8556 1: [sin(pi y) / pi^2 - y cos(pi y) / pi, 1 / pi]
8557 .
8558
8559 V M $ @key{RET}
8560
8561 @end group
8562 @end smallexample
8563 @noindent
8564 @smallexample
8565 @group
8566 1: sin(pi y) / pi^2 - y cos(pi y) / pi - 1 / pi
8567 .
8568
8569 V R -
8570
8571 @end group
8572 @end smallexample
8573 @noindent
8574 @smallexample
8575 @group
8576 1: sin(3.14159 y) / 9.8696 - y cos(3.14159 y) / 3.14159 - 0.3183
8577 .
8578
8579 =
8580
8581 @end group
8582 @end smallexample
8583 @noindent
8584 @smallexample
8585 @group
8586 1: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8587 .
8588
8589 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8590 @end group
8591 @end smallexample
8592
8593 @node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8594 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8595
8596 @noindent
8597 The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8598 the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8599 coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8600 coefficients. Here's one way:
8601
8602 @smallexample
8603 @group
8604 2: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
8605 1: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8606 . .
8607
8608 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8609
8610 @end group
8611 @end smallexample
8612 @noindent
8613 @smallexample
8614 @group
8615 1: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8616 . .
8617
8618 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8619 @end group
8620 @end smallexample
8621
8622 @noindent
8623 Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8624 eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8625
8626 @smallexample
8627 @group
8628 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8629 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8630 .
8631
8632 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8633
8634 @end group
8635 @end smallexample
8636 @noindent
8637 @smallexample
8638 @group
8639 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8640 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8641 .
8642
8643 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8644 @end group
8645 @end smallexample
8646
8647 @noindent
8648 Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8649 same thing.
8650
8651 @smallexample
8652 @group
8653 1: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8654 . . .
8655
8656 * .1 * 3 /
8657 @end group
8658 @end smallexample
8659
8660 @noindent
8661 Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8662
8663 @node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8664 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8665
8666 @noindent
8667 We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8668
8669 @smallexample
8670 @group
8671 ___
8672 V 2 + 2
8673 1: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: ---------
8674 . ___
8675 V 2 + 1
8676
8677 .
8678
8679 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8680 @end group
8681 @end smallexample
8682
8683 @noindent
8684 Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 @group
8688 ___ ___
8689 1: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8690 .
8691
8692 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8693
8694 @end group
8695 @end smallexample
8696 @noindent
8697 @smallexample
8698 @group
8699 ___
8700 1: V 2
8701 .
8702
8703 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c
8704 @end group
8705 @end smallexample
8706
8707 @noindent
8708 (We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8709 second step.)
8710
8711 The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8712 different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8713 sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8714
8715 @node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8716 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8717
8718 @noindent
8719 Here is the rule set:
8720
8721 @smallexample
8722 @group
8723 [ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8724 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8725 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8726 @end group
8727 @end smallexample
8728
8729 @noindent
8730 The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8731 into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8732 second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8733 is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8734 says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8735 then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8736 numbers.
8737
8738 Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8739 conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8740 the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8741 the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8742 extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8743
8744 Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8745 three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8746 which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8747 help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8748 @samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8749 function.
8750
8751 @node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8752 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8753
8754 @noindent
8755 He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8756 @w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8757 apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8758 @samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8759 @samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8760 around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8761 to make sure the rule applied only once.
8762
8763 (Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8764 really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8765 treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8766 to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8767 ``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8768 @samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8769 @samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8770 on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8771 @samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8772
8773 @node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8774 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8775
8776 @noindent
8777 @ignore
8778 @starindex
8779 @end ignore
8780 @tindex seq
8781 Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
8782
8783 @smallexample
8784 @group
8785 [ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
8786 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
8787 @end group
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
8791 rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
8792
8793 @example
8794 seq( 3, 1)
8795 seq(10, 2)
8796 seq( 5, 3)
8797 seq(16, 4)
8798 seq( 8, 5)
8799 seq( 4, 6)
8800 seq( 2, 7)
8801 seq( 1, 8)
8802 @end example
8803
8804 @noindent
8805 whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
8806
8807 We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
8808
8809 @smallexample
8810 @group
8811 [ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
8812 seq(1, c) := c,
8813 ... ]
8814 @end group
8815 @end smallexample
8816
8817 @noindent
8818 Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
8819 as the result.
8820
8821 The change to return a vector is quite simple:
8822
8823 @smallexample
8824 @group
8825 [ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
8826 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
8827 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
8828 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
8829 @end group
8830 @end smallexample
8831
8832 @noindent
8833 Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
8834
8835 Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
8836 rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
8837 But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
8838 initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
8839
8840 While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
8841 was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
8842 will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
8843 the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
8844 apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
8845
8846 @node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8847 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
8848
8849 @noindent
8850 @ignore
8851 @starindex
8852 @end ignore
8853 @tindex nterms
8854 If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' must
8855 be `@tfn{nterms(}@var{a}@tfn{)}' plus `@tfn{nterms(}@var{b}@tfn{)}'. If @expr{x}
8856 is not a sum, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' = 1.
8857
8858 @smallexample
8859 @group
8860 [ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
8861 nterms(x) := 1 ]
8862 @end group
8863 @end smallexample
8864
8865 @noindent
8866 Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
8867 match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
8868 already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
8869
8870 @node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8871 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
8872
8873 @noindent
8874 Here is a rule set that will do the job:
8875
8876 @smallexample
8877 @group
8878 [ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
8879 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8880 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8881 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8882 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8883 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
8884 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
8885 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
8886 @end group
8887 @end smallexample
8888
8889 If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
8890 on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
8891 testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
8892 say, @code{O}, first.
8893
8894 The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
8895 rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
8896 Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
8897 apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
8898 you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
8899
8900 In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O.
8901 The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
8902 @samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
8903 as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
8904
8905 The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
8906
8907 The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
8908 is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
8909 with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
8910
8911 The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
8912 (It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
8913 is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
8914 @w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
8915 but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
8916
8917 The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
8918
8919 Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
8920 that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
8921 function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
8922 a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
8923 on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
8924 objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
8925 @code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
8926 rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
8927 you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
8928 before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
8929 although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
8930
8931 @c [fix-ref Compositions]
8932 Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
8933 similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
8934 like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
8935 @var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
8936 power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
8937 and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
8938 with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
8939 objects have a special display format that makes them look like
8940 @samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
8941 for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
8942 this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
8943 in Lisp.)
8944
8945 @node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8946 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
8947
8948 @noindent
8949 Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
8950 @kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
8951 variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
8952 change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
8953 to be used within @code{ninteg}.
8954
8955 The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
8956 (The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
8957
8958 @node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8959 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
8960
8961 @noindent
8962 One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
8963 it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
8964
8965 Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
8966 again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
8967
8968 Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
8969 command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
8970 which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
8971
8972 Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
8973 @w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
8974
8975 @node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8976 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
8977
8978 @noindent
8979 Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
8980 algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
8981
8982 @noindent
8983 Computing
8984 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
8985 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
8986
8987 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
8988
8989 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
8990
8991 @noindent
8992 Computing the logarithm:
8993
8994 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
8995
8996 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
8997
8998 @noindent
8999 Computing the vector of integers:
9000
9001 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9002 @kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9003 from the stack.)
9004
9005 Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9006 number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9007 next command.)
9008
9009 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9010
9011 @node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9012 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9013
9014 @noindent
9015 Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9016
9017 @node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9018 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9019
9020 @smallexample
9021 @group
9022 2: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
9023 1: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9024 . .
9025
9026 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9027 @end group
9028 @end smallexample
9029
9030 @noindent
9031 This answer is quite accurate.
9032
9033 @node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9034 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9035
9036 @noindent
9037 Here is the matrix:
9038
9039 @example
9040 [ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9041 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9042 @end example
9043
9044 @noindent
9045 Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9046 and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9047
9048 @example
9049 C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9050 @end example
9051
9052 @noindent
9053 This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9054 matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9055 @texline @math{\log_2 n}
9056 @infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9057 steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9058 number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9059 @kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9060 required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9061
9062 @node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9063 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9064
9065 @noindent
9066 The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9067 the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9068 a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9069
9070 @smallexample
9071 @group
9072 1: 1 2: 1 1: .
9073 . 1: 4
9074 .
9075
9076 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9077 @end group
9078 @end smallexample
9079
9080 @noindent
9081 The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9082 so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9083 itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9084 count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9085 the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9086 the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9087 loop counter exceeds 4.
9088
9089 @smallexample
9090 @group
9091 2: 31 3: 31
9092 1: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9093 . 1: 4.02724519544
9094 .
9095
9096 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9097 @end group
9098 @end smallexample
9099
9100 Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9101 harmonic number is 4.02.
9102
9103 @node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9104 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9105
9106 @noindent
9107 The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9108 the formula
9109 @texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9110 @infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9111
9112 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9113 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9114 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9115 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9116 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9117 just for purposes of illustration.)
9118
9119 @smallexample
9120 @group
9121 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
9122 1: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9123 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9124 .
9125
9126 ' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9127
9128 @end group
9129 @end smallexample
9130 @noindent
9131 @smallexample
9132 @group
9133 2: 4.5
9134 1: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9135 .
9136
9137 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9138 @end group
9139 @end smallexample
9140
9141 Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9142 limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9143 (Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9144 repetitions are done.)
9145
9146 @smallexample
9147 @group
9148 1: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9149 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9150 1: 4.5 .
9151 .
9152
9153 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9154 @end group
9155 @end smallexample
9156
9157 This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9158 old one to see if we've converged.
9159
9160 @smallexample
9161 @group
9162 3: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
9163 2: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
9164 1: 4.5 .
9165 .
9166
9167 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9168 @end group
9169 @end smallexample
9170
9171 The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9172 the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9173
9174 @smallexample
9175 @group
9176 2: 5.26345856348
9177 1: 0.499999999997
9178 .
9179
9180 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9181 @end group
9182 @end smallexample
9183
9184 Let's test the new definition again:
9185
9186 @smallexample
9187 @group
9188 2: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
9189 1: 1 .
9190 .
9191
9192 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9193 @end group
9194 @end smallexample
9195
9196 Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9197
9198 @example
9199 @group
9200 C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9201 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9202 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9203 Z >
9204 Z '
9205 C-x )
9206 @end group
9207 @end example
9208
9209 @c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9210 It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9211 repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9212 to see how to use it.
9213
9214 @c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9215 Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9216 method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9217 @xref{Root Finding}.
9218
9219 @node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9220 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9221
9222 @noindent
9223 The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9224 ``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9225 reduce the problem using
9226 @texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9227 @infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9228 on to compute
9229 @texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9230 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9231 and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9232 step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9233
9234 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9235 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9236 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9237 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9238 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9239 just for purposes of illustration.)
9240
9241 @smallexample
9242 @group
9243 1: 1. 1: 1.
9244 . .
9245
9246 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9247 @end group
9248 @end smallexample
9249
9250 Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9251 factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9252
9253 (By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9254 otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9255 and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9256 are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9257
9258 @smallexample
9259 @group
9260 3: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
9261 2: 1. 1: 1 .
9262 1: 5 .
9263 .
9264
9265 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9266 @end group
9267 @end smallexample
9268
9269 Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9270 @texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9271 @infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9272 minus the adjustment factor.
9273
9274 @smallexample
9275 @group
9276 2: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
9277 1: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9278 . .
9279
9280 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9281 @end group
9282 @end smallexample
9283
9284 Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9285 up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9286 @kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9287
9288 @smallexample
9289 @group
9290 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
9291 2: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
9292 1: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9293 . . 1: 36.
9294 .
9295
9296 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9297
9298 @end group
9299 @end smallexample
9300 @noindent
9301 @smallexample
9302 @group
9303 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
9304 2: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
9305 1: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9306 . .
9307
9308 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9309 @end group
9310 @end smallexample
9311
9312 This is the value of
9313 @texline @math{-\gamma},
9314 @infoline @expr{- gamma},
9315 with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9316 a higher precision:
9317
9318 @smallexample
9319 @group
9320 2: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
9321 1: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9322
9323 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9324 @end group
9325 @end smallexample
9326
9327 Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9328
9329 @example
9330 @group
9331 C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9332 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9333 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9334 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9335 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9336 2 Z )
9337 Z '
9338 C-x )
9339 @end group
9340 @end example
9341
9342 @node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9343 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9344
9345 @noindent
9346 Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9347 a term like
9348 @texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9349 @infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9350 Taking the derivative of a constant
9351 produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9352 derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9353 coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9354
9355 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9356 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9357 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9358 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9359 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9360 just for purposes of illustration.)
9361
9362 @smallexample
9363 @group
9364 2: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
9365 1: 6 2: 0
9366 . 1: 6
9367 .
9368
9369 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9370 @end group
9371 @end smallexample
9372
9373 @noindent
9374 Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9375
9376 @smallexample
9377 @group
9378 2: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
9379 1: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9380 . 1: 1 .
9381 .
9382
9383 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9384 @end group
9385 @end smallexample
9386
9387 @noindent
9388 Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9389 in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9390 have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9391
9392 @smallexample
9393 @group
9394 1: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9395 . . .
9396
9397 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9398 @end group
9399 @end smallexample
9400
9401 To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9402 against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9403
9404 @smallexample
9405 @group
9406 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9407 1: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9408 . .
9409
9410 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9411
9412 @end group
9413 @end smallexample
9414 @noindent
9415 @smallexample
9416 @group
9417 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
9418 1: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9419 .
9420
9421 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9422 @end group
9423 @end smallexample
9424
9425 Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9426
9427 @example
9428 @group
9429 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9430 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9431 a d x @key{RET}
9432 1 Z ) r 1
9433 Z '
9434 C-x )
9435
9436 C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9437 @end group
9438 @end example
9439
9440 @node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9441 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9442
9443 @noindent
9444 First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9445 @w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9446 return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9447 sure the stack comes out right.
9448
9449 @smallexample
9450 @group
9451 2: 4 1: 4 2: 4
9452 1: 2 . 1: 2
9453 . .
9454
9455 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9456 @end group
9457 @end smallexample
9458
9459 The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9460 of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9461 definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9462 to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9463
9464 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9465 below. You can use @kbd{C-x * m} to load it from there.)
9466
9467 @smallexample
9468 @group
9469 2: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
9470 1: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9471 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9472 1: 2 .
9473 .
9474
9475 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9476
9477 @end group
9478 @end smallexample
9479 @noindent
9480 @smallexample
9481 @group
9482 4: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
9483 3: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
9484 2: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
9485 1: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9486 . . .
9487
9488 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9489 @end group
9490 @end smallexample
9491
9492 @noindent
9493 (Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9494 it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9495
9496 @smallexample
9497 @group
9498 3: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
9499 2: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
9500 1: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9501 . 1: 2 .
9502 .
9503
9504 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9505
9506 @end group
9507 @end smallexample
9508 @noindent
9509 @smallexample
9510 @group
9511 1: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9512 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9513 . .
9514
9515 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9516 @end group
9517 @end smallexample
9518
9519 Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9520 bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9521 the right answers.
9522
9523 Here's the full program once again:
9524
9525 @example
9526 @group
9527 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9528 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9529 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9530 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9531 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9532 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9533 Z ]
9534 Z ]
9535 C-x )
9536 @end group
9537 @end example
9538
9539 You can read this definition using @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9540 followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9541 first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9542 definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{C-x * m} is often
9543 the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9544
9545 @node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9546 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9547
9548 @noindent
9549 This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9550 denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9551
9552 First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9553 Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9554
9555 @smallexample
9556 s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9557 [ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9558 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9559 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9560 C-c C-c
9561 @end smallexample
9562
9563 Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9564
9565 @smallexample
9566 @group
9567 2: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
9568 1: 2 . .
9569 .
9570
9571 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9572 @end group
9573 @end smallexample
9574
9575 As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9576 rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9577 the last rule.
9578
9579 @c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9580 @tex
9581 \global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9582 @end tex
9583
9584 @c [reference]
9585
9586 @node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9587 @chapter Introduction
9588
9589 @noindent
9590 This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9591 It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9592 numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9593
9594 @c [when-split]
9595 @c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9596
9597 @menu
9598 * Basic Commands::
9599 * Help Commands::
9600 * Stack Basics::
9601 * Numeric Entry::
9602 * Algebraic Entry::
9603 * Quick Calculator::
9604 * Prefix Arguments::
9605 * Undo::
9606 * Error Messages::
9607 * Multiple Calculators::
9608 * Troubleshooting Commands::
9609 @end menu
9610
9611 @node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9612 @section Basic Commands
9613
9614 @noindent
9615 @pindex calc
9616 @pindex calc-mode
9617 @cindex Starting the Calculator
9618 @cindex Running the Calculator
9619 To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9620 By default this creates a pair of small windows, @samp{*Calculator*}
9621 and @samp{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9622 Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9623 It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9624 mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9625 mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9626 list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9627 Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9628 still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9629 to turn the trail window off, but the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9630 still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9631
9632 @kindex C-x * c
9633 @kindex C-x * *
9634 @ignore
9635 @mindex @null
9636 @end ignore
9637 In most installations, the @kbd{C-x * c} key sequence is a more
9638 convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{C-x * *}
9639 is a synonym for @kbd{C-x * c} unless you last used Calc
9640 in its Keypad mode.
9641
9642 @kindex x
9643 @kindex M-x
9644 @pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9645 Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9646 letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9647 for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9648 key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9649 is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9650 for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9651 @kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9652
9653 Although Calc is designed to be used from the keyboard, some of
9654 Calc's more common commands are available from a menu. In the menu, the
9655 arguments to the functions are given by referring to their stack level
9656 numbers.
9657
9658 @cindex Extensions module
9659 @cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9660 The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}, the
9661 Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9662 contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9663 auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9664 functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9665 of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9666 little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9667 extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9668 extensions by using the @kbd{C-x * L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9669 command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9670
9671 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{C-x * c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9672 the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9673 If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9674 loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9675 of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9676 to auto-load the Calculator.
9677
9678 @kindex C-x * b
9679 @pindex full-calc
9680 If you type @kbd{C-x * b}, then next time you use @kbd{C-x * c} you
9681 will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9682 When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{C-x * c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9683 command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9684 @samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9685 as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9686 like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9687
9688 @kindex C-x * o
9689 @pindex calc-other-window
9690 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is like @kbd{C-x * c} except that the Calc
9691 window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9692 window, @kbd{C-x * o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9693 @kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9694 tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9695 @kbd{C-x * o} takes care not to do.)
9696
9697 @ignore
9698 @mindex C-x * q
9699 @end ignore
9700 For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{C-x * q} (@code{quick-calc})
9701 which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9702 displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9703 any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9704
9705 @ignore
9706 @mindex C-x * k
9707 @end ignore
9708 Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9709 @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9710 ``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9711 the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9712
9713 @kindex q
9714 @pindex calc-quit
9715 @cindex Quitting the Calculator
9716 @cindex Exiting the Calculator
9717 The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9718 Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9719 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9720 contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}
9721 again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9722 @code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{C-x * *} as toggling the
9723 Calculator on and off.
9724
9725 @kindex C-x * x
9726 The @kbd{C-x * x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9727 user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9728 It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9729
9730 @kindex d @key{SPC}
9731 @pindex calc-refresh
9732 @cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9733 @cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9734 The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9735 of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9736 buffer have been damaged somehow.
9737
9738 @ignore
9739 @mindex o
9740 @end ignore
9741 The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9742 ``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9743
9744 @kindex <
9745 @kindex >
9746 @pindex calc-scroll-left
9747 @pindex calc-scroll-right
9748 @cindex Horizontal scrolling
9749 @cindex Scrolling
9750 @cindex Wide text, scrolling
9751 The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9752 @code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9753 scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9754 default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9755 window whenever it can.)
9756
9757 @kindex @{
9758 @kindex @}
9759 @pindex calc-scroll-down
9760 @pindex calc-scroll-up
9761 @cindex Vertical scrolling
9762 The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9763 and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9764 height of the Calc window.
9765
9766 @kindex C-x * 0
9767 @pindex calc-reset
9768 The @kbd{C-x * 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{C-x *} followed
9769 by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9770 the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9771 that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9772 caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9773 values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9774 its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9775 With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of
9776 the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9777 negative prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of the
9778 stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9779
9780 @node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
9781 @section Help Commands
9782
9783 @noindent
9784 @cindex Help commands
9785 @kindex ?
9786 @kindex a ?
9787 @kindex b ?
9788 @kindex c ?
9789 @kindex d ?
9790 @kindex f ?
9791 @kindex g ?
9792 @kindex j ?
9793 @kindex k ?
9794 @kindex m ?
9795 @kindex r ?
9796 @kindex s ?
9797 @kindex t ?
9798 @kindex u ?
9799 @kindex v ?
9800 @kindex V ?
9801 @kindex z ?
9802 @kindex Z ?
9803 @pindex calc-help
9804 The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
9805 Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs's
9806 @key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
9807 @kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
9808 prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
9809 to see additional commands for that prefix.)
9810
9811 @kindex h h
9812 @pindex calc-full-help
9813 The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
9814 responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
9815 summary of Calc keystrokes.
9816
9817 In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
9818 provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
9819 Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
9820
9821 @kindex h i
9822 @kindex C-x * i
9823 @kindex i
9824 @pindex calc-info
9825 The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
9826 to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
9827 @kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
9828 is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
9829 manual. The @kbd{C-x * i} command is another way to read the Calc
9830 manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
9831 not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
9832 @kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
9833 different command in a future version of Calc.
9834
9835 @kindex h t
9836 @kindex C-x * t
9837 @pindex calc-tutorial
9838 The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
9839 the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
9840 except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
9841 than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
9842 node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
9843 using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
9844 The @kbd{C-x * t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
9845 all times).
9846
9847 @kindex h s
9848 @kindex C-x * s
9849 @pindex calc-info-summary
9850 The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
9851 on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{C-x * s}
9852 key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
9853
9854 @kindex h k
9855 @pindex calc-describe-key
9856 The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
9857 sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
9858 up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
9859 command. This works by looking up the textual description of
9860 the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
9861 node indicated by the index.
9862
9863 Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
9864 strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
9865 more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
9866 (@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
9867
9868 @kindex h c
9869 @pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
9870 The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
9871 key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
9872 the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
9873 Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
9874 there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
9875 (@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
9876 gives the description:
9877
9878 @smallexample
9879 H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
9880 @end smallexample
9881
9882 @noindent
9883 which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
9884 takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
9885 then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
9886 The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
9887 additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
9888
9889 @kindex h f
9890 @pindex calc-describe-function
9891 The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
9892 algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
9893 algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
9894 Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
9895 up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
9896 symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
9897 @samp{=>}.
9898
9899 @kindex h v
9900 @pindex calc-describe-variable
9901 The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
9902 variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
9903 @code{PlotRejects}.
9904
9905 @kindex h b
9906 @pindex describe-bindings
9907 The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
9908 @kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
9909 listed.
9910
9911 @kindex h n
9912 The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
9913 the ``news'' or change history of Calc. This is kept in the file
9914 @file{README}, which Calc looks for in the same directory as the Calc
9915 source files.
9916
9917 @kindex h C-c
9918 @kindex h C-d
9919 @kindex h C-w
9920 The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
9921 distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
9922 pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
9923 Bugs'' sections of the manual.
9924
9925 @node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
9926 @section Stack Basics
9927
9928 @noindent
9929 @cindex Stack basics
9930 @c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
9931 Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
9932 Tutorial}.
9933
9934 To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
9935 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
9936 (@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
9937 The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
9938 @kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
9939 and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
9940 further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
9941 3 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
9942
9943 Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
9944 of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
9945 the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
9946 directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
9947 command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
9948 @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
9949
9950 @kindex d l
9951 @pindex calc-line-numbering
9952 Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
9953 the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
9954 of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
9955 whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
9956 slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
9957
9958 @kindex o
9959 @pindex calc-realign
9960 The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
9961 the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
9962 horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
9963 argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
9964
9965 The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
9966 two consecutive numbers.
9967 (After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
9968 would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
9969 right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
9970 the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
9971
9972 The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
9973 The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
9974 @xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
9975 commands.
9976
9977 @node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
9978 @section Numeric Entry
9979
9980 @noindent
9981 @kindex 0-9
9982 @kindex .
9983 @kindex e
9984 @cindex Numeric entry
9985 @cindex Entering numbers
9986 Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
9987 minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
9988 or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
9989 pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
9990 you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
9991
9992 @cindex Minus signs
9993 @cindex Negative numbers, entering
9994 @kindex _
9995 There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
9996 typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
9997 (change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
9998 different keys for these operations, respectively:
9999 @kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10000 the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10001 of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10002 The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10003 the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10004 number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10005 @kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10006
10007 Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10008 non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10009 These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10010 data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10011
10012 During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10013
10014 @node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10015 @section Algebraic Entry
10016
10017 @noindent
10018 @kindex '
10019 @pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10020 @cindex Algebraic notation
10021 @cindex Formulas, entering
10022 The @kbd{'} (@code{calc-algebraic-entry}) command can be used to enter
10023 calculations in algebraic form. This is accomplished by typing the
10024 apostrophe key, ', followed by the expression in standard format:
10025
10026 @example
10027 ' 2+3*4 @key{RET}.
10028 @end example
10029
10030 @noindent
10031 This will compute
10032 @texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10033 @infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10034 and push it on the stack. If you wish you can
10035 ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10036 expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10037 clear previous results off the stack.
10038
10039 You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
10040 the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do
10041 this would be to fix a typo, as the full Emacs cursor motion and editing
10042 keys are available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
10043
10044 In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10045 press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10046 you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10047 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10048
10049 @kindex m a
10050 @pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10051 @cindex Algebraic Mode
10052 If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10053 (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10054 digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10055 start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10056 you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10057 begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10058 but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10059 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10060 thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10061
10062 @cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10063 If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10064 command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10065 Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10066 only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10067
10068 @kindex m t
10069 @pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10070 @cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10071 The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10072 stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10073 punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10074 @w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10075 @kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10076 Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10077 is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10078 @kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10079 mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10080 that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10081 @samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10082
10083 Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10084 algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10085 modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10086
10087 @kindex $
10088 @cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10089 Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10090 represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10091 contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10092 stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10093 stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10094 @key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10095 initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10096 first character in the new formula.
10097
10098 Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10099 symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10100 removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10101 signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10102 adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10103 with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10104 since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10105
10106 A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10107 sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10108 like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10109 to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10110 @samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10111 on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10112
10113 If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10114 is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10115 those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10116 @samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10117 @samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10118 @key{TAB} key.
10119
10120 You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10121 of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10122 formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10123 the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10124
10125 If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10126 instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables simplification
10127 (as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10128 is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10129 on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10130 you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10131
10132 @node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10133 @section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10134
10135 @noindent
10136 @kindex C-x * q
10137 @pindex quick-calc
10138 @cindex Quick Calculator
10139 There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10140 is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{C-x * q} (or
10141 @kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10142 The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10143 area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10144
10145 You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10146 refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10147 not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10148 Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10149 forget what it was, just run @code{C-x * q} again and enter
10150 @samp{$} as the formula.
10151
10152 If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10153 session, the @kbd{C-x * q} command will create the @code{*Calculator*}
10154 buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10155 refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10156 Calculator refers to the @code{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10157 settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10158 Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10159 the regular @kbd{p} command.
10160
10161 If you use @code{C-x * q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10162 effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10163
10164 The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10165 as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10166 yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10167 to yank the result into the next @kbd{C-x * q} input line as a more
10168 explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10169 into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{C-x * c}.
10170
10171 If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10172 of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10173 buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10174
10175 Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10176 key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10177 If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10178 @samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10179 then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10180 @xref{Store and Recall}.
10181
10182 If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10183 the number will also be displayed in hex, octal and binary formats. If
10184 the integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10185 an ASCII character.
10186
10187 For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10188 result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10189 `x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10190 is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10191 running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10192 result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10193 decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10194
10195 Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10196 or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10197 merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10198 small calculations.
10199
10200 @node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10201 @section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10202
10203 @noindent
10204 Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10205 @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10206 the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10207 Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10208 and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10209
10210 As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10211 which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10212 operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10213 on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10214 on the entire stack.
10215
10216 Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10217 scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10218 operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10219 (that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10220 conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10221 @var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10222 to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10223 two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10224 prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10225 stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10226 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10227 @var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10228 (for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10229 This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10230 argument for some other purpose.
10231
10232 Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10233 a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10234 or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10235 @kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10236
10237 @kindex ~
10238 @pindex calc-num-prefix
10239 You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10240 top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10241 For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10242 (silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10243 to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10244
10245 Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10246 pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10247
10248 @node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10249 @section Undoing Mistakes
10250
10251 @noindent
10252 @kindex U
10253 @kindex C-_
10254 @pindex calc-undo
10255 @cindex Mistakes, undoing
10256 @cindex Undoing mistakes
10257 @cindex Errors, undoing
10258 The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10259 If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10260 are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10261 queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10262 The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10263 farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10264 specified number of operations. When the Calculator is quit, as with
10265 the @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command, the undo history will be
10266 truncated to the length of the customizable variable
10267 @code{calc-undo-length} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), which by default
10268 is @expr{100}. (Recall that @kbd{C-x * c} is synonymous with
10269 @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this also truncates the
10270 undo history.)
10271
10272 Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10273 undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10274 will need to reset the mode yourself.
10275
10276 @kindex D
10277 @pindex calc-redo
10278 @cindex Redoing after an Undo
10279 The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10280 mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10281 equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10282 times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10283 information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10284 information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10285 any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10286
10287 @kindex M-@key{RET}
10288 @pindex calc-last-args
10289 @cindex Last-arguments feature
10290 @cindex Arguments, restoring
10291 The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10292 it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10293 however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10294 prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10295 command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10296 onto the stack.
10297
10298 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10299 to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10300
10301 It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10302 @xref{Trail Commands}.
10303
10304 The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10305
10306 @node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10307 @section Error Messages
10308
10309 @noindent
10310 @kindex w
10311 @pindex calc-why
10312 @cindex Errors, messages
10313 @cindex Why did an error occur?
10314 Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10315 simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10316 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10317 the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10318 reasons for this to happen.
10319
10320 When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10321 produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10322 surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10323 Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10324 if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10325 the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10326 will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10327
10328 @kindex d w
10329 @pindex calc-auto-why
10330 The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10331 are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10332 after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10333 ``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10334 @emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10335 that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10336
10337 @node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10338 @section Multiple Calculators
10339
10340 @noindent
10341 @pindex another-calc
10342 It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10343 Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10344 is similar to @kbd{C-x * c} except that if a @samp{*Calculator*}
10345 buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10346 form @samp{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10347 command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10348 this would ordinarily never be done.
10349
10350 The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10351 it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10352 Calculator buffer.
10353
10354 Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10355 such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10356 variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10357 global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10358 Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10359 the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10360
10361 There is only one trail buffer, @samp{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10362 Calculator buffers.
10363
10364 @node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10365 @section Troubleshooting Commands
10366
10367 @noindent
10368 This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10369 incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10370
10371 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10372 to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10373
10374 @menu
10375 * Autoloading Problems::
10376 * Recursion Depth::
10377 * Caches::
10378 * Debugging Calc::
10379 @end menu
10380
10381 @node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10382 @subsection Autoloading Problems
10383
10384 @noindent
10385 The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10386 loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10387 Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10388 necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10389 work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10390
10391 @kindex C-x * L
10392 @pindex calc-load-everything
10393 If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{C-x * L}
10394 (@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10395 loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10396 memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10397
10398 @node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10399 @subsection Recursion Depth
10400
10401 @noindent
10402 @kindex M
10403 @kindex I M
10404 @pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10405 @pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10406 @cindex Recursion depth
10407 @cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10408 @cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10409 @cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10410 Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10411 variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10412 possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10413 ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10414 ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10415 to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10416 calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10417
10418 The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10419 is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10420 decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10421 The default value is 1000.
10422
10423 These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10424 internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10425
10426 @node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10427 @subsection Caches
10428
10429 @noindent
10430 @cindex Caches
10431 @cindex Flushing caches
10432 Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10433 example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10434 constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10435 is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10436 approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10437 unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10438 logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10439 @cpiover{4} and
10440 @texline @math{\ln 2}.
10441 @infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10442 The visible effect of caching is that
10443 high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10444 Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10445 functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10446 data points computed by the graphing commands.
10447
10448 @pindex calc-flush-caches
10449 If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10450 @code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10451 (This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10452 The @kbd{C-x * 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10453 with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10454
10455 @node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10456 @subsection Debugging Calc
10457
10458 @noindent
10459 A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10460 @xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10461 your own Calc commands.
10462
10463 @kindex Z T
10464 @pindex calc-timing
10465 The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10466 in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10467 Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10468 to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10469 accurate only to within one second.
10470
10471 All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10472 taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10473 counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10474 be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10475 implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10476 a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10477 keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10478 command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10479 to execute the whole macro.
10480
10481 Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10482 executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10483 So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10484 that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10485 this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10486 to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10487 @kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10488
10489 Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10490 @code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10491 usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10492 This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10493 the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10494 abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10495 factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10496
10497 Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10498 extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10499 the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10500 exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10501 stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10502 Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10503 in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10504 error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10505 errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10506 will be lost.
10507
10508 @node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10509 @chapter Data Types
10510
10511 @noindent
10512 This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10513 on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10514 entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10515 types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10516
10517 Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10518 numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10519 types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10520 or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10521 arbitrarily:@: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10522 Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10523 matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10524
10525 @menu
10526 * Integers:: The most basic data type.
10527 * Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10528 * Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10529 * Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10530 * Infinities::
10531 * Vectors and Matrices::
10532 * Strings::
10533 * HMS Forms::
10534 * Date Forms::
10535 * Modulo Forms::
10536 * Error Forms::
10537 * Interval Forms::
10538 * Incomplete Objects::
10539 * Variables::
10540 * Formulas::
10541 @end menu
10542
10543 @node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10544 @section Integers
10545
10546 @noindent
10547 @cindex Integers
10548 The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10549 subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10550 integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10551 integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10552 floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10553 @xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10554
10555 A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10556 sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10557 insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10558 must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10559
10560 @kindex #
10561 A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10562 between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10563 and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10564 digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10565 to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10566 may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10567 number, the current display radix is used.
10568
10569 @node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10570 @section Fractions
10571
10572 @noindent
10573 @cindex Fractions
10574 A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10575 written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10576 performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10577 @samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10578 assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10579 When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10580 simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10581
10582 Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10583 represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10584 display formats.
10585
10586 Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10587 @samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10588 form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10589
10590 @node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10591 @section Floats
10592
10593 @noindent
10594 @cindex Floating-point numbers
10595 A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10596 notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10597 governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10598 range of acceptable values is from
10599 @texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10600 @infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10601 (inclusive) to
10602 @texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10603 @infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10604 (exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10605
10606 Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10607 as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10608 messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10609 indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10610 that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10611 by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10612 overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10613 (In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10614 would have overflowed!)
10615
10616 If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10617 will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10618 value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10619 floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10620
10621 Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10622 exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10623 including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10624 of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10625 For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10626 or 0.235.
10627
10628 Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10629 all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10630 displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10631 available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10632
10633 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
10634 Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10635 of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10636 number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10637 rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10638 display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10639 as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10640 digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10641 final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10642 accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10643 result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10644 Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10645 way.
10646
10647 While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10648 and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. Since a
10649 float that is entered in a radix other that 10 will be converted to
10650 decimal, the number that Calc stores may not be exactly the number that
10651 was entered, it will be the closest decimal approximation given the
10652 current precision. The notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}}
10653 is a floating-point number whose digits are in the specified radix.
10654 Note that the @samp{.} is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point''
10655 than as a decimal point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is
10656 defined as @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can
10657 use @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific
10658 notation. The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a
10659 power of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above,
10660 the letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10661 out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10662 Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10663
10664 @node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10665 @section Complex Numbers
10666
10667 @noindent
10668 @cindex Complex numbers
10669 There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10670 polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10671 @samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10672 @var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10673 Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10674 notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10675
10676 Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10677 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'
10678 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'
10679 where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10680 @texline @math{\theta}
10681 @infoline @var{theta}
10682 is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10683 @texline @math{\theta}
10684 @infoline @var{theta}
10685 depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10686 generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10687 in radians.
10688
10689 Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10690 @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10691
10692 Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10693 results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10694 are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10695 a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10696 type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10697
10698 A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10699 is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10700 number.
10701
10702 @node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10703 @section Infinities
10704
10705 @noindent
10706 @cindex Infinity
10707 @cindex @code{inf} variable
10708 @cindex @code{uinf} variable
10709 @cindex @code{nan} variable
10710 @vindex inf
10711 @vindex uinf
10712 @vindex nan
10713 The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10714 Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10715 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10716 variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10717 names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10718 treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10719 entered using algebraic entry.
10720
10721 Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10722 ``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10723 so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10724 really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10725 larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10726 that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10727 would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10728 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10729 @texline @math{e^x}
10730 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10731 grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10732 stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10733 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10734 direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10735
10736 The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10737 really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10738 approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10739 tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10740 positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10741 @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10742 toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10743 could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10744 @samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10745 @dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10746 large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10747
10748 Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10749 Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10750 already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10751 error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10752 command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10753 @expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10754 an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10755 as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10756 is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10757 some cases.
10758
10759 Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10760 e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10761 @samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10762 adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10763 Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10764 that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10765 Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10766 note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10767 notation.
10768
10769 It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10770 @samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10771 came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10772 formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10773 or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10774 or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10775 to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10776 comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10777 arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10778 misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10779 infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10780 cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10781 and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10782 expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10783 @samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10784 (as described above).
10785
10786 Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10787 @xref{Interval Forms}.
10788
10789 @node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10790 @section Vectors and Matrices
10791
10792 @noindent
10793 @cindex Vectors
10794 @cindex Plain vectors
10795 @cindex Matrices
10796 The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10797 list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10798 whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10799 themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10800 A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10801
10802 A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10803 in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
10804 3 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
10805 numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10806 During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
10807 brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
10808 vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
10809 with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
10810 when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
10811 place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
10812 this case.
10813
10814 Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
10815 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
10816 Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
10817 the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
10818 of its elements.
10819
10820 @ignore
10821 @starindex
10822 @end ignore
10823 @tindex vec
10824 Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
10825 to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
10826 @texline @math{n\times m}
10827 @infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
10828 matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
10829 from 1 to @samp{n}.
10830
10831 @node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
10832 @section Strings
10833
10834 @noindent
10835 @kindex "
10836 @cindex Strings
10837 @cindex Character strings
10838 Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
10839 Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
10840 elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
10841 enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
10842 marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
10843 inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
10844
10845 @example
10846 @group
10847 \a 7 \^@@ 0
10848 \b 8 \^a-z 1-26
10849 \e 27 \^[ 27
10850 \f 12 \^\\ 28
10851 \n 10 \^] 29
10852 \r 13 \^^ 30
10853 \t 9 \^_ 31
10854 \^? 127
10855 @end group
10856 @end example
10857
10858 @noindent
10859 Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
10860 character from its ASCII code.
10861
10862 @kindex d "
10863 @pindex calc-display-strings
10864 Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
10865 @w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
10866 which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
10867 instead.
10868
10869 The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
10870 strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
10871 you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
10872 backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
10873 for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
10874 there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
10875
10876 The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
10877 @pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
10878 way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
10879
10880 @ignore
10881 @starindex
10882 @end ignore
10883 @tindex string
10884 There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
10885 format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
10886 is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
10887 corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
10888 marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
10889 @samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
10890 This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
10891 only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
10892 mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
10893
10894 Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
10895 Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
10896 (same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
10897 backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
10898
10899 @ignore
10900 @starindex
10901 @end ignore
10902 @tindex bstring
10903 The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
10904 the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
10905 fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
10906 character in the string.
10907
10908 @node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
10909 @section HMS Forms
10910
10911 @noindent
10912 @cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
10913 @cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
10914 @dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
10915 argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
10916 that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
10917 degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
10918 use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
10919 degrees, minutes, and seconds.
10920
10921 @kindex @@
10922 @ignore
10923 @mindex @null
10924 @end ignore
10925 @kindex ' (HMS forms)
10926 @ignore
10927 @mindex @null
10928 @end ignore
10929 @kindex " (HMS forms)
10930 @ignore
10931 @mindex @null
10932 @end ignore
10933 @kindex h (HMS forms)
10934 @ignore
10935 @mindex @null
10936 @end ignore
10937 @kindex o (HMS forms)
10938 @ignore
10939 @mindex @null
10940 @end ignore
10941 @kindex m (HMS forms)
10942 @ignore
10943 @mindex @null
10944 @end ignore
10945 @kindex s (HMS forms)
10946 The default format for HMS values is
10947 @samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
10948 @samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
10949 @samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
10950 @samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
10951 accepted in place of @samp{"}.
10952 The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
10953 The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
10954 The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
10955 (exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
10956 @var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
10957 as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
10958 Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
10959
10960 HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
10961 the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
10962 forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
10963 two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
10964
10965 @pindex calc-time
10966 @cindex Time of day
10967 Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
10968 the stack as an HMS form.
10969
10970 @node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
10971 @section Date Forms
10972
10973 @noindent
10974 @cindex Date forms
10975 A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
10976 Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
10977 produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
10978 a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
10979 computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
10980 number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
10981 are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
10982
10983 Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
10984 The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
10985 or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
10986 Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
10987 notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
10988
10989 Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
10990 of days since midnight on the morning of January 1 of the year 1 AD.
10991 If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
10992 if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
10993 a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991>}
10994 is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
10995 12 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
10996 time can be stored without roundoff error.
10997
10998 If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
10999 additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
11000 precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
11001 decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11002 time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11003 if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11004 issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11005 forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11006 never an issue for them.
11007
11008 You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11009 (@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11010 of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11011
11012 Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11013 year numbers represent years BC. There is no ``year 0''; the day
11014 before @samp{<Mon Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Sun Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11015 days 1 and 0 respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme. The
11016 Gregorian calendar is used for all dates, including dates before the
11017 Gregorian calendar was invented. Thus Calc's use of the day number
11018 @mathit{-10000} to represent August 15, 28 BC should be taken with a
11019 grain of salt.
11020
11021 @cindex Julian calendar
11022 @cindex Gregorian calendar
11023 Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11024 Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the confusion
11025 caused by the irregular Roman calendar that was used before that time.
11026 The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in
11027 all years divisible by four. After some initial confusion, the
11028 calendar was adopted around the year we call 8 AD, although the years were
11029 numbered differently and did not necessarily begin on January 1. Some centuries
11030 later it became apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was
11031 itself not quite right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the
11032 Gregorian calendar, which added the new rule that years divisible
11033 by 100, but not by 400, were not to be considered leap years
11034 despite being divisible by four. Many countries delayed adoption
11035 of the Gregorian calendar because of religious differences, and
11036 used differing year numbers and start-of-year for other reasons;
11037 for example, in early 1752 England changed the start of its year from
11038 March 25 to January 1, and in September it switched to the Gregorian
11039 calendar: in England, the day after December 31, 1750 was January 1,
11040 1750 and the day after March 24, 1750 was March 25, 1751, but the day
11041 after December 31, 1751 was January 1, 1752 and the day after
11042 September 2, 1752 was September 14, 1752. To take another example,
11043 Russia switched both year numbering and start-of-year in 1700, but did
11044 not adopt the Gregorian calendar until 1918. Calc's reckoning
11045 therefore matches English practice starting in 1752 and Russian
11046 practice starting in 1918, but disagrees with earlier dates in both
11047 countries.
11048
11049 Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second'' as
11050 well, but Calc does not take these minor effects into account.
11051 (If it did, it would have to report a non-integer number of days
11052 between, say, @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11053 @samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11054
11055 @cindex Julian day counting
11056 Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also called
11057 ``Julian.'' The Julian day number is the numbers of days since
11058 12:00 noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC, which in Calc's scheme (in GMT)
11059 is @mathit{-1721423.5} (recall that Calc starts at midnight instead
11060 of noon). Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by unpacking a
11061 date form into a Julian day number, simply add 1721423.5 after
11062 compensating for the time zone difference. The built-in @kbd{t J}
11063 command performs this conversion for you.
11064
11065 The Julian day number is based on the Julian cycle, which was invented
11066 in 1583 by Joseph Justus Scaliger. Scaliger named it the Julian cycle
11067 since it involves the Julian calendar, but some have suggested that
11068 Scaliger named it in honor of his father, Julius Caesar Scaliger. The
11069 Julian cycle is based on three other cycles: the indiction cycle, the
11070 Metonic cycle, and the solar cycle. The indiction cycle is a 15 year
11071 cycle originally used by the Romans for tax purposes but later used to
11072 date medieval documents. The Metonic cycle is a 19 year cycle; 19
11073 years is close to being a common multiple of a solar year and a lunar
11074 month, and so every 19 years the phases of the moon will occur on the
11075 same days of the year. The solar cycle is a 28 year cycle; the Julian
11076 calendar repeats itself every 28 years. The smallest time period
11077 which contains multiples of all three cycles is the least common
11078 multiple of 15 years, 19 years and 28 years, which (since they're
11079 pairwise relatively prime) is
11080 @texline @math{15\times 19\times 28 = 7980} years.
11081 @infoline 15*19*28 = 7980 years.
11082 This is the length of a Julian cycle. Working backwards, the previous
11083 year in which all three cycles began was 4713 BC, and so Scaliger
11084 chose that year as the beginning of a Julian cycle. Since at the time
11085 there were no historical records from before 4713 BC, using this year
11086 as a starting point had the advantage of avoiding negative year
11087 numbers. In 1849, the astronomer John Herschel (son of William
11088 Herschel) suggested using the number of days since the beginning of
11089 the Julian cycle as an astronomical dating system; this idea was taken
11090 up by other astronomers. (At the time, noon was the start of the
11091 astronomical day. Herschel originally suggested counting the days
11092 since Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon Alexandria time; this was later amended to
11093 noon GMT.) Julian day numbering is largely used in astronomy.
11094
11095 @cindex Unix time format
11096 The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11097 seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11098 value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11099 for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11100 seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11101 integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11102 day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11103 719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11104 to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11105 Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11106 need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11107 for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11108 counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11109 conversions.
11110
11111 @node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11112 @section Modulo Forms
11113
11114 @noindent
11115 @cindex Modulo forms
11116 A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11117 an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11118 often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11119 `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}',
11120 where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11121 @texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11122 @infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11123 In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11124 integers but this is not required.
11125
11126 @ignore
11127 @mindex M
11128 @end ignore
11129 @kindex M (modulo forms)
11130 @ignore
11131 @mindex mod
11132 @end ignore
11133 @tindex mod (operator)
11134 To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11135 key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11136 shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11137 that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11138 type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11139 Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11140
11141 Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11142 The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11143 the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11144 The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11145 further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11146 the result always lies in the desired range.
11147
11148 When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11149 the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11150 @expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11151 the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11152 possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11153 to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11154 are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11155 actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11156
11157 @cindex Modulo division
11158 Two modulo forms `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'
11159 can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11160 integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11161 `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'. If
11162 there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11163 @expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11164 division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11165 roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11166 @w{`@tfn{(}@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}@tfn{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11167 in the sense of reducing
11168 @texline @math{\sqrt a}
11169 @infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11170 modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11171 number-theoretical point of view.)
11172
11173 It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11174 HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11175 form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11176 also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11177 mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11178 @w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
11179 24 radians!
11180
11181 Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11182 enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11183 to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11184
11185 You can use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11186 @xref{Packing and Unpacking}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11187
11188 @ignore
11189 @starindex
11190 @end ignore
11191 @tindex makemod
11192 The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11193 @w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11194
11195 @node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11196 @section Error Forms
11197
11198 @noindent
11199 @cindex Error forms
11200 @cindex Standard deviations
11201 An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11202 deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11203 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11204 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} sigma'
11205 stands for an uncertain value which follows
11206 a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11207 deviation or ``error''
11208 @texline @math{\sigma}.
11209 @infoline @expr{sigma}.
11210 Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11211 formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11212 complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11213 absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11214 regular number by the Calculator.
11215
11216 All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11217 Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11218 numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11219 @texline @math{\sin x}
11220 @infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11221 is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11222 evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11223 @expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11224 of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11225 @tex
11226 $$ \eqalign{
11227 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11228 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11229 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11230 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11231 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11232 \right| \right)^2
11233 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11234 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11235 } $$
11236 @end tex
11237 Note that this
11238 definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11239 A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11240 is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11241 of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11242 distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11243 The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11244 the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11245
11246 Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11247 of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11248 nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11249 are small. As an example, the error arising from
11250 @texline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}@tfn{)}'
11251 @infoline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}@tfn{)}'
11252 is
11253 @texline `@math{\sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11254 @infoline `@var{sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11255 When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11256 @texline @math{\cos x}
11257 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11258 is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11259 @texline @math{\sigma};
11260 @infoline @expr{sigma};
11261 this makes sense, since
11262 @texline @math{\sin x}
11263 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11264 is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11265 produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11266 @texline @math{\cos x}
11267 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11268 is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11269 small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11270 has relatively little effect on the value of
11271 @texline @math{\sin x}.
11272 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11273 However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11274 Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11275 we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11276 analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11277 @texline @math{\sin x}
11278 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11279 would indeed have been negligible.
11280
11281 @ignore
11282 @mindex p
11283 @end ignore
11284 @kindex p (error forms)
11285 @tindex +/-
11286 To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11287 (``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11288 typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11289 @kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-+} to
11290 type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11291
11292 Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11293 are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11294 to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11295 the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11296 used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11297 distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11298 considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11299 not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11300
11301 Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11302 the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11303
11304 @ignore
11305 @starindex
11306 @end ignore
11307 @tindex sdev
11308 The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11309
11310 @node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11311 @section Interval Forms
11312
11313 @noindent
11314 @cindex Interval forms
11315 An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11316 the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11317 inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11318 obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11319 you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11320 number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11321 from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11322 of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11323 set of possible values of the input.
11324
11325 @ifnottex
11326 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11327 intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11328 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11329 @emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11330 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11331 terms,
11332 @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11333 @samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11334 @samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11335 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11336 @end ifnottex
11337 @tex
11338 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11339 intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11340 \samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11341 \emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11342 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11343 terms,
11344 $$ \eqalign{
11345 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11346 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11347 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11348 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11349 } $$
11350 @end tex
11351
11352 The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11353 (or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11354 real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11355 must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11356 one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11357 automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11358 @samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11359 guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11360 interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11361 or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11362 In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11363 the real infinities.
11364
11365 Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11366 formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11367 In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11368 left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11369 rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11370 get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11371 a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11372
11373 Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11374 (@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11375 as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11376 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11377 otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11378 a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11379 to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11380 contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11381 @samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11382
11383 While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11384 based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11385 form
11386 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11387 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11388 means a variable is random, and its value could
11389 be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11390 @texline @math{\sigma}
11391 @infoline @var{sigma}
11392 of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11393 `@tfn{[}@var{a} @tfn{..@:} @var{b}@tfn{]}' means a
11394 variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11395 range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11396 interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11397 answer.
11398
11399 Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11400 HMS forms or date forms.
11401
11402 @xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11403 as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11404
11405 @ignore
11406 @starindex
11407 @end ignore
11408 @tindex intv
11409 The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11410 from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11411 be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
11412 3 for @samp{[..]}.
11413
11414 Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11415 taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11416 minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11417 infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11418 which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11419 calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11420 be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11421 should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11422 (slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11423 error.
11424
11425 @node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11426 @section Incomplete Objects
11427
11428 @noindent
11429 @ignore
11430 @mindex [ ]
11431 @end ignore
11432 @kindex [
11433 @ignore
11434 @mindex ( )
11435 @end ignore
11436 @kindex (
11437 @kindex ,
11438 @ignore
11439 @mindex @null
11440 @end ignore
11441 @kindex ]
11442 @ignore
11443 @mindex @null
11444 @end ignore
11445 @kindex )
11446 @cindex Incomplete vectors
11447 @cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11448 @cindex Incomplete interval forms
11449 When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11450 vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11451 number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11452 the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11453 and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11454 on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11455
11456 As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11457 pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11458 pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11459
11460 If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11461 all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11462 is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11463 prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11464
11465 As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11466 @kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11467 formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11468 from the list.
11469
11470 @kindex ;
11471 The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11472 numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11473 creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11474 equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11475
11476 @kindex ..
11477 @pindex calc-dots
11478 Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11479 @kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11480 the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11481 you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11482 part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11483 the @code{calc-dots} command.
11484
11485 If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11486 and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11487
11488 @node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11489 @section Variables
11490
11491 @noindent
11492 @cindex Variables, in formulas
11493 A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11494 calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11495 variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11496 or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11497 Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11498 (The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11499 @code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11500 Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11501 formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11502 @samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11503 corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11504 contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11505 added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11506 refer to the same variable.)
11507
11508 In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11509 name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11510 convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11511 @kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11512 @w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11513 @code{foo}.
11514
11515 To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11516 stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11517 (@key{'}) key.
11518
11519 @kindex =
11520 @pindex calc-evaluate
11521 @cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11522 @cindex Variables, evaluation
11523 @cindex Formulas, evaluation
11524 The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11525 replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11526 @code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11527 Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11528 stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11529 been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11530 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11531 @var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11532 the @var{n}th stack entry.
11533
11534 @cindex @code{e} variable
11535 @cindex @code{pi} variable
11536 @cindex @code{i} variable
11537 @cindex @code{phi} variable
11538 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
11539 @vindex e
11540 @vindex pi
11541 @vindex i
11542 @vindex phi
11543 @vindex gamma
11544 A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11545 @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11546 (@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11547 their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11548 or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11549 simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11550
11551 The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11552 infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11553 regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11554 it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11555 a value into any of these special variables.
11556
11557 @xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11558
11559 @node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11560 @section Formulas
11561
11562 @noindent
11563 @cindex Formulas
11564 @cindex Expressions
11565 @cindex Operators in formulas
11566 @cindex Precedence of operators
11567 When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11568 in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11569 interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11570 and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11571 Parentheses may
11572 be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11573 that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11574 Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11575 with their equivalent function names, are:
11576
11577 @samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11578
11579 postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11580
11581 prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
11582
11583 @samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11584 @samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11585
11586 postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11587 and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11588
11589 @samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11590
11591 prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x});
11592
11593 @samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11594
11595 @samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11596 @samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11597
11598 infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11599
11600 @samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11601
11602 relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11603 @samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11604
11605 @samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11606
11607 @samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11608
11609 the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11610
11611 @samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11612
11613 @samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11614
11615 @samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11616
11617 @samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11618
11619 @samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11620
11621 @samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11622
11623 Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11624 strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11625 @texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11626 @infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11627
11628 @cindex Multiplication, implicit
11629 @cindex Implicit multiplication
11630 The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11631 if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11632 expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11633 same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11634 the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11635 as in @samp{f(x)},
11636 is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11637 cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11638 same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11639 is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11640 @samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11641
11642 @cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11643 The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11644 In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11645 separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11646 equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11647 to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11648 Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11649 ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11650 enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11651 interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11652 between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11653
11654 Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11655 brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11656 of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11657 separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11658 @w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11659 a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11660 instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11661 When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11662 insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11663 @w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11664
11665 The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11666 or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11667 an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11668 need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11669
11670 @cindex Function call notation
11671 A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11672 @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11673 but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11674 need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11675 @code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11676 If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11677 call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11678 left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11679 and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11680 single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11681 use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11682
11683 In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11684 (@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11685 command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11686 represent the same operation.
11687
11688 Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11689 algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11690 the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{C-x * g}
11691 and @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11692 ``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11693 use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11694 (@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11695
11696 When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11697 which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11698 you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11699 ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11700
11701 @example
11702 [ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11703 c + d,
11704 %% last line is coming up:
11705 e + f ]
11706 @end example
11707
11708 @noindent
11709 This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11710
11711 @xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11712 input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11713 formats.
11714
11715 @xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11716
11717 @node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11718 @chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11719
11720 @noindent
11721 This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11722 stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11723 type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11724
11725 @menu
11726 * Stack Manipulation::
11727 * Editing Stack Entries::
11728 * Trail Commands::
11729 * Keep Arguments::
11730 @end menu
11731
11732 @node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11733 @section Stack Manipulation Commands
11734
11735 @noindent
11736 @kindex @key{RET}
11737 @kindex @key{SPC}
11738 @pindex calc-enter
11739 @cindex Duplicating stack entries
11740 To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11741 (two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11742 Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11743 several elements at the top of the stack.
11744 Given a negative argument,
11745 these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11746 Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11747 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11748 @key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11749 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11750 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11751 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11752
11753 @kindex @key{LFD}
11754 @pindex calc-over
11755 The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11756 have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11757 except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11758 oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11759 Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11760 are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11761 @samp{10 20 30 20}.
11762
11763 @kindex @key{DEL}
11764 @kindex C-d
11765 @pindex calc-pop
11766 @cindex Removing stack entries
11767 @cindex Deleting stack entries
11768 To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11769 The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11770 (If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11771 last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11772 several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11773 element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11774 stack is emptied.
11775 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11776 @key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11777 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11778 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11779 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11780
11781 @kindex M-@key{DEL}
11782 @pindex calc-pop-above
11783 The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11784 @key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11785 prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11786 Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11787 leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11788 the third stack element.
11789
11790 @kindex @key{TAB}
11791 @pindex calc-roll-down
11792 To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11793 (@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11794 specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11795 Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11796 number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11797 top-for-bottom.
11798 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11799 @key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11800 @kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11801 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11802 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11803
11804 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
11805 @pindex calc-roll-up
11806 The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11807 except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11808 with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11809 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11810 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11811 @kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11812 @kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11813 @kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11814
11815 A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11816 terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11817 With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11818 element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11819 intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11820 element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11821 which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11822
11823 With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11824 to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11825 stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11826 rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @var{n}, also
11827 putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11828
11829 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
11830 any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
11831
11832 @kindex C-xC-t
11833 @pindex calc-transpose-lines
11834 @cindex Moving stack entries
11835 The command @kbd{C-x C-t} (@code{calc-transpose-lines}) will transpose
11836 the stack object determined by the point with the stack object at the
11837 next higher level. For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the
11838 stack and the point on the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-x C-t}
11839 creates @samp{10 20 40 30 50}. More generally, @kbd{C-x C-t} acts on
11840 the stack objects determined by the current point (and mark) similar
11841 to how the text-mode command @code{transpose-lines} acts on
11842 lines. With argument @var{n}, @kbd{C-x C-t} will move the stack object
11843 at the level above the current point and move it past N other objects;
11844 for example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack and the point on
11845 the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-u 2 C-x C-t} creates
11846 @samp{10 40 20 30 50}. With an argument of 0, @kbd{C-x C-t} will switch
11847 the stack objects at the levels determined by the point and the mark.
11848
11849 @node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
11850 @section Editing Stack Entries
11851
11852 @noindent
11853 @kindex `
11854 @pindex calc-edit
11855 @pindex calc-edit-finish
11856 @cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
11857 The @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary buffer
11858 (@samp{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using regular
11859 Emacs commands. Note that @kbd{`} is a backquote, not a quote. With a
11860 numeric prefix argument, it edits the specified number of stack entries
11861 at once. (An argument of zero edits the entire stack; a negative
11862 argument edits one specific stack entry.)
11863
11864 When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
11865 to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
11866 sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
11867 usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
11868 might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
11869
11870 When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
11871 the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
11872 original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
11873 then kills the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
11874 continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
11875 careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
11876 also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
11877
11878 The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
11879 For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
11880 @kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
11881 finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
11882
11883 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
11884 Calc will not kill the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
11885 back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
11886 should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
11887 @kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
11888 stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
11889 rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
11890 with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
11891 (@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
11892
11893 If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
11894 each line of the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
11895 separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
11896 one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
11897 @kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
11898
11899 The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
11900 text entered so far is moved to the @code{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
11901 more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
11902
11903 @node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
11904 @section Trail Commands
11905
11906 @noindent
11907 @cindex Trail buffer
11908 The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
11909 beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
11910
11911 @kindex t d
11912 @pindex calc-trail-display
11913 The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
11914 trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
11915 off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
11916 turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
11917 The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
11918 the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
11919 there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
11920 off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
11921 @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
11922
11923 @kindex t i
11924 @pindex calc-trail-in
11925 @kindex t o
11926 @pindex calc-trail-out
11927 The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
11928 (@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
11929 Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
11930 shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
11931 trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
11932 in the Calculator window.
11933
11934 @cindex Trail pointer
11935 There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
11936 any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
11937 before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
11938 trail pointer in various ways.
11939
11940 @kindex t y
11941 @pindex calc-trail-yank
11942 @cindex Retrieving previous results
11943 The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
11944 the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
11945 re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
11946 prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
11947 trail pointer.
11948
11949 @kindex t <
11950 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
11951 @kindex t >
11952 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
11953 The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
11954 (@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
11955 window left or right by one half of its width.
11956
11957 @kindex t n
11958 @pindex calc-trail-next
11959 @kindex t p
11960 @pindex calc-trail-previous
11961 @kindex t f
11962 @pindex calc-trail-forward
11963 @kindex t b
11964 @pindex calc-trail-backward
11965 The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
11966 (@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
11967 one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
11968 (@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
11969 one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
11970 arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
11971
11972 @kindex t [
11973 @pindex calc-trail-first
11974 @kindex t ]
11975 @pindex calc-trail-last
11976 @kindex t h
11977 @pindex calc-trail-here
11978 The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
11979 (@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
11980 last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
11981 moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
11982 commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
11983
11984 @kindex t s
11985 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
11986 @kindex t r
11987 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
11988 @ifnottex
11989 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
11990 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
11991 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
11992 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
11993 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
11994 it was when the search began.
11995 @end ifnottex
11996 @tex
11997 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
11998 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
11999 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12000 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12001 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12002 it was when the search began.
12003 @end tex
12004
12005 @kindex t m
12006 @pindex calc-trail-marker
12007 The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12008 line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12009 after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12010 added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12011 targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12012
12013 @kindex t k
12014 @pindex calc-trail-kill
12015 The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12016 from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12017 yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12018 into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12019 kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12020
12021 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12022 elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12023
12024 @node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12025 @section Keep Arguments
12026
12027 @noindent
12028 @kindex K
12029 @pindex calc-keep-args
12030 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12031 the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12032 arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12033 the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12034 the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12035
12036 With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12037 take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12038 a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12039 prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12040 As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12041 simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12042 formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12043 could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12044 formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12045 large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12046 @kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12047 extra work.
12048
12049 Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12050 popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12051 so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12052
12053 A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12054 For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12055 its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12056 original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12057 @kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12058 command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12059
12060 If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12061 the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12062 This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12063 onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12064 different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12065 @samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12066
12067 @node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12068 @chapter Mode Settings
12069
12070 @noindent
12071 This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12072 They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12073 the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12074
12075 @menu
12076 * General Mode Commands::
12077 * Precision::
12078 * Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12079 * Calculation Modes::
12080 * Simplification Modes::
12081 * Declarations::
12082 * Display Modes::
12083 * Language Modes::
12084 * Modes Variable::
12085 * Calc Mode Line::
12086 @end menu
12087
12088 @node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12089 @section General Mode Commands
12090
12091 @noindent
12092 @kindex m m
12093 @pindex calc-save-modes
12094 @cindex Continuous memory
12095 @cindex Saving mode settings
12096 @cindex Permanent mode settings
12097 @cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12098 You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12099 (the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12100 @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})
12101 command. This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time
12102 it starts up. The modes saved in the file include everything
12103 controlled by the @kbd{m} and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current
12104 precision and binary word size, whether or not the trail is displayed,
12105 the current height of the Calc window, and more. The current
12106 interface (used when you type @kbd{C-x * *}) is also saved. If there
12107 were already saved mode settings in the file, they are replaced.
12108 Otherwise, the new mode information is appended to the end of the
12109 file.
12110
12111 @kindex m R
12112 @pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12113 The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12114 record all the mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12115 time a mode setting changes. If the modes are saved this way, then this
12116 ``automatic mode recording'' mode is also saved.
12117 Type @kbd{m R} again to disable this method of recording the mode
12118 settings. To turn it off permanently, the @kbd{m m} command will also be
12119 necessary. (If Embedded mode is enabled, other options for recording
12120 the modes are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
12121
12122 @kindex m F
12123 @pindex calc-settings-file-name
12124 The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12125 choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12126 for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12127 You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12128 their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12129 if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12130 use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12131 file name is @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12132 giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12133 discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.
12134
12135 If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12136 @file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12137 is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12138 to reread. You can give
12139 a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12140 file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12141 @kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12142 tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12143 which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12144 modes present in the file you were using before.
12145
12146 @kindex m x
12147 @pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12148 The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12149 in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12150 extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12151 until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12152 has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12153 @kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12154 once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{C-x * L}.
12155
12156 @kindex m S
12157 @pindex calc-shift-prefix
12158 The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12159 all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12160 If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12161 you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12162 @kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12163 be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12164 now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12165 that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12166 the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12167 prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12168 shifted-prefix mode.
12169
12170 @node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12171 @section Precision
12172
12173 @noindent
12174 @kindex p
12175 @pindex calc-precision
12176 @cindex Precision of calculations
12177 The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12178 which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12179 at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12180 memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12181 calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12182
12183 The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12184 can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12185
12186 Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12187 precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12188 current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12189 floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12190 what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12191 round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12192 down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12193 @kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12194 existing value to a new precision.
12195
12196 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
12197 It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12198 @dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12199 123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12200 The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12201 or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12202 The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12203 (again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12204 not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12205 instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12206 more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12207 probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12208 exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12209
12210 The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12211 are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12212 and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12213 (@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12214 deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12215 of the numbers involved.
12216
12217 If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12218 cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12219 with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12220 divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12221 (actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12222 would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12223
12224 @xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12225 issues.
12226
12227 @node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12228 @section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12229
12230 @noindent
12231 @kindex I
12232 @pindex calc-inverse
12233 There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12234 Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12235 the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12236 The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12237 is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12238
12239 @kindex H
12240 @pindex calc-hyperbolic
12241 Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12242 Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12243 If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12244 @code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12245 non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12246 instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12247
12248 Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12249 may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12250 toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12251 corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12252
12253 @kindex O
12254 @pindex calc-option
12255 The @kbd{O} key (@code{calc-option}) sets another flag, the
12256 @dfn{Option Flag}, which also can alter the subsequent Calc command in
12257 various ways.
12258
12259 The Inverse, Hyperbolic and Option flags apply only to the next
12260 Calculator command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They
12261 are also cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits
12262 you type after @kbd{I}, @kbd{H} or @kbd{O} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as
12263 prefix arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The
12264 same is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means
12265 to subtract and keep arguments).
12266
12267 Another Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12268 elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12269
12270 @node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12271 @section Calculation Modes
12272
12273 @noindent
12274 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12275 the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12276 The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12277 (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12278
12279 @menu
12280 * Angular Modes::
12281 * Polar Mode::
12282 * Fraction Mode::
12283 * Infinite Mode::
12284 * Symbolic Mode::
12285 * Matrix Mode::
12286 * Automatic Recomputation::
12287 * Working Message::
12288 @end menu
12289
12290 @node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12291 @subsection Angular Modes
12292
12293 @noindent
12294 @cindex Angular mode
12295 The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12296 and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12297 like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12298 used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12299 form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12300 degrees-minutes-seconds.
12301
12302 Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12303 degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12304 result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12305 instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12306 normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12307 to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12308 multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12309
12310 @kindex m r
12311 @pindex calc-radians-mode
12312 @kindex m d
12313 @pindex calc-degrees-mode
12314 @kindex m h
12315 @pindex calc-hms-mode
12316 The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12317 and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12318 The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12319 The default angular mode is Degrees.
12320
12321 @node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12322 @subsection Polar Mode
12323
12324 @noindent
12325 @cindex Polar mode
12326 The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12327 sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12328 decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12329 number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12330 number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12331
12332 @kindex m p
12333 @pindex calc-polar-mode
12334 The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12335 preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12336 of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12337
12338 @node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12339 @subsection Fraction Mode
12340
12341 @noindent
12342 @cindex Fraction mode
12343 @cindex Division of integers
12344 Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12345 result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12346 rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12347 to use the @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command, which
12348 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fraction:
12349 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 :} produces @expr{3:2} even though
12350 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12351
12352 @kindex m f
12353 @pindex calc-frac-mode
12354 To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12355 divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12356 For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12357 but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12358 Float mode.
12359
12360 At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12361 fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12362 float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12363
12364 @node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12365 @subsection Infinite Mode
12366
12367 @noindent
12368 @cindex Infinite mode
12369 The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12370 formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12371 put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12372 results.
12373
12374 @kindex m i
12375 @pindex calc-infinite-mode
12376 The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12377 on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12378 in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12379 is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12380 generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12381 will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12382
12383 With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12384 an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12385 difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12386 evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12387 functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12388 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12389 note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12390 this calculation has infinity as an input.
12391
12392 @cindex Positive Infinite mode
12393 The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12394 i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12395 which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12396 Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12397 Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12398 separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12399 Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12400 single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12401 you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12402 is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12403
12404 @node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12405 @subsection Symbolic Mode
12406
12407 @noindent
12408 @cindex Symbolic mode
12409 @cindex Inexact results
12410 Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12411 For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12412 algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12413 number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12414 @kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12415
12416 @kindex m s
12417 @pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12418 In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12419 command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12420 left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12421 @samp{sqrt(2)}.
12422
12423 @kindex N
12424 @pindex calc-eval-num
12425 The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12426 the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12427 @code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12428 Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12429 sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12430 of the command.
12431
12432 To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12433 contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12434 @code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12435 variables.)
12436
12437 @node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12438 @subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12439
12440 @noindent
12441 @cindex Matrix mode
12442 @cindex Scalar mode
12443 Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12444 are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12445 Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12446 modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12447
12448 @kindex m v
12449 @pindex calc-matrix-mode
12450 Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12451 In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12452 otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12453 multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12454 @samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12455 rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12456 mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
12457 0 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12458 produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12459 matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12460 @samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12461 identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12462 dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12463 form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12464 with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12465 a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12466 if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12467 will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12468
12469 Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12470 assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12471 For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12472 @samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12473 as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12474 another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12475 non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12476
12477 Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12478
12479 If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12480 get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12481 unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12482 Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12483 matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix. Simply typing
12484 @kbd{C-u m v} will get you a square Matrix mode, in which matrices of
12485 unknown size are assumed to be square matrices of unspecified size.
12486
12487 @cindex Declaring scalar variables
12488 Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12489 affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12490 and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12491 certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12492 @xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12493
12494 There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12495 scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12496 results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12497 get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12498 @samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12499 for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12500 your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12501
12502 Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12503 (@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12504 your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12505 of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12506 change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12507 under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12508
12509 @node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12510 @subsection Automatic Recomputation
12511
12512 @noindent
12513 The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12514 property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12515 whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12516 are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12517
12518 @kindex m C
12519 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
12520 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12521 automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12522 not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12523 attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12524 be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12525 you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12526 recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12527 to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12528
12529 To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12530 automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{C-x * u}}.
12531 @xref{Embedded Mode}.
12532
12533 @node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12534 @subsection Working Messages
12535
12536 @noindent
12537 @cindex Performance
12538 @cindex Working messages
12539 Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12540 designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12541 The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12542 echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12543 operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12544 intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12545 be disabled if you find them distracting.
12546
12547 @kindex m w
12548 @pindex calc-working
12549 Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12550 disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12551 only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12552 see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12553 the current mode.
12554
12555 While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12556 considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12557 quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12558 to turn the messages off.
12559
12560 @node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12561 @section Simplification Modes
12562
12563 @noindent
12564 The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12565 are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12566 Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12567 results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12568 form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12569 are done automatically but can be turned off when necessary.
12570
12571 When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12572 stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12573 @expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12574 rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12575
12576 Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12577 followed by a shifted letter.
12578
12579 @kindex m O
12580 @pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12581 The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12582 simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12583 fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12584 in this mode. Explicit simplification commands, such as @kbd{=} or
12585 @kbd{a s}, can still be given to simplify any formulas.
12586 @xref{Algebraic Definitions}, for a sample use of
12587 No-Simplification mode.
12588
12589
12590 @kindex m N
12591 @pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12592 The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12593 of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12594 example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12595 simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12596 is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12597 because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12598 constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12599 A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12600 error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12601 elements are constant.
12602
12603 @kindex m I
12604 @pindex calc-basic-simplify-mode
12605 The @kbd{m I} (@code{calc-basic-simplify-mode}) command does some basic
12606 simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12607 fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12608 @expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12609 @expr{@tfn{deriv}(x^2, x)} to @expr{2 x}.
12610
12611 @kindex m B
12612 @pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12613 The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the basic
12614 simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12615 uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12616 to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12617 are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12618 results (after the basic simplifications) are left alone.
12619
12620 @kindex m A
12621 @pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12622 The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does standard
12623 algebraic simplifications. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12624
12625 @kindex m E
12626 @pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12627 The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended'', or
12628 ``unsafe'', algebraic simplification. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12629
12630 @kindex m U
12631 @pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12632 The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12633 simplification. @xref{Simplification of Units}. These include the
12634 algebraic simplifications, plus variable names which
12635 are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12636 are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12637
12638 A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12639 amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12640 use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12641 perform higher types of simplifications on demand.
12642 @node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12643 @section Declarations
12644
12645 @noindent
12646 A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12647 use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12648 give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12649 take the fully general situation into account.
12650
12651 @menu
12652 * Declaration Basics::
12653 * Kinds of Declarations::
12654 * Functions for Declarations::
12655 @end menu
12656
12657 @node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12658 @subsection Declaration Basics
12659
12660 @noindent
12661 @kindex s d
12662 @pindex calc-declare-variable
12663 The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12664 way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12665 the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12666 at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12667 You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12668 type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12669 the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12670
12671 A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12672 @dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12673 you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12674 For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12675 be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12676 declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12677 (Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12678 provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12679
12680 @cindex @code{Decls} variable
12681 @vindex Decls
12682 Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12683 This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12684 the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12685 vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12686 specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12687 edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12688 @xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12689 and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12690 permanently if you wish.
12691
12692 Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12693 the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12694 values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12695 command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12696 declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12697
12698 For example, the declaration matrix
12699
12700 @smallexample
12701 @group
12702 [ [ foo, real ]
12703 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12704 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12705 @end group
12706 @end smallexample
12707
12708 @noindent
12709 declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12710 and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12711 returns a real number in the interval shown.
12712
12713 @vindex All
12714 If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12715 declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12716 It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12717 @samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12718 are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12719 The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12720 response to the variable-name prompt.
12721
12722 @node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12723 @subsection Kinds of Declarations
12724
12725 @noindent
12726 The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12727 in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12728 vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12729 more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12730 for the variable.
12731
12732 @smallexample
12733 @group
12734 [ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12735 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12736 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12737 @end group
12738 @end smallexample
12739
12740 Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12741 @code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12742 since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12743 interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12744 nearly equivalent (see below).
12745
12746 The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12747 nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12748 as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12749 @code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12750
12751 The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12752 If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12753 is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12754 as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12755 malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12756 the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12757
12758 The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12759 stored in a variable:
12760
12761 @table @code
12762 @item int
12763 Integers.
12764 @item numint
12765 Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12766 @item frac
12767 Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12768 @item rat
12769 Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12770 @item float
12771 Floating-point numbers.
12772 @item real
12773 Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12774 intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12775 reals here.)
12776 @item pos
12777 Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12778 @item nonneg
12779 Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12780 @item number
12781 Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12782 @end table
12783
12784 Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12785 of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12786 simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12787 @samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12788 However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12789 to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12790 real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12791 deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12792 of the formula.
12793
12794 Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12795 For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12796 has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12797 integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12798 Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12799 it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12800
12801 Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12802 because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12803 nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12804 this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12805 @samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12806
12807 One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12808 @code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12809 Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12810 @kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12811 @samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12812 simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12813
12814 If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12815 they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12816 function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12817 @code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12818 (note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12819 @code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12820 the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12821 redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12822 deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12823 @samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12824
12825 Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12826 used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12827
12828 The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12829 @samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12830 In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12831 the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12832 that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12833 Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12834 and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12835
12836 If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12837 results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12838 where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12839 type symbol.
12840
12841 ``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12842 like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12843 is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12844 polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12845 roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12846
12847 ``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12848 only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12849 shown above).
12850
12851 Calc's algebraic simplifications also make use of declarations when
12852 simplifying equations and inequalities. They will cancel @code{x}
12853 from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12854 is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12855 To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
12856 use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
12857 current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
12858 real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
12859 including canceling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
12860 not known to be nonzero.
12861
12862 Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
12863
12864 @table @code
12865 @item scalar
12866 The value is not a vector.
12867 @item vector
12868 The value is a vector.
12869 @item matrix
12870 The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
12871 @item sqmatrix
12872 The value is a square matrix.
12873 @end table
12874
12875 These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
12876 described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
12877 is a matrix of integers.
12878
12879 Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
12880 algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
12881 is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
12882 it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
12883 other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
12884 but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
12885 and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
12886 never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
12887 declarations.)
12888
12889 @xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
12890 Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
12891 or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
12892
12893 One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
12894 command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
12895
12896 @table @code
12897 @item const
12898 The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
12899 @end table
12900
12901 Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
12902 a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
12903 been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
12904 unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
12905 if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
12906 was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
12907 simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
12908 using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
12909 or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
12910 declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
12911
12912 @node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
12913 @subsection Functions for Declarations
12914
12915 @noindent
12916 Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
12917 in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
12918 can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
12919 can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
12920 left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
12921 rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
12922 (@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
12923 algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
12924 that perform other tests not related to declarations.
12925
12926 For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
12927 do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
12928 @code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
12929 Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
12930 own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
12931
12932 @ignore
12933 @starindex
12934 @end ignore
12935 @tindex dint
12936 @ignore
12937 @starindex
12938 @end ignore
12939 @tindex dnumint
12940 @ignore
12941 @starindex
12942 @end ignore
12943 @tindex dnatnum
12944 The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
12945 The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
12946 number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
12947 checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
12948 integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
12949 data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
12950 suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
12951 are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
12952
12953 @ignore
12954 @starindex
12955 @end ignore
12956 @tindex drat
12957 The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
12958 an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
12959 and error forms do not.
12960
12961 @ignore
12962 @starindex
12963 @end ignore
12964 @tindex dreal
12965 The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
12966 includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
12967
12968 @ignore
12969 @starindex
12970 @end ignore
12971 @tindex dimag
12972 The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
12973 i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
12974
12975 @ignore
12976 @starindex
12977 @end ignore
12978 @tindex dpos
12979 @ignore
12980 @starindex
12981 @end ignore
12982 @tindex dneg
12983 @ignore
12984 @starindex
12985 @end ignore
12986 @tindex dnonneg
12987 The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
12988 The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
12989 function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
12990 equal to zero. Note that Calc's algebraic simplifications, which are
12991 effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules, can simplify
12992 an expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}.
12993 So the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
12994 are rarely necessary.
12995
12996 @ignore
12997 @starindex
12998 @end ignore
12999 @tindex dnonzero
13000 The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
13001 This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
13002 do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13003 elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13004 deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13005 represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13006 also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13007
13008 @ignore
13009 @starindex
13010 @end ignore
13011 @tindex deven
13012 @ignore
13013 @starindex
13014 @end ignore
13015 @tindex dodd
13016 The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13017 an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13018 is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13019 Calc's algebraic simplifications use this to simplify a test of the form
13020 @samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13021
13022 @ignore
13023 @starindex
13024 @end ignore
13025 @tindex drange
13026 The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13027 of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13028 the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13029 a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13030 from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13031 expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13032 etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13033 the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13034 remains unevaluated.
13035
13036 @ignore
13037 @starindex
13038 @end ignore
13039 @tindex dscalar
13040 The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13041 scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13042 unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13043 mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13044 if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13045 (say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13046 ``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13047 provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13048 is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13049 information to tell.
13050
13051 @node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13052 @section Display Modes
13053
13054 @noindent
13055 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13056 @kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13057 (@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13058 @pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13059 Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13060 @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13061
13062 One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13063 @kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13064 refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13065 will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13066 reflect the latest mode settings.
13067
13068 @kindex d @key{RET}
13069 @pindex calc-refresh-top
13070 The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13071 top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13072 arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13073 reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13074 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13075 For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13076 but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13077
13078 The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13079 is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13080 to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13081 words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13082
13083 @menu
13084 * Radix Modes::
13085 * Grouping Digits::
13086 * Float Formats::
13087 * Complex Formats::
13088 * Fraction Formats::
13089 * HMS Formats::
13090 * Date Formats::
13091 * Truncating the Stack::
13092 * Justification::
13093 * Labels::
13094 @end menu
13095
13096 @node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13097 @subsection Radix Modes
13098
13099 @noindent
13100 @cindex Radix display
13101 @cindex Non-decimal numbers
13102 @cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13103 Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13104 notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13105 When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13106 digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13107 potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13108
13109 @kindex d 2
13110 @kindex d 8
13111 @kindex d 6
13112 @kindex d 0
13113 @cindex Hexadecimal integers
13114 @cindex Octal integers
13115 The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13116 binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13117 respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13118 current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13119 digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13120 as decimal.
13121
13122 @kindex d r
13123 @pindex calc-radix
13124 To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13125 an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13126 argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13127
13128 @kindex d z
13129 @pindex calc-leading-zeros
13130 @cindex Leading zeros
13131 Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13132 represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13133 command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13134 current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13135 word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13136 are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13137 @texline @math{2^w-1}
13138 @infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13139 in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13140 entirety.)
13141
13142 @cindex Two's complements
13143 Calc can display @expr{w}-bit integers using two's complement
13144 notation, although this is most useful with the binary, octal and
13145 hexadecimal display modes. This option is selected by using the
13146 @kbd{O} option prefix before setting the display radix, and a negative word
13147 size might be appropriate (@pxref{Binary Functions}). In two's
13148 complement notation, the integers in the (nearly) symmetric interval
13149 from
13150 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13151 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13152 to
13153 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13154 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
13155 are represented by the integers from @expr{0} to @expr{2^w-1}:
13156 the integers from @expr{0} to
13157 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13158 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
13159 are represented by themselves and the integers from
13160 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13161 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13162 to @expr{-1} are represented by the integers from
13163 @texline @math{2^{w-1}}
13164 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)}
13165 to @expr{2^w-1} (the integer @expr{k} is represented by @expr{k+2^w}).
13166 Calc will display a two's complement integer by the radix (either
13167 @expr{2}, @expr{8} or @expr{16}), two @kbd{#} symbols, and then its
13168 representation (including any leading zeros necessary to include all
13169 @expr{w} bits). In a two's complement display mode, numbers that
13170 are not displayed in two's complement notation (i.e., that aren't
13171 integers from
13172 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13173 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13174 to
13175 @c (
13176 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1})
13177 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1})
13178 will be represented using Calc's usual notation (in the appropriate
13179 radix).
13180
13181 @node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13182 @subsection Grouping Digits
13183
13184 @noindent
13185 @kindex d g
13186 @pindex calc-group-digits
13187 @cindex Grouping digits
13188 @cindex Digit grouping
13189 Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13190 example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13191 (@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13192 are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13193 separated by commas.
13194
13195 The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13196 With a numeric prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13197 the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13198 with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13199 digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13200 before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13201 grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13202
13203 @kindex d ,
13204 @pindex calc-group-char
13205 The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13206 character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13207 If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13208 commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13209 This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13210 uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13211 @samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13212
13213 Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13214 if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{C-x * y} and @kbd{C-x * g}.
13215 (@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13216 the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13217 is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13218
13219 @node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13220 @subsection Float Formats
13221
13222 @noindent
13223 Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13224 form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13225 or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13226 in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13227 formats for floats.
13228
13229 @kindex d n
13230 @pindex calc-normal-notation
13231 The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13232 display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13233 With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13234 that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13235 the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13236 precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13237 current precision is 12.)
13238
13239 @kindex d f
13240 @pindex calc-fix-notation
13241 The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13242 notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13243 decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13244 notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13245 way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13246 for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13247 to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13248
13249 @kindex d s
13250 @pindex calc-sci-notation
13251 @cindex Scientific notation, display of
13252 The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13253 notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13254 displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13255 point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13256 The default is to display all significant digits.
13257
13258 @kindex d e
13259 @pindex calc-eng-notation
13260 @cindex Engineering notation, display of
13261 The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13262 notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13263 exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13264 digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13265 number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13266
13267 It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13268 the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13269 and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13270 significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13271 calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13272 but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13273 Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13274 except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-x * y} which operate on the
13275 actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13276
13277 @kindex d .
13278 @pindex calc-point-char
13279 The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13280 as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13281 may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13282 style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13283 numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13284
13285 @node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13286 @subsection Complex Formats
13287
13288 @noindent
13289 @kindex d c
13290 @pindex calc-complex-notation
13291 There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13292 form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13293 and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13294 (@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13295
13296 @kindex d i
13297 @pindex calc-i-notation
13298 @kindex d j
13299 @pindex calc-j-notation
13300 The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13301 numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13302 (@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13303 in some disciplines.
13304
13305 @cindex @code{i} variable
13306 @vindex i
13307 Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13308 If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13309 the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13310 this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13311 will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13312 to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13313 interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13314 @xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13315
13316 @node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13317 @subsection Fraction Formats
13318
13319 @noindent
13320 @kindex d o
13321 @pindex calc-over-notation
13322 Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13323 (@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13324 eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13325 prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13326 that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13327 @samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13328 used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13329 for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13330
13331 If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13332 notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13333 as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13334 the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13335 and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13336
13337 It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13338 a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13339 Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13340 denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13341 be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13342 the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13343 displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13344 and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13345 affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13346 format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13347 integers as @expr{n:1}.
13348
13349 The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13350 stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13351 never affects floats.
13352
13353 @node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13354 @subsection HMS Formats
13355
13356 @noindent
13357 @kindex d h
13358 @pindex calc-hms-notation
13359 The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13360 HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13361 consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13362 ``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13363 Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13364 marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13365 seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13366
13367 The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13368 @samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13369 value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13370 keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13371 The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13372 @kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13373 already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13374 (@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13375 @kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13376 The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13377 @kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13378 entry.
13379
13380 @node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13381 @subsection Date Formats
13382
13383 @noindent
13384 @kindex d d
13385 @pindex calc-date-notation
13386 The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13387 of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13388 contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13389 To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13390 date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13391 marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13392 guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13393 pure dates.
13394
13395 The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13396 An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13397 If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13398 reestablished.
13399
13400 Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13401 dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13402 functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13403
13404 @menu
13405 * Date Formatting Codes::
13406 * Free-Form Dates::
13407 * Standard Date Formats::
13408 @end menu
13409
13410 @node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, Date Formats, Date Formats
13411 @subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13412
13413 @noindent
13414 When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13415 characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13416 copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13417 @samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13418 date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13419 below.
13420
13421 When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13422 match the input string to the current format either with or without
13423 the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13424 match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13425 the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13426 simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13427 since Jan 1, 1 AD. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13428 flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13429
13430 Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13431
13432 Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13433 from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13434 entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13435 @samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13436 entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13437
13438 Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13439
13440 @table @asis
13441 @item Y
13442 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13443 @item YY
13444 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13445 @item BY
13446 Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13447 @item YYY
13448 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13449 @item YYYY
13450 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13451 @item aa
13452 Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13453 @item AA
13454 Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13455 @item aaa
13456 Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13457 @item AAA
13458 Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13459 @item aaaa
13460 Year: ``a.d.'' or blank.
13461 @item AAAA
13462 Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13463 @item bb
13464 Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13465 @item BB
13466 Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13467 @item bbb
13468 Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13469 @item BBB
13470 Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13471 @item bbbb
13472 Year: ``b.c.'' or blank.
13473 @item BBBB
13474 Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13475 @item M
13476 Month: ``8'' for August.
13477 @item MM
13478 Month: ``08'' for August.
13479 @item BM
13480 Month: `` 8'' for August.
13481 @item MMM
13482 Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13483 @item Mmm
13484 Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13485 @item mmm
13486 Month: ``aug'' for August.
13487 @item MMMM
13488 Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13489 @item Mmmm
13490 Month: ``August'' for August.
13491 @item D
13492 Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13493 @item DD
13494 Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13495 @item BD
13496 Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13497 @item W
13498 Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13499 @item WWW
13500 Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13501 @item Www
13502 Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13503 @item www
13504 Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13505 @item WWWW
13506 Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13507 @item Wwww
13508 Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13509 @item d
13510 Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13511 @item ddd
13512 Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13513 @item bdd
13514 Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13515 @item h
13516 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13517 @item hh
13518 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13519 @item bh
13520 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13521 @item H
13522 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13523 @item HH
13524 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13525 @item BH
13526 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13527 @item p
13528 AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13529 @item P
13530 AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13531 @item pp
13532 AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13533 @item PP
13534 AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13535 @item pppp
13536 AM/PM: ``a.m.'' or ``p.m.''.
13537 @item PPPP
13538 AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13539 @item m
13540 Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13541 @item mm
13542 Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13543 @item bm
13544 Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13545 @item s
13546 Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13547 @item ss
13548 Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13549 @item bs
13550 Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13551 @item SS
13552 Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13553 @item BS
13554 Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13555 @item N
13556 Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13557 @item n
13558 Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13559 @item J
13560 Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13561 @item j
13562 Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13563 @item U
13564 Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13565 @item X
13566 Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13567 causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13568 when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13569 required for algebraic entry.
13570 @end table
13571
13572 If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13573 colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13574
13575 If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13576 appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13577 without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13578 exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13579 @samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13580
13581 The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13582 ``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13583 reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13584 punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13585 many digits as there are letters in the format.
13586
13587 The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13588 adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13589 @samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13590
13591 @node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13592 @subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13593
13594 @noindent
13595 When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13596 on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13597 match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13598 ``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13599 but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13600
13601 Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13602 while interpreting dates.
13603
13604 First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13605 text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13606 the date.
13607
13608 A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13609 part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
13610 12-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13611 omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13612 @samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13613 abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13614 @samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13615 @samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13616 The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13617 recognized with no number attached.
13618
13619 If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13620 format.
13621
13622 To read the date portion, all words and numbers are isolated
13623 from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must
13624 be either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which
13625 are ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13626 abbreviations.
13627
13628 Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13629 are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13630 greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13631 number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13632 assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13633 appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13634 current year is taken from the system clock.
13635
13636 If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13637 words, then the input is rejected.
13638
13639 If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13640 the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13641 like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13642 date components when the date was formatted.
13643
13644 One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13645 may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13646 minus sign on the year value.
13647
13648 If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13649 of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13650
13651 @node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13652 @subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13653
13654 @noindent
13655 There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13656 Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13657 you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13658 to select the other formats.
13659
13660 To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13661 argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13662 enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13663 number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13664 You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13665 command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13666
13667 @table @asis
13668 @item 0
13669 @samp{N} (Numerical format)
13670 @item 1
13671 @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13672 @item 2
13673 @samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13674 @item 3
13675 @samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13676 @item 4
13677 @samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13678 @item 5
13679 @samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13680 @item 6
13681 @samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13682 @item 7
13683 @samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13684 @item 8
13685 @samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13686 @item 9
13687 @samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13688 @end table
13689
13690 @node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13691 @subsection Truncating the Stack
13692
13693 @noindent
13694 @kindex d t
13695 @pindex calc-truncate-stack
13696 @cindex Truncating the stack
13697 @cindex Narrowing the stack
13698 The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13699 line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13700 The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13701 the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13702 operations (although still visible to the user). This is similar to the
13703 Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except that the values below the @samp{.}
13704 are @emph{visible}, just temporarily frozen. This feature allows you to
13705 keep several independent calculations running at once in different parts
13706 of the stack, or to apply a certain command to an element buried deep in
13707 the stack.
13708
13709 Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13710 is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13711 these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13712 With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13713 bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13714 all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13715 values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13716
13717 @kindex d [
13718 @pindex calc-truncate-up
13719 @kindex d ]
13720 @pindex calc-truncate-down
13721 The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13722 (@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13723 line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13724
13725 @node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13726 @subsection Justification
13727
13728 @noindent
13729 @kindex d <
13730 @pindex calc-left-justify
13731 @kindex d =
13732 @pindex calc-center-justify
13733 @kindex d >
13734 @pindex calc-right-justify
13735 Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13736 control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13737 @kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13738 (@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13739 stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13740 window.
13741
13742 If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13743 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13744 text.
13745
13746 Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13747 notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13748 together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13749
13750 With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13751 a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13752 horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13753 specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13754 Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13755 breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13756 origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13757 mode.
13758
13759 In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13760 given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13761 maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13762 otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13763 line is indented to the origin.
13764
13765 In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13766 character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13767 window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13768 for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13769 specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13770 specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13771
13772 In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13773 each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13774 allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13775 break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13776 line width or Calc window width is used.
13777
13778 Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13779 is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13780 number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13781 positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13782 when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13783 case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13784 shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13785
13786 @node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13787 @subsection Labels
13788
13789 @noindent
13790 @kindex d @{
13791 @pindex calc-left-label
13792 The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13793 then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13794 entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13795 appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13796 greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13797 or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13798 affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13799
13800 Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13801
13802 @kindex d @}
13803 @pindex calc-right-label
13804 The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13805 label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13806 the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13807 a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13808 stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13809 justified to the line width.
13810
13811 One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13812 formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13813 document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13814 typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13815 left or right as you prefer.
13816
13817 @node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13818 @section Language Modes
13819
13820 @noindent
13821 The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13822 entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13823 other common language such as Pascal or @LaTeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13824 stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13825 in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13826 another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13827
13828 The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13829 trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13830 affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13831 and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13832
13833 For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13834 program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13835 with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13836 to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u C-x * g} to grab the formula
13837 into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13838 to the first variable, and @kbd{C-x * y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13839 back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13840 repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13841
13842 Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13843 the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13844 @code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13845 and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13846 multiplication) which would not have been valid for a C program.
13847
13848 As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a @LaTeX{}
13849 document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13850 formula from the program in C mode, switch to @LaTeX{} mode, and yank the
13851 formula into the document in @LaTeX{} math-mode format.
13852
13853 Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13854 shifted letter key.
13855
13856 @menu
13857 * Normal Language Modes::
13858 * C FORTRAN Pascal::
13859 * TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13860 * Eqn Language Mode::
13861 * Yacas Language Mode::
13862 * Maxima Language Mode::
13863 * Giac Language Mode::
13864 * Mathematica Language Mode::
13865 * Maple Language Mode::
13866 * Compositions::
13867 * Syntax Tables::
13868 @end menu
13869
13870 @node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13871 @subsection Normal Language Modes
13872
13873 @noindent
13874 @kindex d N
13875 @pindex calc-normal-language
13876 The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
13877 notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
13878 Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
13879 objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
13880 keyboard.
13881
13882 @kindex d O
13883 @pindex calc-flat-language
13884 @cindex Matrix display
13885 The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
13886 identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
13887 one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
13888 form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
13889
13890 @kindex d b
13891 @pindex calc-line-breaking
13892 @cindex Line breaking
13893 @cindex Breaking up long lines
13894 Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
13895 across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
13896 The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
13897 feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
13898 If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
13899 command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
13900 long lines.
13901
13902 @kindex d B
13903 @pindex calc-big-language
13904 The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
13905 which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
13906 such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
13907
13908 @example
13909 ____________
13910 | a + 1 2
13911 | ----- + c
13912 \| b
13913 @end example
13914
13915 @noindent
13916 in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
13917
13918 Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
13919 mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
13920 are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
13921 @samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
13922 notation.
13923
13924 One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
13925
13926 @example
13927 3
13928 - -
13929 4
13930 @end example
13931
13932 @noindent
13933 can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
13934 actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
13935 never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
13936 @expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
13937 typical use.
13938
13939 Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
13940 way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
13941 though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
13942 Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
13943 in Big mode.
13944
13945 In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
13946 readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
13947 You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
13948 @kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
13949 one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
13950
13951 Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
13952 Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
13953 to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
13954 even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
13955
13956 @kindex d U
13957 @pindex calc-unformatted-language
13958 The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
13959 the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
13960 shown above would be displayed:
13961
13962 @example
13963 sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
13964 @end example
13965
13966 These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
13967 expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
13968 all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
13969 (except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
13970 parentheses).
13971
13972 @node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
13973 @subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
13974
13975 @noindent
13976 @kindex d C
13977 @pindex calc-c-language
13978 @cindex C language
13979 The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
13980 of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
13981 the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
13982 particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
13983 place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
13984 in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
13985 @samp{pow(a,b)}.
13986
13987 In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
13988 Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
13989 rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
13990 translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
13991 mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
13992 turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
13993 using the @samp{:=} symbol.
13994
13995 The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
13996 and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
13997 @samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
13998 typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
13999 names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
14000 display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
14001 formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
14002 as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
14003
14004 @kindex d P
14005 @pindex calc-pascal-language
14006 @cindex Pascal language
14007 The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
14008 conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
14009 a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
14010 displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
14011 @kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
14012 @kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.) not followed by digits works the same as
14013 always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
14014 vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
14015 of handling these in Pascal.
14016
14017 @kindex d F
14018 @pindex calc-fortran-language
14019 @cindex FORTRAN language
14020 The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
14021 conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
14022 equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
14023 entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
14024 parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
14025 both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
14026 upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
14027 If the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
14028 @code{vector} or @code{matrix}, however, then @samp{a(i)} will be
14029 parsed as a subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't
14030 matter, though; if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and
14031 Calc interprets it as a function call, you'll never know the difference
14032 unless you switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an
14033 actual vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
14034 function!).
14035
14036 Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
14037 language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
14038 Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
14039
14040 FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
14041 formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14042 positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14043 modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14044 convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14045 convert to lower-case for display and input.
14046
14047 @node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14048 @subsection @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} Language Modes
14049
14050 @noindent
14051 @kindex d T
14052 @pindex calc-tex-language
14053 @cindex TeX language
14054 @kindex d L
14055 @pindex calc-latex-language
14056 @cindex LaTeX language
14057 The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14058 of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
14059 and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
14060 conventions of ``math mode'' in @LaTeX{}, a typesetting language that
14061 uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's @LaTeX{} language mode can
14062 read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although @LaTeX{}
14063 mode may display it differently.
14064
14065 Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14066 @texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14067 @infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
14068 will appear as @samp{\sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
14069 @samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in @LaTeX{} mode.
14070 Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14071 @LaTeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14072 the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14073 formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14074
14075 Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14076 quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14077 @code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in @LaTeX{} mode (as in
14078 @code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14079 @code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14080 @code{\binom} in @LaTeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14081 Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14082 written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14083 @samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14084 @code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14085 @code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}
14086 modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14087 when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14088
14089 Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14090 by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14091 and @LaTeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14092 instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14093 braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14094 document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14095 printed result is
14096 @texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14097 @infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14098 but
14099 @texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14100 @infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14101
14102 The @TeX{} specific unit names (@pxref{Predefined Units}) will not use
14103 the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
14104 @samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example.
14105
14106 Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}
14107 are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14108 italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14109 @kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14110 one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14111 will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14112 written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14113 @samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in @LaTeX{} mode. The
14114 @samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14115 reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14116 written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14117 reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14118 variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14119 However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14120 any @TeX{} mode.)
14121
14122 During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14123 by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14124 @code{\bmatrix}. In @LaTeX{} mode this also applies to
14125 @samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14126 @samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14127 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14128 @samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14129 The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14130 and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14131 During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14132 format in @TeX{} mode and in
14133 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14134 @LaTeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14135 preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14136 argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14137 form, such as
14138
14139 @example
14140 \begin@{pmatrix@}
14141 a & b \\
14142 c & d
14143 \end@{pmatrix@}
14144 @end example
14145
14146 @noindent
14147 This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14148 expressions being displayed like
14149
14150 @example
14151 \begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14152 a & b \\
14153 c & d
14154 \end@{pmatrix@}
14155 @end example
14156
14157 @noindent
14158 While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect @LaTeX{}.
14159 (Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14160
14161 Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14162 calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14163 sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14164 to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14165 a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14166 in Calc, @TeX{}, @LaTeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14167
14168 @ignore
14169 @iftex
14170 @begingroup
14171 @let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14172 @let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14173 @end iftex
14174 @starindex
14175 @end ignore
14176 @tindex acute
14177 @ignore
14178 @starindex
14179 @end ignore
14180 @tindex Acute
14181 @ignore
14182 @starindex
14183 @end ignore
14184 @tindex bar
14185 @ignore
14186 @starindex
14187 @end ignore
14188 @tindex Bar
14189 @ignore
14190 @starindex
14191 @end ignore
14192 @tindex breve
14193 @ignore
14194 @starindex
14195 @end ignore
14196 @tindex Breve
14197 @ignore
14198 @starindex
14199 @end ignore
14200 @tindex check
14201 @ignore
14202 @starindex
14203 @end ignore
14204 @tindex Check
14205 @ignore
14206 @starindex
14207 @end ignore
14208 @tindex dddot
14209 @ignore
14210 @starindex
14211 @end ignore
14212 @tindex ddddot
14213 @ignore
14214 @starindex
14215 @end ignore
14216 @tindex dot
14217 @ignore
14218 @starindex
14219 @end ignore
14220 @tindex Dot
14221 @ignore
14222 @starindex
14223 @end ignore
14224 @tindex dotdot
14225 @ignore
14226 @starindex
14227 @end ignore
14228 @tindex DotDot
14229 @ignore
14230 @starindex
14231 @end ignore
14232 @tindex dyad
14233 @ignore
14234 @starindex
14235 @end ignore
14236 @tindex grave
14237 @ignore
14238 @starindex
14239 @end ignore
14240 @tindex Grave
14241 @ignore
14242 @starindex
14243 @end ignore
14244 @tindex hat
14245 @ignore
14246 @starindex
14247 @end ignore
14248 @tindex Hat
14249 @ignore
14250 @starindex
14251 @end ignore
14252 @tindex Prime
14253 @ignore
14254 @starindex
14255 @end ignore
14256 @tindex tilde
14257 @ignore
14258 @starindex
14259 @end ignore
14260 @tindex Tilde
14261 @ignore
14262 @starindex
14263 @end ignore
14264 @tindex under
14265 @ignore
14266 @starindex
14267 @end ignore
14268 @tindex Vec
14269 @ignore
14270 @starindex
14271 @end ignore
14272 @tindex VEC
14273 @ignore
14274 @iftex
14275 @endgroup
14276 @end iftex
14277 @end ignore
14278 @example
14279 Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14280 ---- --- ----- ---
14281 acute \acute \acute
14282 Acute \Acute
14283 bar \bar \bar bar
14284 Bar \Bar
14285 breve \breve \breve
14286 Breve \Breve
14287 check \check \check
14288 Check \Check
14289 dddot \dddot
14290 ddddot \ddddot
14291 dot \dot \dot dot
14292 Dot \Dot
14293 dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14294 DotDot \Ddot
14295 dyad dyad
14296 grave \grave \grave
14297 Grave \Grave
14298 hat \hat \hat hat
14299 Hat \Hat
14300 Prime prime
14301 tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14302 Tilde \Tilde
14303 under \underline \underline under
14304 Vec \vec \vec vec
14305 VEC \Vec
14306 @end example
14307
14308 The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14309 @samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14310 alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14311 top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14312 is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14313 word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14314 You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14315 at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14316
14317 @example
14318 \def\evalto@{@}
14319 \def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14320 @end example
14321
14322 The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14323 way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14324 printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14325 Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14326 which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14327 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14328
14329 The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14330 reading is:
14331
14332 @example
14333 \hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14334 \, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14335 \displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14336 \scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14337 \rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14338 \cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14339 \evalto
14340 @end example
14341
14342 Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14343 @LaTeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14344 font information.
14345
14346 Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14347 the same as @samp{*}.
14348
14349 @ifnottex
14350 The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14351 end of this section.
14352 @end ifnottex
14353 @iftex
14354 Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14355
14356 @example
14357 @group
14358 sin(a^2 / b_i)
14359 \sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14360 @end group
14361 @end example
14362 @tex
14363 $$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14364 @end tex
14365 @sp 1
14366
14367 @example
14368 @group
14369 [(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14370 [3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14371 @end group
14372 @end example
14373 @tex
14374 $$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14375 @end tex
14376 @sp 1
14377
14378 @example
14379 @group
14380 [abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14381 [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14382 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14383 @end group
14384 @end example
14385 @tex
14386 $$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14387 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14388 @end tex
14389 @sp 1
14390
14391 @example
14392 @group
14393 [sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14394 [\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14395 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14396 @end group
14397 @end example
14398 @tex
14399 $$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14400 @end tex
14401 @sp 2
14402
14403 First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14404 @kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14405 @samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14406
14407 @example
14408 @group
14409 [f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14410 [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14411 [f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14412 [f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14413 @end group
14414 @end example
14415 @tex
14416 $$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14417 $$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14418 $$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14419 @end tex
14420 @sp 2
14421
14422 First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14423
14424 @example
14425 @group
14426 2 + 3 => 5
14427 \evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14428 @end group
14429 @end example
14430 @tex
14431 $$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14432 $$ 5 $$
14433 @end tex
14434 @sp 2
14435
14436 First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14437
14438 @example
14439 @group
14440 [2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14441 [@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14442 @end group
14443 @end example
14444 @tex
14445 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14446 {\let\to\Rightarrow
14447 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14448 @end tex
14449 @sp 2
14450
14451 Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14452
14453 @example
14454 @group
14455 [ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14456 \matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14457 \pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14458 @end group
14459 @end example
14460 @tex
14461 $$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14462 $$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14463 @end tex
14464 @sp 2
14465 @end iftex
14466
14467 @node Eqn Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
14468 @subsection Eqn Language Mode
14469
14470 @noindent
14471 @kindex d E
14472 @pindex calc-eqn-language
14473 @dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14474 designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14475 with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14476 command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14477
14478 The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14479 a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14480 @samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14481 @code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14482 grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14483 required only when the argument contains spaces.
14484
14485 In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14486 delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14487 above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14488 @code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14489 @samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14490 in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14491 with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14492
14493 Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14494 peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14495 words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14496 braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14497 (The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14498 recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14499 the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14500 case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14501 names, too.)
14502
14503 Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14504 operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14505 treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14506 symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14507 the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14508
14509 As in @LaTeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14510 arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14511 ``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14512 braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14513
14514 Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14515 (like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14516 @dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14517 @code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14518 are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14519 @samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14520 of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14521
14522 Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14523 function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14524 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14525 functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14526 a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14527 stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14528 derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14529 x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14530
14531 Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14532 and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14533 @samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14534 of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14535 recognized for these operators during reading.
14536
14537 Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14538 matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14539 The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14540 for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14541 if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14542
14543 @node Yacas Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14544 @subsection Yacas Language Mode
14545
14546 @noindent
14547 @kindex d Y
14548 @pindex calc-yacas-language
14549 @cindex Yacas language
14550 The @kbd{d Y} (@code{calc-yacas-language}) command selects the
14551 conventions of Yacas, a free computer algebra system. While the
14552 operators and functions in Yacas are similar to those of Calc, the names
14553 of built-in functions in Yacas are capitalized. The Calc formula
14554 @samp{sin(2 x)}, for example, is entered and displayed @samp{Sin(2 x)}
14555 in Yacas mode, and `@samp{arcsin(x^2)} is @samp{ArcSin(x^2)} in Yacas
14556 mode. Complex numbers are written are written @samp{3 + 4 I}.
14557 The standard special constants are written @code{Pi}, @code{E},
14558 @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio} and @code{Gamma}. @code{Infinity}
14559 represents both @code{inf} and @code{uinf}, and @code{Undefined}
14560 represents @code{nan}.
14561
14562 Certain operators on functions, such as @code{D} for differentiation
14563 and @code{Integrate} for integration, take a prefix form in Yacas. For
14564 example, the derivative of @w{@samp{e^x sin(x)}} can be computed with
14565 @w{@samp{D(x) Exp(x)*Sin(x)}}.
14566
14567 Other notable differences between Yacas and standard Calc expressions
14568 are that vectors and matrices use curly braces in Yacas, and subscripts
14569 use square brackets. If, for example, @samp{A} represents the list
14570 @samp{@{a,2,c,4@}}, then @samp{A[3]} would equal @samp{c}.
14571
14572
14573 @node Maxima Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, Language Modes
14574 @subsection Maxima Language Mode
14575
14576 @noindent
14577 @kindex d X
14578 @pindex calc-maxima-language
14579 @cindex Maxima language
14580 The @kbd{d X} (@code{calc-maxima-language}) command selects the
14581 conventions of Maxima, another free computer algebra system. The
14582 function names in Maxima are similar, but not always identical, to Calc.
14583 For example, instead of @samp{arcsin(x)}, Maxima will use
14584 @samp{asin(x)}. Complex numbers are written @samp{3 + 4 %i}. The
14585 standard special constants are written @code{%pi}, @code{%e},
14586 @code{%i}, @code{%phi} and @code{%gamma}. In Maxima, @code{inf} means
14587 the same as in Calc, but @code{infinity} represents Calc's @code{uinf}.
14588
14589 Underscores as well as percent signs are allowed in function and
14590 variable names in Maxima mode. The underscore again is equivalent to
14591 the @samp{#} in Normal mode, and the percent sign is equivalent to
14592 @samp{o'o}.
14593
14594 Maxima uses square brackets for lists and vectors, and matrices are
14595 written as calls to the function @code{matrix}, given the row vectors of
14596 the matrix as arguments. Square brackets are also used as subscripts.
14597
14598 @node Giac Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Language Modes
14599 @subsection Giac Language Mode
14600
14601 @noindent
14602 @kindex d A
14603 @pindex calc-giac-language
14604 @cindex Giac language
14605 The @kbd{d A} (@code{calc-giac-language}) command selects the
14606 conventions of Giac, another free computer algebra system. The function
14607 names in Giac are similar to Maxima. Complex numbers are written
14608 @samp{3 + 4 i}. The standard special constants in Giac are the same as
14609 in Calc, except that @code{infinity} represents both Calc's @code{inf}
14610 and @code{uinf}.
14611
14612 Underscores are allowed in function and variable names in Giac mode.
14613 Brackets are used for subscripts. In Giac, indexing of lists begins at
14614 0, instead of 1 as in Calc. So if @samp{A} represents the list
14615 @samp{[a,2,c,4]}, then @samp{A[2]} would equal @samp{c}. In general,
14616 @samp{A[n]} in Giac mode corresponds to @samp{A_(n+1)} in Normal mode.
14617
14618 The Giac interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14619 Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]} and
14620 writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot see
14621 the difference between an open and a closed interval while in Giac mode.
14622
14623 @node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Language Modes
14624 @subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14625
14626 @noindent
14627 @kindex d M
14628 @pindex calc-mathematica-language
14629 @cindex Mathematica language
14630 The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14631 conventions of Mathematica. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14632 are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14633 calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14634 formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14635 Mathematica mode.
14636
14637 Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14638 are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14639 written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14640 @code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14641 Mathematica mode.
14642 Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14643 numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14644 Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14645
14646 @node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14647 @subsection Maple Language Mode
14648
14649 @noindent
14650 @kindex d W
14651 @pindex calc-maple-language
14652 @cindex Maple language
14653 The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14654 conventions of Maple.
14655
14656 Maple's language is much like C. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14657 names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14658 multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14659 denote powers.
14660
14661 Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14662 interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14663 brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14664 pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14665 to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14666 and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14667
14668 The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} is like Giac's interval
14669 notation, and is handled the same by Calc.
14670
14671 Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14672 are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14673 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14674 Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14675
14676 Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14677 various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14678 inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14679
14680 @node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14681 @subsection Compositions
14682
14683 @noindent
14684 @cindex Compositions
14685 There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14686 displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14687 mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14688 placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14689 are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14690
14691 Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14692 @xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14693 @samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14694 the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14695 @samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14696 example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14697 select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14698 deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14699
14700 The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14701 (although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14702 language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14703 which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14704 The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14705 the language modes.
14706
14707 @menu
14708 * Composition Basics::
14709 * Horizontal Compositions::
14710 * Vertical Compositions::
14711 * Other Compositions::
14712 * Information about Compositions::
14713 * User-Defined Compositions::
14714 @end menu
14715
14716 @node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14717 @subsubsection Composition Basics
14718
14719 @noindent
14720 Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14721 horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14722 themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14723 to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14724 @dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14725 decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14726 For example, in the Big mode formula
14727
14728 @example
14729 @group
14730 2
14731 a + b
14732 17 + ------
14733 c
14734 @end group
14735 @end example
14736
14737 @noindent
14738 the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14739 its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14740 is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14741
14742 @tex
14743 \bigskip
14744 @end tex
14745
14746 Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14747 an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14748 For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14749 which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14750 parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14751
14752 The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14753 following precedences:
14754
14755 @example
14756 _ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14757 % 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14758 ! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
14759 mod 400
14760 +/- 300
14761 !! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14762 ! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14763 ^ 200
14764 - 197 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
14765 * 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14766 / % \ 190
14767 + - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14768 | 170
14769 < = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14770 && 110
14771 || 100
14772 ? : 90
14773 !!! 85
14774 &&& 80
14775 ||| 75
14776 := 50
14777 :: 45
14778 => 40
14779 @end example
14780
14781 The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14782 occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14783 the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14784 expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14785 components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14786 normally never get additional parentheses).
14787
14788 For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14789 argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14790 in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14791 but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14792 Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14793 with one-higher precedence.
14794
14795 @ignore
14796 @starindex
14797 @end ignore
14798 @tindex cprec
14799 The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14800 precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14801 sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14802 this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14803 precedence than multiplication).
14804
14805 @tex
14806 \bigskip
14807 @end tex
14808
14809 A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14810 different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14811 A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14812 (not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14813 mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14814 exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14815 window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14816 view them.
14817
14818 Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14819 lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14820 composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14821 general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14822 move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14823 didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14824 structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14825 it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14826 For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14827
14828 @example
14829 @group
14830 [ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14831 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14832 @end group
14833 @end example
14834
14835 @noindent
14836 If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14837 But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14838 of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14839 only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14840 itself been too large to fit.
14841
14842 Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14843 generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14844 also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14845 space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14846 end of the string.
14847
14848 Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14849 hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14850 @code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14851 if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14852 @code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14853 in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14854 will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14855 object.
14856
14857 @node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14858 @subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14859
14860 @noindent
14861 @ignore
14862 @starindex
14863 @end ignore
14864 @tindex choriz
14865 The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14866 them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14867 as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14868
14869 @example
14870 @group
14871 a b
14872 17---d
14873 c
14874 @end group
14875 @end example
14876
14877 @noindent
14878 in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
14879 function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
14880 either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
14881 @var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
14882 each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
14883 the precedence from the surrounding environment.
14884
14885 @var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
14886 be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
14887 of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
14888 will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
14889 If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
14890 (unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
14891
14892 For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
14893 formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
14894 to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
14895 enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
14896 formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
14897
14898 The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
14899 baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
14900
14901 @node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
14902 @subsubsection Vertical Compositions
14903
14904 @noindent
14905 @ignore
14906 @starindex
14907 @end ignore
14908 @tindex cvert
14909 The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
14910 component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
14911 the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
14912 For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
14913 formats in Big mode as
14914
14915 @example
14916 @group
14917 f( a , 2 )
14918 bb a + 1
14919 ccc 2
14920 b
14921 @end group
14922 @end example
14923
14924 @ignore
14925 @starindex
14926 @end ignore
14927 @tindex cbase
14928 There are several special composition functions that work only as
14929 components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
14930 controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
14931 will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
14932 in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
14933 cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
14934
14935 @example
14936 @group
14937 2
14938 a + 1
14939 a 2
14940 f(bb , b )
14941 ccc
14942 @end group
14943 @end example
14944
14945 @ignore
14946 @starindex
14947 @end ignore
14948 @tindex ctbase
14949 @ignore
14950 @starindex
14951 @end ignore
14952 @tindex cbbase
14953 There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
14954 make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
14955 or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
14956 Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
14957 cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
14958
14959 @example
14960 @group
14961 a
14962 a -
14963 - + a + b
14964 b -
14965 b
14966 @end group
14967 @end example
14968
14969 There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
14970 function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
14971 be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
14972 which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
14973 @samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
14974 item.
14975
14976 @ignore
14977 @starindex
14978 @end ignore
14979 @tindex crule
14980 The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
14981 across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
14982 characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
14983 e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
14984 vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
14985 width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
14986 with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
14987
14988 @example
14989 @group
14990 a + 1
14991 =====
14992 2
14993 b
14994 @end group
14995 @end example
14996
14997 @ignore
14998 @starindex
14999 @end ignore
15000 @tindex clvert
15001 @ignore
15002 @starindex
15003 @end ignore
15004 @tindex crvert
15005 Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
15006 like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
15007 in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
15008 gives:
15009
15010 @example
15011 @group
15012 a + a
15013 bb bb
15014 ccc ccc
15015 @end group
15016 @end example
15017
15018 Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
15019 which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
15020 Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
15021
15022 @node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
15023 @subsubsection Other Compositions
15024
15025 @noindent
15026 @ignore
15027 @starindex
15028 @end ignore
15029 @tindex csup
15030 The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
15031 example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
15032 language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
15033 @samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
15034 bottom line is one above the baseline.
15035
15036 @ignore
15037 @starindex
15038 @end ignore
15039 @tindex csub
15040 Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
15041 This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
15042 bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
15043 @code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
15044 @code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
15045
15046 @ignore
15047 @starindex
15048 @end ignore
15049 @tindex cflat
15050 The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
15051 as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
15052 or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
15053 @samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
15054 to improve its readability.
15055
15056 @ignore
15057 @starindex
15058 @end ignore
15059 @tindex cspace
15060 The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
15061 @samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
15062 A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
15063 instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
15064 looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
15065 it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
15066 are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
15067
15068 @example
15069 @group
15070 2 2 2 2
15071 a a a a
15072 @end group
15073 @end example
15074
15075 @noindent
15076 If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
15077
15078 @ignore
15079 @starindex
15080 @end ignore
15081 @tindex cvspace
15082 The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
15083 stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
15084 baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15085 argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15086 height if used in a vertical composition.
15087
15088 @ignore
15089 @starindex
15090 @end ignore
15091 @tindex ctspace
15092 @ignore
15093 @starindex
15094 @end ignore
15095 @tindex cbspace
15096 There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15097 create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15098 of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15099 Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15100 displays as:
15101
15102 @example
15103 @group
15104 a
15105 -
15106 a b
15107 - a a
15108 b + - + -
15109 a b b
15110 - a
15111 b -
15112 b
15113 @end group
15114 @end example
15115
15116 @node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15117 @subsubsection Information about Compositions
15118
15119 @noindent
15120 The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15121 arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15122 then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15123
15124 @ignore
15125 @starindex
15126 @end ignore
15127 @tindex cwidth
15128 The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15129 composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15130 @samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15131 @TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15132 the composition functions described in this section.
15133
15134 @ignore
15135 @starindex
15136 @end ignore
15137 @tindex cheight
15138 The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15139 This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15140
15141 @ignore
15142 @starindex
15143 @end ignore
15144 @tindex cascent
15145 @ignore
15146 @starindex
15147 @end ignore
15148 @tindex cdescent
15149 The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15150 of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15151 the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15152 always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15153 @samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15154 For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15155 returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15156 is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15157
15158 @node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15159 @subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15160
15161 @noindent
15162 @kindex Z C
15163 @pindex calc-user-define-composition
15164 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15165 define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15166 formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15167 Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15168 language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15169 replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15170 replaced.
15171
15172 Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15173 that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15174 argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15175 the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15176 literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15177 affect the display at all.
15178
15179 You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15180 defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15181 which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15182 You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15183 number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15184 Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15185 for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15186 none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15187 neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15188 function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15189
15190 If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15191 formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15192 mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15193
15194 For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15195 @samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15196
15197 @example
15198 @group
15199 n
15200 ( )
15201 m
15202 @end group
15203 @end example
15204
15205 @noindent
15206 You might prefer the notation,
15207
15208 @example
15209 @group
15210 C
15211 n m
15212 @end group
15213 @end example
15214
15215 @noindent
15216 To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15217 then put the formula
15218
15219 @smallexample
15220 choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15221 @end smallexample
15222
15223 @noindent
15224 on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15225 @code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15226 of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15227 @key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15228 off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15229 as an algebraic entry.
15230
15231 @example
15232 @group
15233 C + C
15234 a b 7 3
15235 @end group
15236 @end example
15237
15238 As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15239 numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15240 the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15241 instead of parentheses.
15242
15243 @smallexample
15244 choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15245 @end smallexample
15246
15247 Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15248 @samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15249
15250 The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15251 functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15252 onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15253 the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15254 This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15255 purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15256 it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15257 formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15258 Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15259 parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15260 (Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15261 it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15262
15263 The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15264 composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15265 evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15266 @samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15267 as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15268 regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15269 @code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15270 @kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15271 operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15272 rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15273 Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15274 symbolic form.
15275
15276 It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15277 It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15278 example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15279 there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15280 @samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15281 case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15282 the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15283 have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15284 produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15285
15286 You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15287 command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15288
15289 @node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15290 @subsection Syntax Tables
15291
15292 @noindent
15293 @cindex Syntax tables
15294 @cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15295 Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15296 allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15297 Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15298
15299 (Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15300 unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15301
15302 @kindex Z S
15303 @pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15304 The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15305 syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15306 syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15307 mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15308 @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15309 the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15310 @pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15311
15312 @menu
15313 * Syntax Table Basics::
15314 * Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15315 * Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15316 * Conditional Syntax Rules::
15317 @end menu
15318
15319 @node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15320 @subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15321
15322 @noindent
15323 @dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15324 such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15325 Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15326 into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15327 like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15328 ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15329 the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15330 syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15331 followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15332 zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15333
15334 A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15335 which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15336 favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15337 table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15338 language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15339 algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15340 its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15341 and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15342 resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15343 completely different.)
15344
15345 A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15346 Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15347 matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15348
15349 @example
15350 foo ( ) := 2+3
15351 @end example
15352
15353 @noindent
15354 would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15355 were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15356 as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15357 for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15358 the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15359 as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15360 not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15361 zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15362 also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15363 formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15364 instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15365 calls would no longer recognize it!
15366
15367 While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15368 and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15369 break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15370
15371 The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15372 On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15373 be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15374 matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15375 rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15376 and postfix operator, respectively:
15377
15378 @example
15379 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15380 foo # := myprefix(#1)
15381 # foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15382 # foo := mypostfix(#1)
15383 @end example
15384
15385 Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15386 will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15387
15388 It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15389 because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15390 pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15391 match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15392 is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15393 never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15394 written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15395 @samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15396 ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15397 the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15398 exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15399 if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15400
15401 Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15402 The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15403 token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15404 a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15405 patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15406 two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15407 expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15408 expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15409
15410 As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15411 @samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15412 recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15413 rule,
15414
15415 @example
15416 sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15417 @end example
15418
15419 @noindent
15420 to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15421 read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15422 define these operators quite easily:
15423
15424 @example
15425 # *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15426 # ++ := postinc(#1)
15427 ++ # := preinc(#1)
15428 @end example
15429
15430 @noindent
15431 To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15432 and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15433 Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15434 operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15435
15436 You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15437 interpretation in syntax patterns:
15438
15439 @example
15440 # ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15441 @end example
15442
15443 Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15444 again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15445 an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15446 token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15447 backslashes in tokens.)
15448
15449 @example
15450 # "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15451 @end example
15452
15453 @noindent
15454 This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15455
15456 The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15457 it is not valid to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15458 tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15459 @samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15460 the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15461 usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15462 respectively).
15463
15464 Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15465 the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15466
15467 @node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15468 @subsubsection Precedence
15469
15470 @noindent
15471 Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15472 By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15473
15474 @example
15475 # foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15476 @end example
15477
15478 @noindent
15479 will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15480 will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15481 precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15482 place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15483 For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15484 @samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15485
15486 @example
15487 #/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15488 @end example
15489
15490 @noindent
15491 then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15492 Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15493 precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15494 @samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15495 By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15496 can create a right-associative operator.
15497
15498 @xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15499 standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15500 language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15501
15502 @node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15503 @subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15504
15505 @noindent
15506 To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15507 write
15508
15509 @example
15510 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15511 foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15512 foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15513 @end example
15514
15515 @noindent
15516 but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15517 Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15518 ``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15519
15520 @example
15521 foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15522 @end example
15523
15524 The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15525 One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15526 ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15527 or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15528 In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15529 separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15530 Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15531 several expressions separated by commas.
15532
15533 A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15534 items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15535 match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15536 The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15537 of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15538 arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15539
15540 If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15541 (or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15542 strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15543 does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15544 always be an empty vector.
15545
15546 @example
15547 foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15548 foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15549 @end example
15550
15551 @noindent
15552 will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15553 @samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15554 some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15555 @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15556 rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15557
15558 @example
15559 foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15560 @end example
15561
15562 @noindent
15563 will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15564 @samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15565
15566 The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15567 just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15568 count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15569
15570 @example
15571 foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15572 foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15573 @end example
15574
15575 @noindent
15576 Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15577 which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15578 empty vector is produced.
15579
15580 Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15581 optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15582 rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15583 algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15584 the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15585 for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15586 rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15587 this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15588 Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15589 argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15590 prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15591 as optional.
15592
15593 Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15594 patterns will not work as you might expect:
15595
15596 @example
15597 foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15598 @end example
15599
15600 @noindent
15601 Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15602 @samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15603 first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15604 pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15605 pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15606 doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15607 point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15608
15609 @example
15610 foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15611 foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15612 @end example
15613
15614 More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15615 part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15616 If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15617 ``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15618 backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15619 backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15620 the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15621
15622 @node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15623 @subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15624
15625 @noindent
15626 It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15627 example, the rules
15628
15629 @example
15630 foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15631 foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15632 @end example
15633
15634 @noindent
15635 will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15636 @samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15637 number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15638 rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15639 nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15640 functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15641
15642 The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15643 rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15644 @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15645 conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15646 using the algebraic simplifications (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15647 Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15648 that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15649 results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15650 @samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15651 result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15652 goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15653
15654 Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15655 exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15656 @xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15657 condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15658 variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15659 expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15660
15661 @example
15662 foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15663 @end example
15664
15665 @noindent
15666 The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15667 integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15668 This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15669 like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15670
15671 The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15672 variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15673 rules.
15674
15675 The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15676 rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15677 @xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15678 meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15679 conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15680 @code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15681
15682 @example
15683 sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15684 @end example
15685
15686 @noindent
15687 This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15688 In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15689 @samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15690 its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15691 the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15692 Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15693 must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15694 will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15695
15696 @node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15697 @section The @code{Modes} Variable
15698
15699 @noindent
15700 @kindex m g
15701 @pindex calc-get-modes
15702 The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15703 a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15704 are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15705 @var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15706 macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15707 on the current mode settings.
15708
15709 @cindex @code{Modes} variable
15710 @vindex Modes
15711 The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15712 @code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15713 It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15714 @code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15715 command will continue to work, however.)
15716
15717 In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15718 prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15719 that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15720 a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15721
15722 The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15723
15724 @enumerate
15725 @item
15726 Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15727
15728 @item
15729 Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15730
15731 @item
15732 Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15733 This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15734
15735 @item
15736 Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15737
15738 @item
15739 Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15740 constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
15741 20000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15742 These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15743 command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15744 @kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15745 identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15746 produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15747 @kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15748 will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15749
15750 @item
15751 Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15752 and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15753
15754 @item
15755 Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15756
15757 @item
15758 Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15759
15760 @item
15761 Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15762 Command is @kbd{m p}.
15763
15764 @item
15765 Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15766 mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, @mathit{-3} for square Matrix mode,
15767 or @var{N} for
15768 @texline @math{N\times N}
15769 @infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15770 Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15771
15772 @item
15773 Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
15774 0 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15775 or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15776
15777 @item
15778 Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15779 or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15780 @end enumerate
15781
15782 For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15783 precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15784 Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15785 stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15786 keyboard macro.)
15787
15788 As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15789 oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15790
15791 Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15792 to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15793 in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15794 would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15795 do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15796 programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15797
15798 @node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15799 @section The Calc Mode Line
15800
15801 @noindent
15802 @cindex Mode line indicators
15803 This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15804 Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15805 stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15806
15807 The basic mode line format is:
15808
15809 @example
15810 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
15811 @end example
15812
15813 The @samp{%*} indicates that the buffer is ``read-only''; it shows that
15814 regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15815 as if it were text.
15816
15817 The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15818 is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15819 that are in effect.
15820
15821 The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15822 The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15823 @code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15824
15825 Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15826 on the mode line:
15827
15828 @table @code
15829 @item Alg
15830 Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15831
15832 @item Alg[(
15833 Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15834
15835 @item Alg*
15836 Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15837
15838 @item Symb
15839 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15840
15841 @item Matrix
15842 Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15843
15844 @item Matrix@var{n}
15845 Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15846
15847 @item SqMatrix
15848 Square Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15849
15850 @item Scalar
15851 Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15852
15853 @item Polar
15854 Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15855
15856 @item Frac
15857 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15858
15859 @item Inf
15860 Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15861
15862 @item +Inf
15863 Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15864
15865 @item NoSimp
15866 Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15867
15868 @item NumSimp
15869 Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15870
15871 @item BinSimp@var{w}
15872 Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15873
15874 @item BasicSimp
15875 Basic simplification mode (@kbd{m I}).
15876
15877 @item ExtSimp
15878 Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
15879
15880 @item UnitSimp
15881 Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
15882
15883 @item Bin
15884 Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15885
15886 @item Oct
15887 Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
15888
15889 @item Hex
15890 Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
15891
15892 @item Radix@var{n}
15893 Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
15894
15895 @item Zero
15896 Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15897
15898 @item Big
15899 Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15900
15901 @item Flat
15902 One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
15903
15904 @item Unform
15905 Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
15906
15907 @item C
15908 C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
15909
15910 @item Pascal
15911 Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
15912
15913 @item Fortran
15914 FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
15915
15916 @item TeX
15917 @TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15918
15919 @item LaTeX
15920 @LaTeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15921
15922 @item Eqn
15923 @dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
15924
15925 @item Math
15926 Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
15927
15928 @item Maple
15929 Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
15930
15931 @item Norm@var{n}
15932 Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
15933
15934 @item Fix@var{n}
15935 Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
15936
15937 @item Sci
15938 Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
15939
15940 @item Sci@var{n}
15941 Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
15942
15943 @item Eng
15944 Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
15945
15946 @item Eng@var{n}
15947 Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
15948
15949 @item Left@var{n}
15950 Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
15951
15952 @item Right
15953 Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
15954
15955 @item Right@var{n}
15956 Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
15957
15958 @item Center
15959 Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
15960
15961 @item Center@var{n}
15962 Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
15963
15964 @item Wid@var{n}
15965 Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15966
15967 @item Wide
15968 No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
15969
15970 @item Break
15971 Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15972
15973 @item Save
15974 Record modes in @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
15975
15976 @item Local
15977 Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15978
15979 @item LocEdit
15980 Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15981
15982 @item LocPerm
15983 Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15984
15985 @item Global
15986 Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15987
15988 @item Manual
15989 Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
15990 Recomputation}).
15991
15992 @item Graph
15993 GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
15994
15995 @item Sel
15996 Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15997
15998 @item Dirty
15999 The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
16000
16001 @item Inv
16002 ``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
16003
16004 @item Hyp
16005 ``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
16006
16007 @item Keep
16008 ``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
16009
16010 @item Narrow
16011 Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
16012 @end table
16013
16014 In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
16015 as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
16016
16017 @node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
16018 @chapter Arithmetic Functions
16019
16020 @noindent
16021 This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
16022 on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
16023 commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
16024 performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
16025 stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
16026 formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
16027 is invalid) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
16028
16029 Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
16030 Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
16031 the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
16032
16033 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
16034 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
16035 interpret a prefix argument.
16036
16037 @menu
16038 * Basic Arithmetic::
16039 * Integer Truncation::
16040 * Complex Number Functions::
16041 * Conversions::
16042 * Date Arithmetic::
16043 * Financial Functions::
16044 * Binary Functions::
16045 @end menu
16046
16047 @node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16048 @section Basic Arithmetic
16049
16050 @noindent
16051 @kindex +
16052 @pindex calc-plus
16053 @ignore
16054 @mindex @null
16055 @end ignore
16056 @tindex +
16057 The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
16058 be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
16059 onto the stack.
16060
16061 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
16062 the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
16063 other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
16064 elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
16065 number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
16066 to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
16067 you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
16068 the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
16069 safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
16070 to every element of a vector.
16071
16072 If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
16073 be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
16074 the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
16075 mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
16076 conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
16077
16078 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
16079 the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
16080 is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
16081 degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
16082 and then the two HMS forms are added.
16083
16084 If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
16085 real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
16086 an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
16087 Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
16088 Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
16089 subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
16090 negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
16091 are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16092
16093 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16094 with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16095 error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16096 Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16097 adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16098 error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16099 work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16100 write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16101
16102 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16103 or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16104 result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16105 the two values.
16106
16107 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16108 which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16109 one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16110 @w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16111
16112 If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16113 result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16114 the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16115 infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16116
16117 @kindex -
16118 @pindex calc-minus
16119 @ignore
16120 @mindex @null
16121 @end ignore
16122 @tindex -
16123 The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16124 number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16125 computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16126 available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16127
16128 @kindex *
16129 @pindex calc-times
16130 @ignore
16131 @mindex @null
16132 @end ignore
16133 @tindex *
16134 The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16135 argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16136 the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16137 are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16138 vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16139 done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16140 vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16141 dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16142 is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16143
16144 If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16145 HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16146 HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16147 forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16148 see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16149 or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16150 independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16151 whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16152
16153 @kindex /
16154 @pindex calc-divide
16155 @ignore
16156 @mindex @null
16157 @end ignore
16158 @tindex /
16159 The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers.
16160
16161 When combining multiplication and division in an algebraic formula, it
16162 is good style to use parentheses to distinguish between possible
16163 interpretations; the expression @samp{a/b*c} should be written
16164 @samp{(a/b)*c} or @samp{a/(b*c)}, as appropriate. Without the
16165 parentheses, Calc will interpret @samp{a/b*c} as @samp{a/(b*c)}, since
16166 in algebraic entry Calc gives division a lower precedence than
16167 multiplication. (This is not standard across all computer languages, and
16168 Calc may change the precedence depending on the language mode being used.
16169 @xref{Language Modes}.) This default ordering can be changed by setting
16170 the customizable variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} to
16171 @code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}); this will give multiplication and
16172 division equal precedences. Note that Calc's default choice of
16173 precedence allows @samp{a b / c d} to be used as a shortcut for
16174 @smallexample
16175 @group
16176 a b
16177 ---.
16178 c d
16179 @end group
16180 @end smallexample
16181
16182 When dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the
16183 computation performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This
16184 also occurs if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the
16185 effect is to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}.
16186 If @expr{B} is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a
16187 plain vector (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the
16188 equation @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}.
16189 Otherwise, if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of
16190 @emph{columns} as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If
16191 you wish a vector @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be
16192 solved as @expr{X A = B}, make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1
16193 v p} first. To force a left-handed solution with a square matrix
16194 @expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and @expr{B} before dividing, then
16195 transpose the result.
16196
16197 HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16198 forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16199 values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16200 form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16201 encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16202 interval.
16203
16204 @kindex ^
16205 @pindex calc-power
16206 @ignore
16207 @mindex @null
16208 @end ignore
16209 @tindex ^
16210 The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16211 the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16212 multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16213 logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16214 powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16215 the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16216
16217 @kindex I ^
16218 @tindex nroot
16219 If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16220 computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16221 (This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16222
16223 @kindex \
16224 @pindex calc-idiv
16225 @tindex idiv
16226 @ignore
16227 @mindex @null
16228 @end ignore
16229 @tindex \
16230 The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16231 to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16232 @key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16233 more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16234 operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16235 @kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16236
16237 @kindex %
16238 @pindex calc-mod
16239 @ignore
16240 @mindex @null
16241 @end ignore
16242 @tindex %
16243 The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16244 operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16245 for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16246 positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16247 @expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16248 If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16249 must be positive real number.
16250
16251 @kindex :
16252 @pindex calc-fdiv
16253 @tindex fdiv
16254 The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command
16255 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16256 result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16257 @kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16258 the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16259 you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16260 this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16261 as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16262
16263 @kindex n
16264 @pindex calc-change-sign
16265 The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16266 of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16267 forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16268
16269 @kindex A
16270 @pindex calc-abs
16271 @tindex abs
16272 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16273 value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16274 real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16275 With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16276 the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16277 elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16278 the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16279 The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16280 an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16281
16282 @kindex f A
16283 @pindex calc-abssqr
16284 @tindex abssqr
16285 The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16286 absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16287
16288 @kindex f s
16289 @pindex calc-sign
16290 @tindex sign
16291 The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16292 argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16293 argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16294 which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16295 zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16296
16297 @kindex &
16298 @pindex calc-inv
16299 @tindex inv
16300 @cindex Reciprocal
16301 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16302 reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16303 matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16304
16305 @kindex Q
16306 @pindex calc-sqrt
16307 @tindex sqrt
16308 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16309 root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16310 complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16311
16312 @kindex f h
16313 @pindex calc-hypot
16314 @tindex hypot
16315 The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16316 root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16317 is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16318 and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16319 magnitudes are used.
16320
16321 @kindex f Q
16322 @pindex calc-isqrt
16323 @tindex isqrt
16324 The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16325 integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16326 number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16327 produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16328 integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16329 is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16330 the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16331
16332 @kindex f n
16333 @kindex f x
16334 @pindex calc-min
16335 @tindex min
16336 @pindex calc-max
16337 @tindex max
16338 The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16339 [@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16340 respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16341 intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16342 take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16343 all the arguments.)
16344
16345 @kindex f M
16346 @kindex f X
16347 @pindex calc-mant-part
16348 @tindex mant
16349 @pindex calc-xpon-part
16350 @tindex xpon
16351 The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16352 the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16353 (@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16354 @expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16355 @texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16356 @infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16357 where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16358 @expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16359 and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16360 returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16361 used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16362 mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16363 a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16364
16365 @kindex f S
16366 @pindex calc-scale-float
16367 @tindex scf
16368 The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16369 by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16370 real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16371 may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16372 or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16373
16374 @kindex f [
16375 @kindex f ]
16376 @pindex calc-decrement
16377 @pindex calc-increment
16378 @tindex decr
16379 @tindex incr
16380 The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16381 (@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16382 a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16383 floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16384 For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16385 is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
16386 8 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16387 @samp{0.0} produces
16388 @texline @math{10^{-p}},
16389 @infoline @expr{10^-p},
16390 where @expr{p} is the current
16391 precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16392 With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16393
16394 Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16395 almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
16396 6 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16397 will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16398 One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16399 way floating-point numbers work.
16400
16401 Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16402 Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16403
16404 @node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16405 @section Integer Truncation
16406
16407 @noindent
16408 There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16409 differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16410 commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16411 is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16412 to integer form.
16413
16414 If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16415 expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16416
16417 @cindex Integer part of a number
16418 @kindex F
16419 @pindex calc-floor
16420 @tindex floor
16421 @tindex ffloor
16422 @ignore
16423 @mindex @null
16424 @end ignore
16425 @kindex H F
16426 The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16427 truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16428 infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16429 @mathit{-4}.
16430
16431 @kindex I F
16432 @pindex calc-ceiling
16433 @tindex ceil
16434 @tindex fceil
16435 @ignore
16436 @mindex @null
16437 @end ignore
16438 @kindex H I F
16439 The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16440 command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
16441 4, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16442
16443 @kindex R
16444 @pindex calc-round
16445 @tindex round
16446 @tindex fround
16447 @ignore
16448 @mindex @null
16449 @end ignore
16450 @kindex H R
16451 The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16452 rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16453 this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16454 Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16455 but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16456
16457 @kindex I R
16458 @pindex calc-trunc
16459 @tindex trunc
16460 @tindex ftrunc
16461 @ignore
16462 @mindex @null
16463 @end ignore
16464 @kindex H I R
16465 The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16466 command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16467 everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16468 @kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16469
16470 These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16471 do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16472 modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16473 these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16474 Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16475 representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16476
16477 @ignore
16478 @starindex
16479 @end ignore
16480 @tindex rounde
16481 @ignore
16482 @starindex
16483 @end ignore
16484 @tindex roundu
16485 @ignore
16486 @starindex
16487 @end ignore
16488 @tindex frounde
16489 @ignore
16490 @starindex
16491 @end ignore
16492 @tindex froundu
16493 There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16494 algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16495 except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16496 part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16497 Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16498 rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16499 @samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16500 The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16501 after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16502 subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16503 already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16504 begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16505 of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16506 argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16507 @code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16508
16509 Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16510 a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16511 decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16512 produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16513 produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16514 the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16515 no second argument at all.
16516
16517 @cindex Fractional part of a number
16518 To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16519 added to `@tfn{floor(}@var{n}@tfn{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16520 modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16521
16522 Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16523 and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16524 @kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16525 arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16526
16527 @node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16528 @section Complex Number Functions
16529
16530 @noindent
16531 @kindex J
16532 @pindex calc-conj
16533 @tindex conj
16534 The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16535 complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16536 complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16537 this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16538 this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16539
16540 @kindex G
16541 @pindex calc-argument
16542 @tindex arg
16543 The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16544 ``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16545 notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16546 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'.
16547 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'.
16548 The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16549 be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16550 (inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16551
16552 @pindex calc-imaginary
16553 The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16554 top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16555 command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16556 on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16557
16558 @kindex f r
16559 @pindex calc-re
16560 @tindex re
16561 The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16562 by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16563 added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16564 the value part.)
16565
16566 @kindex f i
16567 @pindex calc-im
16568 @tindex im
16569 The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16570 by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16571 or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16572
16573 @ignore
16574 @mindex v p
16575 @end ignore
16576 @kindex v p (complex)
16577 @kindex V p (complex)
16578 @pindex calc-pack
16579 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16580 the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16581 a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16582 with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16583 (Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16584
16585 @ignore
16586 @mindex v u
16587 @end ignore
16588 @kindex v u (complex)
16589 @kindex V u (complex)
16590 @pindex calc-unpack
16591 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16592 (or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16593 into its separate components.
16594
16595 @node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16596 @section Conversions
16597
16598 @noindent
16599 The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16600 to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16601
16602 @kindex c f
16603 @pindex calc-float
16604 @tindex pfloat
16605 The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16606 number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16607 @expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16608 @expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16609 object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16610 converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16611 in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16612 on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16613 format may lose information.
16614
16615 As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16616 are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16617 you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16618 Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16619 it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16620 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16621
16622 The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16623 applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16624 algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16625 changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16626
16627 @kindex H c f
16628 @tindex float
16629 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16630 only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16631 argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16632 is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16633
16634 You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16635 value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16636 would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16637 that appear right now.
16638
16639 @kindex c F
16640 @pindex calc-fraction
16641 @tindex pfrac
16642 The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16643 floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16644 produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16645 input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16646 numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16647 if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16648 as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16649 is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16650 a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16651 precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16652 fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16653
16654 @kindex H c F
16655 @tindex frac
16656 The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16657 There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16658 which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16659
16660 @kindex c d
16661 @pindex calc-to-degrees
16662 @tindex deg
16663 The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16664 number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16665 HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16666 will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16667
16668 @kindex c r
16669 @pindex calc-to-radians
16670 @tindex rad
16671 The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16672 HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16673
16674 @kindex c h
16675 @pindex calc-to-hms
16676 @tindex hms
16677 The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16678 number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16679 form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16680 function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16681 (The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16682
16683 @pindex calc-from-hms
16684 The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16685 stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16686
16687 @kindex c p
16688 @kindex I c p
16689 @pindex calc-polar
16690 @tindex polar
16691 @tindex rect
16692 The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16693 the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16694 to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16695 This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16696 functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16697 conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16698 already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16699 @kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16700
16701 @kindex c c
16702 @pindex calc-clean
16703 @tindex pclean
16704 The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16705 number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16706 according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16707 components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16708 are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16709 angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16710 produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16711 operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16712 number (i.e., pervasively).
16713
16714 If the simplification mode is set below basic simplification, it is raised
16715 for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c} applies the basic
16716 simplifications even if their automatic application is disabled.
16717 @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16718
16719 @cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16720 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16721 to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16722 least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16723 prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16724
16725 @kindex c 0-9
16726 @pindex calc-clean-num
16727 The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16728 to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16729 errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16730 decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16731
16732 The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16733 through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16734 numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16735 of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16736 if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16737 @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16738 Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16739
16740 If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16741 you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16742 (The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16743 does not clip small numbers.)
16744
16745 One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16746 a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16747 plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16748 produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16749 numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16750 you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16751
16752 @kindex H c 0-9
16753 @kindex H c c
16754 @tindex clean
16755 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16756 operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16757
16758 @node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16759 @section Date Arithmetic
16760
16761 @noindent
16762 @cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16763 The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16764 and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16765 use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16766 letters.
16767
16768 The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16769 commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16770 date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16771 form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16772 date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16773 described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16774
16775 Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16776 plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16777 additional argument from the top of the stack.
16778
16779 @menu
16780 * Date Conversions::
16781 * Date Functions::
16782 * Time Zones::
16783 * Business Days::
16784 @end menu
16785
16786 @node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16787 @subsection Date Conversions
16788
16789 @noindent
16790 @kindex t D
16791 @pindex calc-date
16792 @tindex date
16793 The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16794 date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD. The
16795 result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16796 fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16797 argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16798
16799 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16800 (up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16801 of the following ways:
16802
16803 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16804 builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16805 day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16806 such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16807 an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
16808 1 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16809 @var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16810 month will be used.
16811
16812 The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16813 pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16814 real-time clock.
16815
16816 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16817 function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16818
16819 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16820 @var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16821 @var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16822 @var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16823 @var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16824 The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16825
16826 @kindex t J
16827 @pindex calc-julian
16828 @tindex julian
16829 @cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16830 The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16831 a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
16832 since noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC. A pure date is converted to an
16833 integer Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form
16834 is converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
16835 interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16836 day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16837 you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16838 zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16839 are never time-zone adjusted.
16840
16841 This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16842 count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16843 the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16844 current or specified time zone.
16845
16846 @kindex t U
16847 @pindex calc-unix-time
16848 @tindex unixtime
16849 @cindex Unix time format, conversions
16850 The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16851 converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16852 seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16853 will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16854 precision, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16855 digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16856 is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16857 in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16858 numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16859 suppress the adjustment if so.
16860
16861 @kindex t C
16862 @pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16863 @tindex tzconv
16864 @cindex Time Zones, converting between
16865 The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16866 command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16867 are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16868 any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16869 If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16870 zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16871 prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16872 stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16873
16874 @node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
16875 @subsection Date Functions
16876
16877 @noindent
16878 @kindex t N
16879 @pindex calc-now
16880 @tindex now
16881 The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
16882 current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
16883 reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
16884 argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
16885
16886 @kindex t P
16887 @pindex calc-date-part
16888 The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
16889 of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
16890 argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
16891 The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
16892
16893 @tindex year
16894 The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
16895 from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
16896 following functions will also accept a real number for an
16897 argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
16898 Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
16899 1 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
16900
16901 @tindex month
16902 The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
16903 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
16904
16905 @tindex day
16906 The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
16907 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
16908
16909 @tindex hour
16910 The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
16911 a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
16912 that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
16913 date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
16914 HMS forms as input.
16915
16916 @tindex minute
16917 The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
16918 from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
16919
16920 @tindex second
16921 The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
16922 from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
16923 the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
16924 precision, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
16925
16926 @tindex weekday
16927 The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
16928 number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
16929 to 6 (Saturday).
16930
16931 @tindex yearday
16932 The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
16933 number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
16934 to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
16935
16936 @tindex time
16937 The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
16938 of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
16939 for a pure date form.
16940
16941 @kindex t M
16942 @pindex calc-new-month
16943 @tindex newmonth
16944 The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
16945 computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
16946 specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
16947 form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
16948 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
16949 @kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
16950 is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
16951 @var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
16952
16953 @kindex t Y
16954 @pindex calc-new-year
16955 @tindex newyear
16956 The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
16957 computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
16958 the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
16959 of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
16960 @var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
16961 @var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
16962 years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
16963 year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
16964 @mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
16965
16966 @kindex t W
16967 @pindex calc-new-week
16968 @tindex newweek
16969 The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
16970 computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
16971 the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
16972 use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
16973 the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
16974 subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
16975
16976 Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
16977 Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
16978 will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
16979 will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
16980 of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
16981 this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
16982 exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
16983 if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
16984 to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
16985 the time to midnight; hint:@: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
16986 of the @code{weekday} function?).
16987
16988 @ignore
16989 @starindex
16990 @end ignore
16991 @tindex pwday
16992 The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
16993 day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
16994 two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
16995 number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
16996 specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
16997 7 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
16998 in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
16999 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
17000 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
17001 With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
17002 for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
17003
17004 @kindex t I
17005 @pindex calc-inc-month
17006 @tindex incmonth
17007 The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
17008 increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
17009 months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
17010 if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
17011 same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
17012 number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
17013 @samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
17014 Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
17015 the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
17016 in this case).
17017
17018 @ignore
17019 @starindex
17020 @end ignore
17021 @tindex incyear
17022 The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
17023 a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
17024 any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
17025 is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
17026 simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
17027 months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
17028 argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
17029 command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
17030
17031 There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
17032 serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
17033 @code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
17034
17035 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
17036 which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
17037
17038 @node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
17039 @subsection Business Days
17040
17041 @noindent
17042 Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
17043 where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
17044 arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
17045 consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
17046 subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
17047 (assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
17048
17049 @kindex t +
17050 @kindex t -
17051 @tindex badd
17052 @tindex bsub
17053 @pindex calc-business-days-plus
17054 @pindex calc-business-days-minus
17055 The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
17056 and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
17057 commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
17058 one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
17059 number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
17060 then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
17061 days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
17062 evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
17063 possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
17064 half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
17065 date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
17066 case the result is the number of business days between the two
17067 dates.
17068
17069 @cindex @code{Holidays} variable
17070 @vindex Holidays
17071 By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
17072 Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
17073 additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
17074 (There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
17075 variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
17076 @samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
17077 be any of the following kinds of objects:
17078
17079 @itemize @bullet
17080 @item
17081 Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
17082 particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
17083
17084 @item
17085 Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
17086 which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
17087
17088 @item
17089 Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
17090 considered to be a holiday.
17091
17092 @item
17093 Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
17094 If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
17095 yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
17096 numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
17097 Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
17098 Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
17099 If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
17100 takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
17101 a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
17102
17103 @item
17104 A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
17105 a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
17106
17107 @item
17108 An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
17109 years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
17110 business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
17111 in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
17112 list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
17113 want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
17114 where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
17115 limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
17116 @samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17117 for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17118
17119 @item
17120 An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17121 are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17122 range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17123 the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17124 on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17125 four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17126 Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17127 fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17128 as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17129 be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17130 the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17131 (Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17132 treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17133 so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17134 @end itemize
17135
17136 If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17137 @kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17138 then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17139
17140 Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17141 list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17142 sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17143 @samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17144 Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17145 the number of holidays between two dates.)
17146
17147 Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
17148 2737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17149 list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17150 in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17151 worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17152 calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17153 only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17154 holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17155
17156 If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17157 weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17158 recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17159 Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17160 subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17161 effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17162 day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17163 difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17164 equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17165 conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17166 business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17167 original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17168 completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17169 might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17170 producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17171
17172 @ignore
17173 @starindex
17174 @end ignore
17175 @tindex holiday
17176 There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17177 any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17178 holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17179 business day.
17180
17181 @node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17182 @subsection Time Zones
17183
17184 @noindent
17185 @cindex Time zones
17186 @cindex Daylight saving time
17187 Time zones and daylight saving time are a complicated business.
17188 The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17189 compute the correct time zone and daylight saving adjustment to use,
17190 provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17191 Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17192 do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17193 can't determine the right correction to use.
17194
17195 Adjustments for time zones and daylight saving time are done by
17196 @kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17197 commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17198 to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-saving
17199 transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17200 @samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17201 and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight saving time: using Calc's
17202 default daylight saving time rule (see the explanation below),
17203 @samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17204 evaluates to @samp{29.95833} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17205 because one hour was lost when daylight saving commenced on
17206 April 7, 1991.
17207
17208 In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17209 computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17210 @samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17211 days between two dates without taking daylight saving into account.
17212
17213 @pindex calc-time-zone
17214 @ignore
17215 @starindex
17216 @end ignore
17217 @tindex tzone
17218 The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17219 zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17220 seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17221 is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17222 Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17223 Daylight Saving time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17224 the normal difference.
17225
17226 If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17227 date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17228 zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17229 and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17230 stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17231 adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17232 it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17233 For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17234 (for Pacific standard and daylight saving times, respectively).
17235
17236 North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17237 note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17238 another for daylight saving time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17239 in which the daylight saving adjustment is computed from context.
17240
17241 @smallexample
17242 @group
17243 YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17244 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17245
17246 YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17247 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17248
17249 YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
17250 9/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17251 @end group
17252 @end smallexample
17253
17254 @vindex math-tzone-names
17255 To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17256 you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17257 is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17258 structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17259 Pacific Time look like this:
17260
17261 @smallexample
17262 @group
17263 ( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17264 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight saving adjustment.
17265 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17266 @end group
17267 @end smallexample
17268
17269 @cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17270 @vindex TimeZone
17271 With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} will by
17272 default get the time zone and daylight saving information from the
17273 calendar (@pxref{Daylight Saving,Calendar/Diary,The Calendar and the Diary,
17274 emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}). To use a different time zone, or if the
17275 calendar does not give the desired result, you can set the Calc variable
17276 @code{TimeZone} (which is by default @code{nil}) to an appropriate
17277 time zone name. (The easiest way to do this is to edit the
17278 @code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T} command, then use the
17279 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save the value of
17280 @code{TimeZone} permanently.)
17281 If the time zone given by @code{TimeZone} is a generalized time zone,
17282 e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc examines the date being converted to tell whether
17283 to use standard or daylight saving time. But if the current time zone
17284 is explicit, e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is
17285 used exactly and Calc's daylight saving algorithm is not consulted.
17286 The special time zone name @code{local}
17287 is equivalent to no argument; i.e., it uses the information obtained
17288 from the calendar.
17289
17290 The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17291 arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}; namely, use the
17292 information from the calendar if @code{TimeZone} is @code{nil},
17293 otherwise use the time zone given by @code{TimeZone}.
17294
17295 @vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17296 @findex math-std-daylight-savings
17297 When Calc computes the daylight saving information itself (i.e., when
17298 the @code{TimeZone} variable is set), it will by default consider
17299 daylight saving time to begin at 2 a.m.@: on the second Sunday of March
17300 (for years from 2007 on) or on the last Sunday in April (for years
17301 before 2007), and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of
17302 November. (for years from 2007 on) or the last Sunday in October (for
17303 years before 2007). These are the rules that have been in effect in
17304 much of North America since 1966 and take into account the rule change
17305 that began in 2007. If you are in a country that uses different rules
17306 for computing daylight saving time, you have two choices: Write your own
17307 daylight saving hook, or control time zones explicitly by setting the
17308 @code{TimeZone} variable and/or always giving a time-zone argument for
17309 the conversion functions.
17310
17311 The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17312 name of a function that is used to compute the daylight saving
17313 adjustment for a given date. The default is
17314 @code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17315 (either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17316
17317 The daylight saving hook function is called with four arguments:
17318 The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17319 a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17320 hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17321 the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17322 and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17323 converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17324
17325 @findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17326 The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17327 daylight saving computations. This is an internal version of
17328 the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17329 section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17330 the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17331 and the weekday number (0-6).
17332
17333 The default daylight saving hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17334 more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17335 time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17336 depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17337 algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17338 daylight saving hook:
17339
17340 @smallexample
17341 (defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17342 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17343 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17344 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17345 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17346 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17347 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17348 (t -1))))
17349 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17350 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17351 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17352 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17353 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17354 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17355 (t 0))))
17356 (t 0))
17357 )
17358 @end smallexample
17359
17360 @noindent
17361 The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17362 from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17363 It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17364 adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17365 and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17366
17367 There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17368 beginning of daylight saving time; converting a date/time form that
17369 falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17370 from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight saving time, the
17371 hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17372 form that falls in this hour results in a time value for the first
17373 manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour
17374 later).
17375
17376 If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17377 daylight saving adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17378
17379 In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17380 computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17381 given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17382 generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17383 daylight saving computation is applied to it as it appears.
17384 If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17385 daylight-saving version of @var{zone} before being given to
17386 the daylight saving hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17387 that the daylight-saving computation is always done in
17388 local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17389 is typically represented in.
17390
17391 @ignore
17392 @starindex
17393 @end ignore
17394 @tindex dsadj
17395 The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17396 daylight saving adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17397 time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17398 daylight saving time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17399 @var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17400 the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17401 the computation is done for the current time zone.
17402
17403 @node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17404 @section Financial Functions
17405
17406 @noindent
17407 Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17408 key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17409 a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17410
17411 Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17412 functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17413 both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17414 in months will give you very wrong answers!
17415
17416 It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17417 you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17418 last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17419 of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17420
17421 @menu
17422 * Percentages::
17423 * Future Value::
17424 * Present Value::
17425 * Related Financial Functions::
17426 * Depreciation Functions::
17427 * Definitions of Financial Functions::
17428 @end menu
17429
17430 @node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17431 @subsection Percentages
17432
17433 @kindex M-%
17434 @pindex calc-percent
17435 @tindex %
17436 @tindex percent
17437 The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17438 say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17439 @kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17440 @key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17441
17442 Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17443 You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17444 @samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17445 100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17446 @samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17447 (The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17448 @code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17449 @samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17450
17451 The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
17452 0.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17453 the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17454 uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17455 The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17456 but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17457
17458 In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17459 for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17460 but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17461 represents a rate of 540 percent!
17462
17463 The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17464 For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
17465 68 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17466
17467 @kindex c %
17468 @pindex calc-convert-percent
17469 The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17470 value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17471 For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17472 @samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17473 differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17474 this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17475 to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17476
17477 To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17478 use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17479 @samp{25%}.
17480
17481 @kindex b %
17482 @pindex calc-percent-change
17483 @tindex relch
17484 The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17485 calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17486 For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17487 since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17488 decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
17489 20% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17490 because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17491 in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17492 of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17493 the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17494
17495 @node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17496 @subsection Future Value
17497
17498 @noindent
17499 @kindex b F
17500 @pindex calc-fin-fv
17501 @tindex fv
17502 The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17503 the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17504 from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17505 If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17506 years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17507 year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17508 worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17509 have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17510 in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17511 occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17512
17513 @kindex I b F
17514 @tindex fvb
17515 The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17516 but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17517 Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17518 earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17519 in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17520 Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17521 Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17522 @kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17523 as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17524
17525 @kindex H b F
17526 @tindex fvl
17527 The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17528 of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17529 those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17530 they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17531
17532 The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17533 fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17534 of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17535 @var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17536 + fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17537
17538 To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17539 do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17540 final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17541 deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17542 five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17543 deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
17544 1234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17545 year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17546 these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17547 by @code{fvb} directly.
17548
17549 What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17550 are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17551 as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17552 lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17553 now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17554 a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
17555 5870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17556
17557 @node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17558 @subsection Present Value
17559
17560 @noindent
17561 @kindex b P
17562 @pindex calc-fin-pv
17563 @tindex pv
17564 The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17565 the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17566 three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17567 It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17568 Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17569 pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17570 these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17571 You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17572 to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17573 from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17574 result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17575 say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17576 put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17577
17578 Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17579 trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17580 considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17581 the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17582 @code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17583 you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17584 finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17585 @code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17586 the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17587
17588 @kindex I b P
17589 @tindex pvb
17590 The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17591 but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17592 It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17593 to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17594 a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17595 earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17596
17597 @kindex H b P
17598 @tindex pvl
17599 The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17600 an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17601 period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17602 four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17603 less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17604 on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17605 @code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17606
17607 You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17608 and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17609 fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17610
17611 @kindex b N
17612 @pindex calc-fin-npv
17613 @tindex npv
17614 The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17615 the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17616 The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17617 a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17618 at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17619 a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17620 from the first year, second year, and so on.
17621
17622 Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17623 Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17624 not all the same!
17625
17626 The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17627 Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17628 vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17629 @xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17630 payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17631 values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17632 A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17633 payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17634
17635 @kindex I b N
17636 @tindex npvb
17637 The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17638 value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17639 rather than at the end.
17640
17641 @node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17642 @subsection Related Financial Functions
17643
17644 @noindent
17645 The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17646 present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17647
17648 @kindex b M
17649 @pindex calc-fin-pmt
17650 @tindex pmt
17651 The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17652 the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17653 Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17654 value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17655 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17656
17657 @kindex I b M
17658 @tindex pmtb
17659 The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17660 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17661 @code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17662 represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17663
17664 @kindex H b M
17665 The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17666 the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17667
17668 @kindex b #
17669 @pindex calc-fin-nper
17670 @tindex nper
17671 The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17672 the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17673 Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17674 the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17675 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17676 ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17677 the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17678
17679 @kindex I b #
17680 @tindex nperb
17681 The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17682 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17683 lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17684 rather slow in the four-argument case.
17685
17686 @kindex H b #
17687 @tindex nperl
17688 The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17689 using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17690 can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17691 @code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17692 bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17693
17694 @kindex b T
17695 @pindex calc-fin-rate
17696 @tindex rate
17697 The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17698 the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17699 @code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17700 @var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17701 @var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17702
17703 @kindex I b T
17704 @kindex H b T
17705 @tindex rateb
17706 @tindex ratel
17707 The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17708 commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17709 in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17710 accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17711 To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17712 @code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17713 interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17714
17715 @kindex b I
17716 @pindex calc-fin-irr
17717 @tindex irr
17718 The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17719 analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17720 Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17721 computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17722 this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17723
17724 @kindex I b I
17725 @tindex irrb
17726 The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17727 return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17728
17729 @node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17730 @subsection Depreciation Functions
17731
17732 @noindent
17733 The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17734 the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17735 are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17736 of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17737 of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17738 (or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17739
17740 There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17741 the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17742
17743 @kindex b S
17744 @pindex calc-fin-sln
17745 @tindex sln
17746 The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17747 ``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17748 by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17749 @samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17750 initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17751 per year.
17752
17753 @kindex b Y
17754 @pindex calc-fin-syd
17755 @tindex syd
17756 The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17757 accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17758 is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17759 depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17760 parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17761 If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17762 return zero.
17763
17764 @kindex b D
17765 @pindex calc-fin-ddb
17766 @tindex ddb
17767 The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17768 accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17769 It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17770
17771 For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17772 parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17773 return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17774
17775 For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17776 and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17777 ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17778 the three depreciation methods:
17779
17780 @example
17781 @group
17782 [ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17783 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17784 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17785 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17786 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17787 @end group
17788 @end example
17789
17790 @noindent
17791 (Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17792 We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17793 @kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17794 and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17795
17796 Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17797 the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17798 difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17799
17800 @node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17801 @subsection Definitions
17802
17803 @noindent
17804 For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17805 Calc's financial functions.
17806
17807 Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17808 @var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17809 be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17810 formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17811 (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17812 integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17813
17814 @ifnottex
17815 These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17816 mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17817 linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17818
17819 @example
17820 n
17821 (1 + rate) - 1
17822 fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17823 rate
17824
17825 n
17826 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17827 fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17828 rate
17829
17830 n
17831 fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17832
17833 -n
17834 1 - (1 + rate)
17835 pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17836 rate
17837
17838 -n
17839 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17840 pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17841 rate
17842
17843 -n
17844 pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17845
17846 -1 -2 -3
17847 npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17848
17849 -1 -2
17850 npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17851
17852 -n
17853 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17854 pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17855 -n
17856 1 - (1 + rate)
17857
17858 -n
17859 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17860 pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17861 -n
17862 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17863
17864 amt * rate
17865 nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17866 pmt
17867
17868 amt * rate
17869 nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17870 pmt * (1 + rate)
17871
17872 amt
17873 nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
17874 pmt
17875
17876 1/n
17877 pmt
17878 ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
17879 1/n
17880 amt
17881
17882 cost - salv
17883 sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
17884 life
17885
17886 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
17887 syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
17888 life * (life + 1) / 2
17889
17890 book * 2
17891 ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
17892 life
17893 @end example
17894 @end ifnottex
17895 @tex
17896 $$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
17897 $$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17898 $$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
17899 $$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
17900 $$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17901 $$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
17902 $$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
17903 $$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
17904 $$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
17905 $$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
17906 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
17907 $$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
17908 $$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
17909 $$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
17910 $$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
17911 $$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
17912 $$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
17913 $$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
17914 @end tex
17915
17916 @noindent
17917 In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
17918
17919 These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
17920 intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
17921 above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
17922 all sorts of inputs.
17923
17924 Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
17925 negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
17926 returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
17927
17928 @samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
17929 @samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
17930 (@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
17931 for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
17932 that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
17933 directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
17934
17935 Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
17936 for @samp{rate}.
17937
17938 If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
17939 will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
17940 guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
17941
17942 A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
17943 calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
17944 The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
17945
17946 The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
17947 starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
17948 formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
17949 would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
17950 and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
17951 function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
17952 period.
17953
17954 @node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
17955 @section Binary Number Functions
17956
17957 @noindent
17958 The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
17959 the @kbd{b} prefix.
17960
17961 @cindex Binary numbers
17962 The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
17963 displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
17964 like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
17965 commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
17966 zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
17967
17968 @cindex Word size for binary operations
17969 The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
17970 arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
17971 of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
17972 particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
17973 @expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
17974
17975 If the word size is negative, binary operations produce twos-complement
17976 integers from
17977 @texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
17978 @infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
17979 to
17980 @texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
17981 @infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
17982 inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
17983 @expr{w} affects only the results produced.
17984
17985 @kindex b c
17986 @pindex calc-clip
17987 @tindex clip
17988 The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
17989 [@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
17990 @expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
17991 their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
17992 addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
17993 generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
17994 @code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
17995 bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
17996 size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
17997
17998 @kindex b w
17999 @pindex calc-word-size
18000 The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
18001 rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
18002 operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
18003 top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
18004 To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
18005 This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
18006 immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
18007
18008 When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
18009 optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
18010 @samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
18011 will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
18012 @mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
18013 in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
18014 integer-valued floats.
18015
18016 If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
18017 power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
18018 numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
18019 consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
18020
18021 @kindex b a
18022 @pindex calc-and
18023 @tindex and
18024 The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
18025 AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
18026 of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
18027 bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
18028 @samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
18029
18030 @kindex b o
18031 @pindex calc-or
18032 @tindex or
18033 The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
18034 inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
18035 both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
18036
18037 @kindex b x
18038 @pindex calc-xor
18039 @tindex xor
18040 The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
18041 exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
18042 is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
18043
18044 @kindex b d
18045 @pindex calc-diff
18046 @tindex diff
18047 The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
18048 difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
18049 so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
18050
18051 @kindex b n
18052 @pindex calc-not
18053 @tindex not
18054 The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
18055 NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
18056
18057 @kindex b l
18058 @pindex calc-lshift-binary
18059 @tindex lsh
18060 The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
18061 number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18062 prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
18063 in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
18064 is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
18065 Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
18066
18067 @kindex H b l
18068 @kindex H b r
18069 @ignore
18070 @mindex @idots
18071 @end ignore
18072 @kindex H b L
18073 @ignore
18074 @mindex @null
18075 @end ignore
18076 @kindex H b R
18077 @ignore
18078 @mindex @null
18079 @end ignore
18080 @kindex H b t
18081 The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
18082 from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
18083 bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18084 the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18085 has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18086
18087 @kindex b r
18088 @pindex calc-rshift-binary
18089 @tindex rsh
18090 The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18091 number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18092 prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18093
18094 @kindex b L
18095 @pindex calc-lshift-arith
18096 @tindex ash
18097 The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18098 number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18099 is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18100 is performed as described below.
18101
18102 @kindex b R
18103 @pindex calc-rshift-arith
18104 @tindex rash
18105 The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18106 an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18107 to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18108 This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18109 as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18110 and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18111 size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18112 performs a standard left shift.
18113
18114 @kindex b t
18115 @pindex calc-rotate-binary
18116 @tindex rot
18117 The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18118 number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18119 word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18120 numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18121 or right.
18122
18123 @xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18124 pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18125 unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18126 @samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18127 bits in a binary integer.
18128
18129 Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18130 is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18131 unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18132 with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18133 into a binary integer.
18134
18135 @node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18136 @chapter Scientific Functions
18137
18138 @noindent
18139 The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18140 calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18141 full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18142 flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18143
18144 @kindex P
18145 @pindex calc-pi
18146 @cindex @code{pi} variable
18147 @vindex pi
18148 @kindex H P
18149 @cindex @code{e} variable
18150 @vindex e
18151 @kindex I P
18152 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
18153 @vindex gamma
18154 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18155 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
18156 @kindex H I P
18157 @cindex @code{phi} variable
18158 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
18159 @cindex Golden ratio
18160 One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18161 the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18162 Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18163 With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18164 @texline @math{\gamma}
18165 @infoline @expr{gamma}
18166 (about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18167 pushes the ``golden ratio''
18168 @texline @math{\phi}
18169 @infoline @expr{phi}
18170 (about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18171 to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18172 In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18173 actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18174 respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18175
18176 @ignore
18177 @mindex Q
18178 @end ignore
18179 @ignore
18180 @mindex I Q
18181 @end ignore
18182 @kindex I Q
18183 @tindex sqr
18184 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18185 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18186 computes the square of the argument.
18187
18188 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18189 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18190 interpret a prefix argument.
18191
18192 @menu
18193 * Logarithmic Functions::
18194 * Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18195 * Advanced Math Functions::
18196 * Branch Cuts::
18197 * Random Numbers::
18198 * Combinatorial Functions::
18199 * Probability Distribution Functions::
18200 @end menu
18201
18202 @node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18203 @section Logarithmic Functions
18204
18205 @noindent
18206 @kindex L
18207 @pindex calc-ln
18208 @tindex ln
18209 @ignore
18210 @mindex @null
18211 @end ignore
18212 @kindex I E
18213 The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18214 logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18215 the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18216 this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18217
18218 @kindex E
18219 @pindex calc-exp
18220 @tindex exp
18221 @ignore
18222 @mindex @null
18223 @end ignore
18224 @kindex I L
18225 The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18226 exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18227 The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18228 the @code{calc-ln} command.
18229
18230 @kindex H L
18231 @kindex H E
18232 @pindex calc-log10
18233 @tindex log10
18234 @tindex exp10
18235 @ignore
18236 @mindex @null
18237 @end ignore
18238 @kindex H I L
18239 @ignore
18240 @mindex @null
18241 @end ignore
18242 @kindex H I E
18243 The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18244 (base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18245 it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18246 complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18247 by
18248 @texline @math{\ln10}.
18249 @infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18250
18251 @kindex B
18252 @kindex I B
18253 @pindex calc-log
18254 @tindex log
18255 @tindex alog
18256 The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18257 to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18258 @texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18259 @infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18260 In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18261 will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18262 mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18263 similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18264
18265 @kindex f I
18266 @pindex calc-ilog
18267 @tindex ilog
18268 The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18269 integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18270 themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18271 down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18272 range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18273 integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18274 @samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18275
18276 @kindex f E
18277 @pindex calc-expm1
18278 @tindex expm1
18279 The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18280 @texline @math{e^x - 1},
18281 @infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18282 but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18283 answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18284 @texline @math{e^x}
18285 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18286 is close to one.
18287
18288 @kindex f L
18289 @pindex calc-lnp1
18290 @tindex lnp1
18291 The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18292 @texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18293 @infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18294 producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18295
18296 @node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18297 @section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18298
18299 @noindent
18300 @kindex S
18301 @pindex calc-sin
18302 @tindex sin
18303 The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18304 of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18305 as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18306 to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18307 on complex numbers.
18308
18309 Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18310 @code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18311 all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18312 simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18313 of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18314
18315 Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18316 arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18317 the default algebraic simplifications recognize many such
18318 formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18319 mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18320 @xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18321 have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18322 reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18323 the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18324 Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18325
18326 Calc's algebraic simplifications know all angles which are integer multiples of
18327 @cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18328 analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18329 degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18330
18331 @kindex I S
18332 @pindex calc-arcsin
18333 @tindex arcsin
18334 With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18335 available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18336 function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18337 notation depending on the current angular mode.
18338
18339 @kindex H S
18340 @pindex calc-sinh
18341 @tindex sinh
18342 @kindex H I S
18343 @pindex calc-arcsinh
18344 @tindex arcsinh
18345 With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18346 sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18347 Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18348 (@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18349
18350 @kindex C
18351 @pindex calc-cos
18352 @tindex cos
18353 @ignore
18354 @mindex @idots
18355 @end ignore
18356 @kindex I C
18357 @pindex calc-arccos
18358 @ignore
18359 @mindex @null
18360 @end ignore
18361 @tindex arccos
18362 @ignore
18363 @mindex @null
18364 @end ignore
18365 @kindex H C
18366 @pindex calc-cosh
18367 @ignore
18368 @mindex @null
18369 @end ignore
18370 @tindex cosh
18371 @ignore
18372 @mindex @null
18373 @end ignore
18374 @kindex H I C
18375 @pindex calc-arccosh
18376 @ignore
18377 @mindex @null
18378 @end ignore
18379 @tindex arccosh
18380 @ignore
18381 @mindex @null
18382 @end ignore
18383 @kindex T
18384 @pindex calc-tan
18385 @ignore
18386 @mindex @null
18387 @end ignore
18388 @tindex tan
18389 @ignore
18390 @mindex @null
18391 @end ignore
18392 @kindex I T
18393 @pindex calc-arctan
18394 @ignore
18395 @mindex @null
18396 @end ignore
18397 @tindex arctan
18398 @ignore
18399 @mindex @null
18400 @end ignore
18401 @kindex H T
18402 @pindex calc-tanh
18403 @ignore
18404 @mindex @null
18405 @end ignore
18406 @tindex tanh
18407 @ignore
18408 @mindex @null
18409 @end ignore
18410 @kindex H I T
18411 @pindex calc-arctanh
18412 @ignore
18413 @mindex @null
18414 @end ignore
18415 @tindex arctanh
18416 The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18417 of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18418 computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18419 variants of these functions.
18420
18421 @kindex f T
18422 @pindex calc-arctan2
18423 @tindex arctan2
18424 The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18425 numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18426 result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18427 (inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18428 result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18429 value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18430 since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18431 components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18432 which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18433 @samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18434
18435 @pindex calc-sincos
18436 @ignore
18437 @starindex
18438 @end ignore
18439 @tindex sincos
18440 @ignore
18441 @starindex
18442 @end ignore
18443 @ignore
18444 @mindex arc@idots
18445 @end ignore
18446 @tindex arcsincos
18447 The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18448 cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18449 @samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18450 With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18451 vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18452 (This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18453
18454 @pindex calc-sec
18455 @tindex sec
18456 @pindex calc-csc
18457 @tindex csc
18458 @pindex calc-cot
18459 @tindex cot
18460 @pindex calc-sech
18461 @tindex sech
18462 @pindex calc-csch
18463 @tindex csch
18464 @pindex calc-coth
18465 @tindex coth
18466 The remaining trigonometric functions, @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}],
18467 @code{calc-csc} [@code{csc}] and @code{calc-cot} [@code{cot}], are also
18468 available. With the Hyperbolic flag, these compute their hyperbolic
18469 counterparts, which are also available separately as @code{calc-sech}
18470 [@code{sech}], @code{calc-csch} [@code{csch}] and @code{calc-coth}
18471 [@code{coth}]. (These commands do not accept the Inverse flag.)
18472
18473 @node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18474 @section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18475
18476 @noindent
18477 Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18478 various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18479 this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18480 will work to arbitrarily large precision. They can not at present
18481 handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18482
18483 NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18484 accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18485 current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18486 using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18487 slow for some values of the arguments.
18488
18489 @kindex f g
18490 @pindex calc-gamma
18491 @tindex gamma
18492 The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18493 gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18494 factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18495 arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18496 integral:
18497 @texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18498 @infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18499 (The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18500
18501 @kindex f G
18502 @tindex gammaP
18503 @ignore
18504 @mindex @idots
18505 @end ignore
18506 @kindex I f G
18507 @ignore
18508 @mindex @null
18509 @end ignore
18510 @kindex H f G
18511 @ignore
18512 @mindex @null
18513 @end ignore
18514 @kindex H I f G
18515 @pindex calc-inc-gamma
18516 @ignore
18517 @mindex @null
18518 @end ignore
18519 @tindex gammaQ
18520 @ignore
18521 @mindex @null
18522 @end ignore
18523 @tindex gammag
18524 @ignore
18525 @mindex @null
18526 @end ignore
18527 @tindex gammaG
18528 The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18529 the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18530 the integral,
18531 @texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18532 @infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18533 This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18534 definition of the normal gamma function).
18535
18536 Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18537 The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18538 some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18539 You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18540 @expr{x} to infinity.
18541
18542 @ifnottex
18543 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18544 and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18545 factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18546 (where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18547 letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18548 and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18549 @end ifnottex
18550 @tex
18551 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18552 and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18553 factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18554 You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18555 \kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18556 @end tex
18557
18558 @kindex f b
18559 @pindex calc-beta
18560 @tindex beta
18561 The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18562 Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18563 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18564 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18565 or by
18566 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18567 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18568
18569 @kindex f B
18570 @kindex H f B
18571 @pindex calc-inc-beta
18572 @tindex betaI
18573 @tindex betaB
18574 The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18575 the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18576 @texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18577 @infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18578 Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18579 un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18580
18581 @kindex f e
18582 @kindex I f e
18583 @pindex calc-erf
18584 @tindex erf
18585 @tindex erfc
18586 The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18587 error function
18588 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18589 @infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18590 The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18591 is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18592 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18593 @infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18594
18595 @kindex f j
18596 @kindex f y
18597 @pindex calc-bessel-J
18598 @pindex calc-bessel-Y
18599 @tindex besJ
18600 @tindex besY
18601 The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18602 (@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18603 functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18604 In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18605 @expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18606 Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18607 precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18608 Use with care!
18609
18610 @node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18611 @section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18612
18613 @noindent
18614 @cindex Branch cuts
18615 @cindex Principal values
18616 All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18617 defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18618 This section describes the values
18619 returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18620 Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18621 second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18622 function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18623 diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18624
18625 Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
18626 changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Recent
18627 versions of Calc follow the second edition.
18628
18629 The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18630 They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18631 @code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18632 and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18633 Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18634 or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18635
18636 Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18637 are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18638 efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18639 and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18640
18641 For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18642 or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18643 negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18644 in the right half of the complex plane.
18645
18646 For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18647 The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18648 Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18649 negative real axis.
18650
18651 The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18652 If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18653 the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18654 Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18655 occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18656
18657 @smallexample
18658 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18659 ----------------------------------------
18660 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18661 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18662 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18663 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18664 @end smallexample
18665
18666 For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18667 One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18668 not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18669 number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18670 of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18671 less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18672
18673 For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18674 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18675
18676 For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18677 or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18678 the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18679
18680 For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18681 @samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18682 imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18683
18684 For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18685 The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18686 above @expr{i}.
18687
18688 For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18689 @samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18690 real axis less than 1.
18691
18692 For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18693 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18694
18695 The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18696 @code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18697 hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18698
18699 @smallexample
18700 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18701 -------------------------------------------------------
18702 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18703 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18704 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18705 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18706 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18707 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18708 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18709 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18710 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18711 @end smallexample
18712
18713 @smallexample
18714 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18715 -----------------------------------------------------
18716 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18717 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18718 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18719 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18720 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18721 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18722 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18723 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18724 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18725 @end smallexample
18726
18727 @smallexample
18728 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18729 -----------------------------------------------------
18730 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18731 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18732 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18733 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18734 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18735 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18736 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18737 @end smallexample
18738
18739 Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18740 between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18741 are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18742
18743 @smallexample
18744 sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18745 cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18746 tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18747 sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18748 @end smallexample
18749
18750 The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18751 for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18752 are not rigorously specified at present.
18753
18754 @node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18755 @section Random Numbers
18756
18757 @noindent
18758 @kindex k r
18759 @pindex calc-random
18760 @tindex random
18761 The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18762 random numbers of various sorts.
18763
18764 Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18765 integer @expr{N} in the range
18766 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18767 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
18768 Each possible value @expr{N} appears with equal probability.
18769
18770 With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18771 from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18772 the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18773 while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18774 taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18775 the result is a random integer in the range
18776 @texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18777 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18778
18779 If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18780 is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18781 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18782 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18783 or
18784 @texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18785 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18786 according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18787
18788 If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18789 number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18790 of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18791 every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18792
18793 If @expr{M} is an error form
18794 @texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18795 @infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18796 where @var{m} and
18797 @texline @math{\sigma}
18798 @infoline @var{s}
18799 are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18800 @var{m} and standard deviation
18801 @texline @math{\sigma}.
18802 @infoline @var{s}.
18803
18804 If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18805 acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18806 the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18807 is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18808 range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18809 not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18810 intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18811 with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18812 million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18813 additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18814 extremely small.)
18815
18816 If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18817 the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18818
18819 @vindex RandSeed
18820 The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18821 default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18822 the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18823 sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18824 @code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18825 to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18826 @code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18827 sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18828 from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18829 before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18830 of random numbers as before.
18831
18832 @pindex calc-rrandom
18833 The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18834 number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18835
18836 @kindex k a
18837 @pindex calc-random-again
18838 The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18839 number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18840 prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18841 that value of @expr{M}.
18842
18843 @kindex k h
18844 @pindex calc-shuffle
18845 @tindex shuffle
18846 The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18847 random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18848 specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18849 of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18850 gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18851 prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18852 stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18853
18854 If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18855 that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18856 there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18857 @kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18858 of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18859 a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18860 number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18861 elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18862 If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18863 than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18864 each make it into the result vector.)
18865
18866 One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18867 if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18868 @kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18869 @samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18870 @var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18871 by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18872 a small discrete set of possibilities.
18873
18874 To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
18875 given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
18876 prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
18877 @kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
18878 elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
18879
18880 @menu
18881 * Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
18882 @end menu
18883
18884 @node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
18885 @subsection Random Number Generator
18886
18887 Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
18888 the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
18889 Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
18890 of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
18891 characterization.
18892
18893 If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs's built-in
18894 @code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
18895 then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
18896 random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
18897
18898 When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
18899 the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
18900 random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
18901
18902 Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
18903 returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
18904 several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
18905 the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
18906 near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
18907 four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
18908 bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
18909 generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
18910
18911 If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
18912 seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
18913 computing
18914 @texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
18915 @infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
18916 This method expands the seed
18917 value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
18918 @code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
18919 to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
18920 @code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
18921 continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
18922 way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
18923 so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
18924 from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
18925 same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
18926 @kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
18927 to reseed the generator with that number.
18928
18929 Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
18930 of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
18931 to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
18932 index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
18933 random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
18934 obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
18935 the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
18936 supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
18937 generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
18938 provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
18939 damage its randomness.
18940
18941 To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
18942 builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
18943 of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
18944 (which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
18945 or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
18946 value.
18947
18948 To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
18949 simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
18950 @texline @math{10^{-p}}.
18951 @infoline @expr{10^-p}.
18952 The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
18953 that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
18954 In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
18955 numbers on the order of
18956 @texline @math{10^{-9}}
18957 @infoline @expr{10^-9}
18958 or
18959 @texline @math{10^{-10}},
18960 @infoline @expr{10^-10},
18961 but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
18962 correspond to small integers times
18963 @texline @math{10^{-12}}.
18964 @infoline @expr{10^-12}.
18965
18966 To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
18967 counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
18968 additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
18969 power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
18970 the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
18971 if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
18972 modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
18973 numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
18974 modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
18975 ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
18976
18977 The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
18978 ``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C. This method
18979 generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
18980 other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
18981
18982 @node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
18983 @section Combinatorial Functions
18984
18985 @noindent
18986 Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
18987 @kbd{k} key prefix.
18988
18989 @kindex k g
18990 @pindex calc-gcd
18991 @tindex gcd
18992 The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
18993 Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
18994 the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
18995 numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
18996 consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
18997 integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
18998 the operation is left in symbolic form.
18999
19000 @kindex k l
19001 @pindex calc-lcm
19002 @tindex lcm
19003 The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
19004 Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
19005 the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
19006 numbers.
19007
19008 @kindex k E
19009 @pindex calc-extended-gcd
19010 @tindex egcd
19011 The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
19012 the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
19013 @expr{[g, a, b]} where
19014 @texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19015 @infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19016
19017 @kindex !
19018 @pindex calc-factorial
19019 @tindex fact
19020 @ignore
19021 @mindex @null
19022 @end ignore
19023 @tindex !
19024 The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
19025 factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
19026 integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
19027 integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
19028 the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
19029 as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
19030 large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
19031 since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
19032 the commands in this section.
19033
19034 @kindex k d
19035 @pindex calc-double-factorial
19036 @tindex dfact
19037 @ignore
19038 @mindex @null
19039 @end ignore
19040 @tindex !!
19041 The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
19042 computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
19043 this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
19044 integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
19045 the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
19046 approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
19047 The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
19048
19049 @kindex k c
19050 @pindex calc-choose
19051 @tindex choose
19052 The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
19053 binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
19054 on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
19055 are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
19056 floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
19057 real numbers by
19058 @texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
19059 @infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
19060
19061 @kindex H k c
19062 @pindex calc-perm
19063 @tindex perm
19064 @ifnottex
19065 The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
19066 number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
19067 @end ifnottex
19068 @tex
19069 The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
19070 number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
19071 @end tex
19072
19073 @kindex k b
19074 @kindex H k b
19075 @pindex calc-bernoulli-number
19076 @tindex bern
19077 The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
19078 computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
19079 is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
19080 is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
19081 taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
19082 top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
19083 a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
19084
19085 @kindex k e
19086 @kindex H k e
19087 @pindex calc-euler-number
19088 @tindex euler
19089 The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
19090 computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
19091 Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
19092 functions.
19093
19094 @kindex k s
19095 @kindex H k s
19096 @pindex calc-stirling-number
19097 @tindex stir1
19098 @tindex stir2
19099 The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
19100 computes a Stirling number of the first
19101 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19102 @infoline kind,
19103 given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19104 [@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19105 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19106 @infoline kind.
19107 These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19108 and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19109 non-empty sets, respectively.
19110
19111 @kindex k p
19112 @pindex calc-prime-test
19113 @cindex Primes
19114 The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19115 the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19116 answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19117 probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19118 The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19119 any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19120 discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19121 certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19122 a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19123 (Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19124 even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19125 the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19126 or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19127
19128 @ignore
19129 @starindex
19130 @end ignore
19131 @tindex prime
19132 The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19133 test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19134 additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19135 the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19136 @samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19137 is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19138
19139 @kindex k f
19140 @pindex calc-prime-factors
19141 @tindex prfac
19142 The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19143 attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19144 to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19145 result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19146 inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19147 last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19148 million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19149 element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19150 @mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19151
19152 @kindex k n
19153 @pindex calc-next-prime
19154 @ignore
19155 @mindex nextpr@idots
19156 @end ignore
19157 @tindex nextprime
19158 The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19159 the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19160 @code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19161 passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19162 but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19163 slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19164 of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19165 the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19166 matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19167 @kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19168 prime.
19169
19170 @kindex I k n
19171 @pindex calc-prev-prime
19172 @ignore
19173 @mindex prevpr@idots
19174 @end ignore
19175 @tindex prevprime
19176 The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19177 analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19178
19179 @kindex k t
19180 @pindex calc-totient
19181 @tindex totient
19182 The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19183 Euler ``totient''
19184 @texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19185 @infoline function,
19186 the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19187 are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19188
19189 @kindex k m
19190 @pindex calc-moebius
19191 @tindex moebius
19192 The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19193 @texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19194 @infoline Moebius ``mu''
19195 function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19196 distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19197 duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19198 the result is zero.
19199
19200 @node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19201 @section Probability Distribution Functions
19202
19203 @noindent
19204 The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19205 For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19206 density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19207 tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19208 tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19209 For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19210 from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19211 from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19212
19213 To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19214 function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19215 Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19216 lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19217 (``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19218 or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19219
19220 @kindex k B
19221 @kindex I k B
19222 @pindex calc-utpb
19223 @tindex utpb
19224 @tindex ltpb
19225 The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19226 binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19227 then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19228 probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19229 of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19230 trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19231 the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19232
19233 The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19234 form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19235 and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19236 @var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19237 the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19238 distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19239 order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19240 arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19241 the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19242 k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19243 recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19244
19245 @kindex k C
19246 @pindex calc-utpc
19247 @tindex utpc
19248 @ignore
19249 @mindex @idots
19250 @end ignore
19251 @kindex I k C
19252 @ignore
19253 @mindex @null
19254 @end ignore
19255 @tindex ltpc
19256 The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19257 @texline @math{\nu}
19258 @infoline @expr{v}
19259 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19260 correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19261
19262 @kindex k F
19263 @pindex calc-utpf
19264 @tindex utpf
19265 @ignore
19266 @mindex @idots
19267 @end ignore
19268 @kindex I k F
19269 @ignore
19270 @mindex @null
19271 @end ignore
19272 @tindex ltpf
19273 The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19274 various statistical tests. The parameters
19275 @texline @math{\nu_1}
19276 @infoline @expr{v1}
19277 and
19278 @texline @math{\nu_2}
19279 @infoline @expr{v2}
19280 are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19281 respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19282
19283 @kindex k N
19284 @pindex calc-utpn
19285 @tindex utpn
19286 @ignore
19287 @mindex @idots
19288 @end ignore
19289 @kindex I k N
19290 @ignore
19291 @mindex @null
19292 @end ignore
19293 @tindex ltpn
19294 The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19295 with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19296 @texline @math{\sigma}.
19297 @infoline @expr{s}.
19298 It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19299 would exceed @expr{x}.
19300
19301 @kindex k P
19302 @pindex calc-utpp
19303 @tindex utpp
19304 @ignore
19305 @mindex @idots
19306 @end ignore
19307 @kindex I k P
19308 @ignore
19309 @mindex @null
19310 @end ignore
19311 @tindex ltpp
19312 The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19313 mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19314 Poisson random events will occur.
19315
19316 @kindex k T
19317 @pindex calc-ltpt
19318 @tindex utpt
19319 @ignore
19320 @mindex @idots
19321 @end ignore
19322 @kindex I k T
19323 @ignore
19324 @mindex @null
19325 @end ignore
19326 @tindex ltpt
19327 The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19328 with
19329 @texline @math{\nu}
19330 @infoline @expr{v}
19331 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19332 t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19333 (Note: This computes the distribution function
19334 @texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19335 @infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19336 where
19337 @texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19338 @infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19339 and
19340 @texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19341 @infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19342 The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19343 returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19344
19345 While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19346 functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19347 Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19348 to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19349 @xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19350
19351 @node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19352 @chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19353
19354 @noindent
19355 Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19356 (For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19357 The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19358 apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19359 has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19360
19361 Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19362 Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19363 (Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19364 three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19365 vector of matrices, and so on.)
19366
19367 @menu
19368 * Packing and Unpacking::
19369 * Building Vectors::
19370 * Extracting Elements::
19371 * Manipulating Vectors::
19372 * Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19373 * Set Operations::
19374 * Statistical Operations::
19375 * Reducing and Mapping::
19376 * Vector and Matrix Formats::
19377 @end menu
19378
19379 @node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19380 @section Packing and Unpacking
19381
19382 @noindent
19383 Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19384 composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19385 described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19386 vectors.
19387
19388 @kindex v p
19389 @kindex V p
19390 @pindex calc-pack
19391 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19392 elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19393 form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19394 object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19395 If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19396 length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19397 five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19398 elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19399
19400 The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19401 vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19402 the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19403 then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19404
19405 Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19406
19407 @table @cite
19408 @item -1
19409 Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19410 @kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19411 @expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19412 number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19413 i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19414 will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19415 other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19416 components are not suitable.)
19417
19418 @item -2
19419 Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19420 The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19421 in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19422 mode.
19423
19424 @item -3
19425 Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19426 two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19427 integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19428 number.
19429
19430 @item -4
19431 Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19432 may be real numbers or formulas.
19433
19434 @item -5
19435 Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19436 must be real numbers.
19437
19438 @item -6
19439 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19440 The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19441
19442 @item -7
19443 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19444
19445 @item -8
19446 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19447
19448 @item -9
19449 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19450
19451 @item -10
19452 Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19453
19454 @item -11
19455 Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19456 The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19457 integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19458 times ten to the power of the exponent.
19459
19460 @item -12
19461 This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19462 When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19463 is desired.
19464
19465 @item -13
19466 A real number is converted into a date form.
19467
19468 @item -14
19469 Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19470
19471 @item -15
19472 Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19473 @end table
19474
19475 With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19476 of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19477 length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19478 elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19479 other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19480 element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19481 could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19482 into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19483 a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19484 numbers modulo @var{M}.
19485
19486 If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19487 the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19488 be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19489 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19490 enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19491
19492 If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19493 matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19494 which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19495 @samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19496 returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19497
19498 If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19499 packing are done at that level as described above. For
19500 example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19501 @texline @math{2\times3}
19502 @infoline 2x3
19503 matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19504 Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19505 error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19506
19507 @ignore
19508 @starindex
19509 @end ignore
19510 @tindex pack
19511 There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19512 @samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19513 packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19514 is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19515 to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19516 yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19517 left in symbolic form if the packing mode is invalid, or if the
19518 number of data items does not match the number of items required
19519 by the mode.
19520
19521 @kindex v u
19522 @kindex V u
19523 @pindex calc-unpack
19524 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19525 number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19526 ``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19527 objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19528 at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19529 each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19530
19531 You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19532 to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19533 negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19534 will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19535 For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19536 the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19537 @samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19538
19539 Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19540 not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19541 @kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19542 when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19543 and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19544 and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19545 number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19546 is not a composite object.
19547
19548 Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19549 an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19550 (except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19551 Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19552 and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19553 is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19554 the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19555 to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19556
19557 Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19558 A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19559 except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19560 a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19561 Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19562 original object.
19563
19564 A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19565 re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19566 to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19567 unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19568
19569 @ignore
19570 @starindex
19571 @end ignore
19572 @tindex unpack
19573 There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19574 The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19575 @var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19576 a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19577 integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19578 returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19579
19580 @ignore
19581 @starindex
19582 @end ignore
19583 @tindex unpackt
19584 The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19585 of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19586 two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19587 @samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19588 and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19589 The identity for re-building the original object is
19590 @samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19591 @code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19592 name and a vector of arguments.)
19593
19594 @cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19595 Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19596 of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19597 number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19598
19599 @node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19600 @section Building Vectors
19601
19602 @noindent
19603 Vectors and matrices can be added,
19604 subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19605
19606 @kindex |
19607 @pindex calc-concat
19608 @ignore
19609 @mindex @null
19610 @end ignore
19611 @tindex |
19612 The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) [@code{vconcat}] command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19613 into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19614 will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19615 are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19616 rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19617 of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19618
19619 If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19620 like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19621 produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19622 matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19623 one-row matrix.
19624
19625 @kindex H |
19626 @tindex append
19627 The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19628 two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19629 Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19630 argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19631 See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19632
19633 @kindex I |
19634 @kindex H I |
19635 The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19636 two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19637 to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19638
19639 @kindex v d
19640 @kindex V d
19641 @pindex calc-diag
19642 @tindex diag
19643 The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19644 square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19645 and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19646 vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19647 prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19648 the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19649 the prefix argument is required.
19650
19651 To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19652 @texline @math{3\times3}
19653 @infoline 3x3
19654 matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19655 matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19656 alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19657
19658 @kindex v i
19659 @kindex V i
19660 @pindex calc-ident
19661 @tindex idn
19662 The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19663 matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19664 where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19665 this command prompts for one.
19666
19667 In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19668 except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19669 If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19670 identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19671 such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19672 whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19673 matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19674 argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19675 Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19676 identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19677 dimensions.
19678
19679 @kindex v x
19680 @kindex V x
19681 @pindex calc-index
19682 @tindex index
19683 The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19684 of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19685 prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19686 prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19687 is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19688
19689 With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19690 three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19691 @var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19692 by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19693 is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19694 floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19695 of numbers or formulas.
19696
19697 When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19698 different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19699 sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19700 @samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19701 @samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19702 is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19703
19704 @kindex v b
19705 @kindex V b
19706 @pindex calc-build-vector
19707 @tindex cvec
19708 The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19709 vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19710 is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19711 can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19712 (Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19713 to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19714
19715 @kindex v h
19716 @kindex V h
19717 @kindex I v h
19718 @kindex I V h
19719 @pindex calc-head
19720 @pindex calc-tail
19721 @tindex head
19722 @tindex tail
19723 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19724 element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19725 function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19726 cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19727
19728 @kindex v k
19729 @kindex V k
19730 @pindex calc-cons
19731 @tindex cons
19732 The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19733 and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19734 @var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19735 if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19736 whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19737
19738 @kindex H v h
19739 @kindex H V h
19740 @tindex rhead
19741 @ignore
19742 @mindex @idots
19743 @end ignore
19744 @kindex H I v h
19745 @kindex H I V h
19746 @ignore
19747 @mindex @null
19748 @end ignore
19749 @kindex H v k
19750 @kindex H V k
19751 @ignore
19752 @mindex @null
19753 @end ignore
19754 @tindex rtail
19755 @ignore
19756 @mindex @null
19757 @end ignore
19758 @tindex rcons
19759 Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19760 @code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19761 the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19762 representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19763 @samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19764 Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19765 @samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19766
19767 @node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19768 @section Extracting Vector Elements
19769
19770 @noindent
19771 @kindex v r
19772 @kindex V r
19773 @pindex calc-mrow
19774 @tindex mrow
19775 The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19776 the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19777 the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19778 prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19779 The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19780 form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19781
19782 @cindex Permutations, applying
19783 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19784 the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19785 from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19786 integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19787 input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19788 This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19789
19790 With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19791 it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19792 submatrix is returned.
19793
19794 @cindex Subscript notation
19795 @kindex a _
19796 @pindex calc-subscript
19797 @tindex subscr
19798 @tindex _
19799 Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19800 Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19801 Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19802 @expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19803 (@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19804 access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19805 The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19806 formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19807 ``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19808 purely as an algebraic notation.)
19809
19810 @tindex mrrow
19811 Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19812 element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19813 @kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19814 replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19815 In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19816
19817 @tindex getdiag
19818 Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19819 of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19820 function is called @code{getdiag}.
19821
19822 @kindex v c
19823 @kindex V c
19824 @pindex calc-mcol
19825 @tindex mcol
19826 @tindex mrcol
19827 The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19828 the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19829 it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19830 index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19831 matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19832 retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19833
19834 To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19835 extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19836 from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19837 use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19838 of matrix @expr{m}.
19839
19840 @kindex v s
19841 @kindex V s
19842 @pindex calc-subvector
19843 @tindex subvec
19844 The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19845 a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19846 index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19847 position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19848 to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19849 range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19850 the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19851 @samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19852
19853 If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19854 interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19855 @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19856 the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19857 is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19858 end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19859 has this effect when used as the ending index.
19860
19861 @kindex I v s
19862 @kindex I V s
19863 @tindex rsubvec
19864 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19865 from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19866 normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19867 produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19868 @code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19869
19870 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19871 vectors one element at a time.
19872
19873 @node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
19874 @section Manipulating Vectors
19875
19876 @noindent
19877 @kindex v l
19878 @kindex V l
19879 @pindex calc-vlength
19880 @tindex vlen
19881 The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
19882 length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
19883 Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
19884 command.
19885
19886 @kindex H v l
19887 @kindex H V l
19888 @tindex mdims
19889 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
19890 of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
19891 example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
19892 its argument is a
19893 @texline @math{2\times3}
19894 @infoline 2x3
19895 matrix.
19896
19897 @kindex v f
19898 @kindex V f
19899 @pindex calc-vector-find
19900 @tindex find
19901 The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
19902 along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
19903 is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
19904 If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
19905 Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
19906 allows you to select any starting index for the search.
19907
19908 @kindex v a
19909 @kindex V a
19910 @pindex calc-arrange-vector
19911 @tindex arrange
19912 @cindex Arranging a matrix
19913 @cindex Reshaping a matrix
19914 @cindex Flattening a matrix
19915 The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
19916 rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
19917 numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
19918 provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
19919 The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
19920 plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
19921 then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
19922 If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
19923 in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
19924 suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
19925 @samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
19926 @samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
19927 @texline @math{1\times4}
19928 @infoline 1x4
19929 matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
19930 @texline @math{4\times1}
19931 @infoline 4x1
19932 matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
19933 @texline @math{2\times2}
19934 @infoline 2x2
19935 matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
19936 matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
19937 @samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
19938
19939 @cindex Sorting data
19940 @kindex v S
19941 @kindex V S
19942 @kindex I v S
19943 @kindex I V S
19944 @pindex calc-sort
19945 @tindex sort
19946 @tindex rsort
19947 The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
19948 a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
19949 constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
19950 kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
19951 come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
19952 to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
19953 one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
19954 unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
19955 are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
19956 (@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
19957 alphabetical order by this command.
19958
19959 The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
19960
19961 @cindex Permutation, inverse of
19962 @cindex Inverse of permutation
19963 @cindex Index tables
19964 @cindex Rank tables
19965 @kindex v G
19966 @kindex V G
19967 @kindex I v G
19968 @kindex I V G
19969 @pindex calc-grade
19970 @tindex grade
19971 @tindex rgrade
19972 The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
19973 produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
19974 input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
19975 A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
19976 each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
19977 matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
19978 grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
19979 with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
19980 is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
19981 be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
19982 a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
19983 vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
19984 table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
19985
19986 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
19987 sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
19988 use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
19989 will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
19990 to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
19991 but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
19992 example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
19993 you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
19994 are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
19995 by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
19996 phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
19997
19998 @cindex Histograms
19999 @kindex v H
20000 @kindex V H
20001 @pindex calc-histogram
20002 @ignore
20003 @mindex histo@idots
20004 @end ignore
20005 @tindex histogram
20006 The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
20007 histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
20008 integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
20009 bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
20010 command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
20011 each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
20012 are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
20013 range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
20014 that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
20015 input vector.)
20016
20017 If no prefix is given, then you will be prompted for a vector which
20018 will be used to determine the bins. (If a positive integer is given at
20019 this prompt, it will be still treated as if it were given as a
20020 prefix.) Each bin will consist of the interval of numbers closest to
20021 the corresponding number of this new vector; if the vector
20022 @expr{[a, b, c, ...]} is entered at the prompt, the bins will be
20023 @expr{(-inf, (a+b)/2]}, @expr{((a+b)/2, (b+c)/2]}, etc. The result of
20024 this command will be a vector counting how many elements of the
20025 original vector are in each bin.
20026
20027 The result will then be a vector with the same length as this new vector;
20028 each element of the new vector will be replaced by the number of
20029 elements of the original vector which are closest to it.
20030
20031 @kindex H v H
20032 @kindex H V H
20033 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
20034 The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
20035 vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
20036 of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
20037 the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
20038 vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
20039
20040 @kindex v t
20041 @kindex V t
20042 @pindex calc-transpose
20043 @tindex trn
20044 The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
20045 the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
20046 is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
20047 a one-column matrix.
20048
20049 @kindex v v
20050 @kindex V v
20051 @pindex calc-reverse-vector
20052 @tindex rev
20053 The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{rev}] command reverses
20054 a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
20055 (To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
20056 principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
20057 a matrix.)
20058
20059 @kindex v m
20060 @kindex V m
20061 @pindex calc-mask-vector
20062 @tindex vmask
20063 The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
20064 one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
20065 is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
20066 the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
20067 the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
20068 to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
20069 @samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
20070 @xref{Logical Operations}.
20071
20072 @kindex v e
20073 @kindex V e
20074 @pindex calc-expand-vector
20075 @tindex vexp
20076 The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
20077 expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
20078 vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
20079 by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
20080 vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
20081 target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
20082 vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
20083 unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
20084 produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
20085
20086 @kindex H v e
20087 @kindex H V e
20088 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
20089 top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
20090 second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
20091 zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
20092 @samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
20093 then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
20094 interleave two vectors according to the mask:
20095 @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
20096 @samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
20097
20098 Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
20099 with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
20100 You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
20101 operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
20102 the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
20103 masking using vectors.
20104
20105 @node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
20106 @section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
20107
20108 @noindent
20109 Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
20110 for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
20111 the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
20112 matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
20113 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
20114
20115 The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
20116 vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
20117 @code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
20118 @code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
20119
20120 @kindex v J
20121 @kindex V J
20122 @pindex calc-conj-transpose
20123 @tindex ctrn
20124 The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
20125 the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
20126
20127 @ignore
20128 @mindex A
20129 @end ignore
20130 @kindex A (vectors)
20131 @pindex calc-abs (vectors)
20132 @ignore
20133 @mindex abs
20134 @end ignore
20135 @tindex abs (vectors)
20136 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
20137 Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
20138 root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
20139 elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
20140 a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
20141 from that point to the origin.
20142
20143 @kindex v n
20144 @kindex V n
20145 @pindex calc-rnorm
20146 @tindex rnorm
20147 The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes the
20148 infinity-norm of a vector, or the row norm of a matrix. For a plain
20149 vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements. For
20150 a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums, i.e., of
20151 the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the various rows.
20152
20153 @kindex v N
20154 @kindex V N
20155 @pindex calc-cnorm
20156 @tindex cnorm
20157 The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
20158 the one-norm of a vector, or column norm of a matrix. For a plain
20159 vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20160 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20161 General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
20162 not provided. However, the 2-norm (or Frobenius norm) is provided for
20163 vectors by the @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) command.
20164
20165 @kindex v C
20166 @kindex V C
20167 @pindex calc-cross
20168 @tindex cross
20169 The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20170 right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20171 exactly three elements.
20172
20173 @ignore
20174 @mindex &
20175 @end ignore
20176 @kindex & (matrices)
20177 @pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20178 @ignore
20179 @mindex inv
20180 @end ignore
20181 @tindex inv (matrices)
20182 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20183 inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20184 operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20185 that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20186 computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20187 quickly in the future.
20188
20189 If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20190 command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20191 @samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20192 by a matrix.
20193
20194 @kindex v D
20195 @kindex V D
20196 @pindex calc-mdet
20197 @tindex det
20198 The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20199 determinant of a square matrix.
20200
20201 @kindex v L
20202 @kindex V L
20203 @pindex calc-mlud
20204 @tindex lud
20205 The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20206 LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20207 which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20208 The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20209 algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20210 and the third is upper-triangular.
20211
20212 @kindex v T
20213 @kindex V T
20214 @pindex calc-mtrace
20215 @tindex tr
20216 The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20217 trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20218 elements of the matrix.
20219
20220 @kindex v K
20221 @kindex V K
20222 @pindex calc-kron
20223 @tindex kron
20224 The @kbd{V K} (@code{calc-kron}) [@code{kron}] command computes
20225 the Kronecker product of two matrices.
20226
20227 @node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20228 @section Set Operations using Vectors
20229
20230 @noindent
20231 @cindex Sets, as vectors
20232 Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20233 objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20234 only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20235 sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20236 such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20237 equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20238 the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20239 are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20240 attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20241 from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20242 the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20243 expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20244
20245 If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20246 real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20247 of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20248 numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20249 there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20250 all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20251
20252 If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20253 @var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20254 The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20255 single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20256
20257 @xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20258 a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20259 is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20260
20261 @kindex v +
20262 @kindex V +
20263 @pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20264 @tindex rdup
20265 The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20266 converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20267 the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20268 @kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20269 reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20270 necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20271 other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20272 them.
20273
20274 @kindex v V
20275 @kindex V V
20276 @pindex calc-set-union
20277 @tindex vunion
20278 The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20279 the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20280 only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20281 accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20282 then using @kbd{V +}.)
20283
20284 @kindex v ^
20285 @kindex V ^
20286 @pindex calc-set-intersect
20287 @tindex vint
20288 The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20289 the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20290 and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20291 sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20292 will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20293 and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20294 notation for set
20295 @texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20296 @infoline union
20297 and
20298 @texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20299 @infoline intersection.
20300
20301 @kindex v -
20302 @kindex V -
20303 @pindex calc-set-difference
20304 @tindex vdiff
20305 The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20306 the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20307 @expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20308 Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20309 @samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20310 as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20311 all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20312 Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20313 your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20314 enough to express in a few intervals).
20315
20316 @kindex v X
20317 @kindex V X
20318 @pindex calc-set-xor
20319 @tindex vxor
20320 The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20321 the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20322 An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20323 if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20324 occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20325
20326 @kindex v ~
20327 @kindex V ~
20328 @pindex calc-set-complement
20329 @tindex vcompl
20330 The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20331 computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20332 Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20333 For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20334 @samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20335
20336 @kindex v F
20337 @kindex V F
20338 @pindex calc-set-floor
20339 @tindex vfloor
20340 The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20341 reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20342 and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20343 intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20344 integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20345 complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20346 the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20347 @kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20348
20349 @kindex v E
20350 @kindex V E
20351 @pindex calc-set-enumerate
20352 @tindex venum
20353 The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20354 converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20355 the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20356 the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20357 do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20358
20359 @kindex v :
20360 @kindex V :
20361 @pindex calc-set-span
20362 @tindex vspan
20363 The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20364 set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20365 The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20366 limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20367 returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20368
20369 @kindex v #
20370 @kindex V #
20371 @pindex calc-set-cardinality
20372 @tindex vcard
20373 The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20374 the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20375 that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20376 more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20377
20378 @cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20379 Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20380 cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20381 in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20382 particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20383 @xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20384 binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20385 direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20386 @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20387 @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20388 respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20389 convenient to you.
20390
20391 @kindex b p
20392 @kindex b u
20393 @pindex calc-pack-bits
20394 @pindex calc-unpack-bits
20395 @tindex vpack
20396 @tindex vunpack
20397 The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20398 converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20399 in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20400 returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20401 it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20402 Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20403 values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20404 (binary) prefix key.
20405
20406 The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20407 converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20408 a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20409 the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20410 not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20411 set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20412 that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20413 representation
20414 @texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20415 @infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20416
20417 @node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20418 @section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20419
20420 @noindent
20421 @cindex Statistical functions
20422 The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20423 various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20424 references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20425 @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20426 and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20427 Vetterling.
20428
20429 The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20430 a shifted letter or other character.
20431
20432 @xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20433 (@code{calc-histogram}).
20434
20435 @xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20436 least-squares fits to statistical data.
20437
20438 @xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20439 probability distribution functions.
20440
20441 @menu
20442 * Single-Variable Statistics::
20443 * Paired-Sample Statistics::
20444 @end menu
20445
20446 @node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20447 @subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20448
20449 @noindent
20450 These functions do various statistical computations on single
20451 vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20452 @var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20453 vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20454 vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20455 @kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20456 is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20457
20458 If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20459 variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20460 has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20461 the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20462
20463 These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20464 are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20465 a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20466 arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20467 of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20468 not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20469 error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20470
20471 Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20472 or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20473 normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20474 by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20475 the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20476 particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20477 distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20478 An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20479 distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20480 @samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20481
20482 @kindex u #
20483 @pindex calc-vector-count
20484 @tindex vcount
20485 The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20486 computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20487 For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20488 If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20489 simply computes the length of the vector.
20490
20491 @kindex u +
20492 @kindex u *
20493 @pindex calc-vector-sum
20494 @pindex calc-vector-prod
20495 @tindex vsum
20496 @tindex vprod
20497 @cindex Summations (statistical)
20498 The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20499 computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20500 (@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20501 product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20502 these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20503 (@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20504
20505 @kindex u X
20506 @kindex u N
20507 @pindex calc-vector-max
20508 @pindex calc-vector-min
20509 @tindex vmax
20510 @tindex vmin
20511 The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20512 computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20513 (@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20514 If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20515 value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20516 described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20517 plus or minus infinity.
20518
20519 @kindex u M
20520 @pindex calc-vector-mean
20521 @tindex vmean
20522 @cindex Mean of data values
20523 The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20524 computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20525 If the inputs are error forms
20526 @texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20527 @infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20528 this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20529 @texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20530 @infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20531 @tex
20532 $$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20533 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20534 @end tex
20535 If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20536 values divided by the count of the values.
20537
20538 Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20539 error
20540 @texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20541 @infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20542 If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20543 plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20544 plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20545 above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20546 has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20547 weight is completely negligible.)
20548
20549 This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20550 intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @tfn{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20551 @expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20552 and maximum values of the interval.
20553
20554 @kindex I u M
20555 @pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20556 @tindex vmeane
20557 The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20558 command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20559 error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20560 the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20561 root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20562 of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20563 sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20564 @tex
20565 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20566 @end tex
20567 If the inputs are plain
20568 numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20569 divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20570 out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20571 then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20572 deviation.)
20573 @tex
20574 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20575 @end tex
20576
20577 @kindex H u M
20578 @pindex calc-vector-median
20579 @tindex vmedian
20580 @cindex Median of data values
20581 The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20582 command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20583 first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20584 value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20585 the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20586 The median function is different from the other functions in
20587 this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20588 variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20589 (Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20590 any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20591 ignored.
20592
20593 The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20594 (error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20595 the same as the mean.
20596
20597 @kindex H I u M
20598 @pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20599 @tindex vhmean
20600 @cindex Harmonic mean
20601 The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20602 command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20603 defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20604 of the values.
20605 @tex
20606 $$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20607 @end tex
20608
20609 @kindex u G
20610 @pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20611 @tindex vgmean
20612 @cindex Geometric mean
20613 The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20614 command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20615 is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20616 equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20617 of the data values.
20618 @tex
20619 $$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20620 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20621 @end tex
20622
20623 @kindex H u G
20624 @tindex agmean
20625 The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20626 mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20627 replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20628 mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20629 @tex
20630 $$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20631 @end tex
20632
20633 @cindex Root-mean-square
20634 Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20635 for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20636
20637 @kindex u S
20638 @pindex calc-vector-sdev
20639 @tindex vsdev
20640 @cindex Standard deviation
20641 @cindex Sample statistics
20642 The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20643 computes the standard
20644 @texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20645 @infoline deviation
20646 of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20647 as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20648 deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20649 the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20650 divided by @expr{N-1}.
20651 @tex
20652 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20653 @end tex
20654
20655 This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20656 of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20657 of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20658 limits, divided by
20659 @texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20660 @infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20661 The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20662 standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20663
20664 @kindex I u S
20665 @pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20666 @tindex vpsdev
20667 @cindex Population statistics
20668 The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20669 command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20670 It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20671 by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20672 deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20673 data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20674 is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20675 data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20676 only an estimate of the true mean.
20677 @tex
20678 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20679 @end tex
20680
20681 For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20682 exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20683 population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20684
20685 @kindex H u S
20686 @kindex H I u S
20687 @pindex calc-vector-variance
20688 @pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20689 @tindex vvar
20690 @tindex vpvar
20691 @cindex Variance of data values
20692 The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20693 @kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20694 commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20695 is the
20696 @texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20697 @infoline square
20698 of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20699 squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20700 (This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20701
20702 @ignore
20703 @starindex
20704 @end ignore
20705 @tindex vflat
20706 The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20707 arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20708 in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20709 returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20710
20711 @node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20712 @subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20713
20714 @noindent
20715 The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20716 vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20717 way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20718 prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20719 the stack, which must be an
20720 @texline @math{N\times2}
20721 @infoline Nx2
20722 matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20723 of actual vectors and matrices.
20724
20725 @kindex u C
20726 @pindex calc-vector-covariance
20727 @tindex vcov
20728 @cindex Covariance
20729 The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20730 computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20731 of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20732 differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20733 times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20734 and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20735 the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20736 with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20737 errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20738 are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20739 is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20740 input errors.
20741 @tex
20742 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20743 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20744 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20745 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20746 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20747 $$
20748 @end tex
20749
20750 @kindex I u C
20751 @pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20752 @tindex vpcov
20753 The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20754 command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20755 sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20756 instead of @expr{N-1}.
20757
20758 @kindex H u C
20759 @pindex calc-vector-correlation
20760 @tindex vcorr
20761 @cindex Correlation coefficient
20762 @cindex Linear correlation
20763 The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20764 command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20765 This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20766 product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20767 between sample or population statistics here.)
20768 @tex
20769 $$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20770 @end tex
20771
20772 @node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20773 @section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20774
20775 @noindent
20776 The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20777 elements of vectors.
20778
20779 @kindex v A
20780 @kindex V A
20781 @pindex calc-apply
20782 @tindex apply
20783 The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20784 [@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20785 For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20786 @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20787 Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20788 @samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20789 error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20790
20791 While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20792 @kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20793
20794 @menu
20795 * Specifying Operators::
20796 * Mapping::
20797 * Reducing::
20798 * Nesting and Fixed Points::
20799 * Generalized Products::
20800 @end menu
20801
20802 @node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20803 @subsection Specifying Operators
20804
20805 @noindent
20806 Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20807 corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20808 list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20809 sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20810 the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20811 uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20812 expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20813 element as its argument.)
20814
20815 You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20816 function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20817 have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20818 Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20819 defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20820 Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20821 can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20822 is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20823 the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20824 @kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20825 looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20826 if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20827 the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20828 if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20829 type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20830
20831 It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20832 formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20833 @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20834 You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20835 list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20836 order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20837 The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20838 this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20839 be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20840 way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20841
20842 Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20843 @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20844 has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20845 automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20846 may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20847 entry interacts with the stack.)
20848
20849 If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20850 the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20851 instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20852 then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20853 prompted for an argument list.
20854
20855 @cindex Nameless functions
20856 @cindex Generic functions
20857 A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20858 which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20859 argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20860 are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20861 placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20862 colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20863 Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20864 to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20865 Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20866 cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20867 can get it back later if you wish.
20868
20869 If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20870 (Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20871 that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20872 @samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20873 begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
20874
20875 You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
20876 the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
20877 argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
20878 argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
20879 omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
20880 so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
20881 which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
20882
20883 @cindex Lambda expressions
20884 @ignore
20885 @starindex
20886 @end ignore
20887 @tindex lambda
20888 The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
20889 (The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
20890 functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
20891 ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
20892 @code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
20893 used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
20894 to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
20895
20896 (Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
20897 are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
20898 will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
20899 called.)
20900
20901 @tindex add
20902 @tindex sub
20903 @ignore
20904 @mindex @idots
20905 @end ignore
20906 @tindex mul
20907 @ignore
20908 @mindex @null
20909 @end ignore
20910 @tindex div
20911 @ignore
20912 @mindex @null
20913 @end ignore
20914 @tindex pow
20915 @ignore
20916 @mindex @null
20917 @end ignore
20918 @tindex neg
20919 @ignore
20920 @mindex @null
20921 @end ignore
20922 @tindex mod
20923 @ignore
20924 @mindex @null
20925 @end ignore
20926 @tindex vconcat
20927 As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
20928 For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
20929 @samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
20930 and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
20931 or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
20932 written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
20933 @code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
20934 @code{vconcat}.
20935
20936 @ignore
20937 @starindex
20938 @end ignore
20939 @tindex call
20940 The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
20941 @samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
20942 in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
20943 like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
20944 function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
20945 as @samp{x + 2y}).
20946
20947 (Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
20948 a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
20949 @code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
20950 automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
20951 about it.)
20952
20953 @node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
20954 @subsection Mapping
20955
20956 @noindent
20957 @kindex v M
20958 @kindex V M
20959 @pindex calc-map
20960 @tindex map
20961 The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
20962 operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
20963 @code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
20964 elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
20965 the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
20966 pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
20967 is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
20968 @kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
20969 With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
20970 two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
20971 stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
20972 be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
20973
20974 If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
20975 across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
20976 @expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
20977 produce another
20978 @texline @math{3\times2}
20979 @infoline 3x2
20980 matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
20981
20982 @tindex mapr
20983 The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
20984 operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
20985 the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
20986 a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
20987 namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
20988 defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
20989 Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
20990 @kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
20991 of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
20992
20993 Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
20994 happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
20995 want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
20996 their individual elements.
20997
20998 @tindex mapc
20999 The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
21000 transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
21001 matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
21002 values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
21003 and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
21004 @expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
21005
21006 (The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
21007 and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
21008 operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
21009 to type after @kbd{V M}.)
21010
21011 The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
21012 not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
21013 effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
21014 plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
21015 matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
21016 a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
21017
21018 If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
21019 rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
21020 arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
21021 column.
21022
21023 Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
21024 to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
21025 to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
21026 row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
21027 @kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
21028 otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
21029 you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
21030 a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
21031 @kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
21032 mapped over the elements of each row.)
21033
21034 @tindex mapa
21035 @tindex mapd
21036 Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
21037 that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
21038 @kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
21039 functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
21040 Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
21041 set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
21042 it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
21043 mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
21044
21045 @xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
21046 @kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
21047 @xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
21048 variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
21049
21050 @node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
21051 @subsection Reducing
21052
21053 @noindent
21054 @kindex v R
21055 @kindex V R
21056 @pindex calc-reduce
21057 @tindex reduce
21058 The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
21059 binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
21060 a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
21061 example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
21062 of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
21063 the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
21064 and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
21065 produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
21066
21067 @kindex I v R
21068 @kindex I V R
21069 @tindex rreduce
21070 The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
21071 that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
21072 @kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
21073 but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
21074 or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
21075 in power series expansions.
21076
21077 @kindex v U
21078 @kindex V U
21079 @tindex accum
21080 The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
21081 accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
21082 operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
21083 a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
21084 the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
21085 @samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
21086
21087 @kindex I v U
21088 @kindex I V U
21089 @tindex raccum
21090 The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
21091 For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
21092 vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
21093
21094 @tindex reducea
21095 @tindex rreducea
21096 @tindex reduced
21097 @tindex rreduced
21098 As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
21099 example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
21100 compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
21101 @kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
21102 command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
21103 as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
21104 matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
21105 [@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
21106 b + e, c + f]}.
21107
21108 @tindex reducer
21109 @tindex rreducer
21110 There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
21111 useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
21112 the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
21113 matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
21114 row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
21115 would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
21116 while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
21117
21118 These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
21119 but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
21120
21121 @tindex reducec
21122 @tindex rreducec
21123 The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
21124 supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
21125
21126 The commands @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are equivalent to typing
21127 @kbd{C-x * r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
21128 @kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
21129 rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
21130
21131 @node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
21132 @subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
21133
21134 @noindent
21135 @kindex H v R
21136 @kindex H V R
21137 @tindex nest
21138 The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
21139 argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
21140 the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
21141 function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
21142 is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
21143 negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
21144 example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
21145
21146 @kindex H v U
21147 @kindex H V U
21148 @tindex anest
21149 The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
21150 @code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
21151 @samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
21152 @samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
21153 form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
21154
21155 @kindex H I v R
21156 @kindex H I V R
21157 @tindex fixp
21158 @cindex Fixed points
21159 The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
21160 that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
21161 applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
21162 no longer changes.
21163
21164 @kindex H I v U
21165 @kindex H I V U
21166 @tindex afixp
21167 The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
21168 The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
21169 the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
21170 by @code{fixp}.
21171
21172 For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21173 @samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
21174 1.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21175 version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
21176 0.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21177 to converge to 0.739085.)
21178
21179 Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21180 to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21181 initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21182 function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21183 and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
21184 2.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21185 command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21186
21187 These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21188 the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21189 current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21190 imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21191 @samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21192 applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21193 It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21194 if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21195
21196 The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21197 and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21198 and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21199 default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21200 specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21201 formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21202 between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21203 (This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21204 exactly equal.)
21205
21206 Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21207 computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21208 stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21209 when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21210
21211 @node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21212 @subsection Generalized Products
21213
21214 @kindex v O
21215 @kindex V O
21216 @pindex calc-outer-product
21217 @tindex outer
21218 The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21219 a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21220 vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21221 and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21222 @samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21223 the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21224 of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21225
21226 @kindex v I
21227 @kindex V I
21228 @pindex calc-inner-product
21229 @tindex inner
21230 The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21231 the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21232 ``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21233 actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21234 respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21235 @var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21236 multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21237 column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21238 operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21239 vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21240 generalized dot product.
21241
21242 Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21243 you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21244 use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21245 first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21246 and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21247
21248 @node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21249 @section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21250
21251 @noindent
21252 Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21253 instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21254 particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21255 in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21256 influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21257 @pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21258
21259 @kindex v <
21260 @kindex V <
21261 @pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21262 @kindex v =
21263 @kindex V =
21264 @pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21265 @kindex v >
21266 @kindex V >
21267 @pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21268 The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21269 (@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21270 (@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21271 are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21272
21273 @kindex v [
21274 @kindex V [
21275 @pindex calc-vector-brackets
21276 @kindex v @{
21277 @kindex V @{
21278 @pindex calc-vector-braces
21279 @kindex v (
21280 @kindex V (
21281 @pindex calc-vector-parens
21282 The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21283 brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21284 and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21285 (@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21286 respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21287 be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21288 Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21289 @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21290 display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21291 and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21292
21293 @kindex V ]
21294 @kindex v ]
21295 @kindex V )
21296 @kindex v )
21297 @kindex V @}
21298 @kindex v @}
21299 @pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21300 The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21301 ``big'' style display of matrices, for matrices which have more than
21302 one row. It prompts for a string of code letters; currently
21303 implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables brackets on each row
21304 of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer brackets in opposite
21305 corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which enables commas or
21306 semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last. The default format
21307 is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format was fixed at @samp{ROC}.)
21308 Here are some example matrices:
21309
21310 @example
21311 @group
21312 [ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21313 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21314 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21315
21316 RO ROC
21317
21318 @end group
21319 @end example
21320 @noindent
21321 @example
21322 @group
21323 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21324 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21325 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21326
21327 O OC
21328
21329 @end group
21330 @end example
21331 @noindent
21332 @example
21333 @group
21334 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21335 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21336 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21337
21338 R @r{blank}
21339 @end group
21340 @end example
21341
21342 @noindent
21343 Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21344 @samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21345 the others are useful for display only.
21346
21347 @kindex v ,
21348 @kindex V ,
21349 @pindex calc-vector-commas
21350 The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21351 off in vector and matrix display.
21352
21353 In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21354 turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21355 otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21356 of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21357 variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21358 case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21359 (to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21360 ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21361 give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21362
21363 @kindex v .
21364 @kindex V .
21365 @pindex calc-full-vectors
21366 The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21367 display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21368 or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21369 be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21370 three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21371 When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21372 improve Calc's display speed.
21373
21374 @kindex t .
21375 @pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21376 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21377 similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21378 this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21379 more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21380 Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21381 unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21382 large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21383 that involve the trail.
21384
21385 @kindex v /
21386 @kindex V /
21387 @pindex calc-break-vectors
21388 The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21389 vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21390 row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21391 line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21392 displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21393 vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21394
21395 @node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21396 @chapter Algebra
21397
21398 @noindent
21399 This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21400 algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21401 mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21402 commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21403 described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21404 is discussed.
21405
21406 The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21407 commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21408 for anything else'') prefix.
21409
21410 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21411 using regular Emacs editing commands.
21412
21413 When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21414 modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21415 or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21416 Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21417 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21418 of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21419 @xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21420
21421 @menu
21422 * Selecting Subformulas::
21423 * Algebraic Manipulation::
21424 * Simplifying Formulas::
21425 * Polynomials::
21426 * Calculus::
21427 * Solving Equations::
21428 * Numerical Solutions::
21429 * Curve Fitting::
21430 * Summations::
21431 * Logical Operations::
21432 * Rewrite Rules::
21433 @end menu
21434
21435 @node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21436 @section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21437
21438 @noindent
21439 @cindex Selections
21440 @cindex Sub-formulas
21441 @cindex Parts of formulas
21442 When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21443 manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21444 whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21445 the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21446 entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21447 surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21448
21449 One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21450 on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21451 ``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21452
21453 @menu
21454 * Making Selections::
21455 * Changing Selections::
21456 * Displaying Selections::
21457 * Operating on Selections::
21458 * Rearranging with Selections::
21459 @end menu
21460
21461 @node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21462 @subsection Making Selections
21463
21464 @noindent
21465 @kindex j s
21466 @pindex calc-select-here
21467 To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21468 sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21469 highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21470 character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21471 all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21472 display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21473 Suppose you enter the following formula:
21474
21475 @smallexample
21476 @group
21477 3 ___
21478 (a + b) + V c
21479 1: ---------------
21480 2 x + 1
21481 @end group
21482 @end smallexample
21483
21484 @noindent
21485 (by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21486 cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21487 to
21488
21489 @smallexample
21490 @group
21491 . ...
21492 .. . b. . . .
21493 1* ...............
21494 . . . .
21495 @end group
21496 @end smallexample
21497
21498 @noindent
21499 Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21500 to a dot. (If the customizable variable
21501 @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-nil, then the characters
21502 not part of the sub-formula are de-emphasized by using a less
21503 noticeable face instead of using dots. @pxref{Displaying Selections}.)
21504 The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21505 the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21506 obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21507 the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21508 may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21509
21510 If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21511 the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21512
21513 @smallexample
21514 @group
21515 . ...
21516 (a + b) . . .
21517 1* ...............
21518 . . . .
21519 @end group
21520 @end smallexample
21521
21522 @noindent
21523 The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21524 formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21525 formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21526 would have had the same effect.
21527
21528 (Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21529 the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21530 in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21531 sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21532
21533 If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21534 expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21535 the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21536 @samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21537 and so on.
21538
21539 If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21540 numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21541
21542 If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21543 (i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21544 formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21545 on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21546 cursor on any stack entry.
21547
21548 @kindex j a
21549 @pindex calc-select-additional
21550 The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21551 current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21552 sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21553 press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21554 is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21555 select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21556
21557 @kindex j o
21558 @pindex calc-select-once
21559 The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21560 exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21561 last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21562 @kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21563 by the cursor.
21564
21565 (A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21566 such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21567 the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21568 commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21569
21570 @kindex j S
21571 @kindex j O
21572 @pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21573 @pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21574 The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21575 (@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21576 and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21577 has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21578 behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21579 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21580 used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21581 commands.
21582
21583 Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21584 @samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21585 If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21586 on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21587 entire four-term sum.
21588
21589 @kindex j b
21590 @pindex calc-break-selections
21591 The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21592 in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
21593 through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as
21594 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d} and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain
21595 obscure reasons, by default Calc treats multiplication as
21596 right-associative.) Once you have enabled @kbd{j b} mode, selecting
21597 with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would only select the @samp{a + b -
21598 c} portion, which makes sense when the deep structure of the sum is
21599 considered. There is no way to select the @samp{b - c + d} portion;
21600 although this might initially look like just as legitimate a sub-formula
21601 as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d
21602 U} command can be used to view the deep structure of any formula
21603 (@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
21604
21605 When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21606 generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21607 you get.
21608
21609 @kindex j u
21610 @pindex calc-unselect
21611 The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21612 that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21613 this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21614 unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21615 position.
21616
21617 @kindex j c
21618 @pindex calc-clear-selections
21619 The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21620 stack elements.
21621
21622 @node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21623 @subsection Changing Selections
21624
21625 @noindent
21626 @kindex j m
21627 @pindex calc-select-more
21628 Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21629 @w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21630 selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21631
21632 @smallexample
21633 @group
21634 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21635 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
21636 1* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21637 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21638 @end group
21639 @end smallexample
21640
21641 @noindent
21642 In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21643 the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21644 differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21645
21646 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21647 times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21648 with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21649 @kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21650 is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21651
21652 Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21653 cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21654 which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21655 is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21656
21657 @kindex j l
21658 @pindex calc-select-less
21659 The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21660 selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21661 immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21662 cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21663 current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21664
21665 @kindex j 1-9
21666 @pindex calc-select-part
21667 The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21668 select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21669 like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21670 rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21671 For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21672 @kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21673 @kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21674 these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21675
21676 If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21677 the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21678 the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21679 sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21680 @w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21681
21682 @kindex j n
21683 @kindex j p
21684 @pindex calc-select-next
21685 @pindex calc-select-previous
21686 The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21687 (@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21688 to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21689 if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21690 selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21691 even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21692 it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21693 same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21694 the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21695 @w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21696
21697 Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21698 sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21699 arguments to move several steps at a time.
21700
21701 It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21702 Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21703 organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21704 analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21705 @kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21706 (Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21707 The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21708 @kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21709 of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21710
21711 @node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21712 @subsection Displaying Selections
21713
21714 @noindent
21715 @kindex j d
21716 @pindex calc-show-selections
21717 @vindex calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
21718 @vindex calc-selected-face
21719 @vindex calc-nonselected-face
21720 The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21721 selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21722 illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21723 to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21724 by @samp{#} signs:
21725
21726 @smallexample
21727 @group
21728 3 ... # ___
21729 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
21730 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21731 . . . . 2 x + 1
21732 @end group
21733 @end smallexample
21734 If the customizable variable
21735 @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-nil, then the
21736 non-selected portion of the formula will be de-emphasized by using a
21737 less noticeable face (@code{calc-nonselected-face}) instead of dots
21738 and the selected sub-formula will be highlighted by using a more
21739 noticeable face (@code{calc-selected-face}) instead of @samp{#}
21740 signs. (@pxref{Customizing Calc}.)
21741
21742 @node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21743 @subsection Operating on Selections
21744
21745 @noindent
21746 Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21747 on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21748 instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21749 at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21750 given stack element.)
21751
21752 @kindex j e
21753 @pindex calc-enable-selections
21754 The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21755 effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21756 still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21757 This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21758 the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21759 reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21760
21761 To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21762 sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21763 stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21764 element.
21765
21766 To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21767 new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21768 the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21769 the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21770 portion to the top of the stack.
21771
21772 @smallexample
21773 @group
21774 3 ... ... ___
21775 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
21776 2* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21777 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21778
21779 3 3
21780 1: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21781 @end group
21782 @end smallexample
21783
21784 In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21785 enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21786 the complete, edited formula.
21787
21788 If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21789 selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21790
21791 @kindex j '
21792 @pindex calc-enter-selection
21793 The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21794 to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21795 entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21796 the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21797 the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21798 selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21799 the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21800 the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21801 do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21802
21803 @kindex j `
21804 @pindex calc-edit-selection
21805 The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21806 analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21807 selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21808 selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21809
21810 To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21811 the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21812 it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21813 deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21814
21815 @smallexample
21816 @group
21817 ###
21818 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
21819 1* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21820 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21821 @end group
21822 @end smallexample
21823
21824 In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21825 accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21826 resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21827 since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21828 and resimplifies.
21829
21830 If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21831 element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21832 an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21833
21834 @kindex j @key{DEL}
21835 @pindex calc-del-selection
21836 The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21837 @key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21838 @kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21839 indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21840 deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21841
21842 @kindex j @key{RET}
21843 @pindex calc-grab-selection
21844 (There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21845 command.)
21846
21847 Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21848 select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21849 denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21850 press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21851
21852 @smallexample
21853 @group
21854 .. . .. . .. . .. .
21855 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21856 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21857 V 4 - 2 x
21858 @end group
21859 @end smallexample
21860
21861 Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21862 example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21863 the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21864 shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21865 which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21866 this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21867 the command will abort with an error message.
21868
21869 Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21870 in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21871 of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21872 (@code{calc-change-sign}).
21873
21874 @smallexample
21875 @group
21876 .. . .. .
21877 1* .......... 1* ...........
21878 ......... ..........
21879 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
21880 @end group
21881 @end smallexample
21882
21883 Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
21884 normally have canceled out with the subtraction automatically, has
21885 not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
21886 selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
21887 any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
21888 to be simplified.
21889
21890 @smallexample
21891 @group
21892 17 y 17 y
21893 1: ----------- 1: ----------
21894 __________ _________
21895 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
21896 @end group
21897 @end smallexample
21898
21899 @node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21900 @subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
21901
21902 @noindent
21903 @kindex j R
21904 @pindex calc-commute-right
21905 The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
21906 sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
21907 selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
21908 rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
21909
21910 As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
21911 if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
21912 in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
21913 cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
21914
21915 @smallexample
21916 1: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
21917 @end smallexample
21918
21919 @noindent
21920 Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
21921 the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
21922 terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
21923 mathematical meaning of the formula.
21924
21925 The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
21926 of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
21927 In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
21928 course be drastically changed.
21929
21930 @smallexample
21931 1: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
21932
21933 1: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
21934 @end smallexample
21935
21936 @kindex j L
21937 @pindex calc-commute-left
21938 The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
21939 except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
21940
21941 With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
21942 term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
21943 term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
21944 With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
21945 selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
21946
21947 @kindex j D
21948 @pindex calc-sel-distribute
21949 The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
21950 sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
21951 law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
21952 selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
21953 products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
21954 transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
21955 where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
21956 to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
21957
21958 For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
21959 at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
21960 with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
21961 repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
21962 numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
21963 times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
21964
21965 @vindex DistribRules
21966 The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
21967 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
21968 the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
21969 these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
21970 displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
21971 to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
21972 or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
21973
21974 To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
21975 as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
21976 this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
21977 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
21978
21979 @kindex j M
21980 @pindex calc-sel-merge
21981 @vindex MergeRules
21982 The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
21983 of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
21984 @samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
21985 again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
21986 and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
21987 the relevant rules.
21988
21989 @kindex j C
21990 @pindex calc-sel-commute
21991 @vindex CommuteRules
21992 The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
21993 of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
21994 if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
21995 treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
21996 If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
21997 @samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
21998 result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
21999 will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
22000 in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
22001
22002 You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
22003 command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
22004 commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
22005 simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
22006 you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
22007 manipulations described in this section.
22008
22009 @kindex j N
22010 @pindex calc-sel-negate
22011 @vindex NegateRules
22012 The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
22013 term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
22014 formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
22015 @samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
22016 @samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
22017 regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
22018 term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
22019 of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
22020
22021 @kindex j &
22022 @pindex calc-sel-invert
22023 @vindex InvertRules
22024 The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
22025 except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
22026 given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
22027 @samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
22028
22029 @kindex j E
22030 @pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
22031 @vindex JumpRules
22032 The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
22033 selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
22034 @samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
22035 @samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
22036 term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
22037 relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
22038
22039 @kindex j I
22040 @kindex H j I
22041 @pindex calc-sel-isolate
22042 The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
22043 selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
22044 (@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
22045 Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
22046 When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
22047 It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
22048 as well as equations.
22049
22050 @kindex j *
22051 @kindex j /
22052 @pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
22053 @pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
22054 The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
22055 formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
22056 selected quotient or equation by that formula. It performs the
22057 default algebraic simplifications before re-forming the
22058 quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
22059 providing a prefix argument: @kbd{C-u j *}. There is also a @kbd{j /}
22060 (@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
22061 dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
22062
22063 If the selection is a quotient with numerator 1, then Calc's default
22064 simplifications would normally cancel the new factors. To prevent
22065 this, when the @kbd{j *} command is used on a selection whose numerator is
22066 1 or -1, the denominator is expanded at the top level using the
22067 distributive law (as if using the @kbd{C-u 1 a x} command). Suppose the
22068 formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (a + 1)} and you wish to multiplying the
22069 top and bottom by @samp{a - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
22070 normally change the result @samp{(a - 1) /(a + 1) (a - 1)} back
22071 to the original form by cancellation; when @kbd{j *} is used, Calc
22072 expands the denominator to @samp{a (a - 1) + a - 1} to prevent this.
22073
22074 If you wish the @kbd{j *} command to completely expand the denominator
22075 of a quotient you can call it with a zero prefix: @kbd{C-u 0 j *}. For
22076 example, if the formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, you may
22077 wish to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying
22078 the top and bottom by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. If you did this simply by using
22079 a simple @kbd{j *} command, you would get
22080 @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/ (sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1)}. Instead,
22081 you would probably want to use @kbd{C-u 0 j *}, which would expand the
22082 bottom and give you the desired result @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/(a-1)}. More
22083 generally, if @kbd{j *} is called with an argument of a positive
22084 integer @var{n}, then the denominator of the expression will be
22085 expanded @var{n} times (as if with the @kbd{C-u @var{n} a x} command).
22086
22087 If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
22088 accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
22089 is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
22090 of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
22091 for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
22092 negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
22093 will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
22094 message.
22095
22096 For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
22097 these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
22098 multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
22099 back by the formula.
22100
22101 @kindex j +
22102 @kindex j -
22103 @pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
22104 @pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
22105 The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
22106 (@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
22107 subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
22108 types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
22109 prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
22110 results.
22111
22112 @kindex j U
22113 @pindex calc-sel-unpack
22114 The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
22115 selected function call with its argument. For example, given
22116 @samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
22117 is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
22118 wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
22119 now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
22120
22121 @kindex j v
22122 @pindex calc-sel-evaluate
22123 The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
22124 basic simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
22125 These simplifications would normally be done automatically
22126 on all results, but may have been partially inhibited by
22127 previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
22128 by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
22129 version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
22130
22131 With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
22132 the default algebraic simplifications to the selected
22133 sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
22134 applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
22135 @xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
22136 it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
22137 Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
22138 sub-formula.
22139
22140 @kindex j "
22141 @pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
22142 The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
22143 (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
22144
22145 You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
22146 to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22147
22148 @node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
22149 @section Algebraic Manipulation
22150
22151 @noindent
22152 The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
22153 manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
22154 stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
22155 formula).
22156
22157 Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
22158 answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
22159 from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
22160 from the second-to-top stack level.
22161
22162 @kindex a v
22163 @pindex calc-alg-evaluate
22164 The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
22165 default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
22166 changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
22167 automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
22168 you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
22169 command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
22170
22171 It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
22172 but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
22173 Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
22174
22175 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
22176 using Calc's algebraic simplifications; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}.
22177 If you give a numeric prefix of 3 or more, it uses Extended
22178 Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
22179
22180 If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
22181 it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
22182 function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
22183 simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
22184 @samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
22185 @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
22186 in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
22187 10; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
22188 (@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
22189
22190 @tindex evalv
22191 @tindex evalvn
22192 The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
22193 the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
22194 disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
22195 to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
22196 arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
22197 the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
22198 it as a temporary different working precision.)
22199
22200 The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
22201 as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
22202 integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
22203 a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
22204 precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
22205 precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
22206 result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
22207 afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
22208 of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
22209 will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
22210 is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
22211 will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22212
22213 @kindex a "
22214 @pindex calc-expand-formula
22215 The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22216 into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22217 @samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22218 like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22219 and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22220 functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22221 created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22222 Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22223 distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22224 hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22225 affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22226 argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22227 various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22228 top-level function call.
22229
22230 @kindex a M
22231 @pindex calc-map-equation
22232 @tindex mapeq
22233 The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22234 a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22235 to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22236 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22237 @samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22238 @samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22239 With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22240 sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22241 respective sides of a new equation.
22242
22243 Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22244 produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22245 with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22246 @samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22247 If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22248 are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22249 match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22250 reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22251 combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the algebraic simplifications
22252 can reduce to @samp{2 < b}.
22253
22254 Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22255 or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22256 Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22257 @kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22258 though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22259
22260 @kindex H a M
22261 @tindex mapeqp
22262 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22263 mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22264 Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22265 (This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22266 fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22267
22268 @kindex I a M
22269 @tindex mapeqr
22270 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22271 the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22272 change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22273 working with small positive angles.
22274
22275 @kindex a b
22276 @pindex calc-substitute
22277 @tindex subst
22278 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22279 all occurrences
22280 of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22281 sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22282 in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22283 @samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22284 Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22285 the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22286 @samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22287 doing substitutions.
22288
22289 The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22290 one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22291 prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22292 then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22293 blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22294 and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22295 target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22296
22297 Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22298 associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22299 @samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22300 because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22301 structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22302 (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22303 a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22304 these limitations.
22305
22306 As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22307 Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22308 evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22309 you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22310 turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22311
22312 @node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22313 @section Simplifying Formulas
22314
22315 @noindent
22316 @kindex a s
22317 @kindex I a s
22318 @kindex H a s
22319 @pindex calc-simplify
22320 @tindex simplify
22321
22322 The sections below describe all the various kinds of
22323 simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22324 simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22325 they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22326 less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22327 must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22328 and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22329 @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22330
22331 @xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22332 simplification occurs automatically. Normally the algebraic
22333 simplifications described below occur. If you have turned on a
22334 simplification mode which does not do these algebraic simplifications,
22335 you can still apply them to a formula with the @kbd{a s}
22336 (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command.
22337
22338 There are some simplifications that, while sometimes useful, are never
22339 done automatically. For example, the @kbd{I} prefix can be given to
22340 @kbd{a s}; the @kbd{I a s} command will change any trigonometric
22341 function to the appropriate combination of @samp{sin}s and @samp{cos}s
22342 before simplifying. This can be useful in simplifying even mildly
22343 complicated trigonometric expressions. For example, while the algebraic
22344 simplifications can reduce @samp{sin(x) csc(x)} to @samp{1}, they will not
22345 simplify @samp{sin(x)^2 csc(x)}. The command @kbd{I a s} can be used to
22346 simplify this latter expression; it will transform @samp{sin(x)^2
22347 csc(x)} into @samp{sin(x)}. However, @kbd{I a s} will also perform
22348 some ``simplifications'' which may not be desired; for example, it
22349 will transform @samp{tan(x)^2} into @samp{sin(x)^2 / cos(x)^2}. The
22350 Hyperbolic prefix @kbd{H} can be used similarly; the @kbd{H a s} will
22351 replace any hyperbolic functions in the formula with the appropriate
22352 combinations of @samp{sinh}s and @samp{cosh}s before simplifying.
22353
22354
22355 @menu
22356 * Basic Simplifications::
22357 * Algebraic Simplifications::
22358 * Unsafe Simplifications::
22359 * Simplification of Units::
22360 @end menu
22361
22362 @node Basic Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22363 @subsection Basic Simplifications
22364
22365 @noindent
22366 @cindex Basic simplifications
22367 This section describes basic simplifications which Calc performs in many
22368 situations. For example, both binary simplifications and algebraic
22369 simplifications begin by performing these basic simplifications. You
22370 can type @kbd{m I} to restrict the simplifications done on the stack to
22371 these simplifications.
22372
22373 The most basic simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22374 For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)}
22375 is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22376 to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@tfn{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22377 range (@expr{@tfn{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@tfn{tan}(3,5)}),
22378 or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@tfn{f}(5)}), or if
22379 Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22380 (@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2)}).
22381
22382 Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22383 simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22384 simplified to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22385 itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22386 @code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22387 operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22388 operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22389 does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22390
22391 Most commands apply at least these basic simplifications to all
22392 arguments they take from the stack, perform a particular operation,
22393 then simplify the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the
22394 common special case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and
22395 @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}], the arguments are simply popped from the stack
22396 and collected into a suitable function call, which is then simplified
22397 (the arguments being simplified first as part of the process, as
22398 described above).
22399
22400 Even the basic set of simplifications are too numerous to describe
22401 completely here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22402 major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22403 nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22404 a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22405
22406 @tex
22407 \bigskip
22408 @end tex
22409
22410 As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22411 any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22412 will also be applied before any of the basic simplifications.
22413 @xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22414
22415 @tex
22416 \bigskip
22417 @end tex
22418
22419 And now, on with the basic simplifications:
22420
22421 Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22422 arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22423 more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22424 a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
22425 (by default) a right-associative form for products,
22426 @expr{a * (b * (c * d))}. Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are
22427 rearranged to left-associative form, though this rarely matters since
22428 Calc's algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of sums
22429 and products as much as possible. Sums and products in their proper
22430 associative form will be written without parentheses in the examples
22431 below.
22432
22433 Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22434 commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22435 special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22436 rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22437 see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22438 If you are using Basic Simplification mode, Calc assumes you have put
22439 the terms into the order you want and generally leaves that order alone,
22440 with the consequence that formulas like the above will only be
22441 simplified if you explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command.
22442 @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
22443
22444 Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22445 for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22446 is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22447 represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22448 ``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22449 @expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22450 negative-looking.
22451
22452 Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22453 @expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22454 negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22455 @expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22456 @expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22457 (This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22458 cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22459 simplifications.)
22460
22461 The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22462 @expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22463 a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22464 and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22465 @kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22466 using the distributive law.
22467
22468 The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22469 for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22470 is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22471 is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22472 sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22473 square of the number of terms; Calc omits potentially slow
22474 operations like this in basic simplification mode.
22475
22476 Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22477 A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22478 to @expr{-a}.
22479
22480 @tex
22481 \bigskip
22482 @end tex
22483
22484 The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22485 @expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22486 @expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22487 in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22488 is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22489 infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22490
22491 Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22492 where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22493 numbers.
22494
22495 Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22496 @expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22497
22498 The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22499 @expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22500 @expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22501 @expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22502 rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22503
22504 The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22505 terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22506 @texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22507 @infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22508 where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22509 or the implicit one-half of @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22510 @expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22511 if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22512 If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22513 @expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22514
22515 The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22516 power is changed to use division:
22517 @texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22518 @infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22519 goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22520 in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22521 case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22522
22523 Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22524 @expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22525
22526 @tex
22527 \bigskip
22528 @end tex
22529
22530 Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22531 The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22532 exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22533 and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22534 respectively.
22535
22536 The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22537 infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22538 @xref{Infinite Mode}.
22539
22540 The expression
22541 @texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22542 @infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22543 is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22544 power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22545 @texline @math{b^{-c}}
22546 @infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22547 for any power @expr{c}.
22548
22549 Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22550 @expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22551 goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22552 rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22553 @expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22554
22555 The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22556 @expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22557 Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22558 described for multiplication.
22559
22560 Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22561 numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22562 is canceled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22563 again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22564 to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22565
22566 Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22567 to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22568 to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22569
22570 @tex
22571 \bigskip
22572 @end tex
22573
22574 The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22575 in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22576 unless @expr{x} is a negative number, complex number or zero.
22577 If @expr{x} is negative, complex or @expr{0.0}, @expr{0^x} is an
22578 infinity or an unsimplified formula according to the current infinite
22579 mode. The expression @expr{0^0} is simplified to @expr{1}.
22580
22581 Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22582 are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22583 is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22584 real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22585 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22586 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22587 only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22588 evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22589 would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22590 (In other words,
22591 @texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22592 @infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22593 is safe to simplify, but
22594 @texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22595 @infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22596 is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22597 variables satisfy these requirements.
22598
22599 As a special case of this rule, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22600 @texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22601 @infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22602 only for even integers @expr{n}.
22603
22604 If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22605 @expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22606 simplified to @expr{@tfn{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22607
22608 Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22609 even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22610 for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22611
22612 Square roots @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22613 @texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22614 @infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22615 for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22616
22617 Also, note that
22618 @texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22619 @infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22620 is changed to
22621 @texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22622 @infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22623 but @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22624
22625 @tex
22626 \bigskip
22627 @end tex
22628
22629 Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22630 following rules: @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22631 is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22632 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + @tfn{idn}(b)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a + b)};
22633 @expr{-@tfn{idn}(a)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22634 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22635 if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22636 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22637 @code{idn}; and @expr{@tfn{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a^n)} where
22638 @expr{n} is an integer.
22639
22640 @tex
22641 \bigskip
22642 @end tex
22643
22644 The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22645 vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22646 @expr{@tfn{floor}(@tfn{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@tfn{round}(x)}.
22647 Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22648 and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22649 ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22650
22651 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}.
22652 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(@tfn{abs}(x))} changes to
22653 @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22654 @expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22655 (@pxref{Declarations}).
22656
22657 While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22658 imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22659 @expr{@tfn{arg}(@tfn{i})} and @expr{@tfn{arg}(-@tfn{i})} just for convenience.
22660
22661 The expression @expr{@tfn{conj}(@tfn{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22662 Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22663 @code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22664 provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22665 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22666 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a) - @tfn{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22667 and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22668
22669 Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22670 any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22671 for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The algebraic
22672 simplifications described in the next section do provide some
22673 simplifications for these functions, though.
22674
22675 One important simplification that does occur is that
22676 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)} is
22677 simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22678 stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22679 be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22680
22681 Among the logical functions, @tfn{!(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22682 @tfn{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22683 are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22684 and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22685 @expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22686 @expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22687
22688 Most other Calc functions have few if any basic simplifications
22689 defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22690 suitable numbers.
22691
22692 @node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Basic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22693 @subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22694
22695 @noindent
22696 @cindex Algebraic simplifications
22697 @kindex a s
22698 @kindex m A
22699 This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22700 the algebraic simplification mode, which is the default simplification
22701 mode. If you have switched to a different simplification mode, you can
22702 switch back with the @kbd{m A} command. Even in other simplification
22703 modes, the @kbd{a s} command will use these algebraic simplifications to
22704 simplify the formula.
22705
22706 There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22707 to be applied. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22708 but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22709 @samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22710 expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22711 the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22712 the original expression, the process repeats with the basic
22713 simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22714 then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22715
22716 @tex
22717 \bigskip
22718 @end tex
22719
22720 Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22721 end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22722 The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22723 from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22724 commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22725
22726 Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22727 @expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22728 adjacent terms, but Calc's algebraic simplifications compare all pairs
22729 of terms including non-adjacent ones.
22730
22731 @tex
22732 \bigskip
22733 @end tex
22734
22735 Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22736 law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22737 This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the basic
22738 simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22739 but the algebraic simplifications; it first rewrites the sum to
22740 @expr{x y + x y} which can then be recognized as a sum of identical
22741 terms.
22742
22743 The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22744 property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22745 come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22746 command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22747
22748 Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22749 turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22750 two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22751
22752 Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22753 terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22754 use for adjacent terms of products.
22755
22756 Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22757 taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22758 Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22759 A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22760 be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22761 one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22762 that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22763
22764 A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22765 a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22766 done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22767 is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22768 on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22769
22770 @tex
22771 \bigskip
22772 @end tex
22773
22774 Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22775 with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22776 the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22777 cancel @expr{x^2} from the top and bottom to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22778 (The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22779 as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22780 factor in the numerator and denominator, it is canceled out;
22781 for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22782
22783 Non-constant common factors are not found even by algebraic
22784 simplifications. To cancel the factor @expr{a} in
22785 @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first use @kbd{j M} on the product
22786 @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to @expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be
22787 simplified successfully.
22788
22789 @tex
22790 \bigskip
22791 @end tex
22792
22793 Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22794 to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22795 than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22796 will no longer occur. This is not done by the basic
22797 simplifications; in case someone (unwisely) wants to use the name
22798 @code{i} for a variable unrelated to complex numbers, they can use
22799 basic simplification mode.
22800
22801 Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22802 several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22803 Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22804 pulled out so that @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22805 @texline @math{2\,@tfn{sqrt}(2)}.
22806 @infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22807 Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22808 and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22809 efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22810
22811 Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22812 numerator: @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22813 The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22814 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22815
22816 @tex
22817 \bigskip
22818 @end tex
22819
22820 The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22821 when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22822 the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22823 @expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22824 example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22825
22826 If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22827 has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22828 canceled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22829 @samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22830 is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22831 not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22832 about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22833
22834 If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22835 evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22836 often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22837 above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22838 @samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22839 can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22840 declared to be an integer.
22841
22842 @tex
22843 \bigskip
22844 @end tex
22845
22846 Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. Whenever a
22847 products of two trigonometric functions can be replaced by a single
22848 function, the replacement is made; for example,
22849 @expr{@tfn{tan}(x) @tfn{cos}(x)} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{sin}(x)}.
22850 Reciprocals of trigonometric functions are replaced by their reciprocal
22851 function; for example, @expr{1/@tfn{sec}(x)} is simplified to
22852 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. The corresponding simplifications for the
22853 hyperbolic functions are also handled.
22854
22855 Trigonometric functions of their inverse functions are
22856 simplified. The expression @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arcsin}(x))} is
22857 simplified to @expr{x}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22858 Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22859 functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arccos}(x))}
22860 to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22861
22862 If the argument to @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22863 @expr{-@tfn{sin}(x)}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22864 Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22865 @pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22866
22867 Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22868 arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22869 hyperbolic functions.
22870
22871 No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22872 functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22873 @code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
22874 @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
22875 @expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
22876 @texline @math{2 \pi}
22877 @infoline @expr{2 pi}
22878 radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@tfn{arcsinh}(@tfn{sinh}(x))} is
22879 simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22880
22881 Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
22882 are that @expr{@tfn{exp}(@tfn{ln}(x))},
22883 @texline @tfn{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
22884 @infoline @expr{e^@tfn{ln}(x)},
22885 and
22886 @texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
22887 @infoline @expr{10^@tfn{log10}(x)}
22888 all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))}, etc., can
22889 reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
22890 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
22891 is a suitable multiple of
22892 @texline @math{\pi i}
22893 @infoline @expr{pi i}
22894 (as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
22895 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
22896 @expr{@tfn{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
22897 @code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
22898 negative imaginary.
22899
22900 The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
22901 their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
22902 function.
22903
22904 @tex
22905 \bigskip
22906 @end tex
22907
22908 Equations and inequalities are simplified by canceling factors
22909 of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
22910 change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is canceled.
22911 Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
22912 canceled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
22913 because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
22914 are canceled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
22915 sign is known.
22916
22917 Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
22918 1 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
22919 declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
22920 than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
22921 all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
22922 By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
22923 as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22924
22925 @node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22926 @subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
22927
22928 @noindent
22929 @cindex Unsafe simplifications
22930 @cindex Extended simplification
22931 @kindex a e
22932 @kindex m E
22933 @pindex calc-simplify-extended
22934 @ignore
22935 @mindex esimpl@idots
22936 @end ignore
22937 @tindex esimplify
22938 Calc is capable of performing some simplifications which may sometimes
22939 be desired but which are not ``safe'' in all cases. The @kbd{a e}
22940 (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
22941 applies the algebraic simplifications as well as these extended, or
22942 ``unsafe'', simplifications. Use this only if you know the values in
22943 your formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these
22944 simplifications are valid. You can use Extended Simplification mode
22945 (@kbd{m E}) to have these simplifications done automatically.
22946
22947 The symbolic integrator uses these extended simplifications; one effect
22948 of this is that the integrator's results must be used with caution.
22949 Where an integral table will often attach conditions like ``for positive
22950 @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic integration programs)
22951 will simply produce an unqualified result.
22952
22953 Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
22954 to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
22955 on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
22956 In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
22957 to any specific part of a formula.
22958
22959 The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied when
22960 the extended simplifications are used. These are applied in addition to
22961 @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
22962 step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
22963
22964 Following is a complete list of the ``unsafe'' simplifications.
22965
22966 @tex
22967 \bigskip
22968 @end tex
22969
22970 Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
22971 corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified.
22972 For example, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} changes
22973 to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{cos}(x))} and
22974 @expr{@tfn{arccos}(@tfn{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@tfn{pi}/2 - x}.
22975 These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
22976 values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
22977 are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
22978 functions always produce.
22979
22980 Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
22981 @texline @math{x^{a b}}
22982 @infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
22983 for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
22984 in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
22985 @texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
22986 @infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
22987 the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
22988 of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
22989
22990 Similarly, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
22991 simplified (possibly unsafely) to
22992 @texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
22993 @infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
22994
22995 Forms like @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
22996 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
22997 @code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
22998
22999 Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
23000 squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
23001 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
23002 @expr{a b @tfn{sqrt}(a+b)}.
23003
23004 The simplifications of @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))},
23005 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)}, and @expr{@tfn{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
23006 unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
23007 simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
23008
23009 Common factors are canceled from products on both sides of an
23010 equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
23011 to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never canceled from
23012 inequalities: Even the extended simplifications are not bold enough to
23013 reduce @expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
23014 on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
23015 The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
23016 both sides of an inequality.
23017
23018 @node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
23019 @subsection Simplification of Units
23020
23021 @noindent
23022 The simplifications described in this section (as well as the algebraic
23023 simplifications) are applied when units need to be simplified. They can
23024 be applied using the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command, or
23025 will be done automatically in Units Simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
23026 @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
23027
23028 The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
23029 units simplifications. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
23030 and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
23031
23032 Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
23033 @xref{Matrix Mode}.
23034
23035 Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
23036 units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
23037 @expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
23038 using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
23039 is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
23040 in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
23041
23042 If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
23043 which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
23044 leading unit are modified accordingly.
23045
23046 When canceling and combining units in products and quotients,
23047 Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
23048 For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
23049 However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
23050 are not combined in this way.
23051
23052 Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
23053 if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
23054 computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
23055
23056 Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
23057 of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
23058 units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
23059 units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
23060 @samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
23061
23062 Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
23063 a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
23064 number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
23065
23066 For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
23067 @expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
23068 and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
23069 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
23070 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
23071 are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
23072 of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
23073 real.)
23074
23075 Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
23076 base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
23077 multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
23078 is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
23079 according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
23080 is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
23081 is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
23082 @code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
23083 replaced by approximately
23084 @texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
23085 @infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
23086 which is then changed to
23087 @texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
23088 @infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
23089 then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
23090
23091 The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
23092 as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
23093 applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
23094 simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
23095 @samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
23096 and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
23097
23098 The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
23099 that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
23100 simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
23101 with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
23102
23103 @node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
23104 @section Polynomials
23105
23106 A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
23107 various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
23108 is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
23109 polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
23110 is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
23111 are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
23112 involving the base variable.
23113
23114 @kindex a f
23115 @pindex calc-factor
23116 @tindex factor
23117 The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
23118 polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
23119 @expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
23120 example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
23121 @expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
23122
23123 Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
23124 linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
23125 merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
23126 polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
23127 coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
23128 terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
23129 (@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
23130 which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
23131 rewrite mechanism.
23132
23133 Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
23134 root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
23135 polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
23136 or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
23137 quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
23138 arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
23139 integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
23140 Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
23141 found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
23142 (A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
23143 version of Calc.)
23144
23145 @vindex FactorRules
23146 @ignore
23147 @starindex
23148 @end ignore
23149 @tindex thecoefs
23150 @ignore
23151 @starindex
23152 @end ignore
23153 @ignore
23154 @mindex @idots
23155 @end ignore
23156 @tindex thefactors
23157 The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
23158 @code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
23159 operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
23160 to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
23161 @expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
23162 cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
23163 @samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
23164 base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
23165 (which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
23166 i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
23167 changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
23168 where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
23169 Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
23170 factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
23171 @code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
23172 polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
23173 the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
23174 as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
23175
23176 @kindex H a f
23177 @tindex factors
23178 The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
23179 but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
23180 product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
23181 of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
23182 @expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
23183 in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
23184 If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
23185 The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
23186 when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
23187 respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
23188 respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
23189
23190 @kindex a c
23191 @pindex calc-collect
23192 @tindex collect
23193 The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
23194 formula as a
23195 polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
23196 variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
23197 the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
23198 and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
23199 The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
23200 necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
23201 @expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
23202 not be expanded.
23203
23204 The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
23205 expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
23206 by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
23207 in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
23208 treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
23209
23210 @kindex a x
23211 @pindex calc-expand
23212 @tindex expand
23213 The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
23214 expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
23215 products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
23216 distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
23217 the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
23218 the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
23219
23220 The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
23221 @kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
23222 Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
23223 the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
23224 @kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
23225 also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
23226 @samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
23227 do not do.)
23228
23229 Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
23230 expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
23231 to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
23232 to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23233 simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23234 simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23235 @kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23236 the way in one step.
23237
23238 @kindex a a
23239 @pindex calc-apart
23240 @tindex apart
23241 The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23242 rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23243 quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23244 sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23245 notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23246 specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23247 chooses the base variable automatically.
23248
23249 @kindex a n
23250 @pindex calc-normalize-rat
23251 @tindex nrat
23252 The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23253 attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23254 For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23255 @expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23256 @kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23257 out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23258
23259 @kindex a \
23260 @pindex calc-poly-div
23261 @tindex pdiv
23262 The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23263 two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23264 @expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23265 considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23266 with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23267 powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23268 dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23269 The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23270 of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23271
23272 Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23273 variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23274 If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23275 the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23276 above.
23277
23278 @kindex a %
23279 @pindex calc-poly-rem
23280 @tindex prem
23281 The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23282 two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23283 @expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23284 results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23285 (This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23286 integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23287
23288 @kindex a /
23289 @kindex H a /
23290 @pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23291 @tindex pdivrem
23292 @tindex pdivide
23293 The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23294 divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23295 remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23296 command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23297 @expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23298 this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23299
23300 @kindex a g
23301 @pindex calc-poly-gcd
23302 @tindex pgcd
23303 The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23304 the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23305 is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23306 choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23307 command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23308 of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23309 definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23310 leaving a remainder.)
23311
23312 While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23313 often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23314 deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23315 Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23316 applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23317 automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23318 integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23319
23320 Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23321 (@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23322 polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23323
23324 @xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23325 extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23326
23327 @node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23328 @section Calculus
23329
23330 @noindent
23331 The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23332 inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23333 to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23334 to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23335 readable way.
23336
23337 @menu
23338 * Differentiation::
23339 * Integration::
23340 * Customizing the Integrator::
23341 * Numerical Integration::
23342 * Taylor Series::
23343 @end menu
23344
23345 @node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23346 @subsection Differentiation
23347
23348 @noindent
23349 @kindex a d
23350 @kindex H a d
23351 @pindex calc-derivative
23352 @tindex deriv
23353 @tindex tderiv
23354 The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23355 the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23356 some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23357 in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23358 considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23359 the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23360 instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23361 unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23362 of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23363 are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23364 @code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23365
23366 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23367 @var{n}th derivative.
23368
23369 When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23370 Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23371 in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23372 answer!
23373
23374 If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23375 you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23376 of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23377 @texline @math{x=x_0}.
23378 @infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23379
23380 If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23381 not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23382 primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23383 produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23384 derivative of @code{f}.
23385
23386 For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23387 the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23388 also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23389 @samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23390 the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23391 @samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23392 define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23393 result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23394
23395 For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23396 to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23397 respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23398 Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23399 @samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23400 @samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23401 argument once).
23402
23403 @node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23404 @subsection Integration
23405
23406 @noindent
23407 @kindex a i
23408 @pindex calc-integral
23409 @tindex integ
23410 The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23411 indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23412 respect to a prompted-for variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to
23413 work for all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several
23414 large classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational
23415 function (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable.
23416 (Rational functions don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23417 @texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23418 @infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23419 is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23420 @expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23421 @expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23422 integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23423 hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23424
23425 With an argument (@kbd{C-u a i}), this command will compute the definite
23426 integral of the expression on top of the stack. In this case, the
23427 command will again prompt for an integration variable, then prompt for a
23428 lower limit and an upper limit.
23429
23430 @ifnottex
23431 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23432 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23433 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23434 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23435 integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23436 @end ifnottex
23437 @tex
23438 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23439 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23440 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23441 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23442 integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23443 @end tex
23444
23445 Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23446 produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23447 be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23448 @texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23449 @infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23450 is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23451 returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23452 equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23453 an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23454 write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23455 Calc's solution for
23456 @texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23457 @infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23458 differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23459 constant factor of
23460 @texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23461 @infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23462 due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23463
23464 The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23465 change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23466 from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23467 suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23468 @code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23469
23470 @vindex IntegLimit
23471 Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23472 parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23473 If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23474 a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23475 command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23476 has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23477 of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23478 will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23479 this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23480 it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23481 by creating an Emacs buffer called @code{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23482 exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23483
23484 If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23485 set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23486 table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23487 rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23488 and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23489
23490 @node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23491 @subsection Customizing the Integrator
23492
23493 @noindent
23494 @vindex IntegRules
23495 Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23496 @code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23497 methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23498 Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23499 @samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23500 integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23501 rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23502 Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23503 the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23504 integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23505 Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23506 will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23507 automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23508 to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23509 @samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23510 in your @code{IntegRules}.
23511
23512 @cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23513 @ignore
23514 @starindex
23515 @end ignore
23516 @tindex Ei
23517 As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23518 integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23519 integral'' function
23520 @texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23521 @infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23522 was invented to describe it.
23523 We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23524 function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23525 to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23526 and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23527 work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23528 integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23529 involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23530 integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23531 and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23532
23533 Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23534 example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23535 to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23536 Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23537 is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23538 with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23539 to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23540 also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23541 unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still valid
23542 to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23543 if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23544 integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23545 then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23546
23547 If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23548 @var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23549 nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23550 substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23551 integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23552 @samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23553 a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23554 @samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23555 Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23556 appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23557 as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23558 it need not be.
23559
23560 When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23561 equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23562 refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23563 match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23564 of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23565 derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23566 extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23567 general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23568 @var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23569 written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23570 derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23571 specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23572 own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23573 work only in very specific, simple cases.
23574
23575 Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23576 in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23577 set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23578 example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23579 forever!)
23580
23581 @vindex IntegSimpRules
23582 Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23583 every time the integrator uses algebraic simplifications to simplify an
23584 intermediate result. For example, putting the rule
23585 @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into @code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to
23586 convert the @code{twice} function into a form it knows whenever
23587 integration is attempted.
23588
23589 One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23590 the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23591 integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23592 defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23593 be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23594 systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23595 do this.)
23596
23597 @vindex IntegAfterRules
23598 Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23599 expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23600 this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23601 above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23602 you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23603 runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23604 an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23605 (It also does algebraic simplifications, without @code{IntegSimpRules},
23606 after that to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23607 sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23608 the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23609 form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23610 @code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23611 of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23612 @code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23613 finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23614 @code{IntegSimpRules}.
23615
23616 @node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23617 @subsection Numerical Integration
23618
23619 @noindent
23620 @kindex a I
23621 @pindex calc-num-integral
23622 @tindex ninteg
23623 If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23624 use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23625 command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23626 upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23627 that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23628 value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23629
23630 Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23631 the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23632 that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23633 it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23634 the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23635 integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23636 have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23637 determine the value of the integral.
23638
23639 Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23640 best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23641 before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23642 @kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23643 to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23644 well-behaved in the specified interval.
23645
23646 It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23647 infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23648 internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23649 limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23650 The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23651 by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23652 because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23653
23654 @node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23655 @subsection Taylor Series
23656
23657 @noindent
23658 @kindex a t
23659 @pindex calc-taylor
23660 @tindex taylor
23661 The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23662 power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23663 variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23664 the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23665 of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23666 You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23667 otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23668 many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23669 may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23670
23671 If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23672 function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23673 Taylor series.
23674
23675 @node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23676 @section Solving Equations
23677
23678 @noindent
23679 @kindex a S
23680 @pindex calc-solve-for
23681 @tindex solve
23682 @cindex Equations, solving
23683 @cindex Solving equations
23684 The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23685 an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23686 expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23687 will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23688 input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23689 form @expr{X = 0}.
23690
23691 This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23692 Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23693 be; for example, solving
23694 @texline @math{a < b \, c}
23695 @infoline @expr{a < b c}
23696 for @expr{b} is impossible
23697 without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23698 produce the result
23699 @texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23700 @infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23701 (using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23702 inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23703 @texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23704 @infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23705 is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23706 Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23707
23708 Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23709 @kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23710 to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23711 another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23712
23713 @menu
23714 * Multiple Solutions::
23715 * Solving Systems of Equations::
23716 * Decomposing Polynomials::
23717 @end menu
23718
23719 @node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23720 @subsection Multiple Solutions
23721
23722 @noindent
23723 @kindex H a S
23724 @tindex fsolve
23725 Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23726 (@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23727 general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23728 @code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23729 @code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23730 signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23731 flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23732 one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23733 and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23734 the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23735 (@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23736 of these variables.
23737
23738 For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23739 get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23740 equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23741 think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23742 two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23743 single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23744 Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23745 the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23746
23747 There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23748 we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23749 to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23750 some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23751 Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23752 in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23753 solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23754 happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23755
23756 @cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23757 @vindex GenCount
23758 @ignore
23759 @starindex
23760 @end ignore
23761 @tindex an
23762 @ignore
23763 @starindex
23764 @end ignore
23765 @tindex as
23766 If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23767 then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23768 arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23769 where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23770 @code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23771 integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23772 new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23773 arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23774 session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23775 of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23776 you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23777 using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23778 on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23779 command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23780
23781 The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23782 way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23783
23784 If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23785 in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23786 @code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23787
23788 @kindex I a S
23789 @kindex H I a S
23790 @tindex finv
23791 @tindex ffinv
23792 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23793 on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23794 to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23795 For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23796 You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23797 fully general inverse, as described above.
23798
23799 @kindex a P
23800 @pindex calc-poly-roots
23801 @tindex roots
23802 Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23803 of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23804 command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23805 all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23806 variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23807 a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23808 values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23809 For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23810 @samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23811 polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23812 (If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23813 variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23814 reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23815
23816 Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23817 symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23818 note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23819 to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23820 can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23821 can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23822 which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23823 for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23824 @expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23825 into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23826 list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23827 is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23828 @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23829 formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23830 @kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23831 are all numbers (real or complex).
23832
23833 @node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23834 @subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23835
23836 @noindent
23837 @cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23838 You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23839 simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23840 specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23841 the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23842 at the prompt.)
23843
23844 For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23845 and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23846 @samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23847 have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23848 will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23849 are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23850 @expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23851 command.
23852
23853 Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23854 time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23855 substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23856 possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23857 first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23858 equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23859 and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23860 equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23861 solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23862 nonlinear systems.
23863
23864 @ignore
23865 @starindex
23866 @end ignore
23867 @tindex elim
23868 Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23869 give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23870 of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23871 typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23872 would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23873 express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
23874 the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
23875 variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
23876 variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
23877 the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
23878 For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
23879 @samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
23880
23881 If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
23882 Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
23883 and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
23884 @kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
23885 eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
23886 by one.
23887
23888 Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
23889 equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
23890 to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
23891 number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
23892 the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
23893 the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
23894 variables you requested.)
23895
23896 Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
23897 equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
23898 to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
23899
23900 @node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
23901 @subsection Decomposing Polynomials
23902
23903 @noindent
23904 @ignore
23905 @starindex
23906 @end ignore
23907 @tindex poly
23908 The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
23909 arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
23910 coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
23911 @expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
23912 the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
23913 not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
23914 of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
23915 coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
23916 The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
23917 note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
23918 Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
23919 @samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
23920
23921 @cindex Coefficients of polynomial
23922 @cindex Degree of polynomial
23923 To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
23924 @samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
23925 use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
23926 returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
23927 gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
23928
23929 @ignore
23930 @starindex
23931 @end ignore
23932 @tindex gpoly
23933 One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
23934 formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
23935 made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
23936 is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
23937 If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
23938 this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
23939 where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
23940 vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
23941 and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
23942 @samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
23943 @var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
23944 guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
23945 (i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
23946 considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
23947 and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
23948 their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
23949 is considered trivial.
23950
23951 For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
23952 since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
23953
23954 The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
23955 done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
23956 @samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
23957 since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
23958 a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
23959
23960 A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
23961 discover:
23962
23963 @smallexample
23964 sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
23965 x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
23966 x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
23967 x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
23968 x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
23969 x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
23970 (exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
23971 @end smallexample
23972
23973 The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
23974 which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
23975 If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
23976 or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
23977 call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
23978 can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
23979 @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
23980 can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
23981
23982 @ignore
23983 @starindex
23984 @end ignore
23985 @tindex pdeg
23986 The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
23987 @samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
23988 @code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
23989 much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
23990 then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
23991 (e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
23992 It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
23993 @samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
23994 polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
23995 that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
23996 the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
23997 (minus infinity).
23998
23999 @ignore
24000 @starindex
24001 @end ignore
24002 @tindex plead
24003 The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
24004 Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
24005 though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
24006 returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
24007 value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
24008
24009 @ignore
24010 @starindex
24011 @end ignore
24012 @tindex pcont
24013 The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
24014 is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
24015 With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
24016 to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
24017 GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
24018 @samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
24019 basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
24020 exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
24021 coefficient.
24022
24023 With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
24024 content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
24025 coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
24026 is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
24027 the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
24028 denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
24029 Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
24030 denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
24031 numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
24032 if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
24033
24034 @ignore
24035 @starindex
24036 @end ignore
24037 @tindex pprim
24038 The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
24039 polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
24040 if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
24041 coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
24042 terms.
24043
24044 @node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
24045 @section Numerical Solutions
24046
24047 @noindent
24048 Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
24049 section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
24050 instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
24051 numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
24052 good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
24053
24054 (@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
24055 on numerical data.)
24056
24057 @menu
24058 * Root Finding::
24059 * Minimization::
24060 * Numerical Systems of Equations::
24061 @end menu
24062
24063 @node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
24064 @subsection Root Finding
24065
24066 @noindent
24067 @kindex a R
24068 @pindex calc-find-root
24069 @tindex root
24070 @cindex Newton's method
24071 @cindex Roots of equations
24072 @cindex Numerical root-finding
24073 The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
24074 numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
24075 inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
24076 of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
24077
24078 The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
24079 stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
24080 solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
24081 that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
24082 a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
24083 evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
24084 value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
24085 this command.
24086
24087 When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
24088 by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
24089 solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
24090 righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
24091 number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
24092 slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
24093 number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
24094 the equation yourself.)
24095
24096 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
24097 the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
24098
24099 The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
24100 for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
24101 case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
24102 solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
24103 to real numbers inside that interval.
24104
24105 Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
24106 If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
24107 differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
24108 appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
24109 can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
24110 with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
24111 complex number, the function must be differentiable.
24112
24113 If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
24114 is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
24115 the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
24116 Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
24117 positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
24118 an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
24119
24120 @kindex H a R
24121 @tindex wroot
24122 The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
24123 that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
24124 the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
24125 Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
24126 you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
24127
24128 If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
24129 instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
24130 process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
24131 @emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
24132 require a bounding interval in order to work.)
24133
24134 If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
24135 form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
24136 no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
24137 (@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
24138
24139 @node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
24140 @subsection Minimization
24141
24142 @noindent
24143 @kindex a N
24144 @kindex H a N
24145 @kindex a X
24146 @kindex H a X
24147 @pindex calc-find-minimum
24148 @pindex calc-find-maximum
24149 @tindex minimize
24150 @tindex maximize
24151 @cindex Minimization, numerical
24152 The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
24153 finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
24154 to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
24155 guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
24156 may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
24157 the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
24158 value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
24159 with the minimum value itself.
24160
24161 Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
24162 have more than one minimum; some, like
24163 @texline @math{x \sin x},
24164 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
24165 have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
24166 ``global'' minimum of
24167 @texline @math{x \sin x}
24168 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
24169 but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
24170 for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
24171 finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
24172 and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
24173
24174 If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
24175 occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
24176 that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
24177 over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
24178 @expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
24179 use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
24180 range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
24181 any, that happens to lie in that range.
24182
24183 Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
24184 of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
24185 variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
24186 you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
24187 answer.
24188
24189 @ignore
24190 @mindex wmin@idots
24191 @end ignore
24192 @tindex wminimize
24193 @ignore
24194 @mindex wmax@idots
24195 @end ignore
24196 @tindex wmaximize
24197 The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
24198 expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
24199 that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
24200
24201 The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
24202 @kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
24203 negative of the formula you supply.
24204
24205 The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
24206 interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
24207 the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
24208 over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
24209 be minimized over the reals.
24210
24211 @node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
24212 @subsection Systems of Equations
24213
24214 @noindent
24215 @cindex Systems of equations, numerical
24216 The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
24217 case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
24218 guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
24219 supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
24220 can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
24221 equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
24222 work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
24223 values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
24224 between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
24225 There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
24226 only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
24227 no effect when solving a system of equations.
24228
24229 It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
24230 (or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
24231 be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
24232 be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
24233 multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
24234 still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
24235 multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
24236
24237 @node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
24238 @section Curve Fitting
24239
24240 @noindent
24241 The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24242 such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24243 to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24244 no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24245 case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24246 possible fit. The model formula can be entered in various ways after
24247 the key sequence @kbd{a F} is pressed.
24248
24249 If the letter @kbd{P} is pressed after @kbd{a F} but before the model
24250 description is entered, the data as well as the model formula will be
24251 plotted after the formula is determined. This will be indicated by a
24252 ``P'' in the minibuffer after the help message.
24253
24254 @menu
24255 * Linear Fits::
24256 * Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24257 * Error Estimates for Fits::
24258 * Standard Nonlinear Models::
24259 * Curve Fitting Details::
24260 * Interpolation::
24261 @end menu
24262
24263 @node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24264 @subsection Linear Fits
24265
24266 @noindent
24267 @kindex a F
24268 @pindex calc-curve-fit
24269 @tindex fit
24270 @cindex Linear regression
24271 @cindex Least-squares fits
24272 The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24273 to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24274 straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24275 moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24276 will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24277 fit for the data.
24278
24279 In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24280 data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24281 by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24282 values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24283 @expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24284 instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24285 we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24286 @expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24287
24288 In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24289 the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24290 variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24291 the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24292
24293 The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24294 By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24295 for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24296 @texline @math{2\times N}
24297 @infoline 2xN
24298 matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24299 row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24300 shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24301 @expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24302
24303 If you happen to have an
24304 @texline @math{N\times2}
24305 @infoline Nx2
24306 matrix instead of a
24307 @texline @math{2\times N}
24308 @infoline 2xN
24309 matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24310
24311 After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24312 linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24313
24314 Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24315 high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24316 low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24317 variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24318 by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24319 independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24320 name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24321
24322 For example, suppose the data matrix
24323
24324 @ifnottex
24325 @example
24326 @group
24327 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24328 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24329 @end group
24330 @end example
24331 @end ifnottex
24332 @tex
24333 \beforedisplay
24334 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24335 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24336 $$
24337 \afterdisplay
24338 @end tex
24339
24340 @noindent
24341 is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24342 @kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24343 the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3. + 2. x}
24344 on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24345 then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24346 data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24347 substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24348 formula.
24349
24350 The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24351 always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24352 a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24353 @expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24354 than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24355 to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24356
24357 Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24358 resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24359 Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24360 the equations that go into the trail.
24361
24362 @tex
24363 \bigskip
24364 @end tex
24365
24366 To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24367 the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24368 The result is:
24369
24370 @example
24371 2.6 + 2.2 x
24372 @end example
24373
24374 Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24375 a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24376
24377 @example
24378 [4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24379 @end example
24380
24381 Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24382 Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24383 the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24384 error measure
24385
24386 @ifnottex
24387 @example
24388 chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24389 @end example
24390 @end ifnottex
24391 @tex
24392 \beforedisplay
24393 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24394 \afterdisplay
24395 @end tex
24396
24397 @noindent
24398 which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24399 and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24400 corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24401 summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24402 @texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24403 @infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24404 Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24405 for which the error
24406 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24407 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24408 is as small as possible.
24409
24410 Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24411 formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24412
24413 @tex
24414 \bigskip
24415 @end tex
24416
24417 A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24418 data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24419 will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24420 of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24421 is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24422
24423 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24424 items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24425 vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24426 the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24427 in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24428
24429 @node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24430 @subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24431
24432 @noindent
24433 To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24434 digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24435 we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24436 (with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24437 @kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24438
24439 @example
24440 2.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24441 @end example
24442
24443 Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24444 data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24445 for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24446 to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24447 an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24448 Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24449 the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24450 won't help.)
24451
24452 Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24453 gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24454 line slightly to improve the fit.
24455
24456 @example
24457 0.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24458 @end example
24459
24460 An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24461 is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24462 of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24463 Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24464 a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24465
24466 @example
24467 0.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24468 @end example
24469
24470 The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24471 @expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24472 It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24473 digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24474 Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24475 results.
24476
24477 You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24478 the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24479 columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24480 automatically.
24481
24482 Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24483 a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24484 wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24485 if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24486 extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24487 command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24488
24489 @tex
24490 \bigskip
24491 @end tex
24492
24493 Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24494 @expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24495 @expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24496 selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24497 is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24498
24499 Given the data matrix,
24500
24501 @example
24502 @group
24503 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24504 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24505 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24506 @end group
24507 @end example
24508
24509 @noindent
24510 the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24511 second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24512 model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24513
24514 @example
24515 8. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24516 @end example
24517
24518 Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24519 (i.e., with any number of data rows).
24520
24521 @tex
24522 \bigskip
24523 @end tex
24524
24525 Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24526 the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24527 means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24528 case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24529 case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24530 a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24531 @kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24532 This will be indicated by an ``h'' in the minibuffer after the help
24533 message.
24534
24535 It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24536 like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24537 key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24538 any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24539 would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24540
24541 Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24542 are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24543
24544 @node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24545 @subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24546
24547 @noindent
24548 @kindex H a F
24549 @tindex efit
24550 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24551 fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24552 forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24553 with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24554
24555 @example
24556 3. + 2. x
24557 2.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24558 @end example
24559
24560 In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24561 fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24562 moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24563
24564 It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24565 contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24566 or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24567 go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24568 row contains error forms
24569 @texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24570 @infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24571 then the
24572 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24573 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24574 statistic is now,
24575
24576 @ifnottex
24577 @example
24578 chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24579 @end example
24580 @end ifnottex
24581 @tex
24582 \beforedisplay
24583 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24584 \afterdisplay
24585 @end tex
24586
24587 @noindent
24588 so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24589 the fitting operation.
24590
24591 If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24592 errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24593 sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24594 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24595 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24596 used for the data point.
24597
24598 Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24599 matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24600 probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24601 estimates.
24602
24603 If the input contains error forms but all the
24604 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24605 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24606 values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24607 will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24608 @texline (@math{\chi^2}
24609 @infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24610 is simply scaled uniformly by
24611 @texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24612 @infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24613 which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24614 a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24615 @kbd{H a F}.
24616
24617 Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24618 of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24619 interpreted.
24620
24621 @tex
24622 \bigskip
24623 @end tex
24624
24625 @kindex I a F
24626 @tindex xfit
24627 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24628 information. The result is a vector of six items:
24629
24630 @enumerate
24631 @item
24632 The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24633 parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24634 produced.
24635
24636 @item
24637 A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24638 polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24639 same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24640 @kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24641 will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24642
24643 @item
24644 The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24645 an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24646 @texline @math{C_{jj}}
24647 @infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24648 are the variances
24649 @texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24650 @infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24651 of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24652 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24653 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24654 that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24655 set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24656 @texline @math{r_{ij}},
24657 @infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24658 are defined as
24659 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24660 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24661
24662 @item
24663 A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24664 meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24665 will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24666 polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24667
24668 @item
24669 The value of
24670 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24671 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24672 for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24673 measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24674 @texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24675 @infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24676 to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24677 data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24678
24679 @item
24680 A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24681 This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24682 function using
24683 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24684 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24685 with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24686 value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24687 @expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24688 particular,
24689 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24690 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24691 statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24692 follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24693 have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24694
24695 The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24696 estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24697 for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24698 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24699 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24700 value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24701 in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24702 over to use for a confidence test.
24703 @end enumerate
24704
24705 @node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24706 @subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24707
24708 @noindent
24709 The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24710 lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24711 abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24712
24713 Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24714
24715 @table @kbd
24716 @item 1
24717 Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24718 @item 2-9
24719 Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24720 @item e
24721 Exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24722 @item E
24723 Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24724 @item x
24725 Exponential (alternate notation). @tfn{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24726 @item X
24727 Base-10 exponential (alternate). @tfn{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24728 @item l
24729 Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24730 @item L
24731 Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24732 @item ^
24733 General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24734 @item p
24735 Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24736 @item q
24737 Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24738 @item g
24739 Gaussian.
24740 @texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24741 @infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24742 @item s
24743 Logistic @emph{s} curve.
24744 @texline @math{a/(1+e^{b(x-c)})}.
24745 @infoline @mathit{a/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))}.
24746 @item b
24747 Logistic bell curve.
24748 @texline @math{ae^{b(x-c)}/(1+e^{b(x-c)})^2}.
24749 @infoline @mathit{a exp(b (x - c))/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))^2}.
24750 @item o
24751 Hubbert linearization.
24752 @texline @math{{y \over x} = a(1-x/b)}.
24753 @infoline @mathit{(y/x) = a (1 - x/b)}.
24754 @end table
24755
24756 All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24757 letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24758 result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24759 values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24760 the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24761
24762 All models except Gaussian, logistics, Hubbert and polynomials can
24763 generalize as shown to any number of independent variables. Also, all
24764 the built-in models except for the logistic and Hubbert curves have an
24765 additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24766 which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24767 before the model key.
24768
24769 Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24770 the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24771 the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24772 each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24773 with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24774 matches the problem.
24775
24776 The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24777 fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24778 These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24779 @samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24780 @expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24781 @expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24782
24783 @tex
24784 \bigskip
24785 @end tex
24786
24787 If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24788 (the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24789 formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24790 will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24791
24792 The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24793 In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24794 equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24795 (@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24796 and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24797 do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24798 implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24799 model.
24800
24801 When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24802 the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24803 default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24804 (in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24805 Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24806 and thus does not need a name.
24807
24808 For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24809 and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24810 Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24811 data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24812 enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24813 as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24814 variables.
24815
24816 You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24817 different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24818 those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24819 be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24820 and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24821 If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24822 in the model formula will become parameters.
24823
24824 If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24825 for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24826 will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24827 another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24828 a linear model.
24829
24830 If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24831 Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24832 appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24833 choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24834 which are parameters.
24835
24836 Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24837 two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24838 @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24839 and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24840 (If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24841 those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24842
24843 When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24844 describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24845
24846 @tex
24847 \bigskip
24848 @end tex
24849
24850 @vindex Model1
24851 @vindex Model2
24852 Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24853 @code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24854 @kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24855 the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24856 accept for a model on the stack.
24857
24858 @tex
24859 \bigskip
24860 @end tex
24861
24862 Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24863 and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24864 the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24865 form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24866 returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24867 equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24868 believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24869 so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24870 @texline @math{3\times360}
24871 @infoline @mathit{3*360}
24872 degrees.
24873 The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
24874 true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
24875 would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
24876 @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
24877 the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
24878 No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
24879 even approximately.
24880
24881 There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
24882 restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
24883 doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
24884 Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
24885 Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
24886 (Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
24887 taking Fourier and related transforms.)
24888
24889 @node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
24890 @subsection Curve Fitting Details
24891
24892 @noindent
24893 Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
24894 models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
24895 @expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
24896 are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
24897 (of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
24898
24899 In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
24900 to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
24901 is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
24902 and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
24903
24904 For most other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
24905 to try to put the problem into the form
24906
24907 @smallexample
24908 Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
24909 @end smallexample
24910
24911 @noindent
24912 where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
24913 @expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
24914 does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
24915 and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
24916 in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
24917
24918 A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
24919 We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
24920 model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
24921 can be rewritten as follows:
24922
24923 @example
24924 y = a x^b
24925 y = a exp(b ln(x))
24926 y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
24927 ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
24928 @end example
24929
24930 @noindent
24931 which matches the desired form with
24932 @texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
24933 @infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
24934 @texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
24935 @infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
24936 @expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
24937 @texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
24938 @infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
24939 Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
24940 does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
24941 @texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
24942 @infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
24943 and @expr{b = B}.
24944
24945 Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
24946 be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
24947
24948 @example
24949 y = a + b*(x - c)^2
24950 y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
24951 @end example
24952
24953 @noindent
24954 which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
24955 @expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
24956 have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
24957 @expr{H = x^2}.
24958
24959 The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
24960 shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
24961 exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
24962
24963 The logistic models cannot be put into general linear form. For these
24964 models, and the Hubbert linearization, Calc computes a rough
24965 approximation for the parameters, then uses the Levenberg-Marquardt
24966 iterative method to refine the approximations.
24967
24968 Another model that cannot be put into general linear
24969 form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
24970 @expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
24971 this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
24972 constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
24973 manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
24974 graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
24975 @kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
24976 Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
24977 Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
24978 (the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
24979 deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
24980
24981 To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
24982 store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
24983 from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
24984
24985 @tex
24986 \bigskip
24987 @end tex
24988
24989 A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
24990 @code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
24991 functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
24992 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24993 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24994 sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
24995 command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
24996 special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
24997 command can do the same thing by brute force.
24998
24999 A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
25000 fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
25001 which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
25002 to be minimized would be the value of
25003 @texline @math{\chi^2}
25004 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
25005 returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
25006
25007 @smallexample
25008 minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
25009 @end smallexample
25010
25011 @noindent
25012 where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
25013 @code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
25014 the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
25015 This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
25016 rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
25017 were used by itself to solve the problem).
25018
25019 @tex
25020 \bigskip
25021 @end tex
25022
25023 The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
25024 nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
25025 vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
25026 covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
25027 The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
25028 is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
25029 as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
25030 and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
25031 in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
25032 parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
25033 of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
25034 parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
25035 @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
25036 and so on.
25037
25038 When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
25039 @samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
25040 parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
25041 evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
25042 values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
25043 @kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
25044 Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
25045 matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
25046 standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
25047
25048 If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
25049 that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
25050 @emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
25051 figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
25052 nontrivial filter functions.
25053
25054 Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
25055 Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
25056 @expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
25057 data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
25058 of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
25059 and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
25060 form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
25061 linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
25062 form. The error part of that result is used for
25063 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
25064 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
25065 for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
25066 an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
25067 @texline @math{\sigma_i}.
25068 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
25069 Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
25070 for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
25071 the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
25072 arithmetic with no error forms.
25073
25074 (While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
25075 the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
25076 depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
25077 often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
25078 and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
25079 @texline @math{\sigma}
25080 @infoline @expr{sigma}
25081 for the data point with no further ado.)
25082
25083 @tex
25084 \bigskip
25085 @end tex
25086
25087 @vindex FitRules
25088 It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
25089 but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
25090 its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
25091 rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
25092 variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
25093 a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
25094 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
25095
25096 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
25097
25098 @ignore
25099 @starindex
25100 @end ignore
25101 @tindex fitvar
25102 @ignore
25103 @starindex
25104 @end ignore
25105 @ignore
25106 @mindex @idots
25107 @end ignore
25108 @tindex fitparam
25109 @ignore
25110 @starindex
25111 @end ignore
25112 @ignore
25113 @mindex @null
25114 @end ignore
25115 @tindex fitmodel
25116 @ignore
25117 @starindex
25118 @end ignore
25119 @ignore
25120 @mindex @null
25121 @end ignore
25122 @tindex fitsystem
25123 @ignore
25124 @starindex
25125 @end ignore
25126 @ignore
25127 @mindex @null
25128 @end ignore
25129 @tindex fitdummy
25130 Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
25131 to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
25132 call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
25133 function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
25134 Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
25135 @samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
25136 to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
25137 is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
25138 model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
25139
25140 @smallexample
25141 @group
25142 fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
25143 @end group
25144 @end smallexample
25145
25146 Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
25147 (The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
25148 changes are possible.)
25149
25150 When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
25151 been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
25152
25153 @example
25154 fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
25155 @end example
25156
25157 @noindent
25158 where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
25159 @var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
25160 and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
25161 raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
25162 for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
25163 the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
25164 parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
25165
25166 The power law model eventually boils down to
25167
25168 @smallexample
25169 @group
25170 fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
25171 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
25172 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
25173 @end group
25174 @end smallexample
25175
25176 The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
25177 proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
25178 to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
25179 @code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
25180 can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
25181 be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
25182 non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
25183 and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
25184 Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
25185 @samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
25186 are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
25187 linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
25188 will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
25189
25190 Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
25191 and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
25192 form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
25193 initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
25194 to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
25195 from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
25196 calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
25197 this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
25198 four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
25199 @var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
25200 empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
25201 raw parameters, for now.)
25202
25203 Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
25204 of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
25205 terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
25206 is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
25207 factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
25208 that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
25209 is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
25210 complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
25211 with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
25212 using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
25213 raw parameters needed.
25214
25215 Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
25216 @var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
25217 were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
25218 computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
25219 time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
25220 removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
25221 to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
25222 least-squares solver wants to see.
25223
25224 @ignore
25225 @starindex
25226 @end ignore
25227 @ignore
25228 @mindex hasfit@idots
25229 @end ignore
25230 @tindex hasfitparams
25231 @ignore
25232 @starindex
25233 @end ignore
25234 @ignore
25235 @mindex @null
25236 @end ignore
25237 @tindex hasfitvars
25238 Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
25239 are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
25240 whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
25241 respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
25242 argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
25243 calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
25244 nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
25245 returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
25246 or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
25247
25248 @tex
25249 \bigskip
25250 @end tex
25251
25252 The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
25253 arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
25254 where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
25255 @kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
25256 independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
25257 and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25258 must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25259 an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25260 a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25261 allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25262
25263 If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25264 @var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25265 is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25266 @var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25267 and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25268
25269 Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25270 where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25271 and variables, as discussed previously.
25272
25273 If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25274 in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25275 message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25276 linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25277
25278 The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25279 (for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25280
25281 @node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25282 @subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25283
25284 @kindex a p
25285 @pindex calc-poly-interp
25286 @tindex polint
25287 The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25288 a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25289 two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25290 @kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25291 value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25292 then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25293 approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25294 use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25295 efficient and more numerically stable.)
25296
25297 The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25298 value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25299 estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25300 @expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25301 in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25302 value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25303
25304 A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25305 y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25306
25307 If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25308 interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25309 have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25310 If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25311 remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25312 a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25313
25314 In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25315 on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25316
25317 @kindex H a p
25318 @tindex ratint
25319 The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25320 interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25321 uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25322 @expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25323 each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25324 have degree one higher than the numerator).
25325
25326 Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25327 describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25328 goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25329 goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25330 function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25331 is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25332
25333 There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25334 used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25335 explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25336 capabilities to fit.)
25337
25338 @node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25339 @section Summations
25340
25341 @noindent
25342 @cindex Summation of a series
25343 @kindex a +
25344 @pindex calc-summation
25345 @tindex sum
25346 The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25347 the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25348 is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25349 name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25350 sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25351 enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25352 any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25353 the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25354 produces the result 55.
25355 @tex
25356 $$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25357 @end tex
25358
25359 The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25360 use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25361 @code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25362 in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25363 as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25364 be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25365 If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25366 @w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25367 (@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25368
25369 A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25370 than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25371 yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25372 argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25373 step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25374 a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25375 @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25376 the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25377 upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25378
25379 Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25380 @samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25381 this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25382 exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25383 transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25384 and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25385 and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25386 lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25387 just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25388 whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25389
25390 The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25391 @samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25392 If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25393 omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25394 is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25395 and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25396
25397 Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25398 returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25399 form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25400 formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25401 for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25402 infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25403 solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25404 symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25405
25406 As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25407 described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25408 expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25409 the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25410 valid subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25411 @samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25412
25413 The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25414 @samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25415 Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25416 @samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25417 after algebraic simplification, evaluate to an integer.
25418
25419 If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25420 not come out to an integer, the sum is invalid and will be left
25421 in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25422 you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25423 substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25424 @samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25425 evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25426 the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25427
25428 If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25429 positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25430 Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25431 exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25432 of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25433 but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25434 if Calc used a closed form solution.
25435
25436 Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25437 and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25438 used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25439 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25440 prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25441 its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25442 as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25443 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25444 squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25445 there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25446 closed form.
25447
25448 As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25449 sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25450 one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25451 @samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25452 the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25453 this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25454 formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25455 Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25456 @samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25457 an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25458 @texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25459 @infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25460 then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25461 will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25462
25463 @cindex Alternating sums
25464 @kindex a -
25465 @pindex calc-alt-summation
25466 @tindex asum
25467 The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25468 computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25469 are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25470 to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25471 are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25472 @samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25473 if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25474 series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25475 (Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25476 it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25477 Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25478 namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25479
25480 @cindex Product of a sequence
25481 @kindex a *
25482 @pindex calc-product
25483 @tindex prod
25484 The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25485 the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25486 some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25487 Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25488 or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25489
25490 @kindex a T
25491 @pindex calc-tabulate
25492 @tindex table
25493 The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25494 evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25495 like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25496 vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25497 produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25498
25499 @node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25500 @section Logical Operations
25501
25502 @noindent
25503 The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25504 where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25505 a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25506 rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25507 nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25508 for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25509 which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25510 Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25511 portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25512 ``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25513 provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25514 have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25515 unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25516 false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25517
25518 @kindex a =
25519 @pindex calc-equal-to
25520 @tindex eq
25521 @tindex =
25522 @tindex ==
25523 The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25524 (which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25525 formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25526 are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25527 numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
25528 1.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25529 the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25530 operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25531 a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25532
25533 Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25534 For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25535 an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25536 (@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25537 function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25538 multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25539 @kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25540 @samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25541 zero if not.
25542
25543 The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25544 or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25545 algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25546 neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25547 same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25548 one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25549 variables).
25550
25551 @kindex a #
25552 @pindex calc-not-equal-to
25553 @tindex neq
25554 @tindex !=
25555 The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25556 @samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25557 This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25558 tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25559 distinct numbers.
25560
25561 @kindex a <
25562 @tindex lt
25563 @ignore
25564 @mindex @idots
25565 @end ignore
25566 @kindex a >
25567 @ignore
25568 @mindex @null
25569 @end ignore
25570 @kindex a [
25571 @ignore
25572 @mindex @null
25573 @end ignore
25574 @kindex a ]
25575 @pindex calc-less-than
25576 @pindex calc-greater-than
25577 @pindex calc-less-equal
25578 @pindex calc-greater-equal
25579 @ignore
25580 @mindex @null
25581 @end ignore
25582 @tindex gt
25583 @ignore
25584 @mindex @null
25585 @end ignore
25586 @tindex leq
25587 @ignore
25588 @mindex @null
25589 @end ignore
25590 @tindex geq
25591 @ignore
25592 @mindex @null
25593 @end ignore
25594 @tindex <
25595 @ignore
25596 @mindex @null
25597 @end ignore
25598 @tindex >
25599 @ignore
25600 @mindex @null
25601 @end ignore
25602 @tindex <=
25603 @ignore
25604 @mindex @null
25605 @end ignore
25606 @tindex >=
25607 The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25608 operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25609 are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25610 @kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25611 @kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25612
25613 While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25614 than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25615 equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25616 (See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25617 of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25618 of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25619 @samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25620 involve both equations and inequalities, are not allowed.
25621
25622 @kindex a .
25623 @pindex calc-remove-equal
25624 @tindex rmeq
25625 The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25626 the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25627 stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25628 @samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25629 @samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25630 variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25631 Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25632 assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25633 righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25634 taking the lefthand side.
25635
25636 @kindex a &
25637 @pindex calc-logical-and
25638 @tindex land
25639 @tindex &&
25640 The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25641 function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25642 non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25643 @expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25644 zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25645
25646 @kindex a |
25647 @pindex calc-logical-or
25648 @tindex lor
25649 @tindex ||
25650 The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25651 function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25652 The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25653 are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25654 zero.
25655
25656 @kindex a !
25657 @pindex calc-logical-not
25658 @tindex lnot
25659 @tindex !
25660 The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25661 function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25662 true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25663 number.
25664
25665 @kindex a :
25666 @pindex calc-logical-if
25667 @tindex if
25668 @ignore
25669 @mindex ? :
25670 @end ignore
25671 @tindex ?
25672 @ignore
25673 @mindex @null
25674 @end ignore
25675 @tindex :
25676 @cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25677 The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25678 function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25679 number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25680 left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25681 any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25682 whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25683 is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25684 @code{condition}.
25685
25686 One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25687 will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25688 as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25689 @samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25690
25691 As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25692 and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25693 as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25694 @expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25695 is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25696 vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25697 with all elements of @expr{a}.
25698
25699 @kindex a @{
25700 @pindex calc-in-set
25701 @tindex in
25702 The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25703 the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25704 If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25705 encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25706 equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25707 intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25708 plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25709 @xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25710 of this sort.
25711
25712 @ignore
25713 @starindex
25714 @end ignore
25715 @tindex typeof
25716 The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25717 characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25718 the result will be one of the following numbers:
25719
25720 @example
25721 1 Integer
25722 2 Fraction
25723 3 Floating-point number
25724 4 HMS form
25725 5 Rectangular complex number
25726 6 Polar complex number
25727 7 Error form
25728 8 Interval form
25729 9 Modulo form
25730 10 Date-only form
25731 11 Date/time form
25732 12 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25733 100 Variable
25734 101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25735 102 Matrix
25736 @end example
25737
25738 Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25739 represents the name of the top-level function call.
25740
25741 @ignore
25742 @starindex
25743 @end ignore
25744 @tindex integer
25745 @ignore
25746 @starindex
25747 @end ignore
25748 @tindex real
25749 @ignore
25750 @starindex
25751 @end ignore
25752 @tindex constant
25753 The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25754 The @samp{real(a)} function
25755 is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25756 float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25757 any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25758 code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25759 an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25760 Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25761 special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25762
25763 @xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25764 formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25765 is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25766 @samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25767 literally an integer constant.
25768
25769 @ignore
25770 @starindex
25771 @end ignore
25772 @tindex refers
25773 The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25774 @expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25775 tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25776 even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25777 @code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25778 variable (different from @expr{b}).
25779
25780 @ignore
25781 @starindex
25782 @end ignore
25783 @tindex negative
25784 The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25785 because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25786 or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25787 This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25788 evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25789 be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25790 first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25791 as a rewrite rule condition).
25792
25793 @ignore
25794 @starindex
25795 @end ignore
25796 @tindex variable
25797 The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25798 or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25799 in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25800 are considered variables like any others by this test.
25801
25802 @ignore
25803 @starindex
25804 @end ignore
25805 @tindex nonvar
25806 The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25807 If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25808 actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25809 commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25810 often good enough.
25811
25812 @ignore
25813 @starindex
25814 @end ignore
25815 @tindex lin
25816 @ignore
25817 @starindex
25818 @end ignore
25819 @tindex linnt
25820 @ignore
25821 @starindex
25822 @end ignore
25823 @tindex islin
25824 @ignore
25825 @starindex
25826 @end ignore
25827 @tindex islinnt
25828 @cindex Linearity testing
25829 The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25830 check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25831 @expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25832 variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25833 if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25834 example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25835 @samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25836 is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25837 @expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25838 @expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25839 @expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25840 generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25841 e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25842 argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25843 returns true.
25844
25845 The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25846 but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25847 @expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25848 returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25849 but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25850 (in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25851 linear in @expr{x}).
25852
25853 All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25854 argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25855 formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25856 trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25857 recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25858 @samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25859 returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25860 first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25861 @code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25862 case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25863
25864 @ignore
25865 @starindex
25866 @end ignore
25867 @tindex istrue
25868 The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25869 number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25870 Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25871 used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25872 declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25873 @code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
25874 it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
25875 in symbolic form.)
25876
25877 @node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
25878 @section Rewrite Rules
25879
25880 @noindent
25881 @cindex Rewrite rules
25882 @cindex Transformations
25883 @cindex Pattern matching
25884 @kindex a r
25885 @pindex calc-rewrite
25886 @tindex rewrite
25887 The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
25888 substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
25889 known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
25890 matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
25891 matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
25892 rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
25893 @samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
25894 it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
25895 name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
25896
25897 Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
25898 @xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
25899 similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
25900 entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
25901 Calc formulas.
25902
25903 @menu
25904 * Entering Rewrite Rules::
25905 * Basic Rewrite Rules::
25906 * Conditional Rewrite Rules::
25907 * Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
25908 * Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
25909 * Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
25910 * Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
25911 * Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
25912 * Selections with Rewrite Rules::
25913 * Matching Commands::
25914 * Automatic Rewrites::
25915 * Debugging Rewrites::
25916 * Examples of Rewrite Rules::
25917 @end menu
25918
25919 @node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25920 @subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
25921
25922 @noindent
25923 Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
25924 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
25925 This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
25926 The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
25927 assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
25928 Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
25929 assignments in special ways.
25930
25931 For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
25932 every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
25933 square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
25934 on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
25935 it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
25936
25937 To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
25938 rules.
25939
25940 When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
25941 in several ways:
25942
25943 @enumerate
25944 @item
25945 With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
25946 @item
25947 With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
25948 (You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
25949 @item
25950 With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
25951 @kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
25952 @item
25953 With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
25954 will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
25955 and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
25956 @kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
25957 @item
25958 With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
25959 will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
25960 rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
25961 @end enumerate
25962
25963 If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
25964 in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
25965 can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
25966
25967 It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
25968 invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
25969 (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
25970 rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
25971 (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
25972 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
25973
25974 Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
25975 matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
25976 every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
25977 through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
25978 along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
25979 reason to store your rules in a variable.
25980
25981 Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
25982 @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
25983 vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
25984
25985 @node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25986 @subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
25987
25988 @noindent
25989 To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
25990 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
25991 the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
25992 treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
25993 may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
25994 would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
25995 @samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
25996 @samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
25997 @samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
25998 that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
25999 the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
26000
26001 If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
26002 corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
26003 the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
26004 @samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
26005 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
26006
26007 Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
26008 and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
26009 the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
26010 pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
26011 @samp{sin(a)+y}.
26012
26013 The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
26014 @samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
26015 literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
26016 @samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
26017
26018 If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
26019 formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
26020 of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
26021 that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
26022 to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
26023
26024 The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
26025 throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
26026 (up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
26027 change at a time.
26028
26029 @node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26030 @subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
26031
26032 @noindent
26033 A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
26034 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
26035 form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
26036 is present in the
26037 rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
26038 the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
26039 to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
26040 meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
26041 with Calc's algebraic simplifications. If the result is a nonzero
26042 number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
26043 the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
26044 formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
26045 @xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
26046 1 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
26047
26048 For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
26049 is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
26050 @expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
26051 the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
26052 @samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
26053 (assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
26054 @samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
26055 the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
26056 to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
26057
26058 While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
26059 formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
26060 For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
26061 of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
26062 @samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
26063 meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
26064 @samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
26065 reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
26066 the condition.
26067
26068 The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
26069 function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
26070 the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
26071
26072 If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
26073 or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
26074
26075 It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
26076 @samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
26077 convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
26078 effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
26079 decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
26080 matched.
26081
26082 Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
26083 system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
26084 meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
26085 @samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
26086 is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
26087 replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
26088 where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
26089 @samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
26090 since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
26091
26092 An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
26093 will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
26094 because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
26095 evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
26096 remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
26097 number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
26098 But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
26099 is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
26100 evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
26101
26102 Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
26103 condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
26104 For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
26105 the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
26106 where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
26107 lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
26108 the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
26109 the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
26110 it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
26111
26112 @node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26113 @subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
26114
26115 @noindent
26116 The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
26117 like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
26118 the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
26119 account:
26120
26121 @smallexample
26122 + - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
26123 @end smallexample
26124
26125 For example, the rewrite rule:
26126
26127 @example
26128 a x + b x := (a + b) x
26129 @end example
26130
26131 @noindent
26132 will match formulas of the form,
26133
26134 @example
26135 a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
26136 @end example
26137
26138 Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
26139 operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
26140
26141 @example
26142 a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
26143 @end example
26144
26145 @noindent
26146 by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
26147
26148 Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
26149 pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
26150 will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
26151
26152 In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
26153 will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
26154 like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
26155 of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
26156 being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
26157 If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
26158 four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
26159 like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
26160
26161 Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
26162 rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
26163 Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
26164 literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
26165 current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
26166 if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
26167 If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
26168 enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
26169 from occurring.
26170
26171 The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
26172 the rule
26173
26174 @example
26175 f(-x) := -f(x)
26176 @end example
26177
26178 @noindent
26179 will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
26180 a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
26181 condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
26182 ``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
26183 because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
26184 condition is:
26185
26186 @example
26187 f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
26188 f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
26189 @end example
26190
26191 In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
26192 by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
26193
26194 The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
26195 @samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
26196 will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
26197 @samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
26198
26199 Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
26200 @samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
26201 @samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
26202 though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
26203 Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
26204 constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
26205 and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
26206 because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
26207 for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
26208 of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
26209
26210 Even more subtle is the rule set
26211
26212 @example
26213 [ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
26214 @end example
26215
26216 @noindent
26217 attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
26218 will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
26219 the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
26220 Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
26221 first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
26222 does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
26223 meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
26224 not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
26225 tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
26226 @samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
26227 rule will have to be added.
26228
26229 Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
26230 The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
26231 involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
26232 it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
26233 of the above rule for complex numbers would be
26234
26235 @example
26236 myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
26237 @end example
26238
26239 @noindent
26240 (Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
26241 of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
26242 @samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
26243 without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
26244 righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
26245 conjugate of a real number.)
26246
26247 It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
26248
26249 @example
26250 opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
26251 @end example
26252
26253 @noindent
26254 will match the formula
26255
26256 @example
26257 5 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26258 @end example
26259
26260 @noindent
26261 in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26262 formulas like
26263
26264 @example
26265 x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26266 @end example
26267
26268 @noindent
26269 producing, respectively,
26270
26271 @example
26272 f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26273 @end example
26274
26275 (The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26276 have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26277
26278 The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26279 for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26280 quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26281 with @samp{a = -1}.
26282
26283 In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26284
26285 @example
26286 opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26287 @end example
26288
26289 @noindent
26290 so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26291
26292 The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26293 are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26294 functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26295 Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26296 rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26297 @samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26298 but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26299 for a multiplication, not a division.
26300
26301 As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26302 by 1,
26303
26304 @example
26305 sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26306 @end example
26307
26308 @noindent
26309 misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26310 an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26311
26312 @example
26313 opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26314 @end example
26315
26316 Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26317 because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26318
26319 Calc automatically converts a rule like
26320
26321 @example
26322 f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26323 @end example
26324
26325 @noindent
26326 into the form
26327
26328 @example
26329 f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26330 @end example
26331
26332 @noindent
26333 (where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26334 doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26335 match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26336 respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26337 @samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26338
26339 However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26340 following rule,
26341
26342 @example
26343 f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26344 @end example
26345
26346 @noindent
26347 will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26348 but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26349 of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26350 then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26351 last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26352 := g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26353 actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26354
26355 A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26356 You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26357 @code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26358
26359 @example
26360 f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26361 @end example
26362
26363 Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26364 which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26365 only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26366 elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26367 careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26368 which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26369 @samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26370 @samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26371
26372 @smallexample
26373 + - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26374 max min re im conj arg
26375 @end smallexample
26376
26377 You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26378 section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26379 This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26380 matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26381 negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26382 ``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26383 For example,
26384
26385 @example
26386 plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26387 @end example
26388
26389 @noindent
26390 will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26391 marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26392 commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26393 the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26394 @samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26395 further and use
26396
26397 @example
26398 plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26399 @end example
26400
26401 @noindent
26402 which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26403
26404 By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26405 function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26406 The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26407
26408 @example
26409 quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26410 @end example
26411
26412 @noindent
26413 will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26414
26415 @example
26416 quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26417 @end example
26418
26419 @noindent
26420 will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26421 effect!
26422
26423 A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26424 meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26425 in the rule
26426
26427 @example
26428 a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26429 @end example
26430
26431 @noindent
26432 matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26433 taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26434 righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26435 the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26436 special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26437 default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26438 a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26439 If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26440 marker on the righthand side:
26441
26442 @example
26443 a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26444 @end example
26445
26446 @noindent
26447 In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26448 use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26449 always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26450
26451 @node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26452 @subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26453
26454 @noindent
26455 Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26456 Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26457 markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26458 work in the righthand side of a rule.
26459
26460 @ignore
26461 @starindex
26462 @end ignore
26463 @tindex import
26464 One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26465 rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26466 rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26467 imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26468 f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26469 then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26470 all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26471 slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26472 the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26473 @texline @math{v_1},
26474 @infoline @expr{v1},
26475 as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26476 @texline @math{x_1}
26477 @infoline @expr{x1}
26478 and so on. (If
26479 @texline @math{v_1}
26480 @infoline @expr{v1}
26481 is used as a function name, then
26482 @texline @math{x_1}
26483 @infoline @expr{x1}
26484 must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26485 function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26486 import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26487 @samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26488 import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26489
26490 The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26491
26492 @table @samp
26493 @item quote(x)
26494 @ignore
26495 @starindex
26496 @end ignore
26497 @tindex quote
26498 This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26499 not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26500 numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26501 @samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26502 (Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26503 The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26504 The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26505 as a result in this case.)
26506
26507 @item plain(x)
26508 @ignore
26509 @starindex
26510 @end ignore
26511 @tindex plain
26512 Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26513 pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26514 argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26515 function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26516 associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26517 are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26518 as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26519 @samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26520
26521 @item opt(x,def)
26522 @ignore
26523 @starindex
26524 @end ignore
26525 @tindex opt
26526 Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26527 argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26528 the argument or element is optional.
26529 As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26530 or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26531 may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26532 binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26533 matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26534 zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26535
26536 For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26537 must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26538 the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26539 @samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26540 or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26541 supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26542 the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26543 case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26544 In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26545
26546 @item condition(x,c)
26547 @ignore
26548 @starindex
26549 @end ignore
26550 @tindex condition
26551 @tindex ::
26552 This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26553 @expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26554
26555 @item pand(x,y)
26556 @ignore
26557 @starindex
26558 @end ignore
26559 @tindex pand
26560 @tindex &&&
26561 This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26562 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26563 @pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26564
26565 @item por(x,y)
26566 @ignore
26567 @starindex
26568 @end ignore
26569 @tindex por
26570 @tindex |||
26571 This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26572 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26573
26574 @item pnot(x)
26575 @ignore
26576 @starindex
26577 @end ignore
26578 @tindex pnot
26579 @tindex !!!
26580 This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26581 It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26582
26583 @item cons(h,t)
26584 @ignore
26585 @mindex cons
26586 @end ignore
26587 @tindex cons (rewrites)
26588 This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26589 element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26590 elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26591 length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26592 @samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26593 to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26594
26595 @item rcons(t,h)
26596 @ignore
26597 @mindex rcons
26598 @end ignore
26599 @tindex rcons (rewrites)
26600 This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26601 is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26602 to @expr{t}.
26603
26604 @item apply(f,args)
26605 @ignore
26606 @mindex apply
26607 @end ignore
26608 @tindex apply (rewrites)
26609 This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26610 the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26611 of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26612 matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26613 do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26614 @samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26615 matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26616 matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26617 @samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26618 to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26619 way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26620 need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26621 would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26622 Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26623
26624 @example
26625 apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26626 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26627 @end example
26628
26629 Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26630 set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26631 the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26632 if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26633 rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26634 function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26635 the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26636
26637 Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26638 considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26639 with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26640
26641 You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26642 on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26643 is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26644 @samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26645 Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26646 when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26647 evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26648 Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26649 or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26650 @xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26651
26652 @item select(x)
26653 @ignore
26654 @starindex
26655 @end ignore
26656 @tindex select
26657 This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26658 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26659 @end table
26660
26661 Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26662
26663 @table @samp
26664 @item quote(x)
26665 The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26666 righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26667 @code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26668 property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26669 while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26670 on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26671 to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26672 protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26673 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26674 protecting rules from evaluation.)
26675
26676 @item plain(x)
26677 Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26678 @expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26679 is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26680 shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26681 not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26682 @samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26683 rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26684
26685 @item cons(h,t)
26686 Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26687 vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26688 Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26689 is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26690 side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26691 have been turned off.
26692
26693 @item rcons(t,h)
26694 Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26695 the vector @expr{t}.
26696
26697 @item apply(f,args)
26698 Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26699 is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26700 is also a regular Calc function.
26701
26702 @item eval(x)
26703 @ignore
26704 @starindex
26705 @end ignore
26706 @tindex eval
26707 The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26708 default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26709 been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26710 similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26711 treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26712 with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26713 whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26714
26715 @item evalsimp(x)
26716 @ignore
26717 @starindex
26718 @end ignore
26719 @tindex evalsimp
26720 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26721 way, then algebraically simplified.
26722
26723 @item evalextsimp(x)
26724 @ignore
26725 @starindex
26726 @end ignore
26727 @tindex evalextsimp
26728 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26729 way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26730
26731 @item select(x)
26732 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26733 @end table
26734
26735 There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26736
26737 @table @samp
26738 @item let(v := x)
26739 @ignore
26740 @starindex
26741 @end ignore
26742 @tindex let
26743 The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26744 The algebraic simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26745 default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26746 @code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26747 of simplification. The result of @expr{x} is then bound to the
26748 meta-variable @expr{v}. As usual, if this meta-variable has already
26749 been matched to something else the two values must be equal; if the
26750 meta-variable is new then it is bound to the result of the expression.
26751 This variable can then appear in later conditions, and on the righthand
26752 side of the rule.
26753 In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26754 evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26755 meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26756 can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26757 @samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26758 an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26759
26760 The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26761 Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26762 assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26763 in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26764
26765 As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26766 replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26767 that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26768 singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26769 @samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26770 then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26771 to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26772 Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26773 in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26774 because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26775 be bound to @code{ia}.
26776
26777 Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26778 terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26779 The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26780 or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26781 call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26782 so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26783 the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26784 (It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26785 righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26786 rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26787
26788 @ignore
26789 @starindex
26790 @end ignore
26791 @tindex ierf
26792 Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26793 function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26794 @code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26795 where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26796 is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26797 @code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26798
26799 @example
26800 ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26801 @end example
26802
26803 @item matches(v,p)
26804 The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26805 to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26806 @var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26807 can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26808 as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26809 extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26810 inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26811 rule.
26812
26813 The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26814 @samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26815 the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26816
26817 @item remember
26818 @vindex remember
26819 This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26820 appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26821 the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26822 front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26823 was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26824 lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26825 contains any variables.
26826
26827 For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26828 to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26829 of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26830 differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26831 the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26832 Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26833
26834 It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26835 @code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26836 :: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26837 the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26838 @code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26839 be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26840 @code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26841
26842 @item remember(c)
26843 @ignore
26844 @starindex
26845 @end ignore
26846 @tindex remember
26847 Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26848 is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26849 rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26850 is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26851 @end table
26852
26853 @node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26854 @subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26855
26856 @noindent
26857 There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26858 that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26859 combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26860 these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26861 and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26862
26863 Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26864 form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26865 the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26866
26867 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26868 matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26869 when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26870 here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26871
26872 @example
26873 f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
26874 @end example
26875
26876 This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
26877
26878 @example
26879 f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
26880 @end example
26881
26882 @ignore
26883 @starindex
26884 @end ignore
26885 @tindex ends
26886 Here's another interesting example:
26887
26888 @example
26889 ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
26890 @end example
26891
26892 @noindent
26893 which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
26894 the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
26895 vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
26896
26897 @example
26898 ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
26899 @end example
26900
26901 @noindent
26902 would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
26903 one-element vector.
26904
26905 @tex
26906 \bigskip
26907 @end tex
26908
26909 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
26910 matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
26911 against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
26912
26913 @ignore
26914 @starindex
26915 @end ignore
26916 @tindex curve
26917 A simple example of @samp{|||} is
26918
26919 @example
26920 curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
26921 @end example
26922
26923 @noindent
26924 which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
26925
26926 Here is a larger example:
26927
26928 @example
26929 log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
26930 @end example
26931
26932 This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
26933 Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
26934 that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
26935
26936 (In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
26937 omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
26938
26939 While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
26940 conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
26941 variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
26942 bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
26943 @samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
26944 condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
26945 Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
26946 @code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
26947
26948 Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
26949 on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
26950 you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
26951 meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
26952
26953 @example
26954 f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
26955 @end example
26956
26957 Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
26958 the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
26959
26960 @tex
26961 \bigskip
26962 @end tex
26963
26964 The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
26965 match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
26966 @var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
26967
26968 For example,
26969
26970 @example
26971 f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
26972 @end example
26973
26974 @noindent
26975 converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
26976 error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
26977 a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
26978
26979 If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
26980 then an equivalent rule would be:
26981
26982 @example
26983 f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
26984 @end example
26985
26986 @noindent
26987 where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
26988 Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
26989 would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
26990 returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
26991 plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
26992 @samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
26993 the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
26994
26995 It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
26996 elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
26997
26998 @example
26999 f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
27000 @end example
27001
27002 @noindent
27003 matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
27004 this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
27005
27006 If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
27007 contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
27008 matched last. Thus
27009
27010 @example
27011 f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
27012 @end example
27013
27014 @noindent
27015 will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
27016 before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
27017 first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
27018 disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
27019 would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
27020 therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
27021
27022 @node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27023 @subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
27024
27025 @noindent
27026 When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
27027 the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
27028 to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
27029 and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
27030 For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
27031 they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
27032 sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
27033 to the @var{new} part of the rule.
27034
27035 Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
27036 The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
27037 it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
27038 so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
27039 rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
27040 (in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
27041 to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
27042 anywhere in the formula.
27043
27044 It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
27045 most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
27046 because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
27047 side actually comes out to something different than the original
27048 formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
27049 had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
27050 @samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
27051 run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
27052 forms.
27053
27054 To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
27055 made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
27056 but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
27057 computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
27058 halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
27059
27060 To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
27061 In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
27062 useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
27063 rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
27064
27065 @ignore
27066 @starindex
27067 @end ignore
27068 @ignore
27069 @mindex iter@idots
27070 @end ignore
27071 @tindex iterations
27072 You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
27073 in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
27074 the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
27075 number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
27076 @samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
27077 A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
27078 rule set.
27079
27080 @example
27081 [ iterations(1),
27082 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
27083 @end example
27084
27085 More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
27086 where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
27087 righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
27088 default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
27089 that was matched.
27090
27091 A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
27092
27093 Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
27094 substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
27095 will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
27096
27097 In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
27098 does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
27099 being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
27100 variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
27101 iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
27102 integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
27103 the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
27104 are omitted, 100 is used.
27105
27106 @node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27107 @subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
27108
27109 @noindent
27110 It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
27111 During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
27112 will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
27113 phases occur during the rewriting process.
27114
27115 @ignore
27116 @starindex
27117 @end ignore
27118 @tindex phase
27119 @vindex all
27120 If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
27121 vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
27122 members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
27123 Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
27124 @samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
27125 this is the default at the start of the rule set.
27126
27127 If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
27128 numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
27129 ascending order. For example, the rule set
27130
27131 @example
27132 @group
27133 [ f0(x) := g0(x),
27134 phase(1),
27135 f1(x) := g1(x),
27136 phase(2),
27137 f2(x) := g2(x),
27138 phase(3),
27139 f3(x) := g3(x),
27140 phase(1,2),
27141 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
27142 @end group
27143 @end example
27144
27145 @noindent
27146 has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
27147 @code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
27148 @code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
27149 and @code{f3}.
27150
27151 When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
27152 the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
27153 possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
27154 until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
27155 When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
27156 assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
27157 rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
27158 early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
27159 100 by default, is reached.)
27160
27161 During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
27162 formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
27163 Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
27164 way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
27165 The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
27166 in the formula.
27167
27168 @ignore
27169 @starindex
27170 @end ignore
27171 @tindex schedule
27172 A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
27173 conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
27174 In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
27175 for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
27176 arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
27177 @samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
27178 reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
27179 no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
27180 would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
27181 moving on to phase 3.
27182
27183 Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
27184 numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
27185 described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
27186 in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
27187 tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
27188 to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
27189 further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
27190 touches.
27191
27192 Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
27193 numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
27194 to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
27195 says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
27196 call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
27197 Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
27198 phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
27199
27200 Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
27201 a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
27202 and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
27203 will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
27204 Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
27205 spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
27206
27207 There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
27208 rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
27209 examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
27210 command to convert a model expression to linear form.
27211 @xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
27212 The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
27213 easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
27214 linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
27215 opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
27216 If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
27217 into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
27218
27219 Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
27220 then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
27221 fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
27222 If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
27223 rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
27224 before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
27225 two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
27226
27227 @node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27228 @subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
27229
27230 @noindent
27231 If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
27232 @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
27233 command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
27234 prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
27235 specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
27236
27237 @kindex j r
27238 @pindex calc-rewrite-selection
27239 The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
27240 sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
27241 the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
27242 rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
27243 of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
27244 first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
27245 (Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
27246 this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
27247
27248 For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
27249 and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
27250 be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
27251 rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
27252 include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
27253 the selected sub-formula should appear.
27254
27255 If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
27256 the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27257 the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27258 formula will be unselected.
27259
27260 You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27261 of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27262 allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27263 Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27264 the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27265 work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27266 to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27267 stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27268
27269 The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27270 @kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27271 argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27272 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27273
27274 As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27275 entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27276 @samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27277 at stack level 1.)
27278
27279 If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27280 top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27281 cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27282 rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27283 target and the rewrite rules).
27284
27285 If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27286 the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27287 command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27288 the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27289 markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27290 to apply anywhere in the formula.
27291
27292 As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27293 @samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27294 above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27295 the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27296 purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27297 will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27298 both with and without selections.
27299
27300 @node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27301 @subsection Matching Commands
27302
27303 @noindent
27304 @kindex a m
27305 @pindex calc-match
27306 @tindex match
27307 The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27308 vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27309 a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27310 prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27311 a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27312 vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27313 you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27314 from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27315 and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27316 patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27317 of the patterns.
27318
27319 For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27320 will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27321
27322 The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27323
27324 The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27325 which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27326 all the positive vector elements.
27327
27328 @kindex I a m
27329 @tindex matchnot
27330 With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27331 vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27332
27333 @ignore
27334 @starindex
27335 @end ignore
27336 @tindex matches
27337 There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27338 evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27339 to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27340 conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27341
27342 @ignore
27343 @starindex
27344 @end ignore
27345 @tindex vmatches
27346 The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27347 that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27348 the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27349 @samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27350 If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27351
27352 @node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27353 @subsection Automatic Rewrites
27354
27355 @noindent
27356 @cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27357 @vindex EvalRules
27358 It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27359 results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27360 simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27361 variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27362 for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27363
27364 For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27365 to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27366 similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27367 set would be,
27368
27369 @smallexample
27370 @group
27371 [ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27372 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27373 @end group
27374 @end smallexample
27375
27376 To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27377 @code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27378 to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27379 variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27380 sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27381 the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27382 @samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27383
27384 As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27385 @code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27386 Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27387 Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27388 rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27389 the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27390 applies rules from the top down.
27391
27392 Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27393 override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27394
27395 It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27396 loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27397 appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27398 unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27399 will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27400 zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27401 Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27402 @samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27403 @samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27404 occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27405 or ran too long'' message.
27406
27407 Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27408 concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27409 example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27410 already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27411 if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27412 further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27413 get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27414 replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27415 @samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27416 continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27417 to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27418 again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27419 say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27420
27421 (What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27422 meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27423 result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27424 the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27425 (and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27426 form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27427 same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27428 are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27429 this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27430 see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27431 rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27432 the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27433 the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27434
27435 The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27436 not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27437 only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27438 The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27439
27440 The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27441 but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27442 nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27443 to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27444 might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27445 to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27446 rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27447 will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27448
27449 Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27450 functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27451 When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27452 functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27453 number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27454 the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27455 than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27456 @code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27457 would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27458 @samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27459 root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27460 number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27461 then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27462 evaluated exactly to 5.)
27463
27464 One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27465 @code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27466 of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27467 effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27468 then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27469 reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27470 For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27471 attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27472 the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27473 an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27474 a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27475 @samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27476 been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27477
27478 If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27479 anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27480
27481 Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27482 rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27483 @code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27484 particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27485 function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27486 only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27487 but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27488
27489 @smallexample
27490 apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27491 @end smallexample
27492
27493 @noindent
27494 may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27495 @code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27496 with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27497 @emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27498
27499 @cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27500 @vindex AlgSimpRules
27501 Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27502 but only when algebraic simplifications are used to simplify the
27503 formula. The variable @code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose.
27504 The @kbd{a s} command will apply @code{EvalRules} and
27505 @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as well as all of its built-in
27506 simplifications.
27507
27508 Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27509 @code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27510 command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of algebraic
27511 simplifications. It then applies its own built-in simplifications
27512 throughout the formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with
27513 applying the default simplifications) until no further changes are
27514 possible.
27515
27516 @cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27517 @cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27518 @vindex ExtSimpRules
27519 @vindex UnitSimpRules
27520 There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27521 that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27522 also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27523 @code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27524 only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27525
27526 @node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27527 @subsection Debugging Rewrites
27528
27529 @noindent
27530 If a buffer named @samp{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27531 record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27532 formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27533 and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27534 noted.
27535
27536 Calc always appends to @samp{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27537 yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27538
27539 Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27540 @samp{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27541 the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27542 buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27543 existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27544 be needlessly slow.
27545
27546 @node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27547 @subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27548
27549 @noindent
27550 Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27551 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27552 @samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27553 finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27554 @samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27555 if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27556 but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27557
27558 Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27559 To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27560 easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27561 you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27562 select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27563 ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27564 (@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27565
27566 A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27567 This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27568 be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27569 @samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27570 Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27571 evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27572 useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27573 @samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27574
27575 As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27576 with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27577 this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27578 a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27579 to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27580 stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27581 be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27582 the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27583 the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27584 @code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27585
27586 @cindex Quaternions
27587 The following rule set, contributed by
27588 @texline Fran\c cois
27589 @infoline Francois
27590 Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27591 complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27592 represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27593 @var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27594 collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27595 are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27596 or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27597 formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27598 defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27599 @key{RET}}.
27600
27601 @smallexample
27602 [ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27603 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27604 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27605 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27606 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27607 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27608 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27609 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27610 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27611 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27612 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27613 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27614 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27615 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27616 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27617 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27618 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27619 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27620 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27621 @end smallexample
27622
27623 Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27624 In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27625 @expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27626 rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27627 product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27628 to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27629 operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27630
27631 These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27632 it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27633 results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27634 @samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27635 of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27636 in @code{EvalRules}.)
27637
27638 @node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27639 @chapter Operating on Units
27640
27641 @noindent
27642 One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27643 For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27644 per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27645 manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27646 begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27647
27648 @menu
27649 * Basic Operations on Units::
27650 * The Units Table::
27651 * Predefined Units::
27652 * User-Defined Units::
27653 * Logarithmic Units::
27654 * Musical Notes::
27655 @end menu
27656
27657 @node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27658 @section Basic Operations on Units
27659
27660 @noindent
27661 A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27662 multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27663 optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27664 be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27665 expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27666 where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27667 formula.
27668
27669 A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27670 or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27671 or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27672 A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27673 @pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27674 @pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27675
27676 Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27677 it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27678 formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27679 display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27680 representation of one millimeter.
27681
27682 You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27683 with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27684 to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27685
27686 @kindex u s
27687 @pindex calc-simplify-units
27688 @ignore
27689 @mindex usimpl@idots
27690 @end ignore
27691 @tindex usimplify
27692 The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27693 simplifies a units
27694 expression. It uses Calc's algebraic simplifications to simplify the
27695 expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27696 features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27697 to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27698 simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27699 added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27700 lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27701 automatically at all times.
27702
27703 Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27704 dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27705 powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27706 @samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27707 @code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27708 @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27709 applied to units expressions, in which case
27710 the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27711 expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27712 of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27713
27714 @kindex u c
27715 @pindex calc-convert-units
27716 The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27717 expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27718 expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27719 @samp{24.5872 m/s}. If you have previously converted a units expression
27720 with the same type of units (in this case, distance over time), you will
27721 be offered the previous choice of new units as a default. Continuing
27722 the above example, entering the units expression @samp{100 km/hr} and
27723 typing @kbd{u c @key{RET}} (without specifying new units) produces
27724 @samp{27.7777777778 m/s}.
27725
27726 @kindex u t
27727 @pindex calc-convert-temperature
27728 @cindex Temperature conversion
27729 The @kbd{u c} command treats temperature units (like @samp{degC} and
27730 @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example, @kbd{u c} converts
27731 @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10 degrees Celsius
27732 corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit. To convert absolute
27733 temperatures, you can use the @kbd{u t}
27734 (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command. The value on the stack
27735 must be a simple units expression with units of temperature only.
27736 This command would convert @samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the
27737 equivalent temperature on the Fahrenheit scale.
27738
27739 While many of Calc's conversion factors are exact, some are necessarily
27740 approximate. If Calc is in fraction mode (@pxref{Fraction Mode}), then
27741 unit conversions will try to give exact, rational conversions, but it
27742 isn't always possible. Given @samp{55 mph} in fraction mode, typing
27743 @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces @samp{15367:625 m/s}, for example,
27744 while typing @kbd{u c au/yr @key{RET}} produces
27745 @samp{5.18665819999e-3 au/yr}.
27746
27747 If the units you request are inconsistent with the original units, the
27748 number will be converted into your units times whatever ``remainder''
27749 units are left over. For example, converting @samp{55 mph} into acres
27750 produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}. (Recall that multiplication binds
27751 more strongly than division in Calc formulas, so the units here are
27752 acres per meter-second.) Remainder units are expressed in terms of
27753 ``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and @samp{s}, regardless of the
27754 input units.
27755
27756 If you want to disallow using inconsistent units, you can set the customizable variable
27757 @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} to @code{t} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). In this case,
27758 if you request units which are inconsistent with the original units, you will be warned about
27759 it and no conversion will occur.
27760
27761 One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27762 a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27763 that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27764 remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27765 given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27766 change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27767 The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27768 changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27769
27770 You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27771 to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27772 For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27773 @kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27774 (For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27775 in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27776
27777 In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27778 units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27779 For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27780 International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27781 converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27782 except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27783 whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27784
27785 @cindex Composite units
27786 The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27787 are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27788 example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27789 feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27790 sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27791 It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27792 using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27793 to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27794 may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27795 standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27796 @code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27797 Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27798 @samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27799
27800 If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27801 prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27802 to have, then for the new units. Assuming the old and new units you
27803 give are consistent with each other, the result also will not contain
27804 any units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}}
27805 converts the number 2 on the stack to 5.08.
27806
27807 @kindex u b
27808 @pindex calc-base-units
27809 The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27810 @kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27811 stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27812 units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27813
27814 Like the @kbd{u c} command, the @kbd{u b} command treats temperature
27815 units as relative temperatures.
27816
27817 @kindex u r
27818 @pindex calc-remove-units
27819 @kindex u x
27820 @pindex calc-extract-units
27821 The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27822 formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27823 (@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27824 formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27825 that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27826 constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27827
27828 @kindex u a
27829 @pindex calc-autorange-units
27830 The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27831 mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27832 applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27833 range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27834 except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27835 will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27836 some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27837 undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27838 (Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27839
27840 Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27841 Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27842 than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27843 would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27844 Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27845 to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27846 exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27847 is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27848 Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27849 but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27850 ``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27851 @samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27852 Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27853 is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27854 be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27855 (1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27856
27857 @node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27858 @section The Units Table
27859
27860 @noindent
27861 @kindex u v
27862 @pindex calc-enter-units-table
27863 The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27864 in another buffer called @code{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27865 gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27866 of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27867 the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27868 units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27869 meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27870 and steradians.
27871
27872 The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27873 two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27874 prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
27875 prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
27876 or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
27877 wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
27878
27879 The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
27880 new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
27881 argument to @kbd{u v}.
27882
27883 @kindex u V
27884 @pindex calc-view-units-table
27885 The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
27886 that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
27887 type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
27888 return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{C-x * c}
27889 again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
27890 command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
27891 the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
27892
27893 @kindex u g
27894 @pindex calc-get-unit-definition
27895 The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
27896 defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
27897 @kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
27898 same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
27899 Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
27900 will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
27901 really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
27902 definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
27903 unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
27904
27905 @kindex u e
27906 @pindex calc-explain-units
27907 The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
27908 description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
27909 for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
27910 ``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
27911 command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
27912 column of the Units Table.
27913
27914 @node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
27915 @section Predefined Units
27916
27917 @noindent
27918 The definitions of many units have changed over the years. For example,
27919 the meter was originally defined in 1791 as one ten-millionth of the
27920 distance from the equator to the north pole. In order to be more
27921 precise, the definition was adjusted several times, and now a meter is
27922 defined as the distance that light will travel in a vacuum in
27923 1/299792458 of a second; consequently, the speed of light in a
27924 vacuum is exactly 299792458 m/s. Many other units have been
27925 redefined in terms of fundamental physical processes; a second, for
27926 example, is currently defined as 9192631770 periods of a certain
27927 radiation related to the cesium-133 atom. The only SI unit that is not
27928 based on a fundamental physical process (although there are efforts to
27929 change this) is the kilogram, which was originally defined as the mass
27930 of one liter of water, but is now defined as the mass of the
27931 International Prototype Kilogram (IPK), a cylinder of platinum-iridium
27932 kept at the Bureau International des Poids et Mesures in S@`evres,
27933 France. (There are several copies of the IPK throughout the world.)
27934 The British imperial units, once defined in terms of physical objects,
27935 were redefined in 1963 in terms of SI units. The US customary units,
27936 which were the same as British units until the British imperial system
27937 was created in 1824, were also defined in terms of the SI units in 1893.
27938 Because of these redefinitions, conversions between metric, British
27939 Imperial, and US customary units can often be done precisely.
27940
27941 Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
27942 years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
27943 their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
27944 unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
27945 different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
27946 Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
27947 note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
27948 ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
27949
27950 The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
27951 (Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
27952 temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
27953 command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
27954 of the various temperature scales.
27955
27956 The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
27957 @code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
27958
27959 The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
27960 @tex
27961 for \AA ngstroms.
27962 @end tex
27963 @ifnottex
27964 for Angstroms.
27965 @end ifnottex
27966
27967 The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
27968 a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. This is
27969 slightly different than the point defined by the American Typefounder's
27970 Association in 1886, but the point used by Calc has become standard
27971 largely due to its use by the PostScript page description language.
27972 There is also @code{texpt}, which stands for a printer's point as
27973 defined by the @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 texpt = 1 in}.
27974 Other units used by @TeX{} are available; they are @code{texpc} (a pica),
27975 @code{texbp} (a ``big point'', equal to a standard point which is larger
27976 than the point used by @TeX{}), @code{texdd} (a Didot point),
27977 @code{texcc} (a Cicero) and @code{texsp} (a scaled @TeX{} point,
27978 all dimensions representable in @TeX{} are multiples of this value).
27979
27980 When Calc is using the @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} language mode (@pxref{TeX
27981 and LaTeX Language Modes}), the @TeX{} specific unit names will not
27982 use the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
27983 @samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example. To avoid conflicts,
27984 the unit names for pint and parsec will simply be @samp{pint} and
27985 @samp{parsec} instead of @samp{pt} and @samp{pc}.
27986
27987
27988 The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
27989 because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
27990 @expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
27991 preferable to @code{e}.
27992
27993 The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
27994 one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
27995 Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
27996
27997 The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
27998 a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
27999
28000 The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
28001 time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
28002
28003 Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
28004 represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
28005 constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
28006 @samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
28007 meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
28008 the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
28009 in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
28010 units.
28011
28012 Two units, @code{pi} and @code{alpha} (the fine structure constant,
28013 approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
28014 commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
28015 values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
28016 number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
28017 convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
28018 ``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
28019 really is unitless.)
28020
28021 @c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
28022
28023 @node User-Defined Units, Logarithmic Units, Predefined Units, Units
28024 @section User-Defined Units
28025
28026 @noindent
28027 Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
28028 units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
28029
28030 @kindex u 0-9
28031 @pindex calc-quick-units
28032 @vindex Units
28033 @cindex @code{Units} variable
28034 @cindex Quick units
28035 To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
28036 expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
28037 through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
28038 to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
28039 number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
28040 specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
28041 first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
28042 stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
28043 to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
28044 is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
28045 expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
28046 to @samp{2.5 ft}.
28047
28048 The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
28049 Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
28050 variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
28051 a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
28052 @kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
28053 variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
28054
28055 @kindex u d
28056 @pindex calc-define-unit
28057 @cindex User-defined units
28058 The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
28059 expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
28060 user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
28061 typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
28062 16.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
28063 treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
28064 prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
28065 appear in the Units Table. If you wish the definition of this unit to
28066 be displayed in a special way in the Units Table buffer (such as with an
28067 asterisk to indicate an approximate value), then you can call this
28068 command with an argument, @kbd{C-u u d}; you will then also be prompted
28069 for a string that will be used to display the definition.
28070
28071 @kindex u u
28072 @pindex calc-undefine-unit
28073 The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
28074 unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
28075 however.
28076
28077 If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
28078 will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
28079 predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
28080 ``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
28081 @kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
28082
28083 To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
28084 as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
28085 other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
28086 You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
28087 defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
28088 will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
28089 Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
28090 each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
28091 @kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
28092
28093 Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
28094 possible to create user-defined temperature units.
28095
28096 @kindex u p
28097 @pindex calc-permanent-units
28098 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
28099 The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
28100 units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
28101 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so that the
28102 units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
28103 was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
28104 is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
28105 tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28106
28107 @node Logarithmic Units, Musical Notes, User-Defined Units, Units
28108 @section Logarithmic Units
28109
28110 The units @code{dB} (decibels) and @code{Np} (nepers) are logarithmic
28111 units which are manipulated differently than standard units. Calc
28112 provides commands to work with these logarithmic units.
28113
28114 Decibels and nepers are used to measure power quantities as well as
28115 field quantities (quantities whose squares are proportional to power);
28116 these two types of quantities are handled slightly different from each
28117 other. By default the Calc commands work as if power quantities are
28118 being used; with the @kbd{H} prefix the Calc commands work as if field
28119 quantities are being used.
28120
28121 The decibel level of a power
28122 @infoline @math{P1},
28123 @texline @math{P_1},
28124 relative to a reference power
28125 @infoline @math{P0},
28126 @texline @math{P_0},
28127 is defined to be
28128 @infoline @math{10 log10(P1/P0) dB}.
28129 @texline @math{10 \log_{10}(P_{1}/P_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28130 (The factor of 10 is because a decibel, as its name implies, is
28131 one-tenth of a bel. The bel, named after Alexander Graham Bell, was
28132 considered to be too large of a unit and was effectively replaced by
28133 the decibel.) If @math{F} is a field quantity with power
28134 @math{P=k F^2}, then a reference quantity of
28135 @infoline @math{F0}
28136 @texline @math{F_0}
28137 would correspond to a power of
28138 @infoline @math{P0=k F0^2}.
28139 @texline @math{P_{0}=kF_{0}^2}.
28140 If
28141 @infoline @math{P1=k F1^2},
28142 @texline @math{P_{1}=kF_{1}^2},
28143 then
28144
28145 @ifnottex
28146 @example
28147 10 log10(P1/P0) = 10 log10(F1^2/F0^2) = 20 log10(F1/F0).
28148 @end example
28149 @end ifnottex
28150 @tex
28151 $$ 10 \log_{10}(P_1/P_0) = 10 \log_{10}(F_1^2/F_0^2) = 20
28152 \log_{10}(F_1/F_0)$$
28153 @end tex
28154
28155 @noindent
28156 In order to get the same decibel level regardless of whether a field
28157 quantity or the corresponding power quantity is used, the decibel
28158 level of a field quantity
28159 @infoline @math{F1},
28160 @texline @math{F_1},
28161 relative to a reference
28162 @infoline @math{F0},
28163 @texline @math{F_0},
28164 is defined as
28165 @infoline @math{20 log10(F1/F0) dB}.
28166 @texline @math{20 \log_{10}(F_{1}/F_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28167 For example, the decibel value of a sound pressure level of
28168 @infoline @math{60 uPa}
28169 @texline @math{60 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28170 relative to
28171 @infoline @math{20 uPa}
28172 @texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28173 (the threshold of human hearing) is
28174 @infoline @math{20 log10(60 uPa/ 20 uPa) dB = 20 log10(3) dB},
28175 @texline @math{20 \log_{10}(60 \mu{\rm Pa}/20 \mu{\rm Pa}) {\rm dB} = 20 \log_{10}(3) {\rm dB}},
28176 which is about
28177 @infoline @math{9.54 dB}.
28178 @texline @math{9.54 {\rm dB}}.
28179 Note that in taking the ratio, the original units cancel and so these
28180 logarithmic units are dimensionless.
28181
28182 Nepers (named after John Napier, who is credited with inventing the
28183 logarithm) are similar to bels except they use natural logarithms instead
28184 of common logarithms. The neper level of a power
28185 @infoline @math{P1},
28186 @texline @math{P_1},
28187 relative to a reference power
28188 @infoline @math{P0},
28189 @texline @math{P_0},
28190 is
28191 @infoline @math{(1/2) ln(P1/P0) Np}.
28192 @texline @math{(1/2) \ln(P_1/P_0) {\rm Np}}.
28193 The neper level of a field
28194 @infoline @math{F1},
28195 @texline @math{F_1},
28196 relative to a reference field
28197 @infoline @math{F0},
28198 @texline @math{F_0},
28199 is
28200 @infoline @math{ln(F1/F0) Np}.
28201 @texline @math{\ln(F_1/F_0) {\rm Np}}.
28202
28203 @vindex calc-lu-power-reference
28204 @vindex calc-lu-field-reference
28205 For power quantities, Calc uses
28206 @infoline @math{1 mW}
28207 @texline @math{1 {\rm mW}}
28208 as the default reference quantity; this default can be changed by changing
28209 the value of the customizable variable
28210 @code{calc-lu-power-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
28211 For field quantities, Calc uses
28212 @infoline @math{20 uPa}
28213 @texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28214 as the default reference quantity; this is the value used in acoustics
28215 which is where decibels are commonly encountered. This default can be
28216 changed by changing the value of the customizable variable
28217 @code{calc-lu-field-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). A
28218 non-default reference quantity will be read from the stack if the
28219 capital @kbd{O} prefix is used.
28220
28221 @kindex l q
28222 @pindex calc-lu-quant
28223 @tindex lupquant
28224 @tindex lufquant
28225 The @kbd{l q} (@code{calc-lu-quant}) [@code{lupquant}]
28226 command computes the power quantity corresponding to a given number of
28227 logarithmic units. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix, @kbd{O l q}, the
28228 reference level will be read from the top of the stack. (In an
28229 algebraic formula, @code{lupquant} can be given an optional second
28230 argument which will be used for the reference level.) For example,
28231 @code{20 dB @key{RET} l q} will return @code{100 mW};
28232 @code{20 dB @key{RET} 4 W @key{RET} O l q} will return @code{400 W}.
28233 The @kbd{H l q} [@code{lufquant}] command behaves like @kbd{l q} but
28234 computes field quantities instead of power quantities.
28235
28236 @kindex l d
28237 @pindex calc-db
28238 @tindex dbpower
28239 @tindex dbfield
28240 @kindex l n
28241 @pindex calc-np
28242 @tindex nppower
28243 @tindex npfield
28244 The @kbd{l d} (@code{calc-db}) [@code{dbpower}] command will compute
28245 the decibel level of a power quantity using the default reference
28246 level; @kbd{H l d} [@code{dbfield}] will compute the decibel level of
28247 a field quantity. The commands @kbd{l n} (@code{calc-np})
28248 [@code{nppower}] and @kbd{H l n} [@code{npfield}] will similarly
28249 compute neper levels. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix these commands
28250 will read a reference level from the stack; in an algebraic formula
28251 the reference level can be given as an optional second argument.
28252
28253 @kindex l +
28254 @pindex calc-lu-plus
28255 @tindex lupadd
28256 @tindex lufadd
28257 @kindex l -
28258 @pindex calc-lu-minus
28259 @tindex lupsub
28260 @tindex lufsub
28261 @kindex l *
28262 @pindex calc-lu-times
28263 @tindex lupmul
28264 @tindex lufmul
28265 @kindex l /
28266 @pindex calc-lu-divide
28267 @tindex lupdiv
28268 @tindex lufdiv
28269 The sum of two power or field quantities doesn't correspond to the sum
28270 of the corresponding decibel or neper levels. If the powers
28271 corresponding to decibel levels
28272 @infoline @math{D1}
28273 @texline @math{D_1}
28274 and
28275 @infoline @math{D2}
28276 @texline @math{D_2}
28277 are added, the corresponding decibel level ``sum'' will be
28278
28279 @ifnottex
28280 @example
28281 10 log10(10^(D1/10) + 10^(D2/10)) dB.
28282 @end example
28283 @end ifnottex
28284 @tex
28285 $$ 10 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/10} + 10^{D_2/10}) {\rm dB}.$$
28286 @end tex
28287
28288 @noindent
28289 When field quantities are combined, it often means the corresponding
28290 powers are added and so the above formula might be used. In
28291 acoustics, for example, the sound pressure level is a field quantity
28292 and so the decibels are often defined using the field formula, but the
28293 sound pressure levels are combined as the sound power levels, and so
28294 the above formula should be used. If two field quantities themselves
28295 are added, the new decibel level will be
28296
28297 @ifnottex
28298 @example
28299 20 log10(10^(D1/20) + 10^(D2/20)) dB.
28300 @end example
28301 @end ifnottex
28302 @tex
28303 $$ 20 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/20} + 10^{D_2/20}) {\rm dB}.$$
28304 @end tex
28305
28306 @noindent
28307 If the power corresponding to @math{D} dB is multiplied by a number @math{N},
28308 then the corresponding decibel level will be
28309
28310 @ifnottex
28311 @example
28312 D + 10 log10(N) dB,
28313 @end example
28314 @end ifnottex
28315 @tex
28316 $$ D + 10 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB},$$
28317 @end tex
28318
28319 @noindent
28320 if a field quantity is multiplied by @math{N} the corresponding decibel level
28321 will be
28322
28323 @ifnottex
28324 @example
28325 D + 20 log10(N) dB.
28326 @end example
28327 @end ifnottex
28328 @tex
28329 $$ D + 20 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB}.$$
28330 @end tex
28331
28332 @noindent
28333 There are similar formulas for combining nepers. The @kbd{l +}
28334 (@code{calc-lu-plus}) [@code{lupadd}] command will ``add'' two
28335 logarithmic unit power levels this way; with the @kbd{H} prefix,
28336 @kbd{H l +} [@code{lufadd}] will add logarithmic unit field levels.
28337 Similarly, logarithmic units can be ``subtracted'' with @kbd{l -}
28338 (@code{calc-lu-minus}) [@code{lupsub}] or @kbd{H l -} [@code{lufsub}].
28339 The @kbd{l *} (@code{calc-lu-times}) [@code{lupmul}] and @kbd{H l *}
28340 [@code{lufmul}] commands will ``multiply'' a logarithmic unit by a
28341 number; the @kbd{l /} (@code{calc-lu-divide}) [@code{lupdiv}] and
28342 @kbd{H l /} [@code{lufdiv}] commands will ``divide'' a logarithmic
28343 unit by a number. Note that the reference quantities don't play a role
28344 in this arithmetic.
28345
28346 @node Musical Notes, , Logarithmic Units, Units
28347 @section Musical Notes
28348
28349 Calc can convert between musical notes and their associated
28350 frequencies. Notes can be given using either scientific pitch
28351 notation or midi numbers. Since these note systems are basically
28352 logarithmic scales, Calc uses the @kbd{l} prefix for functions
28353 operating on notes.
28354
28355 Scientific pitch notation refers to a note by giving a letter
28356 A through G, possibly followed by a flat or sharp) with a subscript
28357 indicating an octave number. Each octave starts with C and ends with
28358 B and
28359 @c increasing each note by a semitone will result
28360 @c in the sequence @expr{C}, @expr{C} sharp, @expr{D}, @expr{E} flat, @expr{E},
28361 @c @expr{F}, @expr{F} sharp, @expr{G}, @expr{A} flat, @expr{A}, @expr{B}
28362 @c flat and @expr{B}.
28363 the octave numbered 0 was chosen to correspond to the lowest
28364 audible frequency. Using this system, middle C (about 261.625 Hz)
28365 corresponds to the note @expr{C} in octave 4 and is denoted
28366 @expr{C_4}. Any frequency can be described by giving a note plus an
28367 offset in cents (where a cent is a ratio of frequencies so that a
28368 semitone consists of 100 cents).
28369
28370 The midi note number system assigns numbers to notes so that
28371 @expr{C_(-1)} corresponds to the midi note number 0 and @expr{G_9}
28372 corresponds to the midi note number 127. A midi controller can have
28373 up to 128 keys and each midi note number from 0 to 127 corresponds to
28374 a possible key.
28375
28376 @kindex l s
28377 @pindex calc-spn
28378 @tindex spn
28379 The @kbd{l s} (@code{calc-spn}) [@code{spn}] command converts either
28380 a frequency or a midi number to scientific pitch notation. For
28381 example, @code{500 Hz} gets converted to
28382 @code{B_4 + 21.3094853649 cents} and @code{84} to @code{C_6}.
28383
28384
28385 @kindex l m
28386 @pindex calc-midi
28387 @tindex midi
28388 The @kbd{l m} (@code{calc-midi}) [@code{midi}] command converts either
28389 a frequency or a note given in scientific pitch notation to the
28390 corresponding midi number. For example, @code{C_6} gets converted to 84
28391 and @code{440 Hz} to 69.
28392
28393 @kindex l f
28394 @pindex calc-freq
28395 @tindex freq
28396 The @kbd{l f} (@code{calc-freq}) [@code{freq}] command converts either
28397 either a midi number or a note given in scientific pitch notation to
28398 the corresponding frequency. For example, @code{Asharp_2 + 30 cents}
28399 gets converted to @code{118.578040134 Hz} and @code{55} to
28400 @code{195.99771799 Hz}.
28401
28402 Since the frequencies of notes are not usually given exactly (and are
28403 typically irrational), the customizable variable
28404 @code{calc-note-threshold} determines how close (in cents) a frequency
28405 needs to be to a note to be recognized as that note
28406 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). This variable has a default value of
28407 @code{1}. For example, middle @var{C} is approximately
28408 @expr{261.625565302 Hz}; this frequency is often shortened to
28409 @expr{261.625 Hz}. Without @code{calc-note-threshold} (or a value of
28410 @expr{0}), Calc would convert @code{261.625 Hz} to scientific pitch
28411 notation @code{B_3 + 99.9962592773 cents}; with the default value of
28412 @code{1}, Calc converts @code{261.625 Hz} to @code{C_4}.
28413
28414
28415
28416 @node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
28417 @chapter Storing and Recalling
28418
28419 @noindent
28420 Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
28421 or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
28422 section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
28423 to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
28424
28425 @menu
28426 * Storing Variables::
28427 * Recalling Variables::
28428 * Operations on Variables::
28429 * Let Command::
28430 * Evaluates-To Operator::
28431 @end menu
28432
28433 @node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
28434 @section Storing Variables
28435
28436 @noindent
28437 @kindex s s
28438 @pindex calc-store
28439 @cindex Storing variables
28440 @cindex Quick variables
28441 @vindex q0
28442 @vindex q9
28443 The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
28444 the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
28445 name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
28446 immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
28447 @code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
28448
28449 @kindex s t
28450 @pindex calc-store-into
28451 The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
28452 also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
28453 value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
28454
28455 If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
28456 @samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
28457 assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
28458 @kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
28459 value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
28460 a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
28461 its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
28462 with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
28463
28464 In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
28465 assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
28466 default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
28467 righthand sides simultaneously.
28468
28469 It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
28470 the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
28471 In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
28472 symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
28473 stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
28474 and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
28475
28476 @kindex s 0-9
28477 @kindex t 0-9
28478 The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
28479 digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
28480 equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
28481 for trail and time/date commands.)
28482
28483 @kindex s +
28484 @kindex s -
28485 @ignore
28486 @mindex @idots
28487 @end ignore
28488 @kindex s *
28489 @ignore
28490 @mindex @null
28491 @end ignore
28492 @kindex s /
28493 @ignore
28494 @mindex @null
28495 @end ignore
28496 @kindex s ^
28497 @ignore
28498 @mindex @null
28499 @end ignore
28500 @kindex s |
28501 @ignore
28502 @mindex @null
28503 @end ignore
28504 @kindex s n
28505 @ignore
28506 @mindex @null
28507 @end ignore
28508 @kindex s &
28509 @ignore
28510 @mindex @null
28511 @end ignore
28512 @kindex s [
28513 @ignore
28514 @mindex @null
28515 @end ignore
28516 @kindex s ]
28517 @pindex calc-store-plus
28518 @pindex calc-store-minus
28519 @pindex calc-store-times
28520 @pindex calc-store-div
28521 @pindex calc-store-power
28522 @pindex calc-store-concat
28523 @pindex calc-store-neg
28524 @pindex calc-store-inv
28525 @pindex calc-store-decr
28526 @pindex calc-store-incr
28527 There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
28528 @kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
28529 variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
28530 @kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
28531 @kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
28532 and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
28533
28534 All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
28535 order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
28536 variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
28537 @w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
28538 @texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
28539 @infoline @expr{v := v - a},
28540 but @kbd{I s -} assigns
28541 @texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
28542 @infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
28543 While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
28544 useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
28545 arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
28546 forwards and backwards:
28547
28548 @example
28549 @group
28550 s + v := v + a v := a + v
28551 s - v := v - a v := a - v
28552 s * v := v * a v := a * v
28553 s / v := v / a v := a / v
28554 s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
28555 s | v := v | a v := a | v
28556 s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
28557 s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
28558 s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
28559 s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
28560 @end group
28561 @end example
28562
28563 In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
28564 place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
28565 a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
28566 minus-two minus the variable.
28567
28568 The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
28569 etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
28570 arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
28571
28572 All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
28573 Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
28574 previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
28575 turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
28576 arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
28577 @xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
28578 these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
28579
28580 @kindex s m
28581 @pindex calc-store-map
28582 The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
28583 using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
28584 @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
28585 how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
28586 all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
28587 function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
28588 key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28589 equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28590 of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28591 reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28592 takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28593
28594 If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28595 arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28596 is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28597 on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28598 Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28599 argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28600 equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28601
28602 @kindex s x
28603 @pindex calc-store-exchange
28604 The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28605 of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28606 variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28607
28608 You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28609 command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28610 pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28611
28612 @kindex s u
28613 @pindex calc-unstore
28614 @cindex Void variables
28615 @cindex Un-storing variables
28616 Until you store something in them, most variables are ``void,'' that is,
28617 they contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula
28618 they will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28619 The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28620 void state.
28621
28622 @kindex s c
28623 @pindex calc-copy-variable
28624 The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28625 value of one variable to another. One way it differs from a simple
28626 @kbd{s r} followed by an @kbd{s t} (aside from saving keystrokes) is
28627 that the value never goes on the stack and thus is never rounded,
28628 evaluated, or simplified in any way; it is not even rounded down to the
28629 current precision.
28630
28631 The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28632 @code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28633 to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28634 although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28635 variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28636 you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28637 special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28638 normally void).
28639
28640 Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored in it,
28641 but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{} at the current
28642 precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and @code{phi} evaluate
28643 according to the current precision or polar mode. If you recall a value
28644 from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic property will be lost. The
28645 magic property is preserved, however, when a variable is copied with
28646 @kbd{s c}.
28647
28648 @kindex s k
28649 @pindex calc-copy-special-constant
28650 If one of the ``special constants'' is redefined (or undefined) so that
28651 it no longer has its magic property, the property can be restored with
28652 @kbd{s k} (@code{calc-copy-special-constant}). This command will prompt
28653 for a special constant and a variable to store it in, and so a special
28654 constant can be stored in any variable. Here, the special constant that
28655 you enter doesn't depend on the value of the corresponding variable;
28656 @code{pi} will represent 3.14159@dots{} regardless of what is currently
28657 stored in the Calc variable @code{pi}. If one of the other special
28658 variables, @code{inf}, @code{uinf} or @code{nan}, is given a value, its
28659 original behavior can be restored by voiding it with @kbd{s u}.
28660
28661 @node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28662 @section Recalling Variables
28663
28664 @noindent
28665 @kindex s r
28666 @pindex calc-recall
28667 @cindex Recalling variables
28668 The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28669 is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28670 for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28671 of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28672 an error to try to recall a void variable.
28673
28674 It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28675 formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28676 the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28677 former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28678 latter will produce an error message.
28679
28680 @kindex r 0-9
28681 The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
28682 equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}.
28683
28684 @node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28685 @section Other Operations on Variables
28686
28687 @noindent
28688 @kindex s e
28689 @pindex calc-edit-variable
28690 The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28691 value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28692 or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28693 the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28694 editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28695 empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28696 be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28697 description of editing.
28698
28699 The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28700 rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28701 contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28702 actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28703 where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28704 if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28705 replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28706 not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28707 editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28708 as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28709
28710 @kindex s A
28711 @kindex s D
28712 @ignore
28713 @mindex @idots
28714 @end ignore
28715 @kindex s E
28716 @ignore
28717 @mindex @null
28718 @end ignore
28719 @kindex s F
28720 @ignore
28721 @mindex @null
28722 @end ignore
28723 @kindex s G
28724 @ignore
28725 @mindex @null
28726 @end ignore
28727 @kindex s H
28728 @ignore
28729 @mindex @null
28730 @end ignore
28731 @kindex s I
28732 @ignore
28733 @mindex @null
28734 @end ignore
28735 @kindex s L
28736 @ignore
28737 @mindex @null
28738 @end ignore
28739 @kindex s P
28740 @ignore
28741 @mindex @null
28742 @end ignore
28743 @kindex s R
28744 @ignore
28745 @mindex @null
28746 @end ignore
28747 @kindex s T
28748 @ignore
28749 @mindex @null
28750 @end ignore
28751 @kindex s U
28752 @ignore
28753 @mindex @null
28754 @end ignore
28755 @kindex s X
28756 @pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28757 @pindex calc-store-Decls
28758 @pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28759 @pindex calc-store-FitRules
28760 @pindex calc-store-GenCount
28761 @pindex calc-store-Holidays
28762 @pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28763 @pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28764 @pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28765 @pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28766 @pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28767 @pindex calc-store-Units
28768 @pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28769 There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28770 use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28771
28772 @table @kbd
28773 @item s A
28774 Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28775 @item s D
28776 Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28777 @item s E
28778 Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Basic Simplifications}.
28779 @item s F
28780 Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28781 @item s G
28782 Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28783 @item s H
28784 Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28785 @item s I
28786 Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28787 @item s L
28788 Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28789 @item s P
28790 Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28791 @item s R
28792 Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28793 @item s T
28794 Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28795 @item s U
28796 Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28797 @item s X
28798 Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28799 @end table
28800
28801 These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28802 names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28803
28804 @kindex s p
28805 @pindex calc-permanent-variable
28806 @cindex Storing variables
28807 @cindex Permanent variables
28808 @cindex Calc init file, variables
28809 The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28810 variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28811 the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so
28812 that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28813 can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28814 only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28815 by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28816 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28817
28818 If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28819 @kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28820 are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28821 @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28822 and @code{PlotRejects};
28823 @code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28824 rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28825 by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28826 explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28827
28828 @kindex s i
28829 @pindex calc-insert-variables
28830 The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28831 the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28832 The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28833 Lisp @code{setq} commands
28834 which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28835 in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28836 would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28837 omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28838 is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28839 stores in a more human-readable format.)
28840
28841 @node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28842 @section The Let Command
28843
28844 @noindent
28845 @kindex s l
28846 @pindex calc-let
28847 @cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28848 @cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28849 If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28850 compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28851 then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28852 of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28853
28854 The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28855 @emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28856 top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28857 second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28858 in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28859 the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28860 @kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28861 The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28862 by these commands.
28863
28864 The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28865 a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28866 analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28867
28868 Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28869 assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28870 and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28871
28872 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28873 a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28874 rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
28875 example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
28876 produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
28877 since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
28878
28879 @node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
28880 @section The Evaluates-To Operator
28881
28882 @noindent
28883 @tindex evalto
28884 @tindex =>
28885 @cindex Evaluates-to operator
28886 @cindex @samp{=>} operator
28887 The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
28888 operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
28889 other language modes like Pascal and @LaTeX{}.) This is a binary
28890 operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
28891 although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
28892
28893 A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
28894 follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
28895 way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
28896 formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
28897 command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
28898 and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
28899
28900 For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
28901 The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
28902 unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
28903
28904 @kindex s =
28905 @pindex calc-evalto
28906 You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
28907 entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
28908 going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
28909 (@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
28910 and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
28911
28912 Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
28913 recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
28914 values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
28915 if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
28916 if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
28917 @samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
28918 @samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
28919 dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
28920 @samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
28921 of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
28922 to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
28923 make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
28924 (Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
28925 which provides a slightly different format of display. You
28926 can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
28927
28928 @kindex m C
28929 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
28930 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
28931 turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
28932 recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
28933 operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
28934 pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
28935 a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
28936 before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
28937
28938 Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
28939 as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
28940 work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
28941 to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
28942 the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
28943 to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
28944 @kbd{j u} to unselect.
28945
28946 All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
28947 including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
28948 formula @samp{arcsin(sin(x))} will not be handled by Calc's algebraic
28949 simplifications, but Calc's unsafe simplifications will reduce it to
28950 @samp{x}. If you enter @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) =>} normally, the result
28951 will be @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => arcsin(sin(x))}. If you change to
28952 Extended Simplification mode, the result will be
28953 @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a e}
28954 once will have no effect on @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => arcsin(sin(x))},
28955 because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
28956 and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
28957 affected by commands like @kbd{a e}.
28958
28959 The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
28960 with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
28961 second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
28962 a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
28963 if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
28964 side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
28965 fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
28966 to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
28967 that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
28968 entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
28969
28970 @smallexample
28971 @group
28972 2: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
28973 1: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
28974 . . .
28975
28976 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
28977 @end group
28978 @end smallexample
28979
28980 Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
28981 thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
28982 influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
28983 (@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
28984 operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
28985 side effects.
28986
28987 @kindex s :
28988 @pindex calc-assign
28989 @tindex assign
28990 @tindex :=
28991 Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
28992 the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
28993 assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
28994 assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
28995 by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
28996 of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
28997 operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
28998 (@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
28999 and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
29000
29001 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
29002 @TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
29003 treatment to @samp{=>}.
29004
29005 @node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
29006 @chapter Graphics
29007
29008 @noindent
29009 The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
29010 uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or later to do graphics. These commands will only work
29011 if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
29012 a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
29013 However, it is free software. It can be obtained from
29014 @samp{http://www.gnuplot.info}.)
29015
29016 @vindex calc-gnuplot-name
29017 If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
29018 find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable in
29019 your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some
29020 Lisp variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
29021 are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are using
29022 the X window system or MS-Windows, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
29023 automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later and you are using a
29024 Unix or GNU system without X, Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display
29025 graphs using simple character graphics that will work on any
29026 Posix-compatible terminal.
29027
29028 @menu
29029 * Basic Graphics::
29030 * Three Dimensional Graphics::
29031 * Managing Curves::
29032 * Graphics Options::
29033 * Devices::
29034 @end menu
29035
29036 @node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
29037 @section Basic Graphics
29038
29039 @noindent
29040 @kindex g f
29041 @pindex calc-graph-fast
29042 The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
29043 This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
29044 The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
29045 the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
29046 represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
29047 GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
29048 commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
29049 be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
29050 to indicate the points themselves.
29051
29052 The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
29053 ``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
29054 the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
29055
29056 The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
29057 sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
29058 (Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
29059
29060 The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
29061 uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
29062 the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
29063 The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
29064 values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
29065 computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
29066 Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
29067 @kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
29068 or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
29069
29070 @ignore
29071 @starindex
29072 @end ignore
29073 @tindex xy
29074 If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
29075 @samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
29076 parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
29077 are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
29078 In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
29079 visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
29080 and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
29081 will be a circle.
29082
29083 Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
29084 looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
29085 variables.
29086
29087 The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
29088 calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
29089 be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). One exception to this
29090 is that the ``y'' entry can consist of a vector of numbers combined with
29091 error forms, in which case the points will be plotted with the
29092 appropriate error bars. Other than this, if either the ``x''
29093 value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
29094 data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
29095 of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
29096
29097 See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
29098 numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
29099
29100 @cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
29101 @vindex PlotRejects
29102 If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
29103 (i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
29104 this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
29105 ``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
29106 a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
29107 ``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
29108 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
29109 current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
29110 for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
29111 @code{PlotRejects}.
29112
29113 @kindex g c
29114 @pindex calc-graph-clear
29115 To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
29116 If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
29117 Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
29118 to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
29119 or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
29120 window if there is one.
29121
29122 @node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
29123 @section Three-Dimensional Graphics
29124
29125 @kindex g F
29126 @pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
29127 The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
29128 graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
29129 you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
29130
29131 The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
29132 ``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
29133 are several options for these values.
29134
29135 In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
29136 the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
29137 ``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
29138 in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
29139 result is a surface plot where
29140 @texline @math{z_{ij}}
29141 @infoline @expr{z_ij}
29142 is the height of the point
29143 at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
29144 be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
29145 viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29146 buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT documentation for a
29147 description of the @samp{set view} command.
29148
29149 Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
29150 and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
29151
29152 In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
29153 length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
29154 where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
29155 of values from the input vectors.
29156
29157 In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
29158 ``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
29159 with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
29160 order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
29161 values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
29162 3D surface.
29163
29164 @ignore
29165 @starindex
29166 @end ignore
29167 @tindex xyz
29168 If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
29169 @samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
29170 ``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
29171 taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
29172 ``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
29173 to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
29174 @samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
29175 will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
29176 5 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
29177 sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
29178 increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
29179 vectors with more than 5 elements.
29180
29181 It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
29182 evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
29183 a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
29184 @samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
29185 helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
29186
29187 As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
29188 variables containing the relevant data.
29189
29190 @node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
29191 @section Managing Curves
29192
29193 @noindent
29194 The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
29195 @kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
29196 @kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
29197 by using these commands directly.
29198
29199 @kindex g a
29200 @pindex calc-graph-add
29201 The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
29202 represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
29203 graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
29204 you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
29205 on the same axes.
29206
29207 The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
29208 will cause a special buffer, @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
29209 in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
29210 be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
29211 @kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
29212 @kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
29213 Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
29214 buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
29215 directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
29216 must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
29217 in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
29218 configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
29219 the contents of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29220
29221 @vindex PlotData1
29222 @vindex PlotData2
29223 If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
29224 variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
29225 the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
29226 go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
29227 that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
29228 can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
29229 That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
29230 itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
29231
29232 A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
29233 stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
29234 argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
29235 for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
29236 the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
29237 argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
29238
29239 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
29240 ``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
29241 ``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
29242
29243 A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
29244 the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
29245 This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
29246 that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
29247 values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
29248 they are to look nice on the same graph.)
29249
29250 For example, to plot
29251 @texline @math{\sin n x}
29252 @infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
29253 for integers @expr{n}
29254 from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
29255 (@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
29256 across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
29257 for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
29258 command.
29259
29260 @kindex g A
29261 @pindex calc-graph-add-3d
29262 The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
29263 to the graph. It is not valid to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
29264 single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
29265 and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
29266 takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
29267 separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
29268 but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
29269 prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
29270 The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
29271 command to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29272
29273 (Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
29274 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
29275 before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
29276 evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
29277 @kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
29278 check for this.)
29279
29280 @kindex g d
29281 @pindex calc-graph-delete
29282 The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
29283 recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
29284 no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
29285 it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
29286
29287 @kindex g H
29288 @pindex calc-graph-hide
29289 The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
29290 the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
29291 the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
29292 point styles will be retained.
29293
29294 @kindex g j
29295 @pindex calc-graph-juggle
29296 The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
29297 at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
29298 front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
29299 @w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
29300 with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
29301 affect the last curve in the list.
29302
29303 @kindex g p
29304 @pindex calc-graph-plot
29305 The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
29306 the graph described in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
29307 GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
29308 are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
29309 command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
29310 are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
29311 plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
29312 for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
29313 files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
29314
29315 If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
29316 it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
29317 Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
29318 that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
29319 mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
29320 force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
29321 numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
29322
29323 Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
29324 This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
29325 a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
29326 the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
29327 function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
29328 each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
29329 but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
29330
29331 Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
29332 numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
29333 the current graph is three-dimensional.
29334
29335 @kindex g P
29336 @pindex calc-graph-print
29337 The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
29338 except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
29339 screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
29340 or @samp{set output} commands in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
29341 lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
29342 ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
29343 uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
29344 controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
29345 Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
29346 the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
29347 always plot to the printer.
29348
29349 @node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
29350 @section Graphics Options
29351
29352 @noindent
29353 @kindex g g
29354 @pindex calc-graph-grid
29355 The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
29356 on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
29357 edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
29358 across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
29359 changes the setting in @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
29360 of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
29361
29362 @kindex g b
29363 @pindex calc-graph-border
29364 The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
29365 (the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
29366 This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29367
29368 @kindex g k
29369 @pindex calc-graph-key
29370 The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
29371 on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
29372 shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
29373 off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
29374 curves on the same graph.
29375
29376 @kindex g N
29377 @pindex calc-graph-num-points
29378 The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
29379 to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
29380 curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
29381 Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
29382 With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
29383 With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
29384 a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
29385 graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
29386 With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
29387 the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
29388 Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
29389 will be computed for the surface.
29390
29391 Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
29392 precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
29393 time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
29394 it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
29395 interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
29396 to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
29397 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
29398 at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
29399 there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
29400
29401 @kindex g h
29402 @pindex calc-graph-header
29403 The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
29404 for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
29405 The default title is blank (no title).
29406
29407 @kindex g n
29408 @pindex calc-graph-name
29409 The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
29410 individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
29411 affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
29412 list in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
29413 the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
29414 with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
29415 Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
29416 not used.
29417
29418 @kindex g t
29419 @kindex g T
29420 @pindex calc-graph-title-x
29421 @pindex calc-graph-title-y
29422 The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
29423 (@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
29424 and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
29425 tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
29426 Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
29427 but you can edit them into the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
29428 you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
29429
29430 @kindex g r
29431 @kindex g R
29432 @pindex calc-graph-range-x
29433 @pindex calc-graph-range-y
29434 The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
29435 (@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
29436 ``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
29437 suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
29438 form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
29439 default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
29440 in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
29441 Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
29442 vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
29443
29444 @kindex g l
29445 @kindex g L
29446 @pindex calc-graph-log-x
29447 @pindex calc-graph-log-y
29448 The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
29449 commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
29450 be logarithmic instead of linear.
29451
29452 @kindex g C-l
29453 @kindex g C-r
29454 @kindex g C-t
29455 @pindex calc-graph-log-z
29456 @pindex calc-graph-range-z
29457 @pindex calc-graph-title-z
29458 For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
29459 letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
29460 for the ``z'' axis.
29461
29462 @kindex g z
29463 @kindex g Z
29464 @pindex calc-graph-zero-x
29465 @pindex calc-graph-zero-y
29466 The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
29467 (@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
29468 drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
29469 dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
29470 turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
29471 may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
29472 not available for 3D plots.
29473
29474 @kindex g s
29475 @pindex calc-graph-line-style
29476 The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
29477 lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
29478 the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
29479 toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
29480 turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
29481 start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
29482 GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
29483 available for any device.
29484
29485 @kindex g S
29486 @pindex calc-graph-point-style
29487 The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
29488 the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
29489 If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
29490 tiny dots. If the ``y'' values being plotted contain error forms and
29491 the connecting lines are turned off, then this command will also turn
29492 the error bars on or off.
29493
29494 @cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
29495 @cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
29496 @vindex LineStyles
29497 @vindex PointStyles
29498 Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
29499 @code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
29500 values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
29501 the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
29502 instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
29503 An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
29504 the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
29505 altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
29506 last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
29507 you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
29508
29509 For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
29510 to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
29511 lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
29512 still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
29513 @code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
29514
29515 @node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
29516 @section Graphical Devices
29517
29518 @noindent
29519 @kindex g D
29520 @pindex calc-graph-device
29521 The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
29522 (or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
29523 on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
29524 If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
29525 Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
29526
29527 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
29528 the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
29529 not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
29530 blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
29531 name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
29532 the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
29533 @code{DISPLAY} environment variable), @code{windows} on MS-Windows, or
29534 otherwise @code{dumb} under GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or
29535 @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0. This is the initial default
29536 value.
29537
29538 The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
29539 terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
29540 picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
29541 to a buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
29542 The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
29543 dumb terminals will be
29544 @texline @math{80\times24}
29545 @infoline 80x24
29546 characters. The graph is displayed in
29547 an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
29548 the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
29549 device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29550
29551 The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
29552 spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
29553 characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
29554 but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
29555 screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
29556 graph. In the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
29557 @kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
29558 of the four directions.
29559
29560 With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
29561 the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
29562 is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
29563 printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
29564 plot on any text-only printer.
29565
29566 @kindex g O
29567 @pindex calc-graph-output
29568 The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of the
29569 output file used by GNUPLOT. For some devices, notably @code{x11} and
29570 @code{windows}, there is no output file and this information is not
29571 used. Many other ``devices'' are really file formats like
29572 @code{postscript}; in these cases the output in the desired format
29573 goes into the file you name with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout
29574 @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write to its standard output stream,
29575 i.e., to @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}. This is the default setting.
29576
29577 Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
29578 is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
29579 which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
29580 graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
29581 this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
29582 sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
29583 typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
29584 the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
29585 to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
29586
29587 Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29588 sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29589 case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29590 file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29591 will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29592 name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29593
29594 The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29595 permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29596 default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29597 (see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29598 saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29599 of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29600
29601 @vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29602 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29603 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29604 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29605 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29606 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29607 You may wish to configure the default and
29608 printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29609 Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29610 and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29611 file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29612 expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29613
29614 Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29615 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29616 display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29617 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29618 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29619 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29620 to display or print the output. These variables are customizable
29621 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29622
29623 @kindex g x
29624 @pindex calc-graph-display
29625 The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29626 on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29627 a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29628 effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29629
29630 @kindex g X
29631 @pindex calc-graph-geometry
29632 The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29633 command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29634 The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29635 window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29636 Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
29637 window in the upper-left corner of the screen. This command has no
29638 effect if the current device is @code{windows}.
29639
29640 The buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29641 session with GNUPLOT. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29642 GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29643 error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29644 this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
29645 something has gone wrong@footnote{
29646 On MS-Windows, due to the peculiarities of how the Windows version of
29647 GNUPLOT (called @command{wgnuplot}) works, the GNUPLOT responses are
29648 not communicated back to Calc. Instead, you need to look them up in
29649 the GNUPLOT command window that is displayed as in normal interactive
29650 usage of GNUPLOT.
29651 }.
29652
29653 @kindex g C
29654 @pindex calc-graph-command
29655 The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29656 enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29657 GNUPLOT process. The @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29658 like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29659 Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29660
29661 @kindex g v
29662 @kindex g V
29663 @pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29664 @pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29665 The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29666 (@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29667 and @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29668 This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29669 will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29670 or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29671 buffer is hidden again. (Note that on MS-Windows, the @samp{*Gnuplot
29672 Trail*} buffer will usually show nothing of interest, because
29673 GNUPLOT's responses are not communicated back to Calc.)
29674
29675 One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29676 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29677 @kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29678 @samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29679 annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29680 you have to add them to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29681 yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29682 that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29683 To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29684 You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29685 ``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29686 Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29687 reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29688 to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29689 line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29690 with @kbd{g p}.
29691
29692 @kindex g q
29693 @pindex calc-graph-quit
29694 You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29695 process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29696 start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29697 the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29698 running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29699 exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29700
29701 @kindex g K
29702 @pindex calc-graph-kill
29703 The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29704 except that it also views the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29705 you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29706 killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29707
29708 @node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29709 @chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29710
29711 @noindent
29712 The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29713 other Emacs editing buffers.
29714
29715 In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29716 work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29717
29718 @menu
29719 * Killing From Stack::
29720 * Yanking Into Stack::
29721 * Saving Into Registers::
29722 * Inserting From Registers::
29723 * Grabbing From Buffers::
29724 * Yanking Into Buffers::
29725 * X Cut and Paste::
29726 @end menu
29727
29728 @node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29729 @section Killing from the Stack
29730
29731 @noindent
29732 @kindex C-k
29733 @pindex calc-kill
29734 @kindex M-k
29735 @pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29736 @kindex C-w
29737 @pindex calc-kill-region
29738 @kindex M-w
29739 @pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
29740 @kindex M-C-w
29741 @cindex Kill ring
29742 @dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the ``kill
29743 ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y} command.
29744 Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which kills
29745 one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point, and
29746 @kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29747 deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too,
29748 although in the Calculator they operate on whole stack entries, so they
29749 ``round up'' the specified region to encompass full lines. (To copy
29750 only parts of lines, the @kbd{M-C-w} command in the Calculator will copy
29751 the region to the kill ring without any ``rounding up'', just like the
29752 @kbd{M-w} command in normal Emacs.) Also, @kbd{M-k} has been provided
29753 to complete the set; it puts the current line into the kill ring without
29754 deleting anything.
29755
29756 The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
29757 of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below
29758 the bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack.
29759 Otherwise, they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. The
29760 text is copied into the kill ring exactly as it appears on the screen,
29761 including line numbers if they are enabled.
29762
29763 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29764 of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29765 lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29766 current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29767 @kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29768 with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29769 @kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29770 newline.
29771
29772 @node Yanking Into Stack, Saving Into Registers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
29773 @section Yanking into the Stack
29774
29775 @noindent
29776 @kindex C-y
29777 @pindex calc-yank
29778 The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29779 Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29780 the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29781 or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29782 the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29783 itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29784 set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29785 then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29786 full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29787 number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29788 show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29789 difference.)
29790
29791 @node Saving Into Registers, Inserting From Registers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29792 @section Saving into Registers
29793
29794 @noindent
29795 @kindex r s
29796 @pindex calc-copy-to-register
29797 @pindex calc-prepend-to-register
29798 @pindex calc-append-to-register
29799 @cindex Registers
29800 An alternative to killing and yanking stack entries is using
29801 registers in Calc. Saving stack entries in registers is like
29802 saving text in normal Emacs registers; although, like Calc's kill
29803 commands, register commands always operate on whole stack
29804 entries.
29805
29806 Registers in Calc are places to store stack entries for later use;
29807 each register is indexed by a single character. To store the current
29808 region (rounded up, of course, to include full stack entries) into a
29809 register, use the command @kbd{r s} (@code{calc-copy-to-register}).
29810 You will then be prompted for a register to use, the next character
29811 you type will be the index for the register. To store the region in
29812 register @var{r}, the full command will be @kbd{r s @var{r}}. With an
29813 argument, @kbd{C-u r s @var{r}}, the region being copied to the
29814 register will be deleted from the Calc buffer.
29815
29816 It is possible to add additional stack entries to a register. The
29817 command @kbd{M-x calc-append-to-register} will prompt for a register,
29818 then add the stack entries in the region to the end of the register
29819 contents. The command @kbd{M-x calc-prepend-to-register} will
29820 similarly prompt for a register and add the stack entries in the
29821 region to the beginning of the register contents. Both commands take
29822 @kbd{C-u} arguments, which will cause the region to be deleted after being
29823 added to the register.
29824
29825 @node Inserting From Registers, Grabbing From Buffers, Saving Into Registers, Kill and Yank
29826 @section Inserting from Registers
29827 @noindent
29828 @kindex r i
29829 @pindex calc-insert-register
29830 The command @kbd{r i} (@code{calc-insert-register}) will prompt for a
29831 register, then insert the contents of that register into the
29832 Calculator. If the contents of the register were placed there from
29833 within Calc, then the full internal structure of the contents will be
29834 inserted into the Calculator, otherwise whatever text is in the
29835 register is reparsed and then inserted into the Calculator.
29836
29837 @node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Inserting From Registers, Kill and Yank
29838 @section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29839
29840 @noindent
29841 @kindex C-x * g
29842 @pindex calc-grab-region
29843 The @kbd{C-x * g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29844 point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29845 vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29846 @samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29847 then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29848 of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29849 If the @kbd{C-x * g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29850 @kbd{C-x * c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29851
29852 A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29853 point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29854 @expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 C-x * g} grabs from point
29855 to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29856 back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29857 that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29858 delete given that prefix argument.
29859
29860 A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29861 line.
29862
29863 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29864 as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29865 @kbd{C-x * g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29866 values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u C-x * g} on the same region
29867 reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29868 (The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29869 vector of one element by plain @kbd{C-x * g} because the interpretation
29870 @samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29871
29872 If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29873 the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29874
29875 @kindex C-x * r
29876 @pindex calc-grab-rectangle
29877 The @kbd{C-x * r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
29878 point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
29879 are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
29880 entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
29881 whose contents are parsed.
29882
29883 Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
29884 will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
29885 only if every row contains the same number of values.
29886
29887 If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
29888 braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
29889 of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
29890 is ignored.
29891
29892 Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
29893 were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
29894 format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
29895 force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
29896 portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
29897 @kbd{C-x * r} command.
29898
29899 If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
29900 line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
29901 a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will be a
29902 one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
29903 expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} will interpret this as
29904 @samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
29905 one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will interpret this row
29906 as @samp{[2*a]}.
29907
29908 If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
29909 will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
29910 separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
29911 @w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
29912 would correctly split the line into two error forms.
29913
29914 @xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
29915 constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
29916 @texline @math{1\times1}
29917 @infoline 1x1
29918 matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
29919
29920 @kindex C-x * :
29921 @kindex C-x * _
29922 @pindex calc-grab-sum-across
29923 @pindex calc-grab-sum-down
29924 @cindex Summing rows and columns of data
29925 The @kbd{C-x * :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
29926 grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
29927 typing @kbd{C-x * r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
29928 command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
29929 result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
29930 in the input data. The @kbd{C-x * _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
29931 similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
29932
29933 As well as being more convenient, @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are also
29934 much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
29935 the stack. In a @kbd{C-x * r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
29936 for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
29937 (unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
29938
29939 For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
29940 wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
29941 set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{C-x * :}. Since there
29942 is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
29943 (You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
29944 you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
29945
29946 To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
29947 it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
29948 Use @kbd{C-x * r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
29949 the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
29950 handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
29951 @xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
29952 an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
29953
29954 @node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
29955 @section Yanking into Other Buffers
29956
29957 @noindent
29958 @kindex y
29959 @pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
29960 The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
29961 at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
29962 (More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
29963 in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
29964 such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
29965 and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
29966 without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
29967 normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
29968
29969 With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
29970 A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
29971 of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
29972 top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
29973 that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
29974 with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
29975 latter strips off the trailing newline.
29976
29977 With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
29978 region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
29979 Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
29980 @kbd{C-x * g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
29981 data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
29982 original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
29983 display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
29984 display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
29985 that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
29986 @kbd{C-x * g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{C-x * r}).
29987
29988 If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
29989 and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
29990 overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
29991 before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
29992 are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
29993 a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
29994 object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
29995 lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
29996 Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
29997 number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
29998 make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
29999 number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
30000 ``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
30001 to overwriting one complete number with another.
30002
30003 @kindex C-x * y
30004 The @kbd{C-x * y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
30005 it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
30006 way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
30007
30008 @node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
30009 @section X Cut and Paste
30010
30011 @noindent
30012 If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
30013 way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
30014 Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
30015
30016 The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
30017 to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
30018 select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
30019 the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
30020 clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
30021 window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
30022 to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
30023 middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
30024 paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
30025 entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
30026 new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
30027
30028 The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
30029 shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
30030 So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
30031 Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
30032 left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
30033 whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
30034 just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
30035 in the Calc window.
30036
30037 @node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Top
30038 @chapter Keypad Mode
30039
30040 @noindent
30041 @kindex C-x * k
30042 @pindex calc-keypad
30043 The @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
30044 and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
30045 the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
30046 keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
30047 The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
30048 you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
30049 calculations with the mouse.
30050
30051 @pindex full-calc-keypad
30052 If you have used @kbd{C-x * b} first, @kbd{C-x * k} instead invokes
30053 the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
30054 Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
30055 trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
30056 Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
30057
30058 If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
30059 the @samp{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
30060 ``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
30061 is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
30062
30063 Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
30064 keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
30065 keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
30066
30067 Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
30068 at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
30069 to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
30070 stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
30071 To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
30072 [@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
30073 until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
30074 is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
30075
30076 You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
30077 Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
30078 Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
30079 original buffer.
30080
30081 @menu
30082 * Keypad Main Menu::
30083 * Keypad Functions Menu::
30084 * Keypad Binary Menu::
30085 * Keypad Vectors Menu::
30086 * Keypad Modes Menu::
30087 @end menu
30088
30089 @node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
30090 @section Main Menu
30091
30092 @smallexample
30093 @group
30094 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
30095 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
30096 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30097 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
30098 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30099 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
30100 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30101 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
30102 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
30103 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
30104 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30105 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
30106 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30107 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
30108 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30109 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
30110 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
30111 @end group
30112 @end smallexample
30113
30114 @noindent
30115 This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
30116 It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
30117 Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
30118 screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
30119
30120 The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
30121 entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
30122 exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
30123 number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
30124 or any other function key.
30125
30126 The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
30127 numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
30128 At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
30129 stack.
30130
30131 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
30132 having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
30133 defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
30134 below and in the following sections.
30135
30136 The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
30137 duplicates the top entry on the stack.
30138
30139 The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
30140 @kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
30141 ``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
30142
30143 The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
30144 At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
30145 clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
30146 the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
30147
30148 The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
30149 that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
30150 numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
30151 switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
30152 nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
30153
30154 The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
30155 functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
30156 reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
30157 integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
30158
30159 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
30160 give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
30161 is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
30162 unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
30163
30164 @table @kbd
30165 @item INV +/-
30166 is the same as @key{1/x}.
30167 @item INV +
30168 is the same as @key{SQRT}.
30169 @item INV -
30170 is the same as @key{CONJ}.
30171 @item INV *
30172 is the same as @key{y^x}.
30173 @item INV /
30174 is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
30175 @item HYP/INV 1
30176 are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
30177 @item HYP/INV 2
30178 are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
30179 @item HYP/INV 3
30180 are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
30181 @item INV/HYP 4
30182 are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
30183 @item INV/HYP 5
30184 are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
30185 @item INV 6
30186 is the same as @key{ABS}.
30187 @item INV 7
30188 is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
30189 @item INV 8
30190 is the same as @key{CLN2}.
30191 @item INV 9
30192 is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
30193 @item INV 0
30194 is the same as @key{IMAG}.
30195 @item INV .
30196 is the same as @key{PREC}.
30197 @item INV ENTER
30198 is the same as @key{SWAP}.
30199 @item HYP ENTER
30200 is the same as @key{RLL3}.
30201 @item INV HYP ENTER
30202 is the same as @key{OVER}.
30203 @item HYP +/-
30204 packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
30205 @item HYP EEX
30206 packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
30207 @item INV EEX
30208 creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
30209 of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
30210 by the two limits of the interval.
30211 @end table
30212
30213 The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{C-x * k} or @kbd{C-x * *}
30214 again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
30215 hitting @kbd{C-x * c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
30216 running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
30217 command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
30218 @kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
30219
30220 @node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
30221 @section Functions Menu
30222
30223 @smallexample
30224 @group
30225 |----+----+----+----+----+----2
30226 |IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
30227 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30228 |IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
30229 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30230 |GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
30231 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30232 @end group
30233 @end smallexample
30234
30235 @noindent
30236 This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
30237 prefix keys.
30238
30239 @key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
30240 number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
30241
30242 @key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
30243 extracts the imaginary part.
30244
30245 @key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
30246 a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
30247 number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
30248 again'' command; it computes another random number using the
30249 same limit as last time.
30250
30251 @key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
30252
30253 @key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
30254 @texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30255 @infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30256
30257 @key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
30258 @kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
30259
30260 @key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
30261 finds the previous prime.
30262
30263 @node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
30264 @section Binary Menu
30265
30266 @smallexample
30267 @group
30268 |----+----+----+----+----+----3
30269 |AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
30270 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30271 |DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
30272 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30273 | A | B | C | D | E | F |
30274 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30275 @end group
30276 @end smallexample
30277
30278 @noindent
30279 The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
30280 Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
30281 @key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
30282
30283 The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
30284 The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
30285
30286 The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
30287 current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
30288 octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
30289 for entering hexadecimal numbers.
30290
30291 The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
30292 and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
30293 using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
30294 The initial word size is 32 bits.
30295
30296 @node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
30297 @section Vectors Menu
30298
30299 @smallexample
30300 @group
30301 |----+----+----+----+----+----4
30302 |SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
30303 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30304 |MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
30305 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30306 |PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
30307 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30308 @end group
30309 @end smallexample
30310
30311 @noindent
30312 The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
30313
30314 @key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
30315 the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
30316 which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
30317 @kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
30318 @samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
30319 on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
30320 rows into a matrix.
30321
30322 @key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
30323 components separately.
30324
30325 @key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
30326 integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
30327 from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
30328 and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
30329 value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
30330
30331 @key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
30332 identity matrix.
30333
30334 @key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
30335
30336 @key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
30337
30338 @key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
30339 inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
30340
30341 @key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
30342 equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
30343 @key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
30344 @key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
30345
30346 @key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
30347 minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
30348 @key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
30349
30350 @key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
30351 @key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
30352 @key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
30353
30354 @key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
30355 to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
30356 The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
30357 and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
30358 all the elements of a vector.
30359
30360 @key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
30361 vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
30362 several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
30363 second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
30364 alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
30365 the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
30366 the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
30367 For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
30368 the formula @samp{x^y}.
30369
30370 The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
30371 stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
30372 key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
30373 suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
30374 With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
30375 @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
30376 @expr{t}, respectively.
30377
30378 @node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
30379 @section Modes Menu
30380
30381 @smallexample
30382 @group
30383 |----+----+----+----+----+----5
30384 |FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
30385 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30386 |RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
30387 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30388 |SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
30389 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30390 @end group
30391 @end smallexample
30392
30393 @noindent
30394 The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
30395
30396 The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
30397 floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
30398 @key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
30399 others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
30400 keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
30401
30402 The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
30403 @kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
30404 well as to the left.
30405
30406 The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
30407 for trigonometric functions.
30408
30409 The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
30410 whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
30411 fractional or floating-point results.
30412
30413 The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
30414 polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
30415
30416 The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
30417 operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
30418 are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
30419
30420 The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
30421 the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
30422
30423 The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
30424 The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
30425 The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
30426 The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
30427
30428 The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
30429 @kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
30430 @key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
30431 variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
30432 for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
30433
30434 @node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
30435 @chapter Embedded Mode
30436
30437 @noindent
30438 Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
30439 and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
30440 stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
30441 linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
30442
30443 @menu
30444 * Basic Embedded Mode::
30445 * More About Embedded Mode::
30446 * Assignments in Embedded Mode::
30447 * Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
30448 * Customizing Embedded Mode::
30449 @end menu
30450
30451 @node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30452 @section Basic Embedded Mode
30453
30454 @noindent
30455 @kindex C-x * e
30456 @pindex calc-embedded
30457 To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
30458 formula in any buffer and press @kbd{C-x * e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
30459 Note that @kbd{C-x * e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
30460 like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
30461 are visiting your own files.
30462
30463 Calc will try to guess an appropriate language based on the major mode
30464 of the editing buffer. (@xref{Language Modes}.) If the current buffer is
30465 in @code{latex-mode}, for example, Calc will set its language to @LaTeX{}.
30466 Similarly, Calc will use @TeX{} language for @code{tex-mode},
30467 @code{plain-tex-mode} and @code{context-mode}, C language for
30468 @code{c-mode} and @code{c++-mode}, FORTRAN language for
30469 @code{fortran-mode} and @code{f90-mode}, Pascal for @code{pascal-mode},
30470 and eqn for @code{nroff-mode} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30471 These can be overridden with Calc's mode
30472 changing commands (@pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}). If no
30473 suitable language is available, Calc will continue with its current language.
30474
30475 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
30476 nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
30477 delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
30478 understands are:
30479
30480 @enumerate
30481 @item
30482 The @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
30483 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
30484 @item
30485 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
30486 @item
30487 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
30488 @item
30489 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
30490 @item
30491 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
30492 @end enumerate
30493
30494 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
30495 your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
30496 on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
30497
30498 If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
30499 instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and includes
30500 that many lines forward or backward (respectively, including the current
30501 line). Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
30502
30503 With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region (delimited
30504 by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters. With a prefix
30505 argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc uses the current line as the formula.
30506
30507 @kindex C-x * w
30508 @pindex calc-embedded-word
30509 The @kbd{C-x * w} (@code{calc-embedded-word}) command will start Embedded
30510 mode on the current ``word''; in this case Calc will scan for the first
30511 non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a digit,
30512 sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e}) forward and
30513 backward to delimit the formula.
30514
30515 When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
30516 between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
30517 Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
30518 Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
30519 can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
30520 Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
30521 sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
30522 for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
30523 in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
30524 the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
30525 interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
30526
30527 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} or @kbd{C-x * w} to activate an embedded
30528 formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
30529 the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
30530 an algebraic entry.
30531
30532 Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
30533 move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
30534 Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
30535 to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
30536 not affected by Embedded mode.
30537
30538 When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
30539 the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
30540 the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
30541 You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{C-x * o} if you
30542 find you need to see the entire stack.
30543
30544 For example, typing @kbd{C-x * e} while somewhere in the formula
30545 @samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
30546 inequality:
30547
30548 @example
30549 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
30550 @end example
30551
30552 @noindent
30553 The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
30554 the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
30555 This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
30556 to match Calc's usual display style:
30557
30558 @example
30559 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
30560 @end example
30561
30562 @noindent
30563 No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
30564 in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
30565 Embedded mode.
30566
30567 Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
30568 are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
30569 the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
30570 This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
30571 move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
30572 needs to be commuted.
30573
30574 @example
30575 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
30576 @end example
30577
30578 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
30579 without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
30580 verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
30581 @kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
30582
30583 @example
30584 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
30585 @end example
30586
30587 @noindent
30588 with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
30589 at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
30590 @samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
30591 normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
30592 it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
30593 RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
30594 stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{C-x * o}).
30595
30596 Typing @kbd{C-x * e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
30597 window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
30598 removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
30599 Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
30600 leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
30601 that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
30602 Embedded mode is concerned.
30603
30604 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
30605 possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
30606 formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
30607 ``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
30608 press @kbd{C-x * e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
30609 regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
30610 the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
30611 own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
30612 will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
30613 you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
30614
30615 @node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30616 @section More About Embedded Mode
30617
30618 @noindent
30619 When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
30620 the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
30621 loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
30622 written. If the formula contains any @LaTeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
30623 it is parsed (i.e., read) in @LaTeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
30624 be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
30625 it is parsed according to the current language mode.
30626
30627 Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
30628 the formula it reads in. Even though it can read a @LaTeX{} formula when
30629 not in @LaTeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
30630 whatever language mode is in effect.
30631
30632 @tex
30633 \bigskip
30634 @end tex
30635
30636 @kindex d p
30637 @pindex calc-show-plain
30638 Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
30639 example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
30640 specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
30641 recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
30642 command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
30643 formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
30644 When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
30645 front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
30646 version.
30647
30648 Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30649 by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30650 character begins a comment in @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}, so if your formula is
30651 embedded in a @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} document its plain version will be
30652 invisible in the final printed copy. Certain major modes have different
30653 delimiters to ensure that the ``plain'' version will be
30654 in a comment for those modes, also.
30655 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode} to see how to change the ``plain''
30656 formula delimiters.
30657
30658 There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30659 formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30660 read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30661 and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30662 Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30663 the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30664 these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30665 Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30666
30667 Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30668 specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30669 any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30670 lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30671 mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30672 in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30673
30674 @tex
30675 \bigskip
30676 @end tex
30677
30678 Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30679 exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30680 which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30681 type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30682 If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30683 full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30684 even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30685 formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30686 each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30687 save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30688 all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30689 ``plain'' mode.
30690
30691 @tex
30692 \bigskip
30693 @end tex
30694
30695 In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30696 sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30697 work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30698 like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30699 the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30700
30701 @smallexample
30702 The derivative of
30703
30704 ln(ln(x))
30705
30706 is
30707
30708 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30709
30710 whose value at x = 2 is
30711
30712 @r{(the value)}
30713
30714 and at x = 3 is
30715
30716 @r{(the value)}
30717 @end smallexample
30718
30719 @kindex C-x * d
30720 @pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30721 The @kbd{C-x * d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30722 handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{C-x * d},
30723 the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30724 mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30725 Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30726
30727 For this example, you would start with just
30728
30729 @smallexample
30730 The derivative of
30731
30732 ln(ln(x))
30733 @end smallexample
30734
30735 @noindent
30736 and press @kbd{C-x * d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30737 is
30738
30739 @smallexample
30740 The derivative of
30741
30742 ln(ln(x))
30743
30744
30745 ln(ln(x))
30746 @end smallexample
30747
30748 @noindent
30749 with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30750 You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30751 @kbd{C-x * d C-x * d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30752 To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30753 the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30754 and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30755
30756 Finally, you would want to press @kbd{C-x * e} to exit Embedded
30757 mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30758 various formulas and numbers.
30759
30760 @tex
30761 \bigskip
30762 @end tex
30763
30764 @kindex C-x * f
30765 @kindex C-x * '
30766 @pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30767 The @kbd{C-x * f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30768 creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30769 some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30770 and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30771 then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30772 typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30773 the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{C-x * e}. The key sequence
30774 @kbd{C-x * '} is equivalent to @kbd{C-x * f}.
30775
30776 @kindex C-x * n
30777 @kindex C-x * p
30778 @pindex calc-embedded-next
30779 @pindex calc-embedded-previous
30780 The @kbd{C-x * n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{C-x * p}
30781 (@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30782 next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30783 can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30784 formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30785 text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30786 which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30787 @kbd{C-x * n} and @kbd{C-x * p} are a useful way to tell which
30788 embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30789 commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30790 formula, they just move the cursor.
30791
30792 @kindex C-x * `
30793 @pindex calc-embedded-edit
30794 The @kbd{C-x * `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30795 embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30796 Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30797 @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30798
30799 @node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30800 @section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30801
30802 @noindent
30803 The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30804 are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30805 a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30806 other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30807
30808 An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30809
30810 @example
30811 foo := 5
30812 @end example
30813
30814 @noindent
30815 records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30816 purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30817 does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30818 of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30819 formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30820
30821 One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30822 Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30823 @kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30824 @code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30825 is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30826
30827 @example
30828 foo + 7 => 12
30829 @end example
30830
30831 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30832
30833 If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30834 @samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30835
30836 @example
30837 foo := 17
30838
30839 foo + 7 => 24
30840 @end example
30841
30842 The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30843 assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30844 Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30845 by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30846 variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30847
30848 @example
30849 17
30850
30851 foo + 7 => foo + 7
30852 @end example
30853
30854 The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30855 will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30856 Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30857 Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30858
30859 @kindex C-x * j
30860 @pindex calc-embedded-select
30861 The @kbd{C-x * j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30862 easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{C-x * e},
30863 except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30864 @kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30865 is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30866 A formula can also be a combination of both:
30867
30868 @example
30869 bar := foo + 3 => 20
30870 @end example
30871
30872 @noindent
30873 in which case @kbd{C-x * j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30874
30875 The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
30876 mode.
30877
30878 @kindex C-x * u
30879 @pindex calc-embedded-update-formula
30880 Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
30881 to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
30882 mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
30883 the change. The @kbd{C-x * u} (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula})
30884 command is a convenient way to do this.
30885
30886 @example
30887 foo := 6
30888
30889 foo + 7 => 13
30890 @end example
30891
30892 Pressing @kbd{C-x * u} is much like pressing @kbd{C-x * e = C-x * e}, that
30893 is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
30894 cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{C-x * u} does
30895 not actually use @kbd{C-x * e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
30896 else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{C-x * u} and
30897 that formula will not be disturbed.
30898
30899 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * u} updates all active
30900 @samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
30901 been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
30902 @samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
30903 (This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
30904
30905 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u C-x * u} updates only in the
30906 region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
30907
30908 @kbd{C-x * u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
30909 @samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
30910 file.
30911
30912 @kindex C-x * a
30913 @pindex calc-embedded-activate
30914 The @kbd{C-x * a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
30915 through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
30916 that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
30917 that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
30918 formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
30919 the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
30920 changed.
30921
30922 It is a good idea to type @kbd{C-x * a} right after loading a file
30923 that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
30924 ``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
30925 automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
30926 a few lines that look like this:
30927
30928 @example
30929 --- Local Variables: ---
30930 --- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
30931 --- End: ---
30932 @end example
30933
30934 @noindent
30935 where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
30936 any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
30937 or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
30938 leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
30939 C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
30940 trailing strings.
30941
30942 When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
30943 section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
30944 section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
30945 @kbd{C-x * a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
30946 The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
30947 end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
30948 page of the file if the file has any page separators.
30949 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30950 Emacs manual}.
30951
30952 Note that @kbd{C-x * a} does not update the formulas it finds.
30953 To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 C-x * u} after @w{@kbd{C-x * a}}.
30954 Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
30955 formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
30956 saved.
30957
30958 Normally, @kbd{C-x * a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
30959 any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
30960 positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * a} first deactivates
30961 all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
30962 its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
30963 @kbd{C-x * a} simply deactivates all formulas.
30964
30965 Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
30966 which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
30967 It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
30968 formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{C-x * a}
30969 and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
30970 happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
30971 a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
30972 due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
30973 @samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
30974 formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
30975 a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{C-x * a}, or if you
30976 used @kbd{C-x * a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
30977 because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
30978 in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
30979 (e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- C-x * a}).
30980
30981 Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
30982 in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
30983 nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
30984 following assignment is used.
30985
30986 @example
30987 x => 1
30988
30989 x := 1
30990
30991 x => 1
30992
30993 x := 2
30994
30995 x => 2
30996 @end example
30997
30998 As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
30999 expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
31000 @code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
31001 Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
31002 but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
31003 only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
31004
31005 If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
31006 stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
31007 or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
31008 Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
31009 and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
31010 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
31011 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
31012
31013 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
31014 recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
31015 recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{C-x * u} to update these
31016 formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
31017 plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
31018 to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 C-x * u}
31019 to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
31020 controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
31021 Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
31022 stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
31023 use @kbd{C-x * u} to update the buffer by hand.
31024
31025 @node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31026 @section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
31027
31028 @kindex m e
31029 @pindex calc-embedded-preserve-modes
31030 @noindent
31031 The mode settings can be changed while Calc is in embedded mode, but
31032 by default they will revert to their original values when embedded mode
31033 is ended. However, the modes saved when the mode-recording mode is
31034 @code{Save} (see below) and the modes in effect when the @kbd{m e}
31035 (@code{calc-embedded-preserve-modes}) command is given
31036 will be preserved when embedded mode is ended.
31037
31038 Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
31039 settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
31040 in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
31041 file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
31042 case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
31043 is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
31044
31045 When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
31046 mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
31047 a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
31048 delimiter of the formula.
31049
31050 @example
31051 % [calc-mode: fractions: t]
31052 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31053 @end example
31054
31055 When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
31056 the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
31057 Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
31058 in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
31059 the file, or up to a line of the form
31060
31061 @example
31062 % [calc-defaults]
31063 @end example
31064
31065 @noindent
31066 which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
31067 scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
31068 ``zone'' of mode settings and another.
31069
31070 If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
31071 closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
31072 formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
31073 below).
31074
31075 The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
31076 square brackets and the text they enclose. In fact, the leading
31077 characters are different for different major modes. You can edit the
31078 mode annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
31079 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
31080 that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
31081 mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
31082 the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
31083 Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
31084
31085 If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
31086 a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
31087 modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
31088 one.
31089
31090 Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
31091 after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
31092 of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
31093 the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
31094 or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
31095 second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
31096 sure the value is of a valid type or range; if you write an
31097 annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
31098 will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
31099
31100 While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
31101 the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
31102 annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
31103 formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
31104 causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
31105 @kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
31106
31107 @code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
31108 that look like this, respectively:
31109
31110 @example
31111 % [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31112 % [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
31113 @end example
31114
31115 The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
31116 is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
31117 when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
31118 is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
31119 yet, is not relevant here.)
31120
31121 @code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
31122 of the file:
31123
31124 @example
31125 % [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
31126 @end example
31127
31128 Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
31129 and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
31130 mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
31131 the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
31132 formulas in the file.
31133
31134 Enabling a formula with @kbd{C-x * e} causes a fresh scan for local
31135 mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
31136 above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
31137 a formula with @kbd{C-x * u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
31138 global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{C-x * a}.
31139
31140 Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
31141 mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
31142 In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
31143 first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
31144 formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
31145 rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
31146
31147 @example
31148 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31149 1.23e2
31150
31151 456.
31152 @end example
31153
31154 We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{C-x * u}
31155 on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
31156
31157 Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are available
31158 which are also available outside of Embedded mode.
31159 (@pxref{General Mode Commands}.) They are @code{Save}, in which mode
31160 settings are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given
31161 by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el})
31162 rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
31163 mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
31164 the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
31165 annotations at all.
31166
31167 When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
31168 for @code{Save} have no effect.
31169
31170 @node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31171 @section Customizing Embedded Mode
31172
31173 @noindent
31174 You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
31175 variables described here. These variables are customizable
31176 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), or you can use @kbd{M-x set-variable}
31177 or @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly.
31178 (Another possibility would be to use a file-local variable annotation at
31179 the end of the file;
31180 @pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the Emacs manual}.)
31181 Many of the variables given mentioned here can be set to depend on the
31182 major mode of the editing buffer (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
31183
31184 @vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
31185 The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
31186 expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
31187 , Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
31188 how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
31189 pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
31190 blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
31191 @code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
31192 regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
31193 in detail.
31194
31195 The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
31196 Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
31197 @code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
31198 Lisp program.
31199
31200 The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
31201 contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
31202 of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
31203 string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
31204 interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
31205 new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
31206 So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
31207 @samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
31208
31209 Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
31210 to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
31211 a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
31212 expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
31213 or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
31214 @samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
31215
31216 The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
31217 ``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
31218 which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
31219 that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
31220 that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
31221 one or two dollar signs.
31222
31223 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
31224 like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
31225 recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
31226
31227 By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
31228 or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
31229 is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
31230 newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
31231 latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
31232 The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
31233 must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
31234
31235 See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
31236 But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
31237 which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
31238 some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
31239 the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
31240 must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
31241 account for each of these six backslashes!)
31242
31243 @vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
31244 The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
31245 expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
31246 regular expression to match the above example would be
31247 @code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
31248 other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
31249 @samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
31250 of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
31251 case).
31252
31253 @vindex calc-embedded-word-regexp
31254 The @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} variable holds a regular expression
31255 used to define an expression to look for (a ``word'') when you type
31256 @kbd{C-x * w} to enable Embedded mode.
31257
31258 @vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
31259 The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
31260 begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
31261 formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
31262 actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
31263 to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
31264 The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space), but may
31265 be different for certain major modes.
31266
31267 @vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
31268 The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
31269 ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}, but may be
31270 different for different major modes. Without
31271 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
31272 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
31273
31274 @vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
31275 The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
31276 which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
31277 @kbd{C-x * f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
31278 string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{C-x * f} is
31279 typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip this
31280 first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
31281 the file.
31282
31283 @vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
31284 The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
31285 string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
31286 value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
31287 @w{@kbd{C-x * f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
31288 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
31289 newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
31290
31291 @vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
31292 The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
31293 expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
31294 The @kbd{C-x * a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
31295 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{C-x * a} will
31296 not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
31297 all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
31298 But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
31299 actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
31300 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, but may be
31301 different for different major modes.
31302 This pattern will check for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of
31303 lines beginning with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to
31304 make Calc consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the
31305 formula's opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
31306
31307 @vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
31308 The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
31309 regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
31310 Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
31311 annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
31312 the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
31313 The default is @code{"% "}, but may be different for different major
31314 modes.
31315
31316 @vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
31317 The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
31318 follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
31319 is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}, but may be different for different
31320 major modes. If you change this, it is a good idea still to end with a
31321 newline so that mode annotations will appear on lines by themselves.
31322
31323 @node Programming, Copying, Embedded Mode, Top
31324 @chapter Programming
31325
31326 @noindent
31327 There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
31328 on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
31329
31330 @enumerate
31331 @item
31332 @dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
31333 and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
31334 keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
31335 as loops and conditionals.
31336
31337 @item
31338 @dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
31339 new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
31340 as an interactive command.
31341
31342 @item
31343 @dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
31344 @xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
31345 @code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
31346 results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
31347 evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
31348
31349 @item
31350 @dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
31351 is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
31352 can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
31353 can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
31354 rewrite rules.
31355 @end enumerate
31356
31357 @kindex z
31358 Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
31359 prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
31360 beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
31361 use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
31362 command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
31363 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
31364 described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
31365
31366 @menu
31367 * Creating User Keys::
31368 * Keyboard Macros::
31369 * Invocation Macros::
31370 * Algebraic Definitions::
31371 * Lisp Definitions::
31372 @end menu
31373
31374 @node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
31375 @section Creating User Keys
31376
31377 @noindent
31378 @kindex Z D
31379 @pindex calc-user-define
31380 Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
31381 (@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
31382 sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
31383
31384 The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
31385 press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
31386 prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
31387 run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
31388 available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
31389 @kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
31390 in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
31391 @kbd{z s} to be something else.
31392
31393 You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
31394 backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
31395
31396 As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
31397 all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
31398 Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
31399
31400 User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
31401 (@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
31402 function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
31403 You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
31404 of a letter if you wish.
31405
31406 @kindex Z U
31407 @pindex calc-user-undefine
31408 The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
31409 For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
31410 key we defined above.
31411
31412 @kindex Z P
31413 @pindex calc-user-define-permanent
31414 @cindex Storing user definitions
31415 @cindex Permanent user definitions
31416 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
31417 The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
31418 binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
31419 sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
31420 your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
31421 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}.) For example,
31422 @kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
31423 you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
31424 file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
31425 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
31426
31427 The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
31428 command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
31429 key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
31430 which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
31431 command will save all of these definitions.
31432 To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
31433 when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
31434 without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
31435 @samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
31436 (If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
31437 and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
31438 not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
31439 or key bindings associated with the function.)
31440
31441 @kindex Z E
31442 @pindex calc-user-define-edit
31443 @cindex Editing user definitions
31444 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
31445 of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
31446 keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
31447 following sections.
31448
31449 @node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
31450 @section Programming with Keyboard Macros
31451
31452 @noindent
31453 @kindex X
31454 @cindex Programming with keyboard macros
31455 @cindex Keyboard macros
31456 The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
31457 keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
31458 this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
31459 performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
31460 Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
31461 execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
31462 @xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
31463 information.
31464
31465 When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
31466 treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
31467 display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
31468 fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
31469 macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
31470 other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
31471 command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
31472 and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
31473 outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
31474 buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
31475 must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
31476 at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
31477 instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
31478
31479 Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
31480 Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
31481 macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
31482 analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
31483
31484 @menu
31485 * Naming Keyboard Macros::
31486 * Conditionals in Macros::
31487 * Loops in Macros::
31488 * Local Values in Macros::
31489 * Queries in Macros::
31490 @end menu
31491
31492 @node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31493 @subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
31494
31495 @noindent
31496 @kindex Z K
31497 @pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
31498 Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
31499 key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
31500 This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
31501 example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
31502 define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
31503 (@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
31504 @kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
31505 sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
31506 just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
31507 @samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
31508 @kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
31509 descriptive command name if you wish.
31510
31511 Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
31512 in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
31513 as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
31514 give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
31515
31516 Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
31517 @kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
31518
31519 @cindex Keyboard macros, editing
31520 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31521 been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
31522 edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
31523 the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
31524 buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
31525 The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
31526 @code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
31527 sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
31528 @code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
31529 copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
31530 same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
31531 takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
31532 we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
31533 @kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
31534
31535 @kindex C-x * m
31536 @pindex read-kbd-macro
31537 The @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
31538 of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
31539 It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
31540 in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
31541
31542 @node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31543 @subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
31544
31545 @noindent
31546 @kindex Z [
31547 @kindex Z ]
31548 @pindex calc-kbd-if
31549 @pindex calc-kbd-else
31550 @pindex calc-kbd-else-if
31551 @pindex calc-kbd-end-if
31552 @cindex Conditional structures
31553 The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
31554 commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
31555 sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
31556 a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
31557 zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
31558 @kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
31559 performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
31560
31561 For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
31562 function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
31563 number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
31564 (@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
31565 executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
31566 command is skipped.
31567
31568 To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
31569 keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
31570 executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
31571 re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
31572 suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
31573 don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
31574
31575 Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
31576 one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
31577
31578 @kindex Z :
31579 The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
31580 two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
31581 @var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
31582 (i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
31583 has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
31584 @var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
31585 be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
31586
31587 @kindex Z |
31588 The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
31589 between any number of alternatives. For example,
31590 @kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
31591 @var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
31592 otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
31593 it will execute @var{part3}.
31594
31595 More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
31596 next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
31597 actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
31598 @kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
31599 @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
31600 equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
31601 does not.
31602
31603 Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
31604 keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
31605 and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
31606 constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
31607 occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
31608 uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
31609 is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
31610 not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
31611 Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
31612
31613 @kindex Z C-g
31614 If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
31615 macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
31616 actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
31617
31618 @node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31619 @subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
31620
31621 @noindent
31622 @kindex Z <
31623 @kindex Z >
31624 @pindex calc-kbd-repeat
31625 @pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
31626 @cindex Looping structures
31627 @cindex Iterative structures
31628 The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
31629 (@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
31630 which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
31631 the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
31632 body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
31633 computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
31634 stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
31635 pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
31636 repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
31637
31638 Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
31639 In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
31640 conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
31641 happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
31642 Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
31643 then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
31644 another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
31645 in a buffer, then use @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
31646 macro.
31647
31648 @kindex Z /
31649 @pindex calc-break
31650 The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31651 of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31652 if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31653 innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31654 after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31655 effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31656 in the C language.
31657
31658 @kindex Z (
31659 @kindex Z )
31660 @pindex calc-kbd-for
31661 @pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31662 The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31663 commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31664 value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31665 @kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31666 command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31667 a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31668 The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31669 stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31670 counter each time until the loop finishes.
31671
31672 @cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31673 By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31674 less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31675 than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31676 executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31677 once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31678 squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31679
31680 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31681 forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31682 is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31683 Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31684 argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31685 argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31686
31687 @kindex Z @{
31688 @kindex Z @}
31689 @pindex calc-kbd-loop
31690 @pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31691 The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31692 (@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31693 @kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31694 effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31695 loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31696 doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31697 to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31698 feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31699 running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31700 this feature.)
31701
31702 The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31703 keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31704 For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31705 ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31706 as easily as in a macro definition.
31707
31708 @xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31709 conditional and looping commands.
31710
31711 @node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31712 @subsection Local Values in Macros
31713
31714 @noindent
31715 @cindex Local variables
31716 @cindex Restoring saved modes
31717 Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31718 without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31719 macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31720 precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31721 modes.
31722
31723 @kindex Z `
31724 @kindex Z '
31725 @pindex calc-kbd-push
31726 @pindex calc-kbd-pop
31727 Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31728 local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31729 outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31730 (@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31731
31732 When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31733 the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31734 variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31735 you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31736 Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31737
31738 If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31739 a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31740 the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31741 @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31742 in exceptional conditions.
31743
31744 If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31745 you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31746 edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31747 as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31748 type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31749 will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31750 macros were involved.
31751
31752 The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31753 and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31754 simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31755 Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31756 (Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31757 thereof) are also saved.
31758
31759 Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31760 they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31761 or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31762 be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31763 for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31764
31765 In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31766 listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31767 will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31768 Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31769 to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31770 outside the construct.
31771
31772 The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31773 other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31774 are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31775
31776 @node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31777 @subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31778
31779 @c @noindent
31780 @c @kindex Z =
31781 @c @pindex calc-kbd-report
31782 @c The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31783 @c message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31784 @c to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31785 @c is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31786 @c to turn such messages off.
31787
31788 @noindent
31789 @kindex Z #
31790 @pindex calc-kbd-query
31791 The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command prompts for an algebraic
31792 entry which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro
31793 execution. All the normal conventions of algebraic input, including the
31794 use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported. The prompt message itself is
31795 taken from the top of the stack, and so must be entered (as a string)
31796 before the @kbd{Z #} command. (Recall, as a string it can be entered by
31797 pressing the @kbd{"} key and will appear as a vector when it is put on
31798 the stack. The prompt message is only put on the stack to provide a
31799 prompt for the @kbd{Z #} command; it will not play any role in any
31800 subsequent calculations.) This command allows your keyboard macros to
31801 accept numbers or formulas as interactive input.
31802
31803 As an example,
31804 @kbd{2 @key{RET} "Power: " @key{RET} Z # 3 @key{RET} ^} will prompt for
31805 input with ``Power: '' in the minibuffer, then return 2 to the provided
31806 power. (The response to the prompt that's given, 3 in this example,
31807 will not be part of the macro.)
31808
31809 @xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31810 @kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31811 keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31812 @kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31813 any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31814 return control to the keyboard macro.
31815
31816 @node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31817 @section Invocation Macros
31818
31819 @kindex C-x * z
31820 @kindex Z I
31821 @pindex calc-user-invocation
31822 @pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31823 Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{C-x * z}
31824 (@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31825 your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31826 macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31827 @kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31828 There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31829 additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31830 @kbd{C-x * z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31831
31832 For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31833 numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31834 by typing @kbd{C-x * r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31835 To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( C-x * r
31836 V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31837 just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{C-x * z}.
31838
31839 Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31840 all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31841 do not apply. @kbd{C-x * z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31842 uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31843 macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31844
31845 The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31846 @kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31847 @xref{General Mode Commands}.
31848
31849 @node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31850 @section Programming with Formulas
31851
31852 @noindent
31853 @kindex Z F
31854 @pindex calc-user-define-formula
31855 @cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31856 Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31857 The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31858 formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31859 command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31860 name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31861 non-numeric arguments.
31862
31863 For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31864 @samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31865 formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31866 name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31867 for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31868 @code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31869 @kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31870
31871 If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31872 @key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31873 @kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31874 @kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
31875
31876 The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
31877 use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
31878 prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
31879 it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
31880 This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
31881 new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
31882 Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
31883 stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
31884 formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
31885
31886 The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
31887 associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
31888 The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
31889 into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
31890 This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
31891 two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
31892 @samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
31893 push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
31894 would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
31895 @expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
31896 @samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
31897 @expr{b=100} in the definition.
31898
31899 You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
31900 control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
31901 you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
31902 in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
31903 for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
31904 with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
31905 @samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
31906
31907 You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
31908 formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
31909 In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
31910 using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
31911
31912 The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
31913 arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
31914 executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
31915 arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
31916 form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
31917 then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
31918 arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
31919 formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
31920 question.
31921
31922 If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
31923 call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
31924 Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
31925 derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
31926
31927 @kindex Z G
31928 @pindex calc-get-user-defn
31929 Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
31930 with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
31931 key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
31932 key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
31933 specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
31934 an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
31935 by a @kbd{Z F} command.
31936
31937 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31938 been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
31939 to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
31940 store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
31941 @kbd{C-x k} to
31942 cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
31943 definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
31944 @kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
31945 then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
31946
31947 As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
31948 In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
31949 definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
31950
31951 You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
31952 @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
31953 used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
31954 which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
31955 ``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
31956 @expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
31957 default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
31958 in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
31959 @kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
31960
31961 @node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
31962 @section Programming with Lisp
31963
31964 @noindent
31965 The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
31966 do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
31967 in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
31968 automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
31969 @code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
31970 Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
31971 standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
31972 bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
31973 will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
31974
31975 Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
31976 assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
31977 Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
31978 to program the Calculator.
31979
31980 This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
31981 small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
31982 your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
31983 Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
31984 for the true Lisp enthusiast.
31985
31986 @menu
31987 * Defining Functions::
31988 * Defining Simple Commands::
31989 * Defining Stack Commands::
31990 * Argument Qualifiers::
31991 * Example Definitions::
31992
31993 * Calling Calc from Your Programs::
31994 * Internals::
31995 @end menu
31996
31997 @node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
31998 @subsection Defining New Functions
31999
32000 @noindent
32001 @findex defmath
32002 The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
32003 except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
32004 range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
32005 to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
32006 example,
32007
32008 @example
32009 (defmath myfact (n)
32010 (if (> n 0)
32011 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32012 1))
32013 @end example
32014
32015 @noindent
32016 This actually expands to the code,
32017
32018 @example
32019 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32020 (if (math-posp n)
32021 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32022 1))
32023 @end example
32024
32025 @noindent
32026 This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
32027
32028 The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
32029 expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
32030 formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
32031 factorial function would be written along the following lines:
32032
32033 @smallexample
32034 (defmath myfact (n)
32035 (if (> n 0)
32036 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32037 (if (= n 0)
32038 1
32039 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
32040 @end smallexample
32041
32042 If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
32043 (except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
32044 will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
32045 time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
32046 it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
32047 efficiently as possible.
32048
32049 The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
32050 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
32051 @code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
32052 @code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
32053 @code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
32054 @code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
32055
32056 For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
32057 @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
32058 name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
32059 is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
32060 used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
32061 the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
32062 always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
32063
32064 Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
32065 the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
32066 @code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
32067 or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
32068 @samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
32069
32070 A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
32071
32072 @itemize @bullet
32073 @item
32074 The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
32075 Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
32076 element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
32077 the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
32078 yields one element of a Calc matrix.
32079
32080 @item
32081 The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
32082 Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
32083 a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
32084 @code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
32085 in which case the effect is to store into the specified
32086 element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
32087 into one element of a matrix.
32088
32089 @item
32090 A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
32091 @samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
32092 binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
32093 form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
32094 without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
32095 Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
32096 are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
32097 @expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
32098 @code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
32099 that each element of the header is a list of three or four
32100 things, not just two.
32101
32102 @item
32103 The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
32104 For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
32105 @code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
32106 @expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
32107 the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
32108
32109 @item
32110 The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
32111 @code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
32112 value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
32113 loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
32114
32115 @item
32116 The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
32117 function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
32118 as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
32119 inside the body of the function.
32120 @end itemize
32121
32122 Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
32123 directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
32124 reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
32125 Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
32126 formula can go between the quotes. For example,
32127
32128 @smallexample
32129 (defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
32130 (and (numberp x)
32131 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
32132 @end smallexample
32133
32134 expands to
32135
32136 @smallexample
32137 (defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
32138 (and (math-numberp x)
32139 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
32140 @end smallexample
32141
32142 Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
32143 a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
32144 could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
32145 @samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
32146 step of @code{myfact} could have been written
32147
32148 @example
32149 :"n * myfact(n-1)"
32150 @end example
32151
32152 A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
32153 (the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
32154 @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
32155 If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
32156 and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
32157 seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
32158 this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
32159 loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
32160 actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
32161 commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
32162 to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
32163
32164 @example
32165 (put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
32166 (defmath ... )
32167 (defmath ... )
32168 ))
32169 @end example
32170
32171 @noindent
32172 @vindex calc-define
32173 The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
32174 symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
32175 property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
32176 its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
32177 the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
32178 values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
32179 properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
32180 (like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
32181 name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
32182
32183 The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
32184 file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
32185 that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
32186 after Calc itself is loaded.
32187
32188 The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
32189 that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
32190 @file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
32191 that the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
32192
32193 If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
32194 you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
32195 call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
32196 after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
32197 sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
32198 new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
32199 @kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
32200 protect against this situation, you can put
32201
32202 @example
32203 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32204 @end example
32205
32206 @findex calc-check-defines
32207 @noindent
32208 at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
32209 looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
32210 has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
32211 is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
32212
32213 Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
32214 property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
32215 the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
32216 Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
32217
32218 @node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
32219 @subsection Defining New Simple Commands
32220
32221 @noindent
32222 @findex interactive
32223 If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
32224 a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
32225 function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
32226 with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
32227 with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
32228 the command work in the Calc environment.
32229
32230 In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
32231 for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
32232
32233 @smallexample
32234 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32235 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
32236 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
32237 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32238 @end smallexample
32239
32240 This expands to the pair of definitions,
32241
32242 @smallexample
32243 (defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
32244 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32245 (interactive "p")
32246 (calc-wrapper
32247 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
32248
32249 (defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
32250 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32251 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
32252 @end smallexample
32253
32254 @noindent
32255 where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
32256 that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
32257 the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
32258 @code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
32259
32260 @findex calc-wrapper
32261 The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
32262 the function with code that looks roughly like this:
32263
32264 @smallexample
32265 (let ((calc-command-flags nil))
32266 (unwind-protect
32267 (save-current-buffer
32268 (calc-select-buffer)
32269 @emph{body of function}
32270 @emph{renumber stack}
32271 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
32272 @emph{realign cursor and window}
32273 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
32274 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
32275 @end smallexample
32276
32277 @findex calc-select-buffer
32278 The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @samp{*Calculator*}
32279 buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
32280 the @samp{*Calc Trail*} window.
32281
32282 @findex calc-set-command-flag
32283 You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
32284 set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
32285 following command flags:
32286
32287 @table @code
32288 @item renum-stack
32289 Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
32290 after this command completes. This is set by routines like
32291 @code{calc-push}.
32292
32293 @item clear-message
32294 Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
32295 (to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
32296
32297 @item no-align
32298 Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
32299
32300 @item position-point
32301 Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
32302 @code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
32303 this command finishes.
32304
32305 @item keep-flags
32306 Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
32307 and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
32308
32309 @item do-edit
32310 Switch to buffer @samp{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
32311
32312 @item hold-trail
32313 Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
32314 there.
32315 @end table
32316
32317 @kindex Y
32318 @kindex Y ?
32319 @vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
32320 Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
32321 extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
32322 this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
32323 from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
32324 @kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
32325 (initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
32326 other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
32327 future versions of Calc.
32328
32329 If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
32330 others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
32331 you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
32332 consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
32333 stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
32334 within your package.
32335
32336 Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
32337 that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
32338 example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
32339 to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
32340 value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
32341 if necessary without having to modify the file.
32342
32343 Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
32344 command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
32345 decreases the precision.
32346
32347 @smallexample
32348 ;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
32349 ;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
32350
32351 (defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
32352 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
32353
32354 (put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
32355
32356 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
32357 'increase-precision)
32358 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
32359 'decrease-precision)
32360
32361 (setq calc-Y-help-msgs
32362 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
32363 calc-Y-help-msgs))
32364
32365 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32366 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32367 (interactive "p")
32368 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32369
32370 (defmath decrease-precision (delta)
32371 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
32372 (interactive "p")
32373 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
32374
32375 )) ; end of calc-define property
32376
32377 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32378 @end smallexample
32379
32380 @node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
32381 @subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
32382
32383 @noindent
32384 To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
32385 on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
32386
32387 @example
32388 (interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
32389 @end example
32390
32391 @noindent
32392 where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
32393 to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
32394 @code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
32395 function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
32396 @code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
32397 parameters is valid.
32398
32399 Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
32400 acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
32401 are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
32402 recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
32403 a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
32404 or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
32405
32406 As an example, the definition
32407
32408 @smallexample
32409 (defmath myfact (n)
32410 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32411 (interactive 1 "fact")
32412 (if (> n 0)
32413 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32414 (and (= n 0) 1)))
32415 @end smallexample
32416
32417 @noindent
32418 is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
32419 as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
32420
32421 @smallexample
32422 (defun calc-myfact ()
32423 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32424 (interactive)
32425 (calc-slow-wrapper
32426 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
32427 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
32428
32429 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32430 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32431 (if (math-posp n)
32432 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32433 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
32434 @end smallexample
32435
32436 @findex calc-slow-wrapper
32437 The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
32438 that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
32439 computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
32440 with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
32441
32442 @findex calc-top-list-n
32443 The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
32444 of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
32445 calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
32446 empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
32447
32448 @findex calc-enter-result
32449 The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
32450 @var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
32451 Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
32452 resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
32453 of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
32454 being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
32455
32456 Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
32457 ``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
32458 in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
32459 onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
32460 containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
32461
32462 The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
32463 Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
32464 @var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
32465
32466 @example
32467 (defmath foo (a b &optional c)
32468 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
32469 @var{body})
32470 @end example
32471
32472 In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
32473 @samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
32474 executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
32475
32476 The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
32477 code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
32478 number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
32479 In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
32480 arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
32481
32482 @node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
32483 @subsection Argument Qualifiers
32484
32485 @noindent
32486 Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
32487 an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
32488
32489 @example
32490 (defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
32491 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
32492 &rest @var{param})
32493 @var{body})
32494 @end example
32495
32496 @noindent
32497 where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
32498
32499 @example
32500 (@var{qual} @var{param})
32501 @end example
32502
32503 The following qualifiers are recognized:
32504
32505 @table @samp
32506 @item complete
32507 @findex complete
32508 The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
32509 (This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
32510 function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
32511 own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
32512
32513 @item integer
32514 @findex integer
32515 The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
32516 it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
32517 formulas are rejected.
32518
32519 @item natnum
32520 @findex natnum
32521 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
32522
32523 @item fixnum
32524 @findex fixnum
32525 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
32526 which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
32527 argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
32528
32529 @item float
32530 @findex float
32531 The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
32532 vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
32533 actually rejected by this qualifier.)
32534
32535 @item @var{pred}
32536 The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
32537 standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
32538
32539 @item not-@var{pred}
32540 The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
32541 @end table
32542
32543 For example,
32544
32545 @example
32546 (defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
32547 &rest (integer d))
32548 @var{body})
32549 @end example
32550
32551 @noindent
32552 expands to
32553
32554 @example
32555 (defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
32556 (and (math-matrixp b)
32557 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
32558 (or (math-constp b)
32559 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
32560 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
32561 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
32562 @var{body})
32563 @end example
32564
32565 @noindent
32566 which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
32567 body of the function.
32568
32569 @node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
32570 @subsection Example Definitions
32571
32572 @noindent
32573 This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
32574 These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
32575 @pxref{Internals}.
32576
32577 @menu
32578 * Bit Counting Example::
32579 * Sine Example::
32580 @end menu
32581
32582 @node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
32583 @subsubsection Bit-Counting
32584
32585 @noindent
32586 @ignore
32587 @starindex
32588 @end ignore
32589 @tindex bcount
32590 Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
32591 ``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
32592 to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
32593 that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
32594 create an intermediate set.
32595
32596 @smallexample
32597 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32598 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32599 (let ((count 0))
32600 (while (> n 0)
32601 (if (oddp n)
32602 (setq count (1+ count)))
32603 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
32604 count))
32605 @end smallexample
32606
32607 @noindent
32608 When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
32609 Emacs Lisp function:
32610
32611 @smallexample
32612 (defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
32613 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
32614 (let ((count 0))
32615 (while (math-posp n)
32616 (if (math-oddp n)
32617 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
32618 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
32619 count))
32620 @end smallexample
32621
32622 If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
32623 of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
32624 recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
32625 involve actual division.
32626
32627 To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
32628 @var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
32629 they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
32630 routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
32631 1000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
32632
32633 @smallexample
32634 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32635 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32636 (let ((count 0))
32637 (while (not (fixnump n))
32638 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
32639 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
32640 n (car qr))))
32641 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
32642
32643 (defun bcount-fixnum (n)
32644 (let ((count 0))
32645 (while (> n 0)
32646 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32647 n (lsh n -1)))
32648 count))
32649 @end smallexample
32650
32651 @noindent
32652 Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32653 Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32654 it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32655 than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32656 uses.
32657
32658 The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32659 the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32660 might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32661 more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32662 actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32663 a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32664 same thing with a single division by 512.
32665
32666 @node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32667 @subsubsection The Sine Function
32668
32669 @noindent
32670 @ignore
32671 @starindex
32672 @end ignore
32673 @tindex mysin
32674 A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32675 well-known Taylor series expansion for
32676 @texline @math{\sin x}:
32677 @infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32678
32679 @smallexample
32680 (defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32681 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32682 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32683 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32684 newsum
32685 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32686 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32687 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32688 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32689 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32690 x (* x xnegsqr)
32691 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32692 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32693 (break)) ; then we are done.
32694 (setq sum newsum))
32695 sum))
32696 @end smallexample
32697
32698 The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32699 to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32700 ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32701 is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32702 round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32703 by a separate algorithm.
32704
32705 @smallexample
32706 (defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32707 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32708 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32709 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32710 (cond ((complexp x)
32711 (mysin-complex x))
32712 ((< x 0)
32713 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32714 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32715
32716 (defmath mysin-raw (x)
32717 (cond ((>= x 7)
32718 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32719 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32720 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32721 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32722 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32723 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32724 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32725 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32726 @end smallexample
32727
32728 @noindent
32729 where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32730 numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32731 series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32732 @code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32733
32734 The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32735 @code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32736 to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32737 test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32738 that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32739 we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32740 the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32741 recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32742 clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32743 that this rule misses.
32744
32745 If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32746 it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32747 when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32748 a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32749
32750 @node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32751 @subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32752
32753 @noindent
32754 A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32755 Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32756 inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32757 So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32758 @code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32759 need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32760 much simpler to use!
32761
32762 It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32763 options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32764
32765 In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32766 string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32767 the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32768
32769 Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32770 functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32771 Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32772 loaded and initialized for you.
32773
32774 All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32775 evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32776
32777 @ifinfo
32778 @example
32779
32780 @end example
32781 @end ifinfo
32782 @subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32783
32784 @noindent
32785 If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32786 the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32787 separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32788 @samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32789
32790 The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32791 request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32792 one by one below.
32793
32794 You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32795 @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32796 example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32797 expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32798 (assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32799 used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32800
32801 @ifinfo
32802 @example
32803
32804 @end example
32805 @end ifinfo
32806 @subsubsection Error Handling
32807
32808 @noindent
32809 If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32810 the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32811 string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32812 standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32813 division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32814 return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32815
32816 If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32817 using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32818 errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32819 to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32820
32821 If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32822 are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32823 ignored.
32824
32825 As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32826 to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32827 it permanently with @code{setq}.
32828
32829 @ifinfo
32830 @example
32831
32832 @end example
32833 @end ifinfo
32834 @subsubsection Numbers Only
32835
32836 @noindent
32837 Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32838 rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32839 @code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32840 that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32841 reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32842 or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32843
32844 A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32845 object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32846 is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32847
32848 @ifinfo
32849 @example
32850
32851 @end example
32852 @end ifinfo
32853 @subsubsection Default Modes
32854
32855 @noindent
32856 If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32857 element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32858 various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32859 evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32860 digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32861 mode is used.
32862
32863 This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32864 If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32865 be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32866
32867 If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32868 variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32869 settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32870 @file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32871 the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32872 original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32873
32874 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
32875 computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
32876 using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
32877 of the default of 12.
32878
32879 It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
32880 program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
32881 to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
32882 consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
32883 when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
32884
32885 As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
32886 checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
32887 string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
32888 come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
32889 conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
32890 see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
32891
32892 @ifinfo
32893 @example
32894
32895 @end example
32896 @end ifinfo
32897 @subsubsection Raw Numbers
32898
32899 @noindent
32900 Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
32901 You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
32902 in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
32903 numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
32904 from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
32905
32906 If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
32907 as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
32908 how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
32909 treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
32910 structure.
32911
32912 There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
32913 @code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
32914 an error if that object is not a constant).
32915
32916 You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
32917 string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
32918 arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
32919 addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
32920 in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
32921 function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
32922
32923 In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
32924 as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
32925 integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
32926 form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
32927
32928 When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
32929 to format it as a string.
32930
32931 It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
32932 values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
32933 except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
32934
32935 Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
32936 containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
32937 various kinds of error returns discussed above.
32938
32939 @ifinfo
32940 @example
32941
32942 @end example
32943 @end ifinfo
32944 @subsubsection Predicates
32945
32946 @noindent
32947 If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
32948 treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
32949 @code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
32950 non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
32951
32952 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
32953 one value is less than another.
32954
32955 As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
32956 the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
32957 indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
32958 wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
32959 @samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
32960
32961 @ifinfo
32962 @example
32963
32964 @end example
32965 @end ifinfo
32966 @subsubsection Variable Values
32967
32968 @noindent
32969 Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
32970 replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
32971 @code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
32972 if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
32973 @code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
32974 formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
32975 will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
32976
32977 To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
32978 corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
32979 @samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
32980 understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
32981 although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
32982 to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
32983
32984 @example
32985 (setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
32986 @end example
32987
32988 @ifinfo
32989 @example
32990
32991 @end example
32992 @end ifinfo
32993 @subsubsection Stack Access
32994
32995 @noindent
32996 If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
32997 evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
32998 result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
32999 (unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
33000 case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
33001 usual way).
33002
33003 If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
33004 @code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
33005 many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
33006 argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
33007 is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
33008 @samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
33009 the stack.
33010
33011 If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
33012 @code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
33013 stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
33014 @samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
33015 integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
33016
33017 The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
33018 that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
33019 as a string.
33020
33021 In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
33022 order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
33023 Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
33024 second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
33025 instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
33026 hexadecimal instead of decimal.
33027
33028 It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
33029 found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
33030 actually expecting it to affect the stack.
33031
33032 Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @samp{*Calculator*}
33033 buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
33034 the stack buffer if necessary.
33035
33036 @ifinfo
33037 @example
33038
33039 @end example
33040 @end ifinfo
33041 @subsubsection Keyboard Macros
33042
33043 @noindent
33044 If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
33045 string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
33046 This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
33047 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
33048 vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
33049 with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
33050 notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
33051
33052 If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
33053 safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
33054 installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
33055 @kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
33056 ``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
33057
33058 If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
33059 of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
33060 that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
33061
33062 The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
33063
33064 @ifinfo
33065 @example
33066
33067 @end example
33068 @end ifinfo
33069 @subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
33070
33071 @noindent
33072 Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
33073 @code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
33074 be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
33075 quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
33076 @code{calc-eval}.
33077
33078 The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
33079 switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
33080 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
33081 will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
33082
33083 An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
33084 This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
33085 by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
33086 Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
33087 a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
33088 automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
33089 also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
33090 In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
33091 your original buffer when it is done.
33092
33093 As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
33094 expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
33095
33096 The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
33097 returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
33098
33099 @ifinfo
33100 @example
33101
33102 @end example
33103 @end ifinfo
33104 @subsubsection Example
33105
33106 @noindent
33107 @findex convert-temp
33108 Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
33109 you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
33110 Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
33111 references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
33112 Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
33113 command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
33114 already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
33115
33116 @example
33117 (defun convert-temp ()
33118 (interactive)
33119 (save-excursion
33120 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
33121 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
33122 (bot1 (match-end 1))
33123 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
33124 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
33125 (bot2 (match-end 2))
33126 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
33127 (if (equal type "F")
33128 (setq type "C"
33129 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
33130 (setq type "F"
33131 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
33132 (goto-char top2)
33133 (delete-region top2 bot2)
33134 (insert-before-markers type)
33135 (goto-char top1)
33136 (delete-region top1 bot1)
33137 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
33138 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
33139 (insert number))))
33140 @end example
33141
33142 Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
33143 ``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
33144 instead of after it.
33145
33146 @node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
33147 @subsection Calculator Internals
33148
33149 @noindent
33150 This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
33151 may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
33152 rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
33153 conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
33154 generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
33155 apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
33156 their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
33157 prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
33158
33159 The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
33160 Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
33161 for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
33162 function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
33163 autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
33164 in the remaining component files.
33165
33166 Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
33167 generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
33168 normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
33169 be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
33170 special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
33171 from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
33172 before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
33173 prove this file will already be loaded.
33174
33175 @menu
33176 * Data Type Formats::
33177 * Interactive Lisp Functions::
33178 * Stack Lisp Functions::
33179 * Predicates::
33180 * Computational Lisp Functions::
33181 * Vector Lisp Functions::
33182 * Symbolic Lisp Functions::
33183 * Formatting Lisp Functions::
33184 * Hooks::
33185 @end menu
33186
33187 @node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
33188 @subsubsection Data Type Formats
33189
33190 @noindent
33191 Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
33192 Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
33193 Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
33194 which is not a Lisp list.
33195
33196 Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
33197 @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for positive integers 1000000 or more, or
33198 @samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative integers
33199 @mathit{-1000000} or less. Each @var{d} is a base-1000 ``digit,'' a Lisp integer
33200 from 0 to 999. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
33201 @var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
33202 example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} is stored as @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
33203
33204 The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
33205 the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
33206 returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
33207 integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
33208 If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
33209 and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
33210
33211 Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
33212 where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
33213 integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
33214 prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
33215 to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
33216 are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
33217
33218 Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
33219 @var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
33220 @samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
33221 precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
33222 the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
33223 @mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
33224 are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
33225 except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
33226 always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
33227 rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
33228
33229 Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
33230 @var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
33231 integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
33232 The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
33233 components are converted to real numbers automatically.
33234
33235 Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
33236 @var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
33237 is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
33238 usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
33239 or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
33240 If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
33241 (If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
33242 negative real number.)
33243
33244 Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
33245 @var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
33246 a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
33247 float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
33248 in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
33249
33250 Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
33251 a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
33252 January 1, 1 AD. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
33253 form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
33254
33255 Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
33256 positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
33257 form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
33258
33259 Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
33260 is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
33261 component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
33262 (a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
33263 converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
33264 complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
33265
33266 Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
33267 where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
33268 @var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
33269 is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
33270 closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
33271 the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
33272 @w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
33273 intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
33274 represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
33275 is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
33276
33277 Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
33278 is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
33279 An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
33280 where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
33281 Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
33282 generally unused by Calc data structures.
33283
33284 Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
33285 @var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
33286 of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
33287 value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
33288 special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
33289 @var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
33290 signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
33291 @samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
33292 contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
33293 @code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
33294 object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
33295 value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
33296 value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
33297 @var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
33298 which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
33299 which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
33300 only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
33301 cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
33302 the variable is used.
33303
33304 A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
33305 The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
33306 and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
33307 of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
33308 sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
33309 right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
33310 of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
33311 function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
33312 @var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
33313 The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
33314 for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
33315 elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
33316 functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
33317 that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
33318 object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
33319 wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
33320 functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
33321 about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
33322 and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
33323
33324 @node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
33325 @subsubsection Interactive Functions
33326
33327 @noindent
33328 The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
33329 commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
33330 existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
33331 you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
33332
33333 @defun calc-set-command-flag flag
33334 Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
33335 may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
33336 stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
33337 there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
33338 @end defun
33339
33340 @defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
33341 If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
33342 remove it from that list.
33343 @end defun
33344
33345 @defun calc-record-undo rec
33346 Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
33347 current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
33348 automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
33349 you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
33350 which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
33351 contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
33352 the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
33353 contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
33354 @var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
33355 previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
33356 which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
33357 @var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
33358 @samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
33359 @end defun
33360
33361 @defun calc-record-why msg args
33362 Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
33363 This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
33364 if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
33365 enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
33366 @var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
33367 @samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
33368 formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
33369 some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
33370 (such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
33371 satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
33372 integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
33373 automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
33374 @end defun
33375
33376 @defun calc-is-inverse
33377 This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
33378 i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
33379 @end defun
33380
33381 @defun calc-is-hyperbolic
33382 This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
33383 @end defun
33384
33385 @node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
33386 @subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
33387
33388 @noindent
33389 The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
33390 stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
33391
33392 @defun calc-push-list vals n
33393 Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
33394 @var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
33395 are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
33396 elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
33397 end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
33398 The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
33399 are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
33400 is an empty list, nothing happens.
33401
33402 The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
33403 You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
33404 be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
33405 must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
33406 in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
33407 @end defun
33408
33409 @defun calc-top-list n m
33410 Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
33411 stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
33412 taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
33413 defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
33414 one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
33415 @var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
33416 element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
33417 range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
33418 is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
33419 evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
33420
33421 If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
33422 been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
33423 this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
33424 stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
33425 which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
33426 a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
33427 ``invalid operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
33428 the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
33429 If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
33430 or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
33431 command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
33432 list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
33433 formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
33434 @end defun
33435
33436 @defun calc-pop-stack n m
33437 Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
33438 and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
33439 value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
33440
33441 If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
33442 @kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
33443 error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
33444 argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
33445 contain selections.
33446 @end defun
33447
33448 @defun calc-record-list vals tag
33449 This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
33450 are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
33451 tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
33452 will be used.
33453 @end defun
33454
33455 @defun calc-normalize n
33456 This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
33457 least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
33458 current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
33459 selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
33460 actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
33461 it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
33462 @end defun
33463
33464 @defun calc-top-list-n n m
33465 This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
33466 @code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
33467 are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
33468 objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
33469 commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
33470 standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
33471 are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
33472 This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
33473 @code{calc-top-list}.
33474 @end defun
33475
33476 @defun calc-top-n m
33477 This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
33478 a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
33479 of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
33480 @end defun
33481
33482 @defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
33483 This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
33484 The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
33485 of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
33486 stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
33487 non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
33488 A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
33489
33490 @smallexample
33491 (calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
33492 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
33493 @end smallexample
33494
33495 If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
33496 selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
33497 this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
33498 equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
33499 @var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
33500 happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
33501 arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
33502 element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
33503 selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
33504 @var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
33505 you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
33506 combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
33507 are present.
33508 @end defun
33509
33510 @defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
33511 This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
33512 argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
33513 argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
33514 as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
33515 elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
33516
33517 @smallexample
33518 (defun calc-zeta (arg)
33519 (interactive "P")
33520 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
33521 @end smallexample
33522 @end defun
33523
33524 @defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
33525 This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
33526 @code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
33527 arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
33528 one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
33529 is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
33530 is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
33531 is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
33532 specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
33533 the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
33534 stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
33535 mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
33536 top element.
33537 @end defun
33538
33539 @defun calc-stack-size
33540 Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
33541 does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
33542 truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
33543 @end defun
33544
33545 @defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
33546 Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
33547 will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
33548 this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
33549 If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
33550 line number, not the stack entry itself.
33551 @end defun
33552
33553 @defun calc-substack-height n
33554 Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
33555 entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
33556 will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
33557 one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
33558 be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
33559 mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
33560 entries.)
33561 @end defun
33562
33563 @defun calc-refresh
33564 Erase the @code{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
33565 This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
33566 display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
33567 entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
33568 is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
33569 rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
33570 @end defun
33571
33572 @node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
33573 @subsubsection Predicates
33574
33575 @noindent
33576 The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
33577 true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
33578 true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
33579 from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
33580 to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
33581 the full range of Calc data types.
33582
33583 @defun zerop x
33584 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
33585 types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
33586 it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
33587 @samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
33588 and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
33589 @end defun
33590
33591 @defun negp x
33592 Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
33593 of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
33594 all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
33595 @samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
33596 and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
33597 @end defun
33598
33599 @defun posp x
33600 Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
33601 numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
33602 @end defun
33603
33604 @defun looks-negp x
33605 Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
33606 @var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
33607 such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
33608 made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
33609 @end defun
33610
33611 @defun integerp x
33612 Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
33613 @end defun
33614
33615 @defun fixnump x
33616 Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
33617 @end defun
33618
33619 @defun natnump x
33620 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
33621 @end defun
33622
33623 @defun fixnatnump x
33624 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
33625 @end defun
33626
33627 @defun num-integerp x
33628 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
33629 true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
33630 the decimal point.
33631 @end defun
33632
33633 @defun messy-integerp x
33634 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
33635 A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
33636 @code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
33637 @end defun
33638
33639 @defun num-natnump x
33640 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
33641 @end defun
33642
33643 @defun evenp x
33644 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
33645 @end defun
33646
33647 @defun looks-evenp x
33648 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33649 multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33650 @end defun
33651
33652 @defun oddp x
33653 Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33654 @end defun
33655
33656 @defun ratp x
33657 Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33658 fraction.
33659 @end defun
33660
33661 @defun realp x
33662 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33663 or floating-point number.
33664 @end defun
33665
33666 @defun anglep x
33667 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33668 @end defun
33669
33670 @defun floatp x
33671 Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33672 interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33673 is a float.
33674 @end defun
33675
33676 @defun complexp x
33677 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33678 (but not a real number).
33679 @end defun
33680
33681 @defun rect-complexp x
33682 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33683 @end defun
33684
33685 @defun polar-complexp x
33686 Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33687 @end defun
33688
33689 @defun numberp x
33690 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33691 @end defun
33692
33693 @defun scalarp x
33694 Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33695 @end defun
33696
33697 @defun vectorp x
33698 Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33699 is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33700 @end defun
33701
33702 @defun numvecp x
33703 Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33704 @end defun
33705
33706 @defun matrixp x
33707 Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33708 all of the same size.
33709 @end defun
33710
33711 @defun square-matrixp x
33712 Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33713 @end defun
33714
33715 @defun objectp x
33716 Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33717 complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33718 modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33719 as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33720 @end defun
33721
33722 @defun objvecp x
33723 Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33724 incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33725 mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33726 @end defun
33727
33728 @defun primp x
33729 Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33730 i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33731 includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33732 and intervals.
33733 @end defun
33734
33735 @defun constp x
33736 Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33737 HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33738 components are @code{constp}.
33739 @end defun
33740
33741 @defun lessp x y
33742 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33743 if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33744 undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33745 by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33746 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33747 converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33748 and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33749 @end defun
33750
33751 @defun beforep x y
33752 Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33753 of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33754 will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33755 other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33756 objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33757 function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33758 by Calc's algebraic simplifications to put the terms of a product into
33759 canonical order: This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to
33760 @samp{2 x y}.
33761 @end defun
33762
33763 @defun equal x y
33764 This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33765 @var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33766 to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
33767 0 and 0.0 as different.
33768 @end defun
33769
33770 @defun math-equal x y
33771 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33772 they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33773 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33774 converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33775 @end defun
33776
33777 @defun equal-int x n
33778 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33779 is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33780 used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33781 whenever possible.
33782 @end defun
33783
33784 @defun nearly-equal x y
33785 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33786 equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33787 314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33788 precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33789 precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33790 use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33791 series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33792 to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33793 error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33794 lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33795 In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33796 The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33797 @end defun
33798
33799 @defun nearly-zerop x y
33800 Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33801 checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33802 to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33803 if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33804 due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33805 @var{y} must be real.
33806 @end defun
33807
33808 @defun is-true x
33809 Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33810 Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33811 or a provably non-zero formula.
33812 @end defun
33813
33814 @defun reject-arg val pred
33815 Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33816 This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33817 Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33818 function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33819 @end defun
33820
33821 @defun inexact-value
33822 If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33823 @code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33824 ``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33825 Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33826 @code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33827 function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33828 @samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33829 return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33830 @end defun
33831
33832 @defun overflow
33833 This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33834 @end defun
33835
33836 @defun underflow
33837 This signals a floating-point underflow.
33838 @end defun
33839
33840 @node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33841 @subsubsection Computational Functions
33842
33843 @noindent
33844 The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33845 Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33846 the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33847 the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33848 this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33849 command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33850 is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33851
33852 The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33853 @code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33854 in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33855 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33856 respectively, instead.
33857
33858 @defun normalize val
33859 (Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33860 Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33861 is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33862 if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33863 (i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33864 small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33865 forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33866 in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33867 return 6.
33868
33869 If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33870 number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33871 @code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
33872 the formula still in symbolic form.
33873
33874 If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
33875 only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
33876 powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
33877 not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
33878 which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
33879 as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
33880 never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
33881 on the stack.
33882 @end defun
33883
33884 @defun evaluate-expr expr
33885 Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
33886 then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
33887 when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
33888 @end defun
33889
33890 @defmac with-extra-prec n body
33891 Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
33892 digits. This is a macro which expands to
33893
33894 @smallexample
33895 (math-normalize
33896 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
33897 @var{body}))
33898 @end smallexample
33899
33900 The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
33901 result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
33902 is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
33903 mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
33904 @end defmac
33905
33906 @defun make-frac n d
33907 Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
33908 @samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
33909 @end defun
33910
33911 @defun make-float mant exp
33912 Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
33913 of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
33914 properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
33915 if @var{exp} is out of range.
33916 @end defun
33917
33918 @defun make-sdev x sigma
33919 Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
33920 If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
33921 If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
33922 If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
33923 error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33924 @end defun
33925
33926 @defun make-intv mask lo hi
33927 Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
33928 integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
33929 @var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
33930 This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
33931 @end defun
33932
33933 @defun sort-intv mask lo hi
33934 Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
33935 @var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
33936 bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
33937 @end defun
33938
33939 @defun make-mod n m
33940 Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
33941 forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
33942 is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
33943 is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
33944 @end defun
33945
33946 @defun float x
33947 Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
33948 converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
33949 numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33950 modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
33951 or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33952 @end defun
33953
33954 @defun compare x y
33955 Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
33956 @samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
33957 0 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
33958 undefined or cannot be determined.
33959 @end defun
33960
33961 @defun numdigs n
33962 Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
33963 @samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
33964 considered to have zero digits.
33965 @end defun
33966
33967 @defun scale-int x n
33968 Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
33969 digits with truncation toward zero.
33970 @end defun
33971
33972 @defun scale-rounding x n
33973 Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
33974 integer rather than truncating.
33975 @end defun
33976
33977 @defun fixnum n
33978 Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
33979 If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
33980 24 binary bits) the result is undefined.
33981 @end defun
33982
33983 @defun sqr x
33984 Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
33985 @end defun
33986
33987 @defun quotient x y
33988 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
33989 and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
33990 direction of rounding is undefined.
33991 @end defun
33992
33993 @defun idiv x y
33994 Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
33995 integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
33996 @samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
33997 slower than for @code{quotient}.
33998 @end defun
33999
34000 @defun imod x y
34001 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
34002 and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
34003 integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
34004 For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
34005 @end defun
34006
34007 @defun idivmod x y
34008 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
34009 @code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
34010 is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
34011 @end defun
34012
34013 @defun pow x y
34014 Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
34015 also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
34016 @w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
34017 @end defun
34018
34019 @defun abs-approx x
34020 Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
34021 example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
34022 the absolute values of the components.
34023 @end defun
34024
34025 @findex e
34026 @findex gamma-const
34027 @findex ln-2
34028 @findex ln-10
34029 @findex phi
34030 @findex pi-over-2
34031 @findex pi-over-4
34032 @findex pi-over-180
34033 @findex sqrt-two-pi
34034 @findex sqrt-e
34035 @findex two-pi
34036 @defun pi
34037 The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
34038 Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
34039 @code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
34040 @code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, @code{ln-10}, @code{phi} and
34041 @code{gamma-const}. Each function returns a floating-point value in the
34042 current precision, and each uses caching so that all calls after the
34043 first are essentially free.
34044 @end defun
34045
34046 @defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
34047 This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
34048 @code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
34049 It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
34050 if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
34051 form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
34052 is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
34053 satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
34054 with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
34055 two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
34056 calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
34057 digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
34058 again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
34059 @end defmac
34060
34061 @findex half-circle
34062 @findex quarter-circle
34063 @defun full-circle symb
34064 If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
34065 integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
34066 corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
34067 @samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
34068 function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
34069 @end defun
34070
34071 @defun power-of-2 n
34072 Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
34073 integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
34074 particular @var{n} is expensive.
34075 @end defun
34076
34077 @defun integer-log2 n
34078 Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
34079 is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
34080 return @code{nil}.
34081 @end defun
34082
34083 @defun div-mod a b m
34084 Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
34085 there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
34086 @end defun
34087
34088 @defun pow-mod a b m
34089 Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
34090 @var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
34091 algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
34092 @end defun
34093
34094 @defun isqrt n
34095 Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
34096 of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
34097 If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
34098 @end defun
34099
34100 @defun to-hms a ang
34101 Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
34102 it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
34103 or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
34104 is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
34105 @end defun
34106
34107 @defun from-hms a ang
34108 Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
34109 it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
34110 current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
34111 is returned as-is.
34112 @end defun
34113
34114 @defun to-radians a
34115 Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
34116 angular mode.
34117 @end defun
34118
34119 @defun from-radians a
34120 Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
34121 If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
34122 @end defun
34123
34124 @defun to-radians-2 a
34125 Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
34126 radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
34127 @end defun
34128
34129 @defun from-radians-2 a
34130 Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
34131 degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
34132 @end defun
34133
34134 @defun random-digit
34135 Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
34136 @end defun
34137
34138 @defun random-digits n
34139 Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
34140 in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
34141 @end defun
34142
34143 @defun random-float
34144 Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
34145 @end defun
34146
34147 @defun prime-test n iters
34148 Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
34149 one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
34150 because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
34151 was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
34152 @samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
34153 are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
34154 test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
34155 and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
34156 iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
34157 @var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
34158 case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
34159 you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
34160 @code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
34161 @end defun
34162
34163 @defun to-simple-fraction f
34164 If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
34165 as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
34166 For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
34167 fast.
34168 @end defun
34169
34170 @defun to-fraction f tol
34171 Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
34172 a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
34173 function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
34174 @end defun
34175
34176 @defun quarter-integer n
34177 If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
34178 returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
34179 @mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
34180 it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
34181 returns @code{nil}.
34182 @end defun
34183
34184 @node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
34185 @subsubsection Vector Functions
34186
34187 @noindent
34188 The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
34189 matrices.
34190
34191 @defun math-concat x y
34192 Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
34193 in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
34194 @end defun
34195
34196 @defun vec-length v
34197 Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
34198 result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
34199 rows in the matrix.
34200 @end defun
34201
34202 @defun mat-dimens m
34203 Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
34204 a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
34205 but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
34206 of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
34207 the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
34208 produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
34209 @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
34210 and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
34211 elements.
34212 @end defun
34213
34214 @defun dimension-error
34215 Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
34216 The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
34217 form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
34218 @end defun
34219
34220 @defun build-vector args
34221 Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
34222 For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
34223 @samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
34224 @end defun
34225
34226 @defun make-vec obj dims
34227 Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
34228 @var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
34229 filled with 27's.
34230 @end defun
34231
34232 @defun row-matrix v
34233 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
34234 a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
34235 leave it alone.
34236 @end defun
34237
34238 @defun col-matrix v
34239 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
34240 matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
34241 already a matrix, leave it alone.
34242 @end defun
34243
34244 @defun map-vec f v
34245 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
34246 @samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
34247 of vector @var{v}.
34248 @end defun
34249
34250 @defun map-vec-2 f a b
34251 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
34252 If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
34253 vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
34254 for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
34255 @var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
34256 For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
34257 with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
34258 work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
34259 just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
34260 @end defun
34261
34262 @defun reduce-vec f v
34263 Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
34264 @var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
34265 If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
34266 @end defun
34267
34268 @defun reduce-cols f m
34269 Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
34270 example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
34271 is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
34272 @end defun
34273
34274 @defun mat-row m n
34275 Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
34276 @samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
34277 (@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
34278 @end defun
34279
34280 @defun mat-col m n
34281 Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
34282 The arguments are not checked for correctness.
34283 @end defun
34284
34285 @defun mat-less-row m n
34286 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
34287 number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
34288 @end defun
34289
34290 @defun mat-less-col m n
34291 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
34292 @end defun
34293
34294 @defun transpose m
34295 Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
34296 @end defun
34297
34298 @defun flatten-vector v
34299 Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
34300 if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
34301 @end defun
34302
34303 @defun copy-matrix m
34304 If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
34305 @code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
34306 element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
34307 element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
34308 the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
34309 vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
34310 @end defun
34311
34312 @defun swap-rows m r1 r2
34313 Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
34314 other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
34315 function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
34316 matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
34317 is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
34318 @var{m}.
34319 @end defun
34320
34321 @node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
34322 @subsubsection Symbolic Functions
34323
34324 @noindent
34325 The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
34326 Calculator.
34327
34328 @defun calc-prepare-selection num
34329 Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
34330 omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
34331 it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
34332 useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
34333 variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
34334 the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
34335 @code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
34336 list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
34337 as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
34338 a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
34339 which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
34340 their corresponding sub-formulas.
34341
34342 A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
34343 formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
34344 @samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
34345 other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
34346 appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
34347 @code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
34348 @code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
34349 replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
34350 @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
34351 plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
34352 user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
34353 entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
34354 is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
34355 these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
34356 @end defun
34357
34358 @defun calc-encase-atoms x
34359 This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
34360 formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
34361 described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
34362 the formula in-place.
34363 @end defun
34364
34365 @defun calc-find-selected-part
34366 Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
34367 the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
34368 called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
34369 formula, this returns @code{nil}.
34370 @end defun
34371
34372 @defun calc-change-current-selection selection
34373 Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
34374 @var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
34375 of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
34376 The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
34377 to reflect the new selection.
34378 @end defun
34379
34380 @defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
34381 Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
34382 by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
34383 sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
34384 is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
34385 @var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
34386 @end defun
34387
34388 @defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
34389 Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
34390 @var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
34391 is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
34392 will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
34393 sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
34394 @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
34395 This function does not take associativity into account.
34396 @end defun
34397
34398 @defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
34399 This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
34400 (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
34401 to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
34402 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
34403 return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
34404 return the whole expression.
34405 @end defun
34406
34407 @defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
34408 This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
34409 complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
34410 parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
34411 has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
34412 @end defun
34413
34414 @defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
34415 This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
34416 @var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
34417 @samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
34418 If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
34419 If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
34420 function does not take associativity into account.
34421 @end defun
34422
34423 @defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
34424 This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
34425 sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
34426 @end defun
34427
34428 @defun simplify expr
34429 Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying Calc's algebraic
34430 simplifications. This always returns a copy of the expression; the
34431 structure @var{expr} points to remains unchanged in memory.
34432
34433 More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
34434 first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
34435 @code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
34436 the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
34437 each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
34438 further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
34439 traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
34440 before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
34441 the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
34442 until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
34443 needed:@: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
34444 further simplifications were possible.
34445 @end defun
34446
34447 @defun simplify-extended expr
34448 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
34449 help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
34450 circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
34451 to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
34452 implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
34453 to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
34454 Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
34455 before taking any action.
34456 @end defun
34457
34458 @defun simplify-units expr
34459 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
34460 whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
34461 @code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
34462 @end defun
34463
34464 @defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
34465 Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
34466 form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
34467 (like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
34468 applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
34469 @var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
34470 functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
34471 function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
34472 executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
34473 the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
34474 if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
34475 ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
34476 If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
34477 substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
34478
34479 At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
34480 original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
34481 first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
34482 function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
34483 of the main @code{simplify} loop.
34484
34485 Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
34486 be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
34487 provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
34488 function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
34489
34490 The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
34491 before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
34492 list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
34493 allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
34494 convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
34495
34496 @smallexample
34497 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
34498 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
34499 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
34500 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
34501 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
34502 (or math-living-dangerously
34503 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
34504 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
34505 @end smallexample
34506
34507 This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
34508 for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
34509 @samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
34510 replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
34511 @end defmac
34512
34513 @defun common-constant-factor expr
34514 Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
34515 same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
34516 For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
34517 3 is a common factor of all the terms.
34518 @end defun
34519
34520 @defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
34521 Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
34522 divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
34523 destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
34524 it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
34525 allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
34526 square roots:
34527
34528 @smallexample
34529 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
34530 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
34531 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
34532 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
34533 (math-normalize
34534 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
34535 (math-cancel-common-factor
34536 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
34537 @end smallexample
34538 @end defun
34539
34540 @defun frac-gcd a b
34541 Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
34542 rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
34543 numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
34544 It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
34545 @code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
34546 @end defun
34547
34548 @defun map-tree func expr many
34549 Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
34550 @var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
34551 argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
34552 @var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
34553 @var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
34554 recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
34555 until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
34556 is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
34557 @var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
34558 @var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
34559 integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
34560 default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
34561 @end defun
34562
34563 @defun compile-rewrites rules
34564 Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
34565 be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
34566 the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
34567 for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
34568 with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
34569 message.
34570 @end defun
34571
34572 @defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
34573 Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
34574 @var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
34575 top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
34576 matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
34577 the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
34578 it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
34579 @var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
34580 rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
34581 @code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
34582 down to just a few rules in the rule set.
34583 @end defun
34584
34585 @defun rewrite-heads expr
34586 Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
34587 @code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
34588 @end defun
34589
34590 @defun rewrite expr rules many
34591 This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
34592 specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
34593 rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
34594 times.
34595 @end defun
34596
34597 @defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
34598 Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
34599 pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
34600 of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
34601 non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
34602 @end defun
34603
34604 @defun deriv expr var value symb
34605 Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
34606 (which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
34607 the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
34608 derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
34609 functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
34610 functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
34611 However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of nondifferentiable
34612 functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
34613 @code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
34614
34615 Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
34616 adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
34617 of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
34618 function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
34619 should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
34620 original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
34621 a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
34622 is defined by
34623
34624 @smallexample
34625 (put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
34626 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
34627 @end smallexample
34628
34629 The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
34630 @smallexample
34631 (put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
34632 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34633 (put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
34634 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34635 @end smallexample
34636 @end defun
34637
34638 @defun tderiv expr var value symb
34639 Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
34640 @code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
34641 assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
34642 @end defun
34643
34644 @defun integ expr var low high
34645 Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
34646 @xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34647 @end defun
34648
34649 @defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34650 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34651 this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34652 The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34653 with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34654 function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34655 variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34656 evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34657 should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34658 @var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34659 @code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34660
34661 @smallexample
34662 (math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34663 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34664 (and int
34665 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34666
34667 (math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34668 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34669 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34670 @end smallexample
34671
34672 In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34673 relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34674 cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34675 @code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34676 the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34677 result.
34678 @end defmac
34679
34680 @defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34681 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34682 This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34683 is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34684 @var{v}.
34685 @end defmac
34686
34687 @defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34688 Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34689 the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34690 side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34691 @var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34692 the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34693 different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34694 which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34695 If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34696 and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34697 as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34698
34699 @smallexample
34700 (put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34701 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34702 @end smallexample
34703
34704 This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34705 a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34706 @samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34707 variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34708 if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34709 @end defun
34710
34711 @defun solve-eqn expr var full
34712 This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34713 typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34714 interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34715 equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34716 @end defun
34717
34718 @defun solve-system exprs vars full
34719 This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34720 and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34721 @xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34722 @end defun
34723
34724 @defun expr-contains expr var
34725 Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34726 of @var{expr}.
34727
34728 This function might seem at first to be identical to
34729 @code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34730 @code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34731 @code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34732 @samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34733 @code{eq} to each other.
34734 @end defun
34735
34736 @defun expr-contains-count expr var
34737 Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34738 of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34739 @end defun
34740
34741 @defun expr-depends expr var
34742 Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34743 In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34744 in common.
34745 @end defun
34746
34747 @defun expr-contains-vars expr
34748 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34749 contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34750 @end defun
34751
34752 @defun expr-subst expr old new
34753 Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34754 by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34755 to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34756 @var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34757 @end defun
34758
34759 @defun multi-subst expr old new
34760 This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34761 are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34762 list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34763 are ignored.
34764 @end defun
34765
34766 @defun expr-weight expr
34767 Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34768 number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34769 ``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34770 @end defun
34771
34772 @defun expr-height expr
34773 Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34774 which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34775 counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34776 @end defun
34777
34778 @defun polynomial-p expr var
34779 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34780 @var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34781 highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34782 for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34783 @code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34784 (@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34785 appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34786 @var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34787 a polynomial of degree 0.
34788 @end defun
34789
34790 @defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34791 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34792 @var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34793 where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34794 @var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34795 list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34796 produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34797 be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34798 constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34799 if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34800 specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34801 value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34802 @samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34803 @var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34804 is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34805 @var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34806 themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34807 polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34808 x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34809 expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34810 @end defun
34811
34812 @defun polynomial-base expr pred
34813 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34814 if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34815 this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34816 be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34817 and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34818 the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34819 The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34820 you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34821 have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34822 is found.
34823 @end defun
34824
34825 @defun poly-simplify poly
34826 Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34827 clipping off trailing zeros.
34828 @end defun
34829
34830 @defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34831 Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34832 @code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34833 @var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34834 polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34835 @end defun
34836
34837 @defun poly-mul a b
34838 Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34839 result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34840 @end defun
34841
34842 @defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34843 Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34844 list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34845 (@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34846 expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34847 to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34848 @end defun
34849
34850 @defun check-unit-name var
34851 Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34852 name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34853 will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34854 prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34855 Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34856 for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34857 is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34858 @end defun
34859
34860 @defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34861 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34862 interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34863 expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34864 checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34865 @end defun
34866
34867 @defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34868 Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34869 return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34870 not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34871 two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
34872 @end defun
34873
34874 @defun to-standard-units expr which
34875 Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
34876 is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
34877 can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
34878 where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
34879 is an expression to substitute for it.
34880 @end defun
34881
34882 @defun remove-units expr
34883 Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
34884 This expression is generally normalized before use.
34885 @end defun
34886
34887 @defun extract-units expr
34888 Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
34889 by ones.
34890 @end defun
34891
34892 @node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
34893 @subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
34894
34895 @noindent
34896 The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
34897 Calc numbers and formulas.
34898
34899 @defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
34900 This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
34901 @xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
34902 @end defun
34903
34904 @defun read-number str
34905 If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
34906 fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
34907 number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
34908 @end defun
34909
34910 @defun read-expr str
34911 Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
34912 not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
34913 @samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
34914 into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
34915 a string describing the problem.
34916 @end defun
34917
34918 @defun read-exprs str
34919 Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
34920 Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
34921 shown above is returned instead.
34922 @end defun
34923
34924 @defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
34925 Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
34926 conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
34927 is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
34928 entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
34929 if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
34930 given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
34931 If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
34932 is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
34933 be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
34934 @code{calc-normalize} first.
34935
34936 To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
34937 @code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
34938 to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
34939 @code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
34940 will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
34941 that actually appeared in the input.
34942 @end defun
34943
34944 @defun format-number a
34945 Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
34946 @end defun
34947
34948 @defun format-flat-expr a prec
34949 Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
34950 in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
34951 This is a simple format designed
34952 mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
34953 @code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
34954 complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
34955 result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
34956 you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
34957 surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
34958 @end defun
34959
34960 @defun format-nice-expr a width
34961 This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
34962 except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
34963 specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
34964 rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
34965 command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
34966 @end defun
34967
34968 @defun format-value a width
34969 Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
34970 format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
34971 not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
34972 grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
34973 contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
34974 parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
34975 the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
34976 window is used.
34977 @end defun
34978
34979 @defun compose-expr a prec
34980 Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
34981 language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
34982 structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
34983 You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
34984 a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
34985 whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
34986 arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
34987 mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
34988 @code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
34989 In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
34990 tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
34991 or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
34992 normal function-call notation for that language.
34993 @end defun
34994
34995 @defun composition-to-string c w
34996 Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
34997 a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
34998 newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
34999 The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
35000 followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
35001 @end defun
35002
35003 @defun comp-width c
35004 Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
35005 @end defun
35006
35007 @defun comp-height c
35008 Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
35009 @end defun
35010
35011 @defun comp-ascent c
35012 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
35013 above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
35014 @end defun
35015
35016 @defun comp-descent c
35017 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
35018 the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
35019 @end defun
35020
35021 @defun comp-first-char c
35022 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
35023 (leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
35024 return @code{nil}.
35025 @end defun
35026
35027 @defun comp-last-char c
35028 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
35029 (rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
35030 @end defun
35031
35032 @comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
35033 @comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
35034 @comment
35035 @comment @noindent
35036 @comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
35037
35038 @node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
35039 @subsubsection Hooks
35040
35041 @noindent
35042 Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
35043 which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
35044 that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
35045 function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
35046 other customization-related variables are also described here.
35047
35048 @defvar calc-load-hook
35049 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
35050 been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
35051 @code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
35052 @end defvar
35053
35054 @defvar calc-ext-load-hook
35055 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
35056 @end defvar
35057
35058 @defvar calc-start-hook
35059 This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
35060 At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
35061 necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
35062 and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
35063 @end defvar
35064
35065 @defvar calc-mode-hook
35066 This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
35067 this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
35068 after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
35069 has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
35070 have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
35071 @code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
35072 evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
35073 been evaluated yet.
35074 @end defvar
35075
35076 @defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
35077 This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
35078 It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
35079 Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
35080 per Emacs session.
35081 @end defvar
35082
35083 @defvar calc-end-hook
35084 This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
35085 presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
35086 be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
35087 step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
35088 @end defvar
35089
35090 @defvar calc-window-hook
35091 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc window.
35092 Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
35093 (The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
35094 hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
35095 generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
35096 and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
35097 @end defvar
35098
35099 @defvar calc-trail-window-hook
35100 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc Trail
35101 window. The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
35102 which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook}, this hook
35103 must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
35104 @end defvar
35105
35106 @defvar calc-embedded-mode-hook
35107 This hook is called the first time that Embedded mode is entered.
35108 @end defvar
35109
35110 @defvar calc-embedded-new-buffer-hook
35111 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is entered in a
35112 new buffer.
35113 @end defvar
35114
35115 @defvar calc-embedded-new-formula-hook
35116 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is enabled for a
35117 new formula.
35118 @end defvar
35119
35120 @defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
35121 This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
35122 commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
35123 The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
35124 @code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
35125 text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
35126 @code{calc-edit} command.)
35127 @end defvar
35128
35129 @defvar calc-mode-save-hook
35130 This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
35131 after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
35132 Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
35133 message is inserted.
35134 @end defvar
35135
35136 @defvar calc-reset-hook
35137 This hook is called after @kbd{C-x * 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
35138 reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
35139 @end defvar
35140
35141 @defvar calc-other-modes
35142 This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
35143 concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
35144 mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
35145 ``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
35146 by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
35147 @end defvar
35148
35149 @defvar calc-mode-map
35150 This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
35151 to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
35152 Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
35153 loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
35154 which is a command that loads the extensions package and
35155 ``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
35156 one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
35157 extensions are loaded.
35158 @end defvar
35159
35160 @defvar calc-digit-map
35161 This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
35162 entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
35163 key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
35164 @code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
35165 @end defvar
35166
35167 @defvar calc-alg-ent-map
35168 This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
35169 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
35170 @end defvar
35171
35172 @defvar calc-store-var-map
35173 This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
35174 commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
35175 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
35176 @end defvar
35177
35178 @defvar calc-edit-mode-map
35179 This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
35180 temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
35181 and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
35182 @end defvar
35183
35184 @defvar calc-mode-var-list
35185 This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
35186 Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
35187 and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
35188 is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
35189 non-default variables are written out.
35190 @end defvar
35191
35192 @defvar calc-local-var-list
35193 This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
35194 Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
35195 These variables also have their default values manipulated by
35196 the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
35197 Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
35198 used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
35199 list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
35200 @end defvar
35201
35202 @node Copying, GNU Free Documentation License, Programming, Top
35203 @appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
35204 @include gpl.texi
35205
35206 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Customizing Calc, Copying, Top
35207 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
35208 @include doclicense.texi
35209
35210 @node Customizing Calc, Reporting Bugs, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
35211 @appendix Customizing Calc
35212
35213 The usual prefix for Calc is the key sequence @kbd{C-x *}. If you wish
35214 to use a different prefix, you can put
35215
35216 @example
35217 (global-set-key "NEWPREFIX" 'calc-dispatch)
35218 @end example
35219
35220 @noindent
35221 in your .emacs file.
35222 (@xref{Key Bindings,,Customizing Key Bindings,emacs,
35223 The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information on binding keys.)
35224 A convenient way to start Calc is with @kbd{C-x * *}; to make it equally
35225 convenient for users who use a different prefix, the prefix can be
35226 followed by @kbd{=}, @kbd{&}, @kbd{#}, @kbd{\}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{+} or
35227 @kbd{-} as well as @kbd{*} to start Calc, and so in many cases the last
35228 character of the prefix can simply be typed twice.
35229
35230 Calc is controlled by many variables, most of which can be reset
35231 from within Calc. Some variables are less involved with actual
35232 calculation and can be set outside of Calc using Emacs's
35233 customization facilities. These variables are listed below.
35234 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-variable RET @var{variable-name} RET}
35235 will bring up a buffer in which the variable's value can be redefined.
35236 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-group RET calc RET} will bring up a buffer which
35237 contains all of Calc's customizable variables. (These variables can
35238 also be reset by putting the appropriate lines in your .emacs file;
35239 @xref{Init File, ,Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
35240
35241 Some of the customizable variables are regular expressions. A regular
35242 expression is basically a pattern that Calc can search for.
35243 See @ref{Regexp Search,, Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}
35244 to see how regular expressions work.
35245
35246 @defvar calc-settings-file
35247 The variable @code{calc-settings-file} holds the file name in
35248 which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P} store ``permanent''
35249 definitions.
35250 If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user init file (typically
35251 @file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is
35252 @code{nil}, then Calc will automatically load your settings file (if it
35253 exists) the first time Calc is invoked.
35254
35255 The default value for this variable is @code{"~/.emacs.d/calc.el"}
35256 unless the file @file{~/.calc.el} exists, in which case the default
35257 value will be @code{"~/.calc.el"}.
35258 @end defvar
35259
35260 @defvar calc-gnuplot-name
35261 See @ref{Graphics}.@*
35262 The variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name} should be the name of the
35263 GNUPLOT program (a string). If you have GNUPLOT installed on your
35264 system but Calc is unable to find it, you may need to set this
35265 variable. You may also need to set some Lisp variables to show Calc how
35266 to run GNUPLOT on your system, see @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices} .
35267 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-name} is @code{"gnuplot"}.
35268 @end defvar
35269
35270 @defvar calc-gnuplot-plot-command
35271 @defvarx calc-gnuplot-print-command
35272 See @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices}.@*
35273 The variables @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
35274 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} represent system commands to
35275 display and print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
35276 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
35277 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
35278 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
35279 to display or print the output.
35280
35281 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} is @code{nil},
35282 and the default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} is
35283 @code{"lp %s"}.
35284 @end defvar
35285
35286 @defvar calc-language-alist
35287 See @ref{Basic Embedded Mode}.@*
35288 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} controls the languages that
35289 Calc will associate with major modes. When Calc embedded mode is
35290 enabled, it will try to use the current major mode to
35291 determine what language should be used. (This can be overridden using
35292 Calc's mode changing commands, @xref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
35293 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} consists of a list of pairs of
35294 the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} . @var{LANGUAGE})}; for example,
35295 @code{(latex-mode . latex)} is one such pair. If Calc embedded is
35296 activated in a buffer whose major mode is @var{MAJOR-MODE}, it will set itself
35297 to use the language @var{LANGUAGE}.
35298
35299 The default value of @code{calc-language-alist} is
35300 @example
35301 ((latex-mode . latex)
35302 (tex-mode . tex)
35303 (plain-tex-mode . tex)
35304 (context-mode . tex)
35305 (nroff-mode . eqn)
35306 (pascal-mode . pascal)
35307 (c-mode . c)
35308 (c++-mode . c)
35309 (fortran-mode . fortran)
35310 (f90-mode . fortran))
35311 @end example
35312 @end defvar
35313
35314 @defvar calc-embedded-announce-formula
35315 @defvarx calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist
35316 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35317 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} helps determine
35318 what formulas @kbd{C-x * a} will activate in a buffer. It is a
35319 regular expression, and when activating embedded formulas with
35320 @kbd{C-x * a}, it will tell Calc that what follows is a formula to be
35321 activated. (Calc also uses other patterns to find formulas, such as
35322 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=}.)
35323
35324 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which checks
35325 for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning with
35326 @samp{%} and a space.
35327
35328 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist} is used to
35329 set @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} to different regular
35330 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35331 It consists of a list of pairs of the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} .
35332 @var{REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35333 @example
35334 ((c++-mode . "//Embed\n\\(// .*\n\\)*")
35335 (c-mode . "/\\*Embed\\*/\n\\(/\\* .*\\*/\n\\)*")
35336 (f90-mode . "!Embed\n\\(! .*\n\\)*")
35337 (fortran-mode . "C Embed\n\\(C .*\n\\)*")
35338 (html-helper-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35339 (html-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35340 (nroff-mode . "\\\\\"Embed\n\\(\\\\\" .*\n\\)*")
35341 (pascal-mode . "@{Embed@}\n\\(@{.*@}\n\\)*")
35342 (sgml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35343 (xml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35344 (texinfo-mode . "@@c Embed\n\\(@@c .*\n\\)*"))
35345 @end example
35346 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35347 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35348 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35349 @end defvar
35350
35351 @defvar calc-embedded-open-formula
35352 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-formula
35353 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist
35354 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35355 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35356 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} control the region that Calc will
35357 activate as a formula when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * e}.
35358 They are regular expressions;
35359 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
35360 nearest text matching these regular expressions to be the ``formula
35361 delimiters''.
35362
35363 The simplest delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that
35364 Embedded mode understands by default are:
35365 @enumerate
35366 @item
35367 The @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
35368 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
35369 @item
35370 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
35371 @item
35372 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
35373 @item
35374 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
35375 @item
35376 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
35377 @end enumerate
35378
35379 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist} is used to
35380 set @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35381 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} to different regular
35382 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35383 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35384 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-FORMULA-REGEXP}
35385 @var{CLOSE-FORMULA-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35386 @code{nil}.
35387 @end defvar
35388
35389 @defvar calc-embedded-word-regexp
35390 @defvarx calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist
35391 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35392 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} determines the expression
35393 that Calc will activate when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x *
35394 w}. It is a regular expressions.
35395
35396 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} is
35397 @code{"[-+]?[0-9]+\\(\\.[0-9]+\\)?\\([eE][-+]?[0-9]+\\)?"}.
35398
35399 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist} is used to
35400 set @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} to a different regular
35401 expression depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35402 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35403 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{WORD-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35404 @code{nil}.
35405 @end defvar
35406
35407 @defvar calc-embedded-open-plain
35408 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-plain
35409 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist
35410 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35411 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35412 @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} are used to delimit ``plain''
35413 formulas. Note that these are actual strings, not regular
35414 expressions, because Calc must be able to write these string into a
35415 buffer as well as to recognize them.
35416
35417 The default string for @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} is
35418 @code{"%%% "}, note the trailing space. The default string for
35419 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} is @code{" %%%\n"}, without
35420 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
35421 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
35422
35423 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist} is used to
35424 set @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35425 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} to different strings
35426 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35427 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35428 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-PLAIN-STRING}
35429 @var{CLOSE-PLAIN-STRING})}, and its default value is
35430 @example
35431 ((c++-mode "// %% " " %%\n")
35432 (c-mode "/* %% " " %% */\n")
35433 (f90-mode "! %% " " %%\n")
35434 (fortran-mode "C %% " " %%\n")
35435 (html-helper-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35436 (html-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35437 (nroff-mode "\\\" %% " " %%\n")
35438 (pascal-mode "@{%% " " %%@}\n")
35439 (sgml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35440 (xml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35441 (texinfo-mode "@@c %% " " %%\n"))
35442 @end example
35443 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35444 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35445 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35446 @end defvar
35447
35448 @defvar calc-embedded-open-new-formula
35449 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-new-formula
35450 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist
35451 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35452 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35453 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} are strings which are
35454 inserted before and after a new formula when you type @kbd{C-x * f}.
35455
35456 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} is
35457 @code{"\n\n"}. If this string begins with a newline character and the
35458 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip
35459 this first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in the
35460 file. The default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} is
35461 also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by @w{@kbd{C-x * f}}
35462 if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if @kbd{C-x * f} is
35463 typed on a blank line, both a leading opening newline and a trailing
35464 closing newline are omitted.)
35465
35466 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist} is used to
35467 set @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35468 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} to different strings
35469 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35470 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35471 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-NEW-FORMULA-STRING}
35472 @var{CLOSE-NEW-FORMULA-STRING})}, and its default value is
35473 @code{nil}.
35474 @end defvar
35475
35476 @defvar calc-embedded-open-mode
35477 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-mode
35478 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist
35479 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35480 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35481 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} are strings which Calc will place before
35482 and after any mode annotations that it inserts. Calc never scans for
35483 these strings; Calc always looks for the annotation itself, so it is not
35484 necessary to add them to user-written annotations.
35485
35486 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} is @code{"% "}
35487 and the default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} is
35488 @code{"\n"}.
35489 If you change the value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode}, it is a good
35490 idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations will appear on
35491 lines by themselves.
35492
35493 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist} is used to
35494 set @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35495 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} to different strings
35496 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35497 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35498 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-MODE-STRING}
35499 @var{CLOSE-MODE-STRING})}, and its default value is
35500 @example
35501 ((c++-mode "// " "\n")
35502 (c-mode "/* " " */\n")
35503 (f90-mode "! " "\n")
35504 (fortran-mode "C " "\n")
35505 (html-helper-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35506 (html-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35507 (nroff-mode "\\\" " "\n")
35508 (pascal-mode "@{ " " @}\n")
35509 (sgml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35510 (xml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35511 (texinfo-mode "@@c " "\n"))
35512 @end example
35513 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}
35514 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35515 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}.
35516 @end defvar
35517
35518 @defvar calc-lu-power-reference
35519 @defvarx calc-lu-field-reference
35520 See @ref{Logarithmic Units}.@*
35521 The variables @code{calc-lu-power-reference} and
35522 @code{calc-lu-field-reference} are unit expressions (written as
35523 strings) which Calc will use as reference quantities for logarithmic
35524 units.
35525
35526 The default value of @code{calc-lu-power-reference} is @code{"mW"}
35527 and the default value of @code{calc-lu-field-reference} is
35528 @code{"20 uPa"}.
35529 @end defvar
35530
35531 @defvar calc-note-threshold
35532 See @ref{Musical Notes}.@*
35533 The variable @code{calc-note-threshold} is a number (written as a
35534 string) which determines how close (in cents) a frequency needs to be
35535 to a note to be recognized as that note.
35536
35537 The default value of @code{calc-note-threshold} is 1.
35538 @end defvar
35539
35540 @defvar calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
35541 @defvarx calc-selected-face
35542 @defvarx calc-nonselected-face
35543 See @ref{Displaying Selections}.@*
35544 The variable @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces}
35545 determines how selected sub-formulas are distinguished.
35546 If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is nil, then
35547 a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by changing every
35548 character not part of the sub-formula with a dot or by changing every
35549 character in the sub-formula with a @samp{#} sign.
35550 If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is t,
35551 then a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by displaying the
35552 non-selected portion of the formula with @code{calc-nonselected-face}
35553 or by displaying the selected sub-formula with
35554 @code{calc-nonselected-face}.
35555 @end defvar
35556
35557 @defvar calc-multiplication-has-precedence
35558 The variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} determines
35559 whether multiplication has precedence over division in algebraic
35560 formulas in normal language modes. If
35561 @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is non-@code{nil}, then
35562 multiplication has precedence (and, for certain obscure reasons, is
35563 right associative), and so for example @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted
35564 as @samp{a/(b*c)}. If @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is
35565 @code{nil}, then multiplication has the same precedence as division
35566 (and, like division, is left associative), and so for example
35567 @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{(a/b)*c}. The default value
35568 of @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{t}.
35569 @end defvar
35570
35571 @defvar calc-ensure-consistent-units
35572 When converting units, the variable @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units}
35573 determines whether or not the target units need to be consistent with the
35574 original units. If @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} is @code{nil}, then
35575 the target units don't need to have the same dimensions as the original units;
35576 for example, converting @samp{100 ft/s} to @samp{m} will produce @samp{30.48 m/s}.
35577 If @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} is non-@code{nil}, then the target units
35578 need to have the same dimensions as the original units; for example, converting
35579 @samp{100 ft/s} to @samp{m} will result in an error, since @samp{ft/s} and @samp{m}
35580 have different dimensions. The default value of @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units}
35581 is @code{nil}.
35582 @end defvar
35583
35584 @defvar calc-undo-length
35585 The variable @code{calc-undo-length} determines the number of undo
35586 steps that Calc will keep track of when @code{calc-quit} is called.
35587 If @code{calc-undo-length} is a non-negative integer, then this is the
35588 number of undo steps that will be preserved; if
35589 @code{calc-undo-length} has any other value, then all undo steps will
35590 be preserved. The default value of @code{calc-undo-length} is @expr{100}.
35591 @end defvar
35592
35593 @node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Customizing Calc, Top
35594 @appendix Reporting Bugs
35595
35596 @noindent
35597 If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
35598
35599 @example
35600 jay.p.belanger@@gmail.com
35601 @end example
35602
35603 @noindent
35604 There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
35605 you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
35606 line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
35607 send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
35608 reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
35609 regular mailbox.
35610
35611 If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, please send
35612 them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already top-heavy with
35613 features; this obviously cannot be the case, so if you have ideas, send
35614 them right in.
35615
35616 At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
35617 future work. If any enthusiastic souls wish to take it upon themselves
35618 to work on these, please send a message (using @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug})
35619 so any efforts can be coordinated.
35620
35621 The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
35622 repository. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
35623
35624 @c [summary]
35625 @node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
35626 @appendix Calc Summary
35627
35628 @noindent
35629 This section includes a complete list of Calc keystroke commands.
35630 Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
35631 last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
35632 and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
35633 The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
35634 Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
35635 command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
35636 command name refer to notes at the end.
35637
35638 Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
35639 keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
35640 @xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
35641
35642 @iftex
35643 @begingroup
35644 @tex
35645 \vskip-2\baselineskip \null
35646 \gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
35647 \gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
35648 \leavevmode%
35649 {\smallfonts
35650 \hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
35651 \hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
35652 \hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
35653 \hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
35654 \thinspace%
35655 {\tt#5}%
35656 {\sl#6}%
35657 }}%
35658 \gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
35659 \gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
35660 \gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
35661 \gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
35662 \gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
35663 \gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
35664 @end tex
35665 @let@:=@sumsep
35666 @let@r=@sumrow
35667 @catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
35668 @catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
35669 @catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
35670 @catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
35671 @end iftex
35672 @format
35673 @iftex
35674 @advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
35675 @let@c@sumbreak
35676 @end iftex
35677 @r{ @: C-x * a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
35678 @r{ @: C-x * b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
35679 @r{ @: C-x * c @: @: @:calc@:}
35680 @r{ @: C-x * d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
35681 @r{ @: C-x * e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
35682 @r{ @: C-x * f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
35683 @r{ @: C-x * g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
35684 @r{ @: C-x * i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35685 @r{ @: C-x * j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
35686 @r{ @: C-x * k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
35687 @r{ @: C-x * l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
35688 @r{ @: C-x * m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
35689 @r{ @: C-x * n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
35690 @r{ @: C-x * o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
35691 @r{ @: C-x * p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
35692 @r{ @: C-x * q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
35693 @r{ @: C-x * r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
35694 @r{ @: C-x * s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35695 @r{ @: C-x * t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35696 @r{ @: C-x * u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update-formula@:}
35697 @r{ @: C-x * w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
35698 @r{ @: C-x * x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35699 @r{ @: C-x * y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35700 @r{ @: C-x * z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
35701 @r{ @: C-x * : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
35702 @r{ @: C-x * _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
35703 @r{ @: C-x * ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
35704 @r{ @: C-x * 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
35705
35706 @c
35707 @r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
35708 @r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
35709 @r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
35710 @r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
35711 @r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@tfn{#}number}
35712 @r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
35713 @r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
35714 @r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35715 @r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35716
35717 @c
35718 @r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
35719 @r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
35720 @r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
35721
35722 @c
35723 @r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
35724 @r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
35725 @r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
35726 @r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
35727 @r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
35728 @r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
35729 @r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
35730 @r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
35731 @r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
35732 @r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
35733 @r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
35734 @r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
35735 @r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
35736 @r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
35737 @r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
35738 @r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
35739 @r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
35740
35741 @c
35742 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35743 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35744 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
35745 @r{. a b c@: M-@summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
35746 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
35747 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35748 @r{... a b@: M-@summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
35749 @r{ @: M-@summarykey{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
35750 @r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
35751
35752 @c
35753 @r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35754 @r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
35755 @r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
35756 @r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
35757 @r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35758 @r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
35759 @r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
35760
35761 @c
35762 @r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
35763 @r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
35764 @r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
35765 @r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
35766 @r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
35767 @r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
35768 @r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
35769
35770 @c
35771 @r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
35772 @r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
35773 @r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
35774 @r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
35775 @r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
35776 @r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
35777
35778 @c
35779 @r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
35780 @r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
35781 @r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
35782 @r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35783 @r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
35784 @r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
35785 @r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35786
35787 @c
35788 @r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
35789 @r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
35790 @r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35791 @r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
35792 @r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
35793 @r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
35794 @r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
35795 @r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
35796 @r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
35797 @r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
35798 @r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
35799 @r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
35800 @r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
35801 @r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
35802 @r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
35803 @r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
35804 @r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
35805 @r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
35806 @r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
35807 @r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
35808 @r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
35809 @r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
35810 @r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
35811 @r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
35812 @r{ @: O @:command @: 32 @:@:Option}
35813 @r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
35814 @r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
35815 @r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
35816 @r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
35817 @r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
35818 @r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35819 @r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
35820 @r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
35821 @r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
35822 @r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
35823 @r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
35824 @r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
35825 @r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
35826 @r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
35827 @r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
35828 @r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
35829 @r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
35830 @r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
35831 @r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35832 @r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
35833
35834 @c
35835 @r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
35836 @r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
35837 @r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
35838 @r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
35839 @r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
35840 @r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
35841 @r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
35842 @r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
35843 @r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
35844 @r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
35845 @r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
35846 @r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
35847 @r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
35848
35849 @c
35850 @r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35851 @r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35852 @r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
35853 @r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
35854
35855 @c
35856 @r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
35857 @r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
35858 @r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
35859 @r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
35860
35861 @c
35862 @r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
35863 @r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
35864 @r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
35865 @r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
35866 @r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
35867 @r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
35868 @r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
35869 @r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
35870 @r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
35871 @r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
35872 @r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
35873 @r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
35874 @r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
35875 @r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
35876 @r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
35877 @r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
35878 @r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
35879 @r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
35880 @r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
35881 @r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
35882
35883 @c
35884 @r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35885 @r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35886 @r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35887 @r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
35888 @r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
35889 @r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
35890 @r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
35891 @r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
35892 @r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
35893 @r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
35894 @r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
35895 @r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
35896 @r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
35897 @r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
35898 @r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
35899 @r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
35900 @r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
35901 @r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
35902 @r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
35903
35904 @c
35905 @r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
35906 @r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
35907 @r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
35908 @r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35909 @r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35910 @r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
35911 @r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
35912 @r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
35913 @r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35914 @r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35915 @r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35916 @r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35917 @r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
35918 @r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
35919 @r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
35920
35921 @c
35922 @r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
35923 @r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
35924 @r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
35925 @r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
35926 @r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
35927 @r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
35928 @r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35929 @r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35930 @r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
35931 @r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
35932 @r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
35933 @r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
35934 @r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
35935 @r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
35936 @r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
35937 @r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
35938 @r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35939 @r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35940 @r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
35941 @r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
35942 @r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
35943 @r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
35944 @r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
35945
35946 @r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
35947 @r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
35948 @r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
35949 @r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
35950
35951 @c
35952 @r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35953 @r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35954 @r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
35955 @r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
35956 @r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
35957 @r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
35958 @r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
35959 @r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
35960 @r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
35961 @r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
35962 @r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
35963
35964 @c
35965 @r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
35966 @r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
35967
35968 @c
35969 @r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
35970
35971 @c
35972 @r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
35973 @r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
35974 @r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
35975 @r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
35976 @r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
35977 @r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
35978 @r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
35979 @r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
35980 @r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
35981 @r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
35982 @r{ @: d @summarykey{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
35983 @r{ @: d @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
35984
35985 @c
35986 @r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
35987 @r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
35988 @r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
35989 @r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
35990
35991 @c
35992 @r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
35993 @r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
35994 @r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
35995 @r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
35996 @r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
35997 @r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
35998 @r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
35999 @r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
36000 @r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
36001 @r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
36002 @r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
36003 @r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
36004 @r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
36005 @r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
36006 @r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
36007 @r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
36008 @r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
36009 @r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
36010
36011 @c
36012 @r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
36013 @r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
36014 @r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
36015 @r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
36016 @r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
36017 @r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
36018 @r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
36019 @r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
36020 @r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
36021 @r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
36022 @r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
36023 @r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
36024
36025 @c
36026 @r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
36027 @r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
36028
36029 @c
36030 @r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
36031 @r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
36032 @r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
36033 @r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
36034 @r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
36035 @r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
36036 @r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
36037 @r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
36038 @r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
36039 @r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
36040 @r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
36041 @r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
36042
36043 @c
36044 @r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
36045 @r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
36046 @r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
36047 @r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
36048 @r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
36049 @r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
36050 @r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
36051 @r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
36052 @r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
36053 @r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
36054 @r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
36055 @r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
36056 @r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
36057 @r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
36058 @r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
36059 @r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
36060 @r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
36061
36062 @c
36063 @r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
36064 @r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
36065 @r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
36066 @r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
36067 @r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
36068 @r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
36069 @r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
36070 @r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
36071 @r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
36072 @r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
36073 @r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
36074 @r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
36075 @r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
36076 @r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
36077 @r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
36078 @r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
36079 @r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
36080 @r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
36081 @r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
36082
36083 @c
36084 @r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
36085 @r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
36086 @r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
36087 @r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
36088 @r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
36089 @r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
36090 @r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
36091 @r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
36092 @r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
36093 @r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
36094 @r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
36095 @r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
36096 @r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
36097 @r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
36098 @r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
36099 @r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
36100
36101 @c
36102 @r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
36103 @r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
36104 @r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
36105
36106 @c
36107 @r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
36108 @r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
36109 @r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
36110 @r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
36111 @r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
36112 @r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
36113 @r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
36114 @r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
36115 @r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
36116 @r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
36117
36118 @c
36119 @r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
36120 @r{ @: j @summarykey{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
36121 @r{ @: j @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
36122 @r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
36123 @r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
36124 @r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
36125
36126 @c
36127 @r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
36128 @r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
36129 @r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
36130 @r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
36131 @r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
36132
36133 @c
36134 @r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
36135 @r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
36136 @r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
36137 @r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
36138 @r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
36139 @r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
36140 @r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
36141 @r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
36142 @r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
36143 @r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
36144 @r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
36145 @r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
36146 @r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
36147 @r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
36148
36149 @c
36150 @r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
36151 @r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
36152 @r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
36153 @r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
36154 @r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
36155 @r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
36156 @r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
36157 @r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
36158 @r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
36159 @r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
36160 @r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
36161 @r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
36162
36163 @c
36164 @r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
36165 @r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
36166 @r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
36167 @r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
36168 @r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
36169 @r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
36170 @r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
36171 @r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
36172 @r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
36173 @r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
36174 @r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
36175 @r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
36176 @r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
36177 @r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
36178 @r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
36179 @r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
36180 @r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
36181 @r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
36182 @r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
36183 @r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
36184
36185 @c
36186 @r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
36187 @r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
36188 @r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
36189 @r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
36190 @r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
36191 @r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36192 @r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36193 @r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
36194 @r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
36195 @r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
36196 @r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
36197 @r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
36198 @r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
36199
36200 @c
36201 @r{ a b@: l + @: @: @:lupadd@:(a,b)}
36202 @r{ a b@: H l + @: @: @:lufadd@:(a,b)}
36203 @r{ a b@: l - @: @: @:lupsub@:(a,b)}
36204 @r{ a b@: H l - @: @: @:lufsub@:(a,b)}
36205 @r{ a b@: l * @: @: @:lupmul@:(a,b)}
36206 @r{ a b@: H l * @: @: @:lufmul@:(a,b)}
36207 @r{ a b@: l / @: @: @:lupdiv@:(a,b)}
36208 @r{ a b@: H l / @: @: @:lufdiv@:(a,b)}
36209 @r{ a@: l d @: @: @:dbpower@:(a)}
36210 @r{ a b@: O l d @: @: @:dbpower@:(a,b)}
36211 @r{ a@: H l d @: @: @:dbfield@:(a)}
36212 @r{ a b@: O H l d @: @: @:dbfield@:(a,b)}
36213 @r{ a@: l n @: @: @:nppower@:(a)}
36214 @r{ a b@: O l n @: @: @:nppower@:(a,b)}
36215 @r{ a@: H l n @: @: @:npfield@:(a)}
36216 @r{ a b@: O H l n @: @: @:npfield@:(a,b)}
36217 @r{ a@: l q @: @: @:lupquant@:(a)}
36218 @r{ a b@: O l q @: @: @:lupquant@:(a,b)}
36219 @r{ a@: H l q @: @: @:lufquant@:(a)}
36220 @r{ a b@: O H l q @: @: @:lufquant@:(a,b)}
36221 @r{ a@: l s @: @: @:spn@:(a)}
36222 @r{ a@: l m @: @: @:midi@:(a)}
36223 @r{ a@: l f @: @: @:freq@:(a)}
36224
36225 @c
36226 @r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
36227 @r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
36228 @r{ @: m e @: @: @:calc-embedded-preserve-modes@:}
36229 @r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
36230 @r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
36231 @r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
36232 @r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
36233 @r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
36234 @r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
36235 @r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
36236 @r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
36237 @r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
36238 @r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
36239 @r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
36240 @r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
36241
36242 @c
36243 @r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
36244 @r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
36245 @r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
36246 @r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
36247 @r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
36248 @r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
36249 @r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
36250 @r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
36251 @r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
36252 @r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
36253 @r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
36254
36255 @c
36256 @r{ @: r s @:register @: 27 @:calc-copy-to-register@:}
36257 @r{ @: r i @:register @: @:calc-insert-register@:}
36258
36259 @c
36260 @r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
36261 @r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
36262 @r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
36263 @r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
36264 @r{ @: s k @:const, var @: 29 @:calc-copy-special-constant@:}
36265 @r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
36266 @r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
36267 @r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
36268 @r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
36269 @r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
36270 @r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
36271 @r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
36272 @r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
36273 @r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
36274 @r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
36275 @r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
36276 @r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
36277
36278 @c
36279 @r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
36280 @r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
36281 @r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
36282 @r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
36283 @r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
36284 @r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
36285 @r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
36286 @r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
36287 @r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
36288 @r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
36289 @r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
36290 @r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
36291 @r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
36292
36293 @c
36294 @r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
36295 @r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
36296 @r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
36297 @r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
36298 @r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
36299 @r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
36300 @r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
36301 @r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
36302 @r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
36303 @r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @tfn{:=} b}
36304 @r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @tfn{=>}}
36305
36306 @c
36307 @r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
36308 @r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
36309 @r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
36310 @r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
36311 @r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
36312
36313 @c
36314 @r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
36315 @r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
36316 @r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
36317 @r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
36318 @r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
36319 @r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
36320 @r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
36321 @r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
36322 @r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
36323 @r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
36324 @r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
36325 @r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
36326 @r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
36327
36328 @c
36329 @r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36330 @r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36331 @r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
36332 @r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
36333 @r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
36334 @r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
36335 @r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
36336 @r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
36337 @r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
36338 @r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
36339 @r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
36340 @r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
36341 @r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
36342 @r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
36343 @r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
36344 @r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
36345 @r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
36346 @r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
36347 @r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
36348
36349 @c
36350 @r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
36351 @r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
36352
36353 @c
36354 @r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
36355 @r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
36356 @r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
36357 @r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
36358 @r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
36359 @r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
36360 @r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
36361 @r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
36362 @r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
36363 @r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
36364 @r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
36365 @r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
36366 @r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
36367 @r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
36368
36369 @c
36370 @r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
36371 @r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
36372 @r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
36373 @r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
36374 @r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
36375 @r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
36376 @r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
36377 @r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
36378 @r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
36379 @r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
36380 @r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
36381 @r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
36382 @r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
36383 @r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
36384 @r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
36385 @r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
36386
36387 @c
36388 @r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
36389 @r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
36390 @r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
36391
36392 @c
36393 @r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
36394 @r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
36395 @r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
36396 @r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
36397 @r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
36398 @r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
36399 @r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
36400 @r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
36401 @r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
36402 @r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
36403
36404 @c
36405 @r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
36406 @r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
36407 @r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
36408 @r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
36409 @r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
36410 @r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
36411
36412 @c
36413 @r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
36414
36415 @c
36416 @r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
36417 @r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
36418 @r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
36419 @r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
36420 @r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36421 @r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
36422 @r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
36423 @r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
36424 @r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
36425 @r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
36426 @r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
36427 @r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
36428 @r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
36429 @r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
36430 @r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
36431 @r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
36432 @r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
36433 @r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
36434 @r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
36435 @r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
36436 @r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
36437 @r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
36438 @r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
36439 @r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
36440 @r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36441 @r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
36442 @r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
36443 @r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
36444 @r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
36445 @r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
36446 @r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
36447 @r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
36448
36449 @c
36450 @r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
36451 @r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
36452 @r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
36453 @r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
36454 @r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
36455 @r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
36456 @r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
36457 @r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
36458 @r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
36459 @r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
36460 @r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
36461 @r{ m1 m2@: V K @: @: @:kron@:(m1,m2)}
36462 @r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
36463 @r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
36464 @r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
36465 @r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
36466 @r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
36467 @r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
36468 @r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
36469 @r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
36470 @r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
36471 @r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
36472 @r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
36473 @r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
36474 @r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
36475 @r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
36476 @r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
36477 @r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
36478 @r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
36479
36480 @c
36481 @r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
36482
36483 @c
36484 @r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
36485
36486 @c
36487 @r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
36488 @r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
36489 @r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
36490 @r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
36491
36492 @c
36493 @r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
36494 @r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
36495 @r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
36496 @r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
36497 @r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
36498 @r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
36499 @r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
36500
36501 @c
36502 @r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
36503
36504 @c
36505 @r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
36506 @r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
36507 @r{ @: Z # @: @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
36508
36509 @c
36510 @r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
36511 @r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
36512 @r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
36513 @r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
36514 @r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
36515 @r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
36516 @r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
36517 @r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
36518 @r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
36519 @r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
36520 @r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
36521
36522 @end format
36523
36524 @noindent
36525 NOTES
36526
36527 @enumerate
36528 @c 1
36529 @item
36530 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36531 Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
36532 A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
36533 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
36534
36535 @c 2
36536 @item
36537 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36538 Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
36539 and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
36540
36541 @c 3
36542 @item
36543 Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
36544 Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
36545 A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
36546
36547 @c 4
36548 @item
36549 Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
36550
36551 @c 5
36552 @item
36553 Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
36554 Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
36555
36556 @c 6
36557 @item
36558 A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
36559 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
36560
36561 @c 7
36562 @item
36563 A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
36564 1=Basic simplifications, 2=Algebraic simplifications, 3=Extended simplifications
36565
36566 @c 8
36567 @item
36568 A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
36569
36570 @c 9
36571 @item
36572 Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
36573 Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
36574
36575 @c 10
36576 @item
36577 Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
36578 cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
36579
36580 @c 11
36581 @item
36582 From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
36583
36584 @c 12
36585 @item
36586 Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
36587 prefix always clears the mode.
36588
36589 @c 13
36590 @item
36591 Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
36592
36593 @c 14
36594 @item
36595 A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
36596 @expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
36597 @iftex
36598 {@advance@tableindent10pt
36599 @end iftex
36600 @table @asis
36601 @item Integer
36602 Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36603 @item Float
36604 Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36605 @item 0.0
36606 Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
36607 @item Error form
36608 Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
36609 @item Interval
36610 Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
36611 @item Vector
36612 Random element from the vector.
36613 @end table
36614 @iftex
36615 }
36616 @end iftex
36617
36618 @c 15
36619 @item
36620 A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
36621 to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
36622
36623 @c 16
36624 @item
36625 A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
36626 time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
36627
36628 @c 17
36629 @item
36630 A prefix argument specifies a day number (0-6, 0-31, or 0-366).
36631
36632 @c 18
36633 @item
36634 If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
36635 the new units.
36636
36637 @c 19
36638 @item
36639 With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
36640 input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
36641
36642 @c 20
36643 @item
36644 With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
36645 @texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
36646 @infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
36647 matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
36648
36649 @c 21
36650 @item
36651 The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
36652 argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
36653 from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
36654 a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
36655
36656 @c 22
36657 @item
36658 The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
36659 desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
36660 or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
36661 @kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
36662 be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
36663 may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
36664 last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
36665 prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
36666 stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
36667
36668 @c 23
36669 @item
36670 One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
36671 by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
36672 reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
36673 entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
36674 @code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
36675 or @code{d} for ``down.''
36676
36677 @c 24
36678 @item
36679 The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
36680 is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
36681 (for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
36682 prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
36683 may be an integer or a vector of integers.
36684 @iftex
36685 {@advance@tableindent-20pt
36686 @end iftex
36687 @table @cite
36688 @item -1
36689 (@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
36690 @item -2
36691 (@var{2}) Polar complex number.
36692 @item -3
36693 (@var{3}) HMS form.
36694 @item -4
36695 (@var{2}) Error form.
36696 @item -5
36697 (@var{2}) Modulo form.
36698 @item -6
36699 (@var{2}) Closed interval.
36700 @item -7
36701 (@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
36702 @item -8
36703 (@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
36704 @item -9
36705 (@var{2}) Open interval.
36706 @item -10
36707 (@var{2}) Fraction.
36708 @item -11
36709 (@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
36710 @item -12
36711 (@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
36712 @item -13
36713 (@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
36714 @item -14
36715 (@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
36716 @item -15
36717 (@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
36718 @end table
36719 @iftex
36720 }
36721 @end iftex
36722
36723 @c 25
36724 @item
36725 A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
36726 prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
36727 the input vector.
36728
36729 @c 26
36730 @item
36731 The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
36732
36733 @c 27
36734 @item
36735 Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
36736
36737 @c 28
36738 @item
36739 Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
36740
36741 @c 29
36742 @item
36743 Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
36744
36745 @c 30
36746 @item
36747 Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
36748 @key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
36749 buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
36750 of the result of the edit.
36751
36752 @c 31
36753 @item
36754 The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
36755
36756 @c 32
36757 @item
36758 Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
36759
36760 @c 33
36761 @item
36762 With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
36763 prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
36764
36765 @c 34
36766 @item
36767 Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
36768 prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
36769 non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
36770 backward by that many lines.
36771
36772 @c 35
36773 @item
36774 Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
36775 parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
36776 parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
36777 region between point and mark as a single formula.
36778
36779 @c 36
36780 @item
36781 Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
36782 prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
36783 A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
36784 prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
36785
36786 @c 37
36787 @item
36788 A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
36789
36790 @c 38
36791 @item
36792 Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
36793 later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
36794
36795 @c 39
36796 @item
36797 Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
36798 @expr{v - v_0}.
36799
36800 @c 40
36801 @item
36802 With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
36803 common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
36804 @expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
36805 contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
36806 @expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
36807
36808 @c 41
36809 @item
36810 With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
36811
36812 @c 42
36813 @item
36814 With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
36815 With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
36816
36817 @c 43
36818 @item
36819 With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
36820 value for this graph.
36821
36822 @c 44
36823 @item
36824 With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
36825
36826 @c 45
36827 @item
36828 Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
36829 number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
36830 otherwise.
36831
36832 @c 46
36833 @item
36834 Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
36835 entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
36836 delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
36837 in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
36838 stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
36839 causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
36840 of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
36841 to evaluate variables.
36842
36843 @c 47
36844 @item
36845 The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
36846 Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
36847 assigns
36848 @texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
36849 @infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
36850
36851 @c 48
36852 @item
36853 Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
36854 variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
36855 independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
36856 takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
36857 and a vector from the stack.
36858
36859 @c 49
36860 @item
36861 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
36862 destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
36863
36864 @c 50
36865 @item
36866 All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
36867 The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
36868 entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
36869
36870 @c 51
36871 @item
36872 A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
36873 default 2D resolution.
36874
36875 @c 52
36876 @item
36877 This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
36878 @var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
36879 @var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
36880 grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
36881 @end enumerate
36882
36883 @iftex
36884 (Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
36885 @page
36886 @endgroup
36887 @end iftex
36888
36889
36890 @c [end-summary]
36891
36892 @node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
36893 @unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
36894
36895 @printindex ky
36896
36897 @node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
36898 @unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
36899
36900 Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
36901 @kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
36902 types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
36903 @kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
36904
36905 @printindex pg
36906
36907 @node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
36908 @unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
36909
36910 This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
36911 expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
36912 @samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
36913 @iftex
36914 All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
36915 Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
36916 @end iftex
36917
36918 @printindex tp
36919
36920 @node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
36921 @unnumbered Concept Index
36922
36923 @printindex cp
36924
36925 @node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
36926 @unnumbered Index of Variables
36927
36928 The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
36929 as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
36930 corresponding Lisp variable.
36931
36932 The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
36933 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
36934
36935 @printindex vr
36936
36937 @node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
36938 @unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
36939
36940 The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
36941 @code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
36942 the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
36943 @samp{math-}.
36944
36945 @printindex fn
36946
36947 @bye